0% found this document useful (0 votes)
182 views159 pages

أخبار الزمان-المسعودي

The document is an introduction to a book titled "Akhbar Al-Zaman" by Ali ibn al-Husayn al-Mas'udi. It begins with praise of God and blessings upon the prophet Muhammad. It states that the book will discuss natural phenomena, human societies, rulers and their accomplishments, innovations, buildings and artifacts as reported to the author. It will begin with Islamic traditions and teachings of early philosophers, with God's help. The creation of humanity by God is discussed, with the purpose being to worship Him so He may bless them and they praise Him.
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
182 views159 pages

أخبار الزمان-المسعودي

The document is an introduction to a book titled "Akhbar Al-Zaman" by Ali ibn al-Husayn al-Mas'udi. It begins with praise of God and blessings upon the prophet Muhammad. It states that the book will discuss natural phenomena, human societies, rulers and their accomplishments, innovations, buildings and artifacts as reported to the author. It will begin with Islamic traditions and teachings of early philosophers, with God's help. The creation of humanity by God is discussed, with the purpose being to worship Him so He may bless them and they praise Him.
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 159

‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‬

‫ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬

‫‪To PDF: www.al-mostafa.com‬‬

‫‪1‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺩﻤﺔ‬

‫ﺑﺴﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ‬


‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺣﺴﺒﻨﺎ ﻭﻧﻌﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﻛﻴﻞ‬
‫"ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺦ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺍﳊﺴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳊﺴﲔ ﺑﻦ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﺍﳍﺬﱄ ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ ﺭﲪﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺭﺿﻲ ﻋﻨﻪ "‬
‫ﻧﺒﺘﺪﺉ ﲝﻤﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻭﺷﻜﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻨﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻜﺮ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻧﺒﻴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﻭﻣﻼﺋﻜﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳔﺺ‬
‫ﺳﻴﺪﻧﺎ ﻭﻧﺒﻴﻨﺎ ﳏﻤﺪﺍﹰ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﻟﻪ ﻭﺃﺯﻭﺍﺟﻪ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﺑﺄﻓﻀﻞ ﺻﻠﻮﺍﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﻤﻞ ﲢﻴﺎﺗﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺯﻛﻰ ﺑﺮﻛﺎﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﺎﺋﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﳑﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺸﺎﻛﻼ ﻟﻘﺼﺪﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺐ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ؛ ﻭﺷﻴﺪﻭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻭﺻﻔﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻄﺮﻓﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻼﲰﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺩﻋﻮﻩ ﻧﻮﺍﺳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﻩ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺠﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ .‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻧﺒﺪﺃ ﲟﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻋﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻠﺔ ﺍﳊﻨﻴﻔﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﺭﻭﻱ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺍﳌﺘﻘﺪﻣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﷲ‬
‫ﺃﺳﺘﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺣﺴﱯ ﻭﻧﻌﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﻛﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﲰﻴﺖ ﻛﺘﺎﰊ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ "ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﳊﺪﺛﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﺎﺀ ﻭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ" ﻓﺄﻧﺎ ﺃﻗﻮﻝ‪" :‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ" ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺟﻞ ﺟﻼﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺪﺳﺖ ﺃﲰﺎﺅﻩ‪ ،‬ﺧﻠﻖ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺓ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺧﻠﻘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺸﺄﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺇﻧﺸﺎﺋﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﺑﻞ ﺧﻠﻘﻬﻢ ﻟﻴﻌﺒﺪﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺠﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺑﻨﻌﻤﻪ‬
‫ﻭﳛﻤﺪﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺰﻳﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﻠﻪ ﻓﻴﺸﻜﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﳝﺠﺪﻭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ " ﻭﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻘﺖ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺍﻻﻧﺲ ﺇﻻ ﻟﻴﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺯﻕ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻄﻌﻤﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﺯﺍﻕ ﺫﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺓ ﺍﳌﺘﲔ" ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﺩﻩ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﺇﻳﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﺇﳚﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻣﺜﻘﺎﻝ ﺫﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻨﻘﺼﻪ ﺇﻓﻨﺎﺅﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻭﺇﻋﺪﺍﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺯﻥ ﺷﻌﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻻ ﺗﻐﲑﻩ ﺍﻷﺣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻪ ﺍﳌﻼﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﺘﻘﺎﺿﻰ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻴﺎﻝ‪ .‬ﺑﻞ ﺧﺼﻬﻢ ﺑﺄﲰﺎﻉ ﻭﺃﺑﺼﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻘﻮﻝ ﻭﺃﻓﻜﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﻳﺼﻠﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳊﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺎﻃﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﻓﻊ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻀﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺴﺎﻃﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺴﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺒﻼﹰ ﻓﺠﺎﺟﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺳﻘﻔﺎﹰ ﳏﻔﻮﻇﺎﹰ‪.‬ﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺚ ﺍﳌﺪﺭﺍﺭ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺯﺍﻕ ﲟﻘﺪﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﴰﺲ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﻳﺘﻌﺎﻗﺒﺎﻥ ﳌﺼﺎﳊﻬﻢ ﺩﺍﺋﺒﲔ‪.‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺳﻜﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﻣﻌﺎﺷﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﳏﺎ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﻣﺒﺼﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻟﻴﺼﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﺄﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﻓﺮﻭﺿﻬﻢ‬

‫‪2‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﻓﺮﺿﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻛﺎﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﳊﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﲔ ﲢﻞ‬
‫ﺩﻳﻮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲡﺐ ﺣﻘﻮﻗﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻭﻋﻼ‪ ":‬ﻳﺴﺄﻟﻮﻧﻚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻷﻫﻠﺔ ﻗﻞ ﻫﻲ ﻣﻮﺍﻗﻴﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﳊﺞ" ﻭﻗﺎﻝ " ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺿﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﻗﺪﺭﻩ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﻟﺘﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺎﳊﻖ"‬
‫ﺇﻧﻌﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻃﻮﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺣﺴﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻓﻀﻼ‪.‬‬
‫ﺭﻭﻯ ﺳﻌﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺟﺒﲑ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ‪":‬ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﲨﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻊ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺪ ﻣﻀﺖ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﻭﻣﺌﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺄﺗﲔ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺌﻮﻥ ﻟﻴﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺣﺪ ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻦ ﻧﺎﻓﻊ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﲰﻌﺖ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ " ﺇﳕﺎ ﺃﺟﻠﻜﻢ ﰲ ﺁﺟﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺻﻼﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻏﺮﻭﺏ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻦ ﺃﰊ ﻫﺮﻳﺮﺓ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ " ﺑﻌﺜﺖ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ ﻛﻬﺎﺗﲔ "ﻭ ﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺒﺎﺑﺔ ﻭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻄﻰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﺳﻬﻞ ﺑﻦ ﺳﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺪﻱ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ " ﻣﺎ ﻣﺜﻠﻲ ﻭﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﻛﻔﺮﺳﻲ ﺭﻫﺎﻥ "‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ ﻗﺎﻝ " ﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ " ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻢ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ‬
‫ﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻋﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺯﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺡ ﺍﶈﻔﻮﻅ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺭﺓ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﺣﺎﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﺃﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻋﺮﺿﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﺧﻠﻘﻬﻤﺎﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﻖ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻠﻘﻠﻢ ﺍﻛﺘﺐ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻛﺘﺐ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺃﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻤﻲ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻘﻲ ﺍﻟﻯﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻢ ﲟﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻛﺎﺋﻦ ﺍﱃ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﷲ‪،‬‬
‫ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺡ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﻧﻈﺮﺓ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﻧﻈﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﺨﻠﻖ ﻭﻳﺮﺯﻕ ﻭﳛﻴﻲ ﻭﳝﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﺸﺎﺀ ﻭﳛﻜﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺌﻞ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ :‬ﺃﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺑﻨﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﻖ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ "‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻋﻤﺎﺀ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﻫﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﻣﺎ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻫﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻋﺮﺷﻪ ﻋﻠﻯﺎﳌﺎﺀ"‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺳﺌﻞ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ " ﻋﻠﻯﺄﻱ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﱳ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﻱ ﺟﻞ ﺟﻼﻟﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﻖ‬
‫ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﺳﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻄﻔﺖ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﺟﻪ ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﺯﺑﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻼ ﺩﺧﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻌﺪ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﲰﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﻤﺎﻩ ﺍﷲ ﲰﺎﺀ ﻭﲨﺪ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺪ ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺃﺭﺿﺄﹰ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻮﺕ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ"ﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻠﻢ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﻄﺮﻭﻥ "ﻭﺍﳊﻮﺕ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﺮ ﺻﻔﺎﺓ؛ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻔﺎﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﱳ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺘﺰﻟﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﺝ ﻓﺄﺭﺳﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻻﹰ ﺟﺎﻣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻘﺮﺕ ﻭﺛﺒﺘﺖ ﻓﺬﻟﻚ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‬

‫‪3‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫"ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﺳﻲ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ"‪" ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺭﻭﺍﺳﻲ ﺃﻥ ﲤﻴﺪ ﺑﻜﻢ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ‪ :‬ﺍﺗﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﺀ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ " ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺣﺪ ﻭﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻻﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﻓﻊ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺎﺀ ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻭ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻌﺎﺀ ﻓﺬﻟﻚ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺟﻠﺖ ﻗﺪﺭﺗﻪ" ﻗﻞ ﺃﺋﻨﻜﻢ ﻟﺘﻜﻔﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﰲ ﻳﻮﻣﲔ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺳﻮﺍﺀ ﻟﻠﺴﺎﺋﻠﲔ" ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳋﻤﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳉﻤﻌﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‪ :‬ﰒ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ ﻳﺎ ﳏﻤﺪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﰒ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺵ‪،‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻟﻮ‪ :‬ﻗﺪ ﺃﺻﺒﺖ ‪ ،‬ﻟﻮ ﺃﲤﻤﺖ ﻭﻗﻠﺖ ﰒ ﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺡ‪ .‬ﻓﻐﻀﺐ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻏﻀﺒﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ "ﻭﻟﻘﺪ ﺧﻠﻘﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﰲ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻣﺴﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻐﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺻﱪ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻲ ﺭﻭﺍﻳﺔ ﺃﺳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻗﺎﻝ" ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﺒﺎﺭﻙ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻭﺗﺴﻤﻮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻨﺒﺴﻂ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﻓﺎﻧﺒﺴﻄﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺣﺎﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﷲ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ " ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻣﻮﺝ ﻣﻜﻔﻮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮﻻ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻷﺣﺮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﲰﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻋﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺵ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﺃﻟﻒ‬
‫ﻋﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ " ﻫﻮ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻓﻼ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻓﻼ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ "‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻦ ﺯﺭﺍﺭﺓ ﺑﻦ ﺃﰊ ﺃﻭﰱ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻗﺎﻝ " ﻗﻠﺖ ﳉﱪﻳﻞ ﻫﻞ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺭﺑﻚ ﻗﻂ ؟ ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻔﺾ‪،‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﺎ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺇﻥ ﺑﻴﲏ ﻭﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺣﺠﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻟﻮ ﺩﻧﻮﺕ ﺍﱃ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻻﺣﺘﺮﻗﺖ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﻖ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﺍﻥ ﻳﱰﻝ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻳﻘﺒﺾ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻀﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ‬
‫ﻟﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺃﻋﻮﺫ ﺑﺎﷲ ﻣﻨﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺄﺧﺬ ﻣﲏ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺭﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﺎ ﺭﺏ ﺗﻌﻮﺫﹶﺕ ﺑﻚ ﻣﲏ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺮﺍﻓﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ ﻓﺘﻌﻮﺫﹶﺕ ﺑﺎﷲ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ ﺇﻥ ﺭﰊ ﺃﻣﺮﱐ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺃﻋﻮﺫ‬
‫ﺑﻪ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻐﲑ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﱐ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻭﻯ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﺎﺃﺟﺮﻯﺎﷲ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺡ ﰲ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺃﺟﺮﺍﻩ ﰲ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻭﻋﻴﻨﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺭﺃﻯ ﲦﺎﺭ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﻮﺽ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺒﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺡ ﺍﱃ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻊ ﻓﺬﻟﻚ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ "ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻋﺠﻮﻻ" ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﺠﺒﺖ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ ﻟﻪ ﻛﻠﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺠﺪﻭﺍ ﻃﺎﻋﺔ ﷲ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺇﻻ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺗﻜﱪ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﻸ ﺣﺴﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﻣﻌﺼﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻀﺐ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻟﻌﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﺒﺐ‪ ‬ﻫﺒﻮﻃﻪ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺘﻘﺪﻣﻮﻥ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﻝ ﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﺭﻱ ﰲ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﲑ‬
‫ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﻛﺎﻟﻜﺎﺗﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﺎﺿﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﻛﺎﻟﺸﺮﻃﻲ ﻭﻛﻤﻦ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻛﺎﳋﺎﺯﻥ‪،‬‬

‫‪4‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻛﺎﻟﺼﺎﺣﺒﺔ ﻭﺯﺣﻞ ﻛﺎﻟﺸﻴﺦ ﺍﳌﺸﺎﻭﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺯﻫﺮ ﻛﺎﳌﻘﻮﻡ ﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﺍﺋﻞ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲦﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻣﺔ ﳐﻠﻮﻗﺔ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺫﻭﺍﺕ ﻗﻮﺓ ﻭﺑﻄﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ‬
‫ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﲝﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﺜﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﱰﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﱰﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﻔﺮﺩﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﳌﺎﺿﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺗﻌﺎﻟﻯﺎﷲ ﻋﻦ ﻗﻮﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﺇﳕﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺪﺑﲑﻫﺎ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻛﻮﻛﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻄﻊ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﱪﺝ ﰲ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻷﻓﻼﻙ ﻣﻦ ﲞﺎﺭ ﻭﺇﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﺻﻌﺪ ﺍﻧﻌﻘﺪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺳﺒﻌﺔﺃﻓﻼﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺩﺭﺟﺎﹰﻟﻠﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺭﲪﺔ ﻭﺑﺮﻛﺔﺇﳕﺎ ﺗﱰﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ‪،‬‬
‫ﻣﻘﺴﻮﻣﺔﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﱪﻭﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺼﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻫﻮﻣﻞﺀ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﺍﳊﺠﺐ ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺳﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ "ﻭﺳﻊ ﻛﺮﺳﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ" ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺮﺳﻲ ﻭﻣﺎﺣﻮﻯ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺵ ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺣﻮﻯ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺟﻠﺖ ﻋﻈﻤﺘﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺃﻋﻼ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﺭﻱ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔﺯﺣﻞ ﰒ ﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﰒ ﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﰒ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﰒ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﰒ ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﰒ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪.‬‬


‫ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﻭﺍﺋﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻣﻼﺋﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺪﺑﲑ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﳚﻌﻞ ﻟﻐﲑﻫﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻈﻤﻮﻫﺎ ﻭﻋﺒﺪﻭﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻫﻢ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺻﻨﻔﺎﹰ ﲝﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﱪﻭﺝ ﺍﻻﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﻳﺘﻮﺍﺭﺛﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﷲ ﻓﻴﻤﻦ ﺷﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﻮﻻﹰﻭﻗﻮﺓ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﲤﻸﺍﻻﺭﺽ ﻋﻈﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﺍﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺮﻕ ﺍﻻﺑﺮﺓ ﻟﻄﻔﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻔﻮﺹ ﰲ ﲣﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻻ‬
‫ﳝﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎﻧﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻣﺜﲎ ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﻭﺭﺑﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻳﻠﺘﺤﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻗﻄﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻛﻠﻤﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﳐﻠﻮﻕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺯﺭﻕ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺷﻌﺎﻋﻴﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳊﻔﻈﺔ ﻭﺍﳋﺰﻧﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﳐﻠﻮﻗﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺭﻃﻮﺑﺔ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺣﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﲰﺮ ﺍﻻﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﷲ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻻﲢﺼﻰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻴﻌﺔ‪ :‬ﺍﻥ ﺍﻻﻓﻼﻙ ﳌﺎ ﰎ ﺧﻠﻘﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻛﺎﻷﺟﺴﺎﻡ ﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺒﻬﺎﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻛﺎﻷﺭﻭﺍﺡ‬
‫ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﳌﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﻭﺝ ﻗﺴﻢ ﳍﺎ ﺩﻭﺍﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻟﻠﺤﻤﻞ ﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪،‬‬

‫‪5‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻟﻠﺜﻮﺭ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺠﻮﺯﺍﺀ ﻋﺸﺮﺓﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻸﺳﺪ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺴﻨﺒﻠﺔ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﻤﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﻌﻘﺮﺏ ﲬﺴﺔﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﻘﻮﺱ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺠﺪﻱ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ‬
‫ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺪﻟﻮ ﺃﻟﻔﻲ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺤﻮﺕ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﻟﻠﺪﻭﺭ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔﻭﺳﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﻲ ﻟﺴﺎﺋﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﰲ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺯﺍﺀ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻋﺎﱂ‬
‫ﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﱂ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﺖ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻫﻮﺍﻡ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺎﻡ ﺍﻻﺳﺪ ﰲ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﺖ ﺫﻭﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻬﺎﺋﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺒﻠﺔ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻧﺎﻥ ﺃﺩﻣﺎﻧﻮﺱ ﻭﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻴﺰﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﺎ ﻣﻘﺎﺩﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﻛﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲟﺎﺋﺔ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺣﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻛﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺎﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﻧﺼﻒ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﺑﺈﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﺑﺜﻼﺙ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ‬
‫ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﺑﻨﻴﻒ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﺑﺜﻼﺙ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺛﻠﺚ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺑﺴﺒﻊ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺭﺑﻊ‬
‫ﻣﺮﺓﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻛﺎﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﺭﻱ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻼﺳﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻧﺎﻃﻘﺔ ﺣﺴﺎﺳﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﳍﺎ ﺣﺎﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻊ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﺎ ﺣﺎﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﺬﻭﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻢ ﻻ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺸﺘﻐﻠﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺯﻋﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﺣﻲ ﳑﻴﺰ ﳉﻤﻴﻊ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺫﻭ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻓﻜﺬﻟﻚ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ‪‬ﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﱰﻟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﺿﻴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻣﺄﺧﻮﺫ ﻣﻦ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﻤﺎﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﻘﻤﺮﻧﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﳏﺪﺙ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻴﺪ ﻷﻧﻪ ﺣﻜﻤﺔ ﻭﺻﻨﻌﺔ ﺣﻜﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻴﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻔﺴﺪ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻋﻤﺭ ﺍﻟﺩﻨﻴﺎ‬

‫ﻓﺄﻣﺎ ﻣﺎﺫﻛﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻮﻗﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﺪﺗﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﻗﻮﺍﻻﹰ ﻻﺗﺴﻠﻢ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﺇﳕﺎﺗﺴﻤﻊ ﻭﺗﺬﻛﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻻ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺪﻳﻖ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻧﻌﻮﺫ ﺑﺎﷲ‪ .‬ﻓﻔﻲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺪ ﻫﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍ‪‬ﺴﻄﻲ‬
‫ﻭﻏﲑﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﳚﺎﺕ ﺃﻥ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺳﲑﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ ﺍﳕﺎ ﺳﲑﻫﺎ ﻳﻨﻘﻀﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺣﺴﺒﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻵﻻﻑ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﻭﲬﺴﺔﻭﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺭﺑﻊ ﻳﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﺃﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺭ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺁ ﻻﻑ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺃﻟﻒ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬

‫‪6‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻯﺂﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺳﺒﻌﺔﺁﻻﻑ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻭﺍﻳﺔ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺟﺮﻳﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﱪﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﻨﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺀ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻃﻠﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻐﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ‪ :‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺐ ﲬﺲ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻧﺎﺭ ﳛﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺑﺄﺳﺮﻩ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺒﻘﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺧﺮﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﺴﺘﺎﻧﻒ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺭﺳﻄﺎﻃﺎﻟﻴﺲ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻔﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻴﻌﺔ ﻗﺪﳝﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﺃﻭﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﻞ ﺟﻼﻟﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻷﻤﻡ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﻠﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﻗﺒﻝ ﺁﺩﻡ‬

‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬

‫ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳉﻤﻠﺔ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺑﺎﺯﺍﺀﺍﳌﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﳛﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻮﱄ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻟﺘﺪﺑﲑﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺍﻷﺭﺿﻲ ﺑﺎﺫﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﻞ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﺧﻠﻘﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺰﺟﺔ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ ﺃﺻﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻲ ﻣﺘﺒﺎﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﺧﻔﺎﻑ ﺯﺭﻕ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻗﺮﻗﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺄﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻭﺭﺅﻭﺳﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺭﺅﻭﺱ ﳍﺎ ﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﻭﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﺩﻭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻣﺔ ﳍﺎ ﻭﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻗﺪﺍﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺧﻠﻔﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﺭﺟﻞ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻛﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺻﻔﺔ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻗﻲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﻭﻛﻼﻣﻬﺎ‬
‫ﳘﻬﻤﺔ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺗﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺻﺪﻭﺭﻫﻢ ﻳﺼﻔﺮﻭﻥ ﻳﺼﻔﲑﺍﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﻣﺔ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺍﻝ ﳍﺈﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻭﺃﺭﺟﻞ ﻭﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻳﺸﺒﻬﻮﻥ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺷﻖ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ ﻋﲔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻭﻳﺪ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻭﺭﺟﻞ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻳﻘﻔﺰﻭﻥ ﺗﻘﻔﻴﺰﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻛﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺍﻧﻴﻖ‪.‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﳍﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﻛﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﺻﻼﺏ‬
‫ﻛﺄﺻﻼﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺣﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﳐﺎﻟﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺭﺅﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻛﻌﻮﻱ ﺍﻟﺬﺋﺎﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺭﺃﺳﺎﻥ ﻭﻭﺟﻬﺎﻥ ﻛﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻻﺳﺪ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻬﻢ ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎﺃﻣﺔﻣﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﺑﻴﺾ ﻭﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﻛﺄﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ ﻳﺰﺭﻗﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﳍﻢ ﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﻭﺛﺪﻱ‬
‫ﻟﻴﺲ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺫﻛﺮ‪ ،‬ﺗﻠﻘﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻭﺗﻠﺪ ﺃﻣﺜﺎﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﺎ ﺃﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﻣﻄﺮﺑﺔ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﳊﺴﻦ‬

‫‪7‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﺻﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻡ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﻡ ﻭﺍﳊﺸﺮﺍﺕ ﺇﻻ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﺟﺴﺎﻡ ﺗﺄﻛﻞ ﻭﺗﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻷﻧﻌﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺑﺸﺒﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻧﻴﺎﺏ ﻛﺎﳋﻨﺎﺯﻳﺮ ﺑﺎﺭﺯﺓ ﻭﺁﺫﺍﻥ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻣﺔﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻻﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ ﺍﻻ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺣﺸﻴﺔ ﺍﳌﻨﻈﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‬
‫ﺗﻨﺎﲡﺖ ﻓﺼﺎﺭﺕ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻣﺔ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﺠﻥ ﻭﺃﺠﻨﺎﺴﻬﻡ ﻭﻗﺒﺎﺌﻠﻬﻡ‬

‫ﻭﺳﺌﻞ ﺃﻣﲑ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻦ ﺃﰊ ﻃﺎﻟﺐ ﻛﺮﻡ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻫﻞ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻗﺒﻞ‬
‫ﺁﺩﻡ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻧﻌﻢ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﳑﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻳﺴﺒﺤﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﻘﺪﺳﻮﻧﻪ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻔﺘﺮﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻳﻄﲑﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺘﻌﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳋﲑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻌﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﲞﱪ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺇﻥ ﻃﺎﺋﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ ﲤﺮﺩﻭﺍ ﻭﻋﺘﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻐﻮﺍ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﻐﲑ ﺍﳊﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻼ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺳﻔﻜﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ؛ ﻭﺃﻇﻬﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺤﺪﻭﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺑﻮﺑﻴﺔ‪.‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﳌﻄﻴﻌﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺑﺎﻳﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻋﺘﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺼﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﻄﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﻨﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﲔ ﺫﻭﻱ ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻳﻄﲑﻭﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺣﻴﺚ ﺻﲑﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻃﺒﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻳﺴﺒﺤﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﻘﺪﺳﻮﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻔﺘﺮﻭﻥ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺻﻄﻔﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺃﻗﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﺳﺮﺍﻓﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻴﻜﺎﺋﻴﻞ ﰒ ﺟﱪﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺻﻠﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﺳﻼ ﻣﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﲨﻌﲔ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﺼﻝ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻓﺬﻛﺮﺕ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻥ ﻭﻻﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﻗﺒﺎﺋﻠﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻔﺘﺮﻗﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﲬﺴﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﴰﺎﺋﻴﻞ ﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺱ ﺟﻦ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻓﺘﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﻓﻤﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺩﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻃﻮﻳﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻏﺎﺭ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺎﺋﻊ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺣﺮﻭﺏ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺑﺎﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻏﲑ ﺃﻥ ﺍﲰﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﺍﳊﺎﺭﺙ ﻭﻳﻜﲎ ﺃﺑﺎ ﻣﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻣﻄﻴﻘﺎﹰ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺼﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﻳﻘﻒ ﰲ ﺻﻔﻮﻑ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﺘﻬﺪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻐﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﺏ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻫﺒﻂ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﰲ‬
‫ﺟﻨﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻏﻠﻯﺎﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﻃﻐﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﻨﺘﺎﻋﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ ﻵﺩﻡ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﻧﺒﺄﻧﺎ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻫﺒﻂ ﰲ ﺃﻗﺒﺢ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺃﺷﺪﻫﺎ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﻧﻜﺮﻩ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻗﺒﺎﺋﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻮﺣﺸﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺮﺷﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﰒ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻻﺩﺓ ﻛﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻵﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﻟﻘﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﻬﻮﺓ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﺎﺩ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻘﺎﺣﻪ ﻛﻠﻘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻴﻀﻪ ﻛﺒﻴﻀﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪8‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻓﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﲬﺲ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﻄﲑﻭﻥ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻮ ﲬﺲ‬
‫ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻣﻊ ﳍﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻗﺒﺎﺋﻞ ﻭﺃﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﺮﻗﻲ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻊ ﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺎﺋﻞ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ ﻟﺪﻓﻊ ﺷﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﺻﻨﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﺎﱄ ﻳﺘﺼﻮﺭﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﻥ ﻭﻳﺘﺰﻭﺟﻦ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻝ ﺍﻻﻧﺲ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺣﻜﻲ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺭﺟﻞ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺳﻌﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺟﺒﲑ‪ ،‬ﺃﻧﻪ ﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻲ؛ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‬
‫ﺃﻭﻻﺩﺍﹰﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﻳﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﰲ ﺃﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻧﺔ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﻳﺘﺄﳌﻦ ﻓﻄﺮﺑﺖ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﺒﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺎ ﺗﺮﻯ ﻧﲑﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﺎﱄ ﺷﺄﻧﻚ ﻭﺑﺒﻨﻴﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﺹ ‪‬ﻢ ﺧﲑﺍﹰ ﻓﻄﺎﺭﺕ ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻈﻔﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺍﳋﺎﱄ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺃﻭ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺄﺧﺬﻩ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻓﺘﺮﻗﺼﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﺤﲑ ﻭﻳﺴﻘﻂ ﻓﺘﻤﺺ‬
‫ﺩﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻻ ﺗﻔﺎﺭﻕ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺓ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻗﺘﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻓﻬﻠﻚ‪ .‬ﳛﻜﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻓﱴ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻧﺼﺎﺭ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻋﻬﺪ ﺑﻌﺮﺱ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺄﺫﻥ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﰲ ﺗﻘﺪﻣﻪ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳋﻨﺪﻕ ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﻢ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻪ ﻓﺄﺫﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻣﱰﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺟﺪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﻓﺄﺩﺭﻛﺘﻪ ﻏﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﻫﻮﻯ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﳏﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻻ ﺗﻌﺠﻞ ﻭﺍﺩﺧﻞ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻨﻈﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺍﺷﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﺍﺷﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﻌﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﳏﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻻﺑﺮﺹ ﺍﻻﺳﺪﻱ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮ ﻟﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺇﺫ ﻫﻮ ﺑﺸﺠﺎﻉ ﻳﻠﻬﺚ ﻋﻄﺸﺎﹰ ﻭﺧﻠﻔﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ ﺗﻄﺮﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻝ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﺀ ﻭﺣﻞ ﺇﺩﻭﺍﺗﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻧﻀﺢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺎﻉ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﺸﺮﺏ ﻭﺍﻧﺴﺎﺏ ﺣﱴ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺟﺤﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻋﺒﻴﺪ ﺣﱴ ﻗﻀﻰ ﺣﻮﺍﺋﺠﻪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺃﻏﻔﻰ ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻣﻔﺎﺯﺓ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﻗﻠﻮﺻﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺿﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺟﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ‪‬ﺎﺗﻒ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪:‬‬
‫ﻤﺎ ﻋﻨﺩﻩ ﻤﻥ ﺫﻱ ﺭﺸﺎﺩ ﻴﺼﺤﺒﻪ‬ ‫ﻴﺎ ﺼﺎﺤﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﻴﺩ ﻤﺫﻫﺒﻪ‬
‫ﺤﺘﻰ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻝ ﺘﻭﻟﻰ ﻏﻴﻬﺒﻪ‬ ‫ﺩﻭﻨﻙ ﻫﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺭ ﻤﻨﺎ ﺘﺭﻜﺒﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺒﻌﺩ ﺤﻁ ﺭﺤﻠﻪ ﺘﺴﺘﻠﺒﻪ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﻗﺒﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﺢ ﻭﻻﺡ ﻜﻭﻜﺒﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻊ ﻋﺒﻴﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺎﺗﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺑﻜﺮ ﻛﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﺮﻛﺒﻪ ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﻟﻴﻠﺘﻪ ﻓﺎﺻﺒﺢ‬
‫ﰲ ﻣﱰﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻣﱰﻟﻪ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﺮﺣﻠﺔ ﻓﱰﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﺸﺄ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪:‬‬
‫ﻭﻤﻥ ﺤﻤﺎﻡ ﻴﻀﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﺩﻟﺞ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺩﻱ‬ ‫ﻴﺎ ﺼﺎﺤﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺭ ﻗﺩ ﺃﻨﺠﺒﺕ ﻤﻥ ﻋﻁﺏ‬

‫‪9‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺠﻭﺯﻴﺕ ﻤﻥ ﺭﺍﺌﺢ ﺒﺎﻟﺨﻴﺭ ﺃﻭ ﻏﺎﺩﻱ‬ ‫ﺍﺭﺠﻊ ﺤﻤﻴﺩﺍﹰ ﻓﻘﺩ ﺍﻭﻟﻴﺘﻨﺎ ﻤﻨﻨﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺮ‪:‬‬
‫ﻓﻲ ﻤ‪‬ﻬ‪‬ﻤ‪‬ﻪ ﻨﺎﺯﺡ ﻋﻥ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺼﺎﺩﻱ‬ ‫ﺃﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺫﻱ ﺃﻟﻔﻴﺘﻨﻲ ﺭﻤﻀﺎﹰ‬
‫ﺭﻭﻴﺕ ﻤﻨﻪ ﻭﻟﻡ ﺘﻠﻤﻡ ﺒﺄﻨﻜﺎﺩ‬ ‫ﻓﺠﺩﺕ ﺒﺎﻟﻤﺎﺀ ﻟﻤﺎ ﻀﻥ ﺤﺎﻤﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺭ ﺃﺨﺒﺙ ﻤﺎ ﺍﻭﻋﻴﺕ ﻤﻥ ﺯﺍﺩ‬ ‫ﺍﻟﺨﻴﺭ ﻴﺒﻘﻰ ﻭﺇﻥ ﻁﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺯﻤﺎﻥ ﺒﻪ‬
‫ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻪ ﻳﻄﺮﺩﱐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﻱ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻗﺘﻠﻲ ﻓﻜﻔﻴﺘﲏ ﺷﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﻭﻳﺘﲏ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻤﺌﻲ ﻭﻟﻦ‬
‫ﻳﻀﻴﻊ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻦ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺱ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﳊﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺟﻦ ﺻﻔﺔ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺭﺍﻭﻛﻢ ﺗﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻓﺄﻟﻘﻮﺍ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﺎﹰ ‪ -‬ﻳﻌﲏ ﻳﺎﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺭﺍﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻞ ﰲ ﻗﺪﺭﺍﻟﺸﺎﺓ ﻭﻓﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺑﺴﻮﻕ ﻋﻜﺎﻅ ﻧﺎﺩﻯ ﺃﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻬﺒﲏ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﺑﻜﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻫﺠﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﺩﻣﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺒﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺿﺮﺏ ﲨﻠﻪ ﻭﻃﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻛﺎﻟﱪﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺒﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺤﺪﺛﻬﻢ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻟﻘﻴﺖ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﺭﺯ ﺭﺍﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﻋﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﻣﺸﻘﻮﻗﺘﺎﻥ ﺑﻄﻮﻝ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﺬﺗﲏ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺭﻭﻋﺔ ﰒ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﻗﻔﺘﻪ ﻓﻘﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺍﺗﺮﻭﻱ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻧﻌﻢ ﻭﺃﻗﺮﺿﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺸﺪﱐ‪:‬‬
‫ﻭﻀﻨﺎ ﺒﺎﻟﺘﺤﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬ ‫ﺃﺘﺎﺭﻜﺔ ﺘﺤﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻗﻁﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﺃﺗﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﺎ ﻓﻘﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻫﻴﻬﺎﺕ ﺳﺒﻘﻚ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺧﻮ ﺑﲏ ﺫﺑﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﻧﺎ ﻭﺍﷲ ﻳﺄﺧﻲ‪ ،‬ﻧﻄﻘﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻟﺴﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺴﻮﻕ ﻋﻜﺎﻅ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻨﺖ ﻗﻠﺘﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺄﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻋﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺃﻟﻔﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺳﺘﻤﺎﺋﺔﺃﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﺣﺴﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﲤﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﺣﺒﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﻱ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﺃﻓﻀﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﻓﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺍﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻮﺍﹰ ﻛﺒﲑﺍﹰ؛ ﻭﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ "ﻻ ﺗﻀﺮﺑﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﻓﺈ‪‬ﺎ ﻏﻠﻯﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﻓﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ" ﻭﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ " ﻻ ﺗﻠﺠﻮﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﺍﱃ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺩ ﻓﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﶈﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﲔ"‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﺬﻟﻚ ﺳﺨﺮ ﻟﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳊﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻗﺘﻨﺼﻬﺎ ﻭﺫﻟﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺨﺮ‬
‫ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﲨﻊ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﺄﻛﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﻴﻤﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺸﻲ ﻭﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺧﻠﻘﺖ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﺍﺕ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ‬

‫‪10‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫‪‬ﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻨﻄﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﻀﺤﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻄﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮﺍﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺧﺎﻃﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﻱ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻭ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺒﻂ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻵﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﻗﻌﻮﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺨﺮ ﻟﻪ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻛﻤﺜﻞ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﺪ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻭﺭﺟﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺜﺐ ﻭﺛﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﻌﺪﻭ‬
‫ﻋﺪﻭﺍﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺗﺼﻴﺪﻩ ﻭﺗﺄﻛﻠﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺳﻴﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻗﻌﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﺫﲝﻮﻩ ﻭﻃﺒﺨﻮﻩ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﲰﻴﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ‪ :‬ﻟﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻨﺎﺱ ﲰﻴﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻧﺴﻨﺎﺱ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﻔﻰ ﰲ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ :‬ﺇﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻭ ﻓﺬﻟﻚ ﲰﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺒﻬﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﻩ ﻓﺬﲝﻮﻩ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺘﻔﻰ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ :‬ﻟﻮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻗﻼ ﺻﻤﺖ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻨﻄﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﺬﻭﻩ ﻭﺫﲝﻮﻩ‪ .‬ﻓﻨﺎﺫﺍﻫﻢ ﻧﺴﻨﺎﺱ ﺁﺧﺮ ﲣﺒﺄ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ‬
‫ﺧﺮﻭﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ :‬ﺇﱐ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺣﺴﻨﺖ ﻓﻠﻢ ﺃﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﻩ ﻭﺫﲞﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﺕ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻳﻐﺘﺬﻱ ﺑﺎﻟﺜﻤﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺒﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﱪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻄﺶ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺰﻡ ﳑﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﺘﻮﻟﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ ﻭﺑﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ ﻋﺮﺍﺽ‬
‫ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﺑﺼﺎﺻﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺎﺭﺯﺓ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﺫﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺑﺪﺍ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻛﺄﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺃﻇﻔﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻛﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻣﻌﻘﻔﺔ ﳏﺪﻭﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻭﺭﺍﺀﻫﻢ ﻏﲑﻫﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﺎ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺇﻻ ﻧﺴﺎ ﻥ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻕ ﻭﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﲪﻞ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻋﻈﺎ ﻡ ﻟﺸﻌﻮﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﺎ ﺃﻳﺪﻱ ﻭﻓﺮﻭﺝ‬
‫ﻣﺜﻞ ﻓﺮﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻷﺯﻟﻦ ﻳﺼﺤﻦ ﻭﺍﻕ ﻭﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻗﻄﻌﺖ ﺍ ﺣﺪﺍ ﻫﻦ ﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﻣﻴﺘﺔ ﻻ ﺗﻨﻄﻖ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﻧﺔ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺎﻭﺯ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻭﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺃﻋﺠﺎﺯﺍ ﻭﻓﺮﻭﺟﺎ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﻫﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻥ‬
‫ﻗﻄﻌﺖ ﺃﻗﻤﺖ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﻄﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻃﻴﺐ ﺭﺍﺋﺤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺬ‬
‫ﻣﺒﺎﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺃﻃﻴﺐ ﺭﺍﺋﺤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﻧﺲ‪.‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﳛﻜﻲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺳﻘﻄﻮﺍﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﲝﺮﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﺫﻭﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺴﻂ‪ ،‬ﳍﺎ ﻓﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻭﺛﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻳﻔﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻗﻬﻘﻬﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺣﻜﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﲔ ﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺃﻟﻘﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻋﺬﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺴﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﺿﻮﺿﺎﺓ ﻭﺿﺤﻜﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻤﻨﻮﺍ ﳍﻦ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﲔ ﻓﺄﻭﺛﻘﻮﳘﺎ‪.‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﺘﺎ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﺧﺬﺍﳘﺎ ﻳﻘﻌﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻭﳚﺪﺍﻥ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻟﺬﺓ‬
‫ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﺣﺪﳘﺎ ﻭﺛﻖ ﺑﺼﺎﺣﺒﺘﻪ ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺛﺎﻗﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﺮﺑﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﻫﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻘﻴﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻻﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺣﺼﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﻛﺐ ﺭﲪﻬﺎ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻬﺎ ﻓﺤﻞ ﻭﺛﺎﻗﻬﺎ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰﺫﻛﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ‬

‫‪11‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺭﻛﺒﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺃﻟﻘﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺻﺪﻓﺎﹰ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻧﻔﻴﺲ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬
‫ﺭﲪﻪ ﷲ‪ :‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺃﻟﻴﻨﺎ ﻭﺍﷲ ﺍﻋﻠﻢ ﲞﻠﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺠﺐ ﻻﻣﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺪﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﻗﺮﺃ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻓﻠﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺬﺭ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺃﻭﺭﺩﻧﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﷲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﻓﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺴﺪﻳﺪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻌﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺄﻳﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﺍﻻﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺭﻭﻯ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺧﻠﻘﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﺮ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻭﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﻭﺟﻨﺎﺣﺎﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺭﺟﻼﻩ ﻭﺫﻧﺒﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻟﺮﺃﺱ ﻣﻜﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳉﻨﺎﺡ ﺍﻷﳝﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻕ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﻮﺍﻕ ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳉﻨﺎﺡ ﺍﻷﻳﺴﺮﻧﺎﺳﻚ ﻭﻣﻨﺴﻚ ﻭﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻧﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻐﺮﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺚ "ﺍﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﲔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ ﻭﺍﲰﻬﺎ ﺟﺎﺑﻠﻘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﻭﺍﲰﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺟﺎﺑﺮﺿﺎ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻝ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺁﻻﻑ ﻓﺮﺳﺦ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺑﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺑﲔ ﻓﺮﺳﺦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻟﻠﺒﺎﺏ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻻ ﺗﻠﺤﻘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﻌﻤﺮﻭﻥ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺃﻻ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺩﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺘﻨﺎﻛﺤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺣﻜﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﳍﻢ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﺗﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻫﺎﺗﲔ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺘﲔ‬
‫ﺧﺎﺭﺟﺘﲔ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﴰﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﻻ ﻗﻤﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﻻ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﻳﻮﺣﺪﻭﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻥ ﳍﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﺴﻌﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺵ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﴰﺲ ﻭﻻ ﻗﻤﺮ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻭﻱ ﺇﻥ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻗﺎﻝ " ﻣﺮ ﰊ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﺃﺳﺮﻱ ﰊ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺪﻋﻮ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻮﱐ ﻓﻤﺤﺴﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻊ ﳏﺴﻨﻜﻢ ﻭﻣﺴﻴﺌﻬﻢ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺴﻴﺌﻜﻢ"‪.‬‬
‫ﺭﻭﻯ ﻭﻫﺐ ﺑﻦ ﻣﻨﺒﻪ ﺑﺈﺳﻨﺎﺩ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ"ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻋﺎﱂ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺎﱂ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﺇﻻ ﻛﺨﺮﺩﻟﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻒ ﺃﺣﺪﻛﻢ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺭﻭﺍﻩ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺮﻭﺟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺝ ﰲ ﻏﺎﻣﺾ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺭﺯﻗﻬﺎ‬
‫ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﺯﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺑﺄﺳﺮﻩ‪ .‬ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺩﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻴﻁ ﻭﻤﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻤﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺌﺏ‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﺮﺵ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻟﻌﻨﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ ﻳﺘﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺎﺭﻱ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻠﻪ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺑﺎﻟﺴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻔﺎﺭﻳﺖ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ ﳊﻤﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻴﻂ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻔﺎﺭﻳﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﰲ ﳉﺠﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻔﺎﺭﻗﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﺼﺮﻑ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﺘﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻄﻤﻊ ﰲ ﻓﺘﻨﺘﻪ ﺃﻭ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺻﺎﱀ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻛﻴﺪﻩ‪،‬‬

‫‪12‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻮﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﺴﻌﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻳﻀﻠﻮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺠﻨﻪ ﰲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻨﻪ ﳛﺒﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻗﺼﺮ ﻋﺠﻴﺐ ﰲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻻ ﺗﺰﺍﻝ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﺗﺮﻣﻲ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺗﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﲰﺎﻙ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﳊﻮﺕ ﻣﺪﺓ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‬
‫ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺗﻄﻔﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﺑﺮﻫﺔ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﺎ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺊ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﳜﺎﻃﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺎﻭﺯﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﺭﺍﻓﻊ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺑﺎﺳﻂ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻳﻦ ﺗﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﺍﺳﻮﺩ ﻣﻔﻠﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ‬
‫ﻳﻮﻣﺊ ﺑﺄﺻﺒﻌﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ :‬ﻣﻦ ﺟﺎﺯ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﻏﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻣﻜﺘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ"ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺻﻨﻊ ﺃﺑﺮﻫﺔ ﺫﻭ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻤﲑﻱ ﻟﺴﻴﺪﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺗﻘﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺎﳊﺼﻮﻥ ﺗﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻋﻤﻖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻠﺤﻖ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺑﺎﻉ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻭﺃﻗﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻛﺎﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺰﻓﱵ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﱳ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﻀﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﻴﻞ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺧﻠﻘﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺃﻭﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﲝﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﲝﺮ ﺿﻴﻖ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻐﺎﻳﺺ ﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺩﻭﺭ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺮﻛﺐ ﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﻠﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺴﲑ ﻭﻋﻮﻳﺮ ﻭﳘﺎ ﺟﺒﻼﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺷﱴ ﻭﺣﻴﺘﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﱵ ﺑﺎﻉ ﻭﺃﻗﻞ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺗﻨﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻣﺴﻜﻮﻧﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﺪﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻠﻌﺔ ﺗﻀﻲﺀ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ ﺑﻘﻨﺎﺩﻳﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻻ ﺗﻨﻄﻔﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﲝﺮ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﻋﻤﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﻋﺮﺿﻪ‪ ،‬ﺗﻘﻄﻌﻪ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﻦ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﶈﻴﻂ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻻ ﺃﺷﺪ ﻫﻮﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺮﺩ ﻭﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎ ﻭﺍﳋﻴﺰﺭﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻛﻞ ﲰﻜﺔ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﺃﻗﻞ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﻜﺔ ﺻﻐﲑﺓ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﺍﻉ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻃﻐﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻜﺔ ﻭﺑﻐﺖ ﻭﺁﺫﺕ ﲰﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ ﺳﻠﻄﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﲑﺓ ﻓﺼﺎﺭﺕ ﰲ ﺃﺫﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ‬

‫‪13‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑﺓ ﻓﻼ ﺗﻔﺎﺭﻗﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﱂ ﺗﻘﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑﺓ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﳛﻜﻲ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﲰﺎﻙ ﻃﻴﺎﺭﺓ ﺗﻄﲑ ﻟﻴﻼﹰ ﻭﺗﺮﻋﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺪﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﻃﻠﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺭﺟﻌﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﺗﻜﺘﺐ ﻣﺮﺍﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻓﺘﻘﺮﺃ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪.‬‬


‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﺧﻀﺮﺍﺀ ﺩﲰﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻋﺘﺼﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺫﻭﻗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﳍﺎ ﻗﺮﻧﺎﻥ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﻗﺮﻧﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻳﺮﻣﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻧﺎﺭﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﻣﺪﻭﺭﺓ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﳌﺼﺢ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻇﻬﺮﻫﺎ ﻛﺎﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻣﺴﺘﺤﺪ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﳍﺎ ﲰﻜﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻘﺎﻫﻦ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻥ ﻓﺘﻘﺘﻠﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻧﻘﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﻛﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﳎﺰﻉ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺿﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻜﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻫﻔﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺪﺭﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺱ ﻳﻄﻴﻒ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻴﻮﻥ ﺗﻨﻈﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﻃﻮﻳﻞ ﻣﺜﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﰲ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﺑﺄﺭﺟﻞ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺃﺳﻨﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻨﺸﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺪﺭﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻧﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻴﺲ ﺗﺘﺼﻞ‬
‫ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﺇﻻ ﺃﺗﻠﻔﺘﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻄﻮﻱ ﺫﻧﺒﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﳊﻤﻬﺎ ﻳﺸﻔﻲ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺃﻻ ﻭﺻﺎﺏ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻠﻴﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﱪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲝﺮ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻫﺮﻛﻨﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻚ ﺭﲟﺎ ﻳﻨﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﺮﻩ ﺍﳊﺸﻴﺶ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﺪﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﺭﺳﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻓﻴﻌﺘﻘﺪﻭﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻓﻄﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺃﻗﻠﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻧﺸﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﺃﺣﺪ‬
‫ﺟﻨﺎﺣﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﰲ ﺻﻠﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﳉﺒﻞ ﻋﻈﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺭﻓﻊ ﺃﺫﻧﻴﻪ ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺟﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﺑﺬﻧﺒﻪ ﰒ ﻓﺘﺢ ﻓﻤﻪ ﻓﻴﱰﻝ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺣﻠﻘﻪ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﱰﻝ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺌﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﳜﺎﻓﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻢ ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻮﺍﻗﻴﺲ ﳐﺎﻓﺔ ﺇﻥ ﻳﺘﻜﺊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺮﻛﺐ ﻓﻴﻐﺮﻗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﲣﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﱪ ﻓﺘﺒﺘﻠﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻠﺘﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺨﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ ﻓﺘﺘﻜﺴﺮ ﰲ ﺃﺟﻮﺍﻓﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺕ ﻫﺎﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻜﺔ ﻻ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺇﻻ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻄﺒﺦ ﺣﱴ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻭﺩﻛﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﺪﻫﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺘﺰﻳﺪ ﰲ ﻗﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﻧﺸﺎﻃﻪ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻠﻮﺩ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ‪ -‬ﻭﻫﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻤﺮﺓ ‪-‬ﻓﺮﺵ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻞ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺼﻴﺒﻪ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻳﺢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺑﻪ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﳍﺎ ﺿﻮﺀ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻊ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﳓﺪ ﻭﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﲝﺮ ﻫﺮﻛﻨﺪ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻊ‬
‫ﺑﲔ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻋﻨﱪ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﻳﻨﺒﺖ ﰲ ﻗﻌﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻧﺒﺎﺗﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺍﺷﺘﺪ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻗﺬﻓﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ‪،‬‬

‫‪14‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﲑﺗﻔﻊ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻭﺍﳊﻤﺄﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻨﱪ ﺩﺳﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺮﺃﺕ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻟﻔﻪ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳌﻬﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﺃﲪﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺣﻔﺺ ﺍﻟﻌﻄﺎﺭ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻛﻨﺖ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ ﺃﰊ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺤﻖ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺼﻔﻲ ﻋﻨﱪﺍﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺫﺍﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺸﻴﺶ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻗﲑ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺄﻟﲏ ﻓﻘﻠﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻣﻨﺎﻗﲑ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺍﺛﺘﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻀﺤﻚ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺍﺳﺤﻖ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺗﻘﻮﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ‪ .‬ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﺗﺮﻭﺙ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﺇﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻗﻌﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻘﺪ ﻋﲏ ﺍﻟﺮﺷﻴﺪ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲪﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﻭﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﺄﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺘﺐ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﻋﺪﻥ ﺃﻋﻠﻤﻮﻩ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻴﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻗﻌﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺗﻘﺬﻓﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺑﺎﻷﻣﻮﺍﺝ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﲣﺮﺝ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻫﺘﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﺍﻟﺰﻓﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻣﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺁﺧﺮ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺑﺴﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﻫﺮﻛﻨﺪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺭﺃﺱ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻐﺎﻳﺺ ﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ ﻭﻧﺒﺎﺕ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺒﺤﺮ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻃﺮﻕ ﺑﲔ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺴﺎﻟﻚ ﳌﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ‬
‫ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﻐﺎﻳﺺ ﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻘﺮ ﻭﺣﺸﻴﺔ ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﳌﻬﺮﺍﺝ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﻇﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺎﺏ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﻟﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﻄﻊ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﳌﻄﺮ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ‬
‫ﺣﻴﺘﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺷﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﻭﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻭﲤﺮ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺪﻋﻰ ﺍﳌﻬﺮﺍﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻣﺮﻛﺐ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﺍﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﲜﺰﺍﺋﺮﻩ ﰲ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﻮﻓﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﻠﻜﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺯﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺴﺒﺎﺳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺎﻗﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺎ ﳌﻠﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﻳﺴﲑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻳﺘﺮﺍﺀﻯ ﻷﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ ﻓﻴﺘﺒﺎﺷﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻫﻢ ﺃﺑﺼﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺑﺢ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺑﺮﻃﺎﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻣﺴﻜﻮﻧﺔ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻑ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺒﻮﻝ ﻭﺍﻷﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﳌﻨﻜﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻄﺮﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﳐﺮﻗﻮ ﺍﻵﺫﺍﻥ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﲔ ﳎﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﳜﺮﺝ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻣﻨﺘﻬﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﺒﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺸﺘﺮﻭﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻻ ﻳﺒﺼﺮﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﻗﻴﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ‬
‫ﺑﺮﺍﻕ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺿﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﻭﺃﺻﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﻯ ‪‬ﺎ ﺳﺎﻛﻦ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﻩ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺯﻻﻻ ﺣﻠﻮ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺭﻭﺍﺋﺢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻪ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻦ ﻭﻗﺒﺎﺏ ﺑﻴﺾ ﺗﻠﻮﺡ ﻭﺗﺘﺰﺍﻳﺎ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻴﻄﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﺒﺎﻋﺪﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‬

‫‪15‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻼ ﻳﺰﺍﻟﻮﻥ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻴﺄﺳﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺘﻬﺎﻩ ﻏﲑ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻗﺼﺎﻩ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﺗﺘﻮﻗﺪ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻟﻴﻼ‬
‫ﻭ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﳍﺎ ﻗﻮﺍﺻﻒ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻗﻮﺍﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﺮﻋﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﲰﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺻﻮﺗﺎﹰ ﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺕ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺃﻭ ﻛﺒﲑ ﻣﻦ ﻛﱪﺍﺋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲝﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎﻩ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﲝﺮ ﺧﺒﻴﺚ ﺑﺎﺭﺩ ﻟﻴﺲ ﰲ ﻏﲑﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﺭﳛﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﲝﺮ ﻣﺴﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﰲ ﺑﻄﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﺮﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻫﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﰲ ﺟﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻛﻬﻴﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻄﻠﻌﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻻ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻫﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﲝﺮﺍ ﻳﺴﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﲝﺮ ﻳﻐﻠﻲ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﻐﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﻗﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺻﻔﺔ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻛﺴﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﲰﻜﺔ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻗﺔ ﻳﺮﻣﻲ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺍﳒﺬﺭ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﺗﺰﺍﻝ‬
‫ﺗﻀﻄﺮﺏ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﻧﺼﻒ ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﻨﺴﻠﺦ ﰲ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺝ ﳍﺎ ﺟﻨﺎﺡ ﻓﺘﺴﺘﻘﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺘﻄﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﲤﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻓﺮﺳﺦ ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻭﺟﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﺴﺘﺪﻳﺮ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﻟﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻐﻄﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺟﺒﻠﲔ ﻭﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺒﻠﲔ ﻓﺮﺟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﲟﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﻘﻤﻮﻟﻴﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺴﻄﻨﻄﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻛﻨﻴﺴﺔ ﰲ ﺟﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺗﻨﻜﺸﻒ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺤﺞ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﺪﻭﻥ ﳍﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻴﻘﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻮﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺘﻔﺮﻗﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﻬﺪﻭﻥ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺪ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺮ ﺑﺪﺍ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻓﻴﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺒﺎﺩﺭﻭﻥ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺰﺍﻝ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﻐﻄﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﻐﻴﺐ ﺇﱃ ﺭﺃﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻧﺎﹰ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺣﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﺘﺨﺬ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻛﺤﻞ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻋﻠﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﲝﺮ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻓﻬﻮ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻨﺒﺖ ﰲ ﻗﻌﺮﻩ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺩﺭﻙ ﺍﻟﻐﻮﺍﺻﲔ‬
‫ﳛﺘﺎﻝ ﰲ ﻗﻠﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﺑﺄﻥ ﻳﺮﺑﻂ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺮﺍﻳﻂ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺜﻘﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﻭﻳﺪﱃ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ‬
‫ﳛﺮﻙ ﺍﳌﺮﻛﺐ ﺑﺎﳉﺬﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻮﻃﺔ ‪‬ﺎ ﳝﻨﺔ ﻭﻳﺴﺮﺓ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﺗﺸﺒﻜﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻏﺼﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﻘﻠﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﻳﻂ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻮﺟﺪ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺍﲣﺬ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﻧﻔﺎﻕ ﻛﺜﲑ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﱪ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻚ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﻨﻜﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻚ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬

‫‪16‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺨﺒﺭ ﺘﻨﻴﺱ‬

‫ﺃﻣﺎ ﺧﱪ ﺗﻨﻴﺲ ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺟﻨﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺮﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻣﺘﱰﻫﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻘﺴﻮﻣﺔ ﺑﲔ ﻣﻠﻜﲔ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺣﺪﳘﺎ ﻣﺆﻣﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻛﺎﻓﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻧﻔﻖ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﱪ ﺣﱴ ﺑﺎﻉ ﺣﺼﺘﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺧﺬ ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﱪ ﻓﺄﻓﻠﺤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺮﻭﺷﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻧﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳝﻨﻌﻪ ﻭﻳﻔﺘﺨﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﲟﺎ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻣﺒﺴﻄﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺃﻧﺎ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻨﻚ ﻣﺎﻻﹰ ﻭﺃﻋﺰ ﻧﻔﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ‪ :‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﻙ ﺷﺎﻛﺮﺍﹰ ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻄﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻮﺷﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﱰﻉ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺩﻋﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻐﺮﻕ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺣﱴ ﻛﺄﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻠﲔ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﻳﻦ ﺫﻛﺮﳘﺎ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪:‬‬
‫"ﻭﺍﺿﺮﺏ ﳍﻢ ﻣﺜﻼ ﺭﺟﻠﲔ ﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﻷﺣﺪﳘﺎ ﺟﻨﺘﲔ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ" ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﻴﺲ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﳍﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻭﺑﺎﻗﻲ‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﲝﲑﺓ ﺗﻨﻴﺲ ﺗﻌﺬﺏ ﻭﻗﺖ ﳎﻲﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺗﻘﻴﻢ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﺣﻠﻮﺓ ﰒ ﲤﻠﺢ ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﲔ ﻻ ﳜﺮﺝ‬
‫ﻣﺎﺅﻫﺎ ﺇﻻ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺃﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﻮﺍﺕ ﻓﻴﺘﻮﺿﺄ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰒ ﺗﻔﻴﺾ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻼﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻌﺮﻭﻓﺔ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ‬
‫ﻋﲔ ﺍﻷﻭﻗﺎﺕ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻷﻫﻞ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ‪‬ﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﺳﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﺃﻭ ﳓﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ‬
‫ﻣﺜﺒﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﺎﺋﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺫﺭﻉ ﻭﻋﺮﺿﻪ ﳓﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻗﻠﻴﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ‬
‫ﺛﻼﺙ ﺷﻌﺐ ﻏﻼﻅ ﻣﺴﺘﻮﻳﺔ ﳏﺪﻭﺩﺓ ﻛﺎﳌﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻳﻘﺮﺃ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻠﻨﻬﺮ‪ :‬ﻳﺎ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻋﲔ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻟﻠﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﻮﰉ ﳌﻦ ﺻﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻨﺘﺪﺏ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺪﺓ ﳑﻦ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻭﻳﺼﻌﺪﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩ ﻓﻴﻘﻄﻌﻮﻥ ﻗﻄﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﻘﻌﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﺪﻋﻮﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺻﺤﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻮﰉ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺬﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ‪‬ﺮ ﻣﻜﺮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻣﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻧﻪ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﻪ ﻟﻮ ﱂ ﻳﻨﺠﺲ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻧﻮﺏ ﳌﺈﺫﺍ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﳝﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ‪‬ﺮ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻀﺮﻩ ﺭﺟﺎﻝ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺳﻴﻮﻑ ﻗﺎﻃﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻄﻬﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﻘﺮﺏ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﻱ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﺃﺗﻰ ﰲ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻠﻰ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺒﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﻃﻮﺍﻕ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻷﺳﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻃﻖ ﻷﻥ ﺃﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﺎ ﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮ ﰒ ﻳﻄﺮﺣﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﻮﺡ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺑﺄﻃﻮﺍﻗﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺴﻴﻮﻓﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﻘﻄﻌﻮﻧﻪ ﻧﺼﻔﲔ ﻓﻴﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻔﲔ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﻛﻨﺪ‬

‫‪17‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮﻳﻦ ﳜﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﳌﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﻌﺮ ﻭﺑﻪ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﺆﺫﻳﺔ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻭﺍ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﳌﺎﺱ ﻃﺮﺣﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﳊﻤﺎﹰ ﺣﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻃﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﺦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺮﻯ ﻧﺴﻮﺭ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﻬﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻠﺤﻢ ﻓﺘﻨﻘﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺄﺧﺬﻩ ﻭﺗﺮﻓﻌﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺣﻴﺚ ﺗﺄﻛﻠﻪ ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﺼﺪ ﻃﺎﻟﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﳌﺄﻛﻮﻝ ﻓﻴﺠﺪﻭﻥ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﺤﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻮﻟﺔ ﻭﺍﳊﻤﺼﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﱪ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺪﻭﻧﻪ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺨﺬ ﻣﻨﻪ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﺼﻮﺻﺎﹰ ﳋﻮﺍﰎ ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﳌﻨﻄﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺱ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻛﺒﺎﺭ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺻﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻷﺟﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺩﻱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﺎﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﻻ ﳑﻦ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻭﻻ ﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ‬
‫ﺗﺒﻴﻌﻪ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﺮﺳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻌﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﻀﺎﻋﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﺩﻭﻥ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻧﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺃﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﺟﺎﺀﻭﺍ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﻛﻞ ﺑﻀﺎﻋﺔ ﺟﺰﺀﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺗﺮﻙ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻀﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻓﺮﲟﺎ ﻳﺰﺍﺩ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻃﻠﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﺃﻣﻌﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺻﻔﺮﺍﹰ ﺑﻐﲑ ﳊﻰ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺯﻱ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺭ ﻓﻐﺎﺑﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻳﺘﺮﺩﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺳﺎﺣﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻋﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﻨﲔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﻃﺒﺎﹰ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻠﻮ ﺍﳌﻄﻌﻢ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﻼ ﳝﺮﺿﻮﻥ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻬﺮﺑﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻟﺒﺎﺳﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻭﺭﻕ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻳﻠﺘﺤﻔﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻓﺬﻛﺮ ﺑﻄﻠﻴﻤﻮﺱ ﺃﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﻏﲑ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻘﺎﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺏ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﲦﺮﻩ ﻭﻳﻠﺘﺤﻔﻮﻥ ﺑﻮﺭﻗﻪ ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﳊﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺿﺤﻀﺎﺡ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺬﻭﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﺭﺅﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﺸﻌﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﺍﻕ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻯ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻪ ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻌﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺪﺭ ﺍﻷﺟﺴﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻌﻔﺖ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ؛ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺮﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﺎﺩﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻀﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻠﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺨﻠﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﲔ ﳌﺎ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻤﺔ ﻣﺮ ﲜﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﻢ ﺭﻭﺅﺳﻬﻢ ﺭﻭﺅﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺑﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﺃﻧﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﻢ ﳍﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻓﺤﺎﺭﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﺣﺎﺭ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﲣﻠﺺ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ‬
‫ﺳﺎﻃﻌﺎﹰ ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻩ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻫﻮﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻗﺼﺮ ﻣﺒﲏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﻠﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﰲ ﻋﻠﻰ‬

‫‪18‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺷﺎﻃﺊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﱰﻭﻝ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻡ ﻓﻴﻠﺴﻮﻑ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‬
‫ﻭﻏﺮﺏ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻊ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻇﻬﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻗﺪ ﺻﺎﺭ ﻟﺒﺎﺳﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻝ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺍﻣﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻩ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻡ ﺇﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﲦﺮﺍﹰ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﻛﻠﻮﻩ ﺯﺍﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻇﻬﺮ ﺑﺸﺮﻓﺎﺕ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺑﻴﺢ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﺢ ﰒ ﲣﻤﺪ ‪‬ﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﰒ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ ﺍﻳﻀﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻭﺷﺠﺮ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺷﻘﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺀﻫﻢ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻠﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻭﻓﺮﺝ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﲟﺜﻞ ﻛﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﻭﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺒﺎﺕ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻤﺄﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻏﺪﺭﺍﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﲔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻭﺯﺭﻭﻉ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺣﺼﻦ ﻋﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﻨﲔ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺳﺎﻡ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﻗﺒﺢ ﺳﻮﻡ ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﻭﺻﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺍﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻐﺎﺛﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﺗﻠﻒ ﻣﻮﺍﺷﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺿﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺛﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﻳﻨﺼﺒﻮﳘﺎ ﻗﺮﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺝ ﻓﻴﺒﺘﻠﻊ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻏﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺭﻭﱐ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺃﻭﻗﻔﻮﺍ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭﻳﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺳﺤﺎﺑﺔ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ ﻭﻋﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﻛﺎﻟﱪﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻓﻪ ﻓﺎﺑﺘﻠﻊ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭﻳﻦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺑﺜﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﲔ ﻓﺴﻠﺨﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﻤﻠﺌﺖ ﺟﻠﻮﺩﳘﺎ ﺯﻓﺘﺎﹰ ﻭﻛﱪﻳﺘﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﺒﺴﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﺯﺭﻧﻴﺨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺰﺝ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﺧﻼﻁ ﻛﻼﻟﻴﺐ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﻭﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩﺍ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻧﺼﺒﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻋﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﻓﺎﺑﺘﻠﻌﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻟﻮﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻢ ﻳﻠﺒﺚ ﺍﻻ ﻗﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﻓﺎﺿﻄﺮﺑﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﺧﻼﻁ ﰲ ﺣﻠﻘﻪ ﻓﺨﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﻘﻴﹰﺎ ﻻ ﳝﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺘﺢ ﻓﺎﻩ ﻟﻴﺴﺘﺮﻭﺡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺑﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﻓﺄﲪﻴﺖ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺬﻓﺖ ﰲ ﺣﻠﻘﻪ ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺡ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻓﺮﺣﻮﺍ ﳌﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﻜﻔﺄﻭﺍ ﻟﻼﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻒ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﲪﻠﻮﻩ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻻﺭﻧﺐ ﻭ‪‬ﺑﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﺻﻔﺮ ﻳﱪﻕ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﱪﻕ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻳﺴﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺘﺮﺍﺡ ﻭﰲ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺮﻥ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﻫﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻛﻞ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﺗﺮﺍﻫﺎ ‪‬ﺮﺏ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻔﺮ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺍﺷﻬﺮ ﻭﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻴﺌﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺎﻥ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﲝﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﻃﻨﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺑﺔ ﺭﺅﻭﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻮﻩ‬

‫‪19‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻴﺎﺏ ﻣﻌﻘﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﺎ ﻃﻌﺎﻡ ﺇﻻ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺼﻴﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺮﻛﺐ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﳍﺎ ﺟﻨﺎﺣﲔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﺘﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲨﻌﺖ ﺑﲔ ﺭﺃﺳﻴﻬﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺭﺍ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﺭﻑ ﻳﻠﺘﺒﺲ ﺑﻈﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪..‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻷﻭﺍﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻳﻐﻮﺻﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﲟﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻴﺄﻛﻠﻮﻧﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺻﻴﺪﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻴﺪﻭﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﺷﻬﺮ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﳎﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﺪ ﻣﺮﻣﺮ ﻣﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻔﺼﻞ ﺑﺄﻧﻮﺍﻉ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻳﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳉﻦ ﺗﻄﻮﻑ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻓﺪﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳉﻦ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻐﺰﺍﻩ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺧﺮﺏ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻭﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺮ ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﻟﺼﻴﺪﻭﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﰲ‬
‫ﺯﻣﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﲨﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻛﻤﻞ ﻛﻤﺎﻻﹰ ﻭﻇﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﻭﺣﻼﻭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺻﻄﻔﺎﻫﺎ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺟﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺪﱘ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﳊﺰﻥ ﳌﻔﺎﺭﻗﺘﻬﺎ ﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﺑﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﻀﺎﺭﺓ ﻧﻌﻴﻤﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﺲ ﺣﺸﻤﻬﺎ ﻭﺧﺪﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﱄ ﺍﺭﺍﻙ ‪‬ﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﱰﻟﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺰﻥ ﻭﺍﺗﺎ ﺧﲑ ﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﻴﻚ ﻣﻠﻜﻲ ﺍﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪:‬‬
‫ﺍﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﲏ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﻛﻮﱐ ﻣﻊ ﺃﰊ ﻭﺃﻧﺴﻲ ﺑﻪ ﻫﺎﺝ ﱄ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺟﺪﺍﹰ ﻓﻠﻮ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺇﻥ ﻳﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﱄ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻌﻠﻲ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻬﺎ ﺳﻠﻮﺕ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻓﺼﻮﺭﻭﺍ ﳍﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺻﻮﺭﻩ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺼﺤﺐ ﺃﺑﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﻮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﺳﺄﻟﺖ‬
‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺑﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺎﺻﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺍﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺮ ﺑﻨﺎﻩ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺑﺪﺍﺋﻊ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻭﻓﺠﺮ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﰲ ﻗﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻓﻀﻪ ﻣﻄﻮﻗﺔ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺁﻩ ﻷﺑﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﺪﺕ ﺇﱃ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻓﺄﻟﺒﺴﺘﻬﺎ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺧﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﳌﺰﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﺄﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺍﻛﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﺟﺘﻪ ﺑﺘﺎﺝ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﻡ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﺃﺟﻠﺴﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺻﺪﺭ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﳐﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺝ ﻭﺍﻭﻗﺪﺕ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‬
‫ﳎﺎﻣﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺜﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺳﺤﻴﻖ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺷﺖ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﲝﻴﺚ ﲢﺎﺫﻳﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺮﳛﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻋﻔﺮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻜﺮﺓ ﻭﻋﺸﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺴﺠﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻊ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻭﺻﺎﺋﻔﻬﺎ ﻭﺧﺪﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﺗﺼﻨﻊ ﻷﺑﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﳋﱪ ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺂﺻﻒ ﺑﻦ ﺑﺮﺧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﺍﺀ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﺗﺒﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﺣﻀﺮ ﻋﺮﺵ ﺑﻠﻘﻴﺲ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻠﺐ‬
‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺣﺒﻪ ﳍﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺪﺭ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻔﻪ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺍﲡﻪ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﺴﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻳﺎ ﻧﱯ‬

‫‪20‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﷲ‪ :‬ﺃﱐ ﺳﺎﺋﻠﻚ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺳﻞ‪ .‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﱐ ﻗﺪ ﻛﱪﺕ ﻭﻟﺴﺖ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺇﻥ ﻳﻔﺠﺄﱐ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺭﺩﺕ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻗﻮﻡ‬
‫ﻣﻘﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺍﺫﻛﺮ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺻﻒ ﻓﻀﺎﺋﻠﻬﻢ ﻓﻠﺘﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﺣﻀﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﲡﻤﻊ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﺠﻠﺴﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺐ ﱄ ﻣﻨﱪﺍﹰ ﺃﺭﻗﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﲟﺎ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺇﻥ ﳛﻀﺮﱐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻨﱪ ﺧﻄﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻓﺤﻤﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺃﺛﲎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺜﲏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻐﺮﻩ ﻭﻛﱪﻩ ﻭﻣﺪﺓ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺛﲎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻐﻔﺮ ﻟﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺛﲎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺻﻐﺮﻩ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻩ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﰲ ﻛﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﲞﲑ ﻭﻻ ﺑﺸﺮ ﻓﺄﺣﻔﻆ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺩﻋﺎﻩ ﳌﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﺃﺧﱪﱐ ﻋﻨﻚ ﻳﺎ ﺁﺻﻒ ﲰﻌﺘﻚ ﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻓﺄﺛﻨﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﺣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻠﻐﺖ ﺫﻛﺮﻱ ﺃﺛﻨﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻲ‪ ‬ﺻﻐﲑﺍﹰ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﺘﲏ ﻛﺒﲑﺍﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﻫﺬﺍ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺑﻪ ﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻤﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﱀ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﲟﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺤﻘﻘﺖ ﺃﱐ ﺃﺛﲏ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻌﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻷﻥ ﻏﲑ ﺍﷲ ﻳﻌﺒﺪ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭﻙ ﻣﻨﺬ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺟﺰﺍﺀ ﻧﻌﻤﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﻭﻻ ﺷﻜﺮ ﲤﻠﻴﻜﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ ﻭﺃﺑﺎﻙ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻐﻔﺮ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻓﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻭﻛﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻭﻫﺮﺏ‬
‫ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﻈﻔﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺣﺒﺴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﳜﺎﻃﺐ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺑﻠﺴﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺣﺴﻨﺖ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻐﻮﻳﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ ﻓﻌﻨﻒ ﺍﷲ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﺕ ﺍﳉﻦ ﺧﺎﲤﻪ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﰲ ﺑﲏ‬
‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻓﻴﺬﻛﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻓﺮﺩ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻭﺧﺎﲤﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺳﺠﺪﺕ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﺼﻨﻢ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﺎﺗﺖ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺧﻠﻖ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻭﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﻭﺧﺮﺍﻃﻴﻢ ﺿﻴﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﳝﺸﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺟﻠﲔ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻄﲑﻭﻥ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺇ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﻣﻠﻤﻠﻤﺔ ﻛﺎﻟﻜﺮﺓ ﺗﺼﻴﺢ ﺻﻴﺎﺣﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻯ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺻﻴﺎﺣﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﻘﻴﻢ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺍﺷﻬﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻻ ﺃﻱ‬
‫ﺷﻲﺀ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻱ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻫﺎﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻋﻈﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺷﻴﺦ ﺍﺑﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺤﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﺧﻀﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻠﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻥ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﱂ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﻭﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﳉﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‬
‫ﺑﻘﺪﺭﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃ ﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺳﲑﻭﺍ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻨﺘﻬﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻕ‪.‬‬

‫‪21‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻗﻀﺒﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻳﻌﺘﻤﺪﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺴﻂ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺒﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﻨﻌﻮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ‬
‫ﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺖ ﻓﺨﻠﺼﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺭﺷﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﳋﻀﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﻋﻈﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻄﻠﻴﻤﻮﺱ ﺃ ﻥ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻒ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻓﺮﺳﺨﺎﹰ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺇ ﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﻫﺒﻂ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺗﺮﺍﻩ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﳘﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺪﻡ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻐﻤﻮﺳﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺳﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﻕ‬
‫ﻟﻴﻼ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻓﻼ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇ ﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺧﻄﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺧﻄﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﻳﻮﻣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﻭﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻄﺮ ﻭﺍﻷﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﺃﺭﺿﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺒﺎﺩﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺃﻭﺩﻳﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭﻩ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻏﻮﺹ ﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺘﺼﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺍﻣﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﺎﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻛﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﻢ؛ ﻭﻋﺮﻭﻗﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻢ ﻟﺴﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺟﺮﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻢ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻋﻲ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﻻ ﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺎﺱ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﰲ ﻏﻴﺎﺽ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻬﻢ ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻣﺘﻮﺣﺸﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺷﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻠﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺮﺝ ﺻﻐﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﺷﻌﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﺯﻏﺐ ﺍﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﺴﻠﻘﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻴﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺳﺒﺎﺣﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺳﺮﻋﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻳﺒﻴﻌﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﺑﺎﳊﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻌﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻣﻔﻠﻔﻠﺔ؛ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﺣﻴﺎﺀ‬
‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﻇﻔﺮﻭﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﺸﺮﺣﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺗﺸﺮﳛﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻃﻴﻨﻪ ﻓﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇ ﺫﺍ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺫﺍﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺘﺼﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻧﺒﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﻈﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻛﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﺗﺜﻘﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﺴﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﳝﻸ ﻋﺪﺓ‬
‫ﺟﺮﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﺻﻤﻎ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻏﺼﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﻄﻌﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺸﺒﻬﺎ ﺍﺑﻴﺾ ﺧﻔﻴﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﲝﺮﻳﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻃﻴﺎﺭ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻌﻲ ﻭﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﳋﻴﺰﺭﺍﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﳝﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﻮﻣﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻮﺯ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻭﻛﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﻧﺎﺭﺟﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺼﺐ ﺳﻜﺮ ﻭﺃﺭﺯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺧﺎﻗﻪ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺳﻼﻫﻴﻂ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻳﺴﲑ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺳﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻟﺒﺎﺳﻪ ﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺬﻫﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻗﻠﻨﺴﻮﺓ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻣﻜﻠﻠﺔ ﺑﻐﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻧﺎﺭﺟﻴﻞ ﻭﻣﻮﺯ ﻭﺳﻜﺮ ﻭﺻﻨﺪﻝ ﻭﺳﻨﺒﻞ ﻭﻗﺮﻧﻔﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﲝﺬﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﰲ‬
‫ﺫﺭﻭﺗﻪ ﻧﺎﺭ ﺗﺘﻘﺪ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﲰﻜﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻮ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻧﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺩﺧﺎﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪22‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻭﻳﻪ ﻭﰲ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﳌﻬﺮﺍﺝ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻓﺮﻃﺎﺋﻴﻞ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻮﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺰﻑ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻣﺮ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻐﻨﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺇ ﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺧﻴﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻋﺮﺍﻑ ﲡﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻴﻤﻮﻧﺔ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻤﺎﺭﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻳﺴﲑﺓ ﻭﺑﻘﻤﺎﺭﻱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﺭﻱ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻔﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﻳﻐﺮﻕ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﳉﻮﺩﺗﻪ ﻭﺛﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﻘﺮ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻕ ﻭﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﻣﺸﺎﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻘﺎﻭﺩ ﺩﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺳﻼﺣﻬﻢ ﻭﺳﻼﺳﻞ‬
‫ﻛﻼ‪‬ﻢ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺐ ﺍﳌﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﳚﲎ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻚ ﻭﺍﻵﺑﻨﻮﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﺻﻴﲏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﻢ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﻮ ﺍﻷﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﻼﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﱐ ﻭﺍﳌﺬﺍﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ ﻭﺍﳊﻠﺰﻭﻧﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳊﻠﻰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺪﻓﻨﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻋﻔﻨﺖ ﺃﺗﻰ ﲡﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺪ ﻓﺎﺷﺘﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﲝﺮ ﻫﺮﻛﻨﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺑﻄﻠﻴﻤﻮﺱ ﻭﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﺳﻮﻯ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺏ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳝﻠﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﱪ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻌﺔ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﺃﻭ ﳓﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ‬
‫ﳜﺮﺝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻫﺎﺟﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻌﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺭﻣﺖ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻓﻘﺬﻓﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺍﺣﻞ‪.‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﲡﺎﺭ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﺧﺮﻩ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻋﺪﺩﻫﻢ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺭﻭﺡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺷﻘﻒ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭﺟﻴﻞ ﻓﻴﻄﺮﺣﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺄﺧﺬﻭﻧﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﳚﻤﻌﻮﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻬﺮﺍﺝ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ ﻟﻴﺲ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺮﻕ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻄﻮﻑ ‪‬ﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺪﺭﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﲝﺮ ﻻ ﲢﺼﻰ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺯﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺴﺒﺎﺳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺎﻓﻠﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺒﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻟﻐﲑﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻄﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺸﺎﺭﻛﻪ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﻧﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺳﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﻭﺍﻷﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﻭﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‬
‫ﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺑﺎﺑﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺟﺒﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺒﻠﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﺮﺟﺔ ﻭﲝﺮ ﻳﺼﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ‬

‫‪23‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺍﳌﻌﺮﻭﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲤﺮ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﻭﺯﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﰲ ﲝﺮ‬
‫ﻓﺴﻴﺢ ﻭﻣﺎﺀ ﻋﺬﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺴﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺮﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﺮﺳﺎ ﺗﱰﻟﻪ ﺧﺎﻧﻘﻮﺍ ﻭﻣﺎﺅﻫﺎ ﻋﺬﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻋﺬﺑﺔ ﻭﰲ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﻦ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﱀ ﻭﺷﺠﺮ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺯﺭﻉ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻴﻨﺎﺀ ﺃﻭﺩﻳﺔ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺑﲔ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺗﲔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺮﺳﺎ ﺃﺳﻮﺍﻕ ﻭﲡﺎﺭ ﻭﺧﺮﻭﺝ‬
‫ﻭﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﻭﲡﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﲢﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺗﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﲡﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺧﻠﻨﺠﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻭﻓﻠﻨﱳ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺳﻮﺩ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻋﺮﰊ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻏﲑ ﺑﻼﺩﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻘﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﻗﻄﻌﻮﻩ ﻗﻄﻌﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻏﺬﺍﺅﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭﺟﻴﻞ ﻭﻗﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺁﺟﺎﻡ ﺗﻨﺒﺖ ﺍﳋﻴﺰﺭﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﻻ ﻳﺴﺘﺘﺮﻭﻥ‬
‫ﺑﺸﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻘﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻨﺠﻲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﺧﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﺭﻳﺎﺣﺎ ﻭﻣﻮﺟﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻀﺎﻳﻘﺎ ﻭﺟﺒﺎﻻ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﻄﺎﻳﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺻﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺻﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻝ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﳓﻮ ﲬﺴﺔ ﺃﺷﺒﺎﺭ‬
‫ﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻳﺘﻮﺍﺛﺒﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻳﺪﻭﺭﻭﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺆﺫﻭﻥ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﰒ ﻳﻌﻮﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻇﻬﺮﻭﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﻷﺧﺒﺚ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺴﺘﻌﺪﻭﻥ ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺃﻫﺒﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﻔﻔﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﻘﻄﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻗﻞ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﲔ ﺇﻥ ﺧﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﻛﺴﺮﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺇ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﲰﻜﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﻴﻘﺔ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﰲ ﻋﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﻭﻳﻨﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺗﻌﺮﺿﺖ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻓﻜﺴﺮ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﲟﺎ ﻗﺮﺑﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻨﺪﻓﻊ ﺑﻘﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﺘﺒﻊ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﺍﳍﺎﺭﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻼ ﺗﺸﻌﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻻ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺣﺼﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ ﲜﻤﻠﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﻼ ﳝﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﻓﺘﻬﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻗﻄﻊ ﳊﻤﻬﺎ ﻭﺫﻭﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﺬﻭﺏ ﳊﻤﻬﺎ ﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﲑ ﺩﻫﻨﺎ ﻳﻨﺘﻔﻊ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‬
‫ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺑﻘﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺩﺧﺎﻥ ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﳍﺐ ﻧﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﺣﺪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻮ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﳌﺪﺭ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﳍﺎ ﺑﺎﺭﻧﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻳﻘﻄﻌﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻭﻳﺴﺒﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﻘﺘﻠﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﻳﻌﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻔﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻧﻔﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻣﻘﺎﺗﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﻄﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻄﻤﻊ ﰲ ﺳﻮﺍﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻐﺘﺎﻝ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻧﺞ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻷﻫﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﳌﺎ ﻓﺴﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﲔ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳋﻮﺍﺭﺝ ﻭﺍﳍﺮﺝ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﺗﻘﺼﺪ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻧﺞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﺗﻠﻮﻥ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮﻫﺎ‬

‫‪24‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺪﺍﺋﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺎﻧﻘﻮﺍ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑﻩ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻧﺞ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﺴﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺗﻜﺴﲑﻫﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻓﺮﺳﺦ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺘﺎﺟﺮ ﻭﻃﻴﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻣﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺗﻜﺴﲑﻫﺎ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﺮﺍﺳﺦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﻢ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻜﺴﲑﻫﺎ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻓﺮﺳﺨﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ ﺑﲔ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻭﺗﻜﺴﲑﻫﺎ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻓﺮﺳﺨﺎﹰ‪.‬ﻭﺑﻜﻠﻪ ﳎﺘﻤﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺘﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻌﻲ ﻭﺍﻵﺑﻨﻮﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻘﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳉﻬﺎﺯ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﳌﻬﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﰲ ﻏﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﳋﺼﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﺣﻜﻲ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﻮﺛﻖ ﺑﻘﻮﳍﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻜﺔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻏﺮﺩﺕ ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺳﺤﺎﺭ ﲡﺎﻭﺑﺖ ﻣﻦ ﳓﻮ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺳﺦ ﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﻋﻤﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻈﺎﻡ ﻗﺮﺍﻫﺎ ﻻﻣﻔﺎﻭﺯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﻓﺮ ﻳﺴﺎﻓﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻼ ﺯﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﱰﻝ‬
‫ﺣﻴﺚ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻳﺘﺪﺍﺭﺳﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺳﺮﻳﺎﻧﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺼﺺ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻟﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺒﻠﻎ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﻭﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺭﻃﻞ ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﳍﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻳﺘﺪﺍﺭﺳﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺘﻜﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺩﻳﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻳﺒﻴﺢ ﳍﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺃﻋﻨﺎﺏ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻋﻨﺎﺏ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﺐ ﻭﺍﺩ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﳚﻮﺯ ﺍ‪‬ﺘﺎﺯ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺐ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﻦ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﰲ ﺭﻳﺎﺽ ﻭﻏﻴﺎﺽ ﻭﻫﻮﺍﺀ ﻣﻌﺘﺪﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺎﺓ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺑﻨﺼﻒ ﺩﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺮﺩ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻄﺮﻧﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﺘﺰﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺑﻌﻠﻢ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻧﺞ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻳﺰﺭﻉ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺫﺭﺓ ﻭﻗﺼﺐ ﻭﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﺎﺕ ﻓﻬﻮ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮﻫﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﳌﺨﺮﻣﲔ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﻣﺖ ﺃﻧﻮﻓﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﲤﻮﺍ ﺃﺳﻠﺤﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺑﻄﺮﻑ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻠﺴﻠﺔ ﳚﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻭﳝﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﺪﻡ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺴﻔﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ ﻭﺇﻻ ﺷﺪﺕ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺳﻞ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻨﺎﻗﻬﻢ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻘﻢ ﳍﻢ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ‪‬ﺸﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺮﻛﺰﻩ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺘﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻠﻌﺮﺏ ﰲ ﻗﻠﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻫﻴﺒﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻋﺎﻳﻨﻮﺍ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﺠﺪﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﺑﻦ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺗﻨﺒﺖ ﰲ‬

‫‪25‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺑﻼﺩﻫﻢ ﺷﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﳉﻼﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺮ ﰲ ﺻﺪﻭﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺇﳕﺎ ﻳﺼﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺻﺒﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺧﻄﺒﺎﺀ ﺑﻠﻐﺎﺀ ﺑﺄﻟﺴﻨﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﺘﺮ ﲜﻠﺪ ﳕﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻋﺼﺎ‪ ،‬ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻳﻘﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺟﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﳜﻄﺐ ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮﻫﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﳍﻢ ﺃﻣﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻀﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺳﻘﻄﺮﻯ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﱪ ﺍﻟﺴﻘﻄﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻮﺿﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺑﻼﺩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﳌﺎ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻓﻮﺭ ﺍﳍﻨﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻜﺎﺗﺐ ﺍﺭﺳﻄﺎﻃﺎﻟﻴﺲ‬
‫ﲟﺎ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﲟﺎ ﻭﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻏﻠﺒﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻤﺎﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺭﺳﻄﺎﻃﺎﻟﻴﺲ ﻳﻜﺘﺐ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻳﺆﻛﺪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﺴﻘﻄﺮﻯ ﻻﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﱪ ﺍﻟﺴﻘﻄﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻻﺗﺘﻢ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﺭﺟﺎﺕ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺇﻥ ﻭﺟﺪﻫﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﻋﻤﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻳﺴﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﻭﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﳍﻢ ﲟﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﳊﻔﻆ ﳍﺎ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺍﺋﻒ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺘﻔﺎﻅ ‪‬ﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻌﺚ ﺍﻟﺴﻴﺪ ﻋﻴﺴﻰ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺮﱘ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻤﻠﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﺒﻘﺎﻳﺎﻫﻢ ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻣﻊ ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ؛ ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﳝﲔ ﺍﳋﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺎﻥ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﲢﺎﺫﻱ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﻠﺒﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺽ ﻋﺎﺩ ﻭﺟﺮﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺒﺎﺑﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻗﺸﻌﻤﺔ ﻭﺿﻴﻖ ﻋﻴﺶ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﻌﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺳﻮﺍﺣﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺘﺴﻊ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻗﻠﻴﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻴﺶ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻧﺒﺎﺕ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﱪ ﻓﺒﺎﻋﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﻣﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻠﺰﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﻘﻄﻊ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﱵ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺳﻠﻄﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺿﺠﻴﺠﻬﻢ ﻭﺗﺼﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻣﻌﺎﺷﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﳜﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻭﳜﺎﻃﺒﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﺍﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺌﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻓﺬﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻧﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺑﻌﺚ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻧﱯ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺳﺎﻓﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺟﺮﺩﻭﻝ ﻓﺂﻣﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻨﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺩ ﰲ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻔﻴﻪ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻟﻴﺎﻝ ﲤﺮﺍ ﰲ ‪‬ﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﳊﻼﻭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺎﺭﺟﻴﻼ ﻭﻃﻴﻮﺭﺍ ﻣﺸﻮﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻃﻴﺐ ﻣﻀﻐﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻮﻉ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺳﻴﻖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺮﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ ﻻ ﻳﺘﺠﻪ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﺴﲑ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﱴ ﳛﻤﻞ ﻭﺇﻥ ﱂ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺴﺮ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﺩ ﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺍﳋﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﺮﻑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﺮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻋﺮﻓﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﳛﻤﻞ ﲦﺮﺍ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺯ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻛﱪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻳﺆﻛﻞ ﺑﻘﺸﺮﻩ ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻡ‬

‫‪26‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻣﻘﺎﻡ ﻛﻞ ﺩﻭﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﱂ ﳝﺮﺽ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻬﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻣﻠﻚ ﳝﻨﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺟﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﺯﺭﻋﻪ ﻓﺄﻭﺭﻕ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺜﻤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺪﳍﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﺮ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﺄﻛﻞ‬
‫ﳊﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﺮﺣﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺭﻓﻌﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻻ ﺧﻼﺹ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺃﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺇﺭﺍﺩﺗﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﻴﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﲪﻞ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﲰﻌﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﻗﻔﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﻣﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺣﺎﺭﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﺻﱪﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺘﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ‪‬ﻢ ﺻﻴﺤﺔ ﺳﻘﻄﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻐﺸﻴﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﱪﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﺎﺩﺗﻪ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺭﺟﻞ ﺻﺎﱀ ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻄﻠﺒﺎﹰ ﳌﺎ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﻣﺘﻌﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﻳﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺗﻠﻮﺡ ﻷﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻓﻴﻄﻠﺒﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻇﻨﻮﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻗﺪ ﻗﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺗﺒﺎﻋﺪﺕ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺇﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺻﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺩﺧﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺨﻮﺻﺎﹰ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺷﺠﺮﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺪﺝ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻴﻨﻴﻪ ﺩﻣﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳑﺮ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻳﺒﻜﻲ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻧﻪ ﻓﻐﺰﺍﻫﻢ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺒﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻛﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺿﺮﺑﻮﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﱂ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﺏ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻓﺘﺮﻛﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺫﻧﻴﻪ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺗﺼﻔﲑﺍﹰ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺳﺮﻫﺎﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﺎ ﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺷﺠﺮ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﻢ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺛﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻼﺣﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﱴ ﻭﻗﻊ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺩﻓﻌﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﺻﻘﻠﻴﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﺩﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ‬
‫ﻭﳍﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻭﻣﺰﺍﺭﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﺎﺯﺍﺀ ﺃﻓﺮﻳﻘﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺎﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺰﺍﻝ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺩﺧﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺎﺭﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﻳﻄﲑ ﻣﻨﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺷﺮﺍﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺳﻮﺩ ﻣﺜﻘﺒﻪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻹﺳﻔﻨﺞ ﺗﻄﻔﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﺘﺤﻤﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﳛﻜﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﻗﺪﺍﻣﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﺪﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻴﺤﺮﻕ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺻﺎﺩﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺍﺑﻪ ﻭﺣﻴﺘﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻠﻘﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﺝ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻮ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺳﺮﺩﺍﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮ ﻭﻋﻴﻮﻥ ﻭﺯﺭﻭﻉ ﻭﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﲡﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺃﻗﺮﻳﻄﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﻌﺪﻥ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻭﲦﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺳﺘﺔ‬
‫ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺗﺮﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺻﺪ ﺑﻌﺪﺕ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻭﻏﺎﺑﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﺍﻫﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ‪.‬‬

‫‪27‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺷﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﻄﻠﻊ ﺑﻄﻠﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺰﺍﻝ ﻃﺎﻟﻌﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﰒ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﳓﻄﺎﻁ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻐﻴﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﲰﻜﺔ ﺻﻐﲑﺓ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ﲪﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‬
‫ﺃﺑﺼﺮ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﱂ ﺗﻐﺐ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻭﺩﺧﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻋﺠﻴﺐ ﻇﺮﻳﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻃﺎﻭﺭﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻠﻴﺲ ﲟﻠﻚ ﻭﻳﺘﻔﺎﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﻜﺜﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻭﻻﺩ ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻩ ﻗﻮﺓ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺴﻴﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﳎﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﻣﺮﺍﺭﺍﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﲟﺴﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻫﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻫﺒﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺩﺃ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺣﺠﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﺧﻔﻴﻔﺔ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ ﻗﻨﺎﻃﲑ ﻳﺰﻥ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺃﺭﻃﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻗﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻭﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻮﺩ ﻟﻌﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺃﻥ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﻬﻢ ﺍﻧﻜﺴﺮ ‪‬ﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‬
‫ﻃﺮﺣﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺗﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺣﺠﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻻ ﳚﺪﻭﻥ ﻏﺬﺍﺀ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻊ ﻛﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺧﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻒ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﻠﻢ ﳍﻢ ﺯﻭﺭﻕ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﻛﺐ ﻓﺠﺮﻭﻩ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻓﺄﻭﺳﻘﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺛﻘﻠﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻤﻊ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻣﺎ ﳛﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻬﺪﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺠﺎﺓ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺴﲑﻭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺇﻻ ﻳﺴﲑﺍﹰ ﺣﱴ ﻋﻄﺐ ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺭﻕ ﻭﺗﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻨﺞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﺣﺔ ﳓﻮ ﻣﻬﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﰲ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﺠﻌﻠﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻌﻠﻘﻮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺑﻴﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻋﺰﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺭﺃﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺀﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﱪﻭﺍ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺳﺠﺪﻭﺍ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺨﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺧﲑ ﻭﺷﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﲣﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻦ ﻳﻠﻘﺤﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻭﻳﻠﺪﻭﻥ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇ‪‬ﻦ ﻳﻠﻘﺤﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻋﺮﻭﻕ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳋﺰﺭﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﺑﺘﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻦ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻓﻬﻤﻤﻦ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﲪﺘﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻭﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﺸﺒﺔ ﻭﺳﻠﻤﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﺘﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺃﺗﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‬
‫ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﻓﻄﺎﻓﺖ ﺗﻄﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻭﻗﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﳍﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﱪ ﻭﻻ ﺃﺛﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺃﺳﻌﻼﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻣﺸﻮﻩ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻯ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ‪ ،‬ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﲡﺴﺪ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺲ‪،‬‬

‫‪28‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ ﲝﺮﻱ ﻣﺸﻮﻩ ﻣﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺧﱪ ﺫﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﲔ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ ﻧﻘﻴﺔ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﺃﲦﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺧﻠﻖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻹﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﺼﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻏﺎﺑﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺑﺼﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ‪‬ﺮ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﺽ ﺑﺸﺎﻃﺌﻪ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﲦﺮﺓ ﻃﻴﺒﺔ ﻟﺬﻳﺬﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﻢ‬
‫ﻣﺸﺮﻗﺔ ﺑﺄﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﺭﻗﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﳋﻼﻝ ﻛﱪﺍﹰ ﻭﻟﻴﻨﺎﹰ ﻭﺣﺴﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺗﺴﲑ ﺑﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺪ ﻭﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺯﺍﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺗﻘﻠﺼﺖ ﻭﺍﳓﻄﺖ ﺑﺎﳓﻄﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺎﺑﺖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﺒﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲦﺮﻫﺎ ﺃﺣﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺭﻗﻬﺎ ﺃﻃﻴﺐ ﺭﺍﺋﺤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﻗﻬﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻟﻴﺤﻤﻠﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﻀﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻭﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﺏ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻀﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺻﻴﺢ ‪‬ﻢ "ﺭﺩﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺧﺬﰎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻭﻻ ﺗﺘﻌﺮﺿﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﻓﺘﻬﻠﻜﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺩﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺧﺬﻭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺭﻛﺒﻮﺍ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﻔﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻏﲑ ﺣﺸﻴﺶ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﺪﺭﺍﻥ ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺃ‪‬ﻜﺘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﻭﺻﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻛﺎﳊﻤﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺮﺩﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻴﺸﻜﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﺑﻼﺩﻛﻢ ﻫﺬﻩ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺯﻕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﲰﺎﻙ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺿﺮﻭﺏ ﺍﳊﺸﻴﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻧﺸﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﺪﺭﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻓﻼ ﺃﻧﻘﻠﻜﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﺧﺼﺐ ﻟﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻧﺼﻨﻊ ﺑﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ ﰲ‬
‫ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺗﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻐﲎ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻔﻴﻬﻢ ﻟﻮ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻓﺎﻧﻄﻠﻘﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺩ ﳍﻢ ﻳﺴﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺘﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺟﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺜﻤﺮﺍﺕ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﻣﺜﻠﻪ ﺑﺒﻠﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ؟‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﷲ ﻭﻻ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻌﻀﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻓﻬﺬﺍ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻨﺎ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻧﻠﺘﻔﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﺎ ﻟﻨﺆﺛﺮ ﺍﳊﺸﻴﺶ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻫﺐ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻟﻴﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺩﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺘﻌﺠﺒﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﻟﻪ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﺳﺮﺍﺑﻴﻠﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﻕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻭﺑﻴﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﻴﻨﺔ ﻓﺴﺄﳍﻢ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺴﺎﺋﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻮﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺳﻠﻮﱐ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺃﺣﺒﺒﺘﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻧﺎ ﻧﺴﺄﻟﻚ ﺍﳋﻠﺪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﱏ ﱄ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺃﻗﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻧﻔﺲ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﰲ ﺃﻧﻔﺎﺳﻲ ‪.‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻨﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺁﺟﺎﻟﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻻ ﺃﻋﺮﻑ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺃﺟﻠﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻴﻒ ﱄ ﲟﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺃﺟﻞ ﻏﲑﻱ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻓﺎﻣﻨﺤﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﺤﺔ ﺗﺒﻘﻰ‬
‫ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﺃﺑﻠﻐﻪ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻲ ﻓﻜﻴﻒ ﻟﻐﲑﻱ ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻓﺪﻋﻨﺎ ﻧﻄﻠﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳑﻦ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﺘﻄﺎﻭﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺴﺎﻛﺮ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﻃﺊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺭﺟﻞ ﺣﺪﺍﺩ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻓﻊ‬
‫ﺑﺼﺮﻩ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺇﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺴﺎﻛﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻨﻌﻚ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪29‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻨﻬﻮﺽ ﺇﱄ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺴﻜﺮﻱ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺠﺒﲏ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ ﻓﺄﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﱂ ؟ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﱐ ﻋﺎﻳﻨﺖ ﻗﺒﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﺭﻱ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﺴﻜﲔ ﻻ ﳝﻠﻚ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻜﲔ ﰲ ﻳﻮﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻓﻜﻨﺖ ﺃﺗﻌﺎﻫﺪﳘﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻴﺖ ﺃﻛﻔﺎ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﻭﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﺭﳑﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﺧﺘﻠﻄﺎ ﻓﺠﻬﺪﺕ ﺇﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻋﺮﻑ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻜﲔ ﻓﻠﻢ ﺃﻗﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻲ‪ ‬ﻛﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺼﻨﺎﻋﺘﻚ ﺗﻜﻔﻴﻚ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﻛﺴﺐ ‪‬ﺎ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺩﺭﺍﻫﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺃﻧﻔﻖ ﺩﺭﳘﺎ ﻭﺍﻗﻀﻲ ﺩﺭﳘﺎ ﻭﺃﺳﻠﻒ ﺩﺭﳘﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻟﺪﺭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﻧﻔﻖ ﻫﻮ ﻣﺆﻧﱵ ﻭﻣﺆﻧﺔ ﻋﻴﺎﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻗﻀﻴﻪ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﺰﻣﲏ ﰲ ﻛﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﻴﱵ ﻭﻣﻮﺿﻊ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻠﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺳﻠﻔﻪ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻧﻔﻘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﻟﺪﻱ ﻟﻴﻨﻔﻘﻪ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﱪﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻓﻼ ﺗﻨﻔﻖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻚ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﻢ ﻻ ﳛﺘﺎﺟﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﻻ ﺃﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻻ ﻳﻨﺼﻒ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻧﺼﻒ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻼ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﺫﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻜﻤﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻭﻟﺩﻩ‬

‫ﺃﲨﻊ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳉﻤﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﺴﺖ ﺧﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﻴﺎﻥ ﻭﻛﺴﺎﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻟﺒﺎﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻔﺮﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺳﺠﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻼﺋﻜﺘﻪ ﻓﺴﺠﺪﻭﺍ ﺇﻻ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻳﺼﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ ﻣﱴ ﺷﺎﺀ ﻓﺄﰉ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ ﻵﺩﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺘﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺮﺍﺏ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺃﻃﺆﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺭ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻃﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻔﻀﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﻀﻠﻪ ﺑﺎﻷﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻏﺸﻰ ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻗﻄﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﰲ ﺍﻗﻞ ﻣﻦ ﳌﺢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ ﺃﺑﻠﺴﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻟﻌﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻬﺎ ﻟﺒﺎﺳﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻟﺜﻼﺙ ﺳﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻣﻀﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻭﺃﺑﺎﺣﻬﻤﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﺍﻻ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ‪‬ﺎﳘﺎ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳊﺒﺔ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﻷﺗﺮﺟﺔ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻟﻘﺘﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻋﻄﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺍﻣﺔ ﺍﺷﺘﺎﻕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳋﻠﻮﺩ ﻓﻄﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻝ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺩﺧﻠﻪ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺐ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ " ﻣﺎ‪‬ﺎﻛﻤﺎ ﺭﺑﻜﻤﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﻻ ﺇﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﺎ ﻣﻠﻜﲔ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺎﻟﺪﻳﻦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﲰﻬﻤﺎ ﺃﱐ ﻟﻜﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺻﺤﲔ " ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﲝﻮﺍﺀ ﺣﱴ ﺃﻛﻠﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻭﺃﻃﻌﻤﺖ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻵﺩﻡ ﻓﺄﻛﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻛﻼ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﻜﺸﻒ ﻟﺒﺎﺳﻬﻤﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻌﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﺑﺪﺕ ﳍﻤﺎ ﺳﻮﺁ‪‬ﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺮﺏ ﺁﺩﻡ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﳝﻴﻨﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﴰﺎﻻﹰ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻱ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻌﻠﻘﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﻻﺗﺮﺝ ﻭﺣﺒﺴﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﺎﺻﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﻔﻘﺎ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﺍﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﻕ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﺘﺮﺍﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻗﺪ ﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻏﺬﺍﺀ ﻟﻜﻤﺎ ﻭﻟﺬﺭﻳﺘﻜﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﻌﲏ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﺁﻛﻼ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺎﺻﻴﲔ ﻓﺎﻫﺒﻄﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ ﺃﻧﺘﻤﺎ ﻭﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﻀﻜﻢ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻋﺪﻭ‪.‬‬

‫‪30‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻧﺰﻉ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻤﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﺒﻄﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻘﺎﻡ ﺁﺩﻡ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﻣﺎﺋﺘﲔ‬
‫ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺭﺑﻊ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻫﺒﻂ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺭﻕ ﺍﳌﺨﺼﻮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺟﻒ ﺍﻟﻮﺭﻕ ﻭﺫﻫﺒﺖ ﺭﻃﻮﺑﺘﻪ ﺗﻘﻄﻊ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻘﻂ ﻓﻨﺴﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻭﻃﺮﺣﺘﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ ﻓﻨﺒﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﺄﺭﺽ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻭﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺇﻻ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﺍﻗﻴﺖ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﲝﺮﻩ ﻣﻐﺎﻳﺺ ﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲰﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻛﻨﺎﻩ ﺃﺑﺎ ﳏﻤﺪ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﻳﻼ ﺟﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻧﻘﺺ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﺣﺴﻨﻪ ﻭﻃﻮﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﻓﺤﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻟﺴﺎﻧﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﺰﻉ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﰒ ﺭﺩﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﻮﺑﺘﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﺒﻂ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﻴﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﺒﻀﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻓﺘﻨﺎﺛﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﻘﺺ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺴﻨﻬﺎ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﺋﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﺒﻂ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻗﺒﻀﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﻋﺼﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺷﺠﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺳﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺁﺱ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻗﻀﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﲦﺎﺭ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺇﻛﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺸﻮﺭ ﻭﻫﻲ‪ :‬ﺍﳉﻮﺯ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻨﺪﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺴﺘﻖ ﻭﺍﳋﺸﺨﺎﺵ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻠﻮﻁ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺴﻄﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﺯ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺯ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﳍﺎ ﻧﻮﻯ ﻭﻫﻲ‪ :‬ﺍﳋﻮﺥ ﻭﺍﳌﺸﻤﺶ ﻭﺍﻷﺟﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻋﺮﻭﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺒﲑﺍ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺻﻴﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺎﻩ ﺑﻠﻮﻁ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺒﻖ ﻭﺍﳌﻘﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻻ ﻗﺸﻮﺭ ﳍﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻧﻮﻯ ﻭﻫﻲ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺎﺡ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻔﺮﺟﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻤﺜﺮﻯ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻮﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺗﺮﺝ ﻭﺍﳋﺮﻧﻮﺏ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳋﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺦ ﻭﺍﻟﱪ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺜﺮﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺎﺏ ﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ؛ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻻ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺳﻮﺀً ﻓﺎﻏﻔﺮ ﱄ ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺧﲑ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻓﺮﻳﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﰲ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻫﺒﻂ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺘﲔ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﻭﺳﺒﻜﻪ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺪﺓ ﺍﳌﻄﺮﻗﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻼﻟﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﳌﺪﻳﺔ ﻭﺁﻻﺕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻵﻻﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳚﺘﻨﺒﻪ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﲑ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻗﺪﻣﻪ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻔﺎﻭﺯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺗﻰ ﺟﺪﺓ ﻓﻮﺟﺪ ‪‬ﺎ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺗﺒﻜﻲ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻋﻤﻠﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪31‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻳﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ ﻓﻄﻒ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺸﻰ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﻠﻘﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺑﺎﻷﺑﻄﺢ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺣﻴﺎﻙ ﺍﷲ ﻳﺎ ﺁﺩﻡ‪ ،‬ﻟﻘﺪ ﻃﻔﻨﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻠﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﺑﺄﻟﻔﻲ ﻋﺎﻡ ﻭﻟﺴﻨﺎ ﺑﺄﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺳﻚ ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺽ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻛﺎﺓ ﻭﺍﻻﻏﺘﺴﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺭﻉ ﻭﺣﺼﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺒﺰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺩﺃﺑﻚ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻭﺫﺭﻳﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﺎ ﺭﺏ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻠﻐﺖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺸﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺲ ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﲞﻄﻴﺌﺘﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻮﻗﺒﺖ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺑﻌﺸﺮ ﺧﺼﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺬﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﻻﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻴﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺰﻥ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻨﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ ﻟﻠﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻦ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳉﻤﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻟﻮﻟﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﺼﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻗﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺐ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳊﺰﻥ ﻭﲨﻊ ﺑﲔ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﲜﻤﻊ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﺭﻓﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻮﻗﺐ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺑﻨﻘﺼﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻐﲑ ﺣﺴﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻮﻓﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲣﺎﻓﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺘﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﺭﻳﺘﻪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳌﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻔﻈﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺭﺯﻗﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻌﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻮﻗﺒﺖ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﺑﻘﺺ ﺟﻨﺎﺣﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﺪﻡ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻳﻬﺎ ﻭﺭﺟﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺸﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻄﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺷﻖ ﻟﺴﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻮﻓﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻋﺪﺍﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻏﺬﺍﺅﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻃﻠﺒﺖ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﺘﻞ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﺴﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﻥ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻏﺸﻲ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻭﺗﻮﺃﻣﺘﻪ ﻗﻠﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻮﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺗﻮﺃﻣﲔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺑﻄﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻭﺗﻮﺃﻣﺘﻪ ﻟﺒﻮﺫﺍ ﻓﺸﻐﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﳊﺮﺙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻐﻞ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺑﺮﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﻐﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﻭﺝ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺖ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻓﻀﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎ ﺃﺣﻖ ﺑﺄﺧﱵ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﳘﺎ ﺃﺑﻮﳘﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺮﺑﺎ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻓﺄﻳﻬﻤﺎ ﺗﻘﺒﻞ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺃﺣﻖ ﺑﺄﺧﺖ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺿﻴﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪.‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺃﲰﻦ ﻛﺒﺶ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺫﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﻨﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳉﻤﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﺶ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﻭﱂ ﺗﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻏﻀﺒﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻋﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺼﺮﻓﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻣﲎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻢ ﻳﺪﺭ ﻛﻴﻒ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﻓﺘﺼﻮﺭ ﻟﻪ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻟﻌﻨﻪ ﺍﷲ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﻩ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﻃﺎﺋﺮﺍﹰ ﻓﻔﺸﺦ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﲝﺠﺮ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻪ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻏﺎﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻴﻨﻪ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻔﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺣﱴ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻏﻨﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺮﻋﻰ ﻓﺤﻤﻞ ﺣﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﻓﻄﺮﺣﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺻﺒﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺩﻣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﺎﻝ ﲢﺴﺮ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻫﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻓﺎﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻟﻪ ﺧﻴﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺧﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺎﻗﻮﺗﺔ ﲪﺮﺍﺀ ﻭﺿﻌﺖ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎﺋﺘﲔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻬﺒﻂ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻫﺒﺔ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺗﻮﺃﻣﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺭﻳﺦ‪ :‬ﺇﻧﻪ ﻭﻟﺪ‬
‫ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﻄﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻜﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻷﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﻬﺮ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳉﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﺯﻣﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﲑ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﺭﺑﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺧﲑ ﻭﺷﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺜﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﲝﺮﺍﹰ ﻓﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﱃ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻜﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻭﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺧﲑ ﻭﺷﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺋﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻛﺜﺮ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺑﻌﺜﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﻨﻬﺎﻫﻢ ﻋﻤﺎ ‪‬ﺎﻩ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ‬

‫‪32‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻮﻓﺎﻩ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺴﻨﺪ ﻭﺻﻴﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻭﻳﻌﻠﻤﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻠﻢ ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻼﺣﺔ ﻣﻮﻋﻮﻛﺎﹰ ﻓﺤﻢ ﻭﻣﺮﺽ ﺇﺣﺪﻯﻮﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﲣﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺍﺷﺘﻬﻰ ﻗﻄﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺐ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳑﻦ ﻟﻘﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻘﻴﻪ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻌﺰﺍﻩ ﰲ ﺍﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺭﺟﻊ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﺎﻙ ﻗﺪ ﻣﺎﺕ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﻨﻪ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺎ ﻭﻫﺐ ﻟﺪﺍﻭﺩ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻜﻔﻦ ﻭﺣﻨﻮﻁ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﻐﺴﻠﻪ ﻭﻳﻜﻔﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻟﻜﻢ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺗﺎﻛﻢ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﱃ ﻏﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﱰ ﰲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺃﰊ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻴﺲ ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﻓﺎﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳉﻤﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺑﻴﺖ‬
‫ﻭﺭﻓﻌﺖ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﺍﳋﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﺰﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺣﺰﻧﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺳﻨﺔ ﰒ ﻣﺎﺗﺖ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﲪﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻠﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﻴﺚ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻴﲔ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺳﻠﲔ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺸﻲﺀ ﻤﻥ ﺃﺨﺒﺎﺭ ﻭﻟﺩﻩ‬

‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺼﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻭﻛﻔﺮ ﻭﳌﺎ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺃﺧﺎﻩ ﻫﺮﺏ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺑﺄﺧﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﺷﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﱪﻳﺔ ﻭﺇﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻧﺼﻒ ﻋﺬﺍﺏ‬
‫ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻣﱴ ﺳﻔﻚ ﺩﻡ ﺑﻐﲑ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺣﻖ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺷﺮﻳﻜﺎﹰ ﻟﺼﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﺷﻴﺚ ﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺑﻌﺜﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺍﱃ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‬
‫ﻫﻮ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺎﺯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﳊﺞ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﲜﻬﺎﺩ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﱪﺡ‬
‫ﺑﲔ ‪‬ﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﻣﻜﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻷﻧﻮﺵ ﺑﻦ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺑﻜﺮﻩ ﻭﻭﺻﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺗﺮﻛﲔ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻳﻐﻮﺙ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﻕ ﻭﻧﺴﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻮﺍﻉ ﻭﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺮ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺻﺎﳊﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺎﺗﻮﺍ ﺣﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﺑﻨﺎﺅﻫﻢ ﺣﺰﻧﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻓﺘﻤﺜﻞ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﳍﻢ ﺻﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺮﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺑﻴﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﻟﻴﺘﺬﻛﺮﻭﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻳﺘﺂﻧﺴﻮﺍ ﻭﳜﻒ ﺣﺰ‪‬ﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻭﻧﺸﺄ ﻏﲑﻫﻢ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺁﳍﺔ ﻭﺃﻥ ﺁﺑﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻬﻮﺍﻫﻢ ﻓﻌﺒﺪﻭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻤﺮ ﺷﻴﺚ ﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﻪ ﻭﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬

‫‪33‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻗﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺴﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺈﻗﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺇﻳﺘﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺰﻛﺎﺓ ﻭﺍﳊﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﲜﻬﺎﺩ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻗﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻟﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻬﻼﻳﻞ ﻭﻭﺻﺎﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻭﺻﺎﻩ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﻣﻬﻼﻳﻞ ﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺑﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻗﺴﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺳﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻜﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻣﻬﻼﻳﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻵﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﺭﺛﻮﻧﻪ ﳐﺘﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻻ ﻳﻨﻈﺮﻭﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﺒﻮﺍﺩﺭ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺧﻨﻮﺥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺇﻧﻪ ﰎ ﻟﻠﻌﺎﱂ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺃﻟﻔﺎﻥ ﻭﺳﺘﻤﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﺧﻨﻮﺥ ﻫﻮ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻧﺒﺄﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﲰﻲ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻟﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﺩﺭﺳﻪ ﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﻨﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ ﻓﻜﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ ﺍﳌﱰﻟﺔ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻬﺪ ﺑﻮﺍﺭﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺧﻨﻮﺥ ﻭﺭﻓﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺻﻴﺔ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﺍﻟﺴﺮ ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻓﻌﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻏﲑ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺘﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺇﻧﻪ ﱂ ﳜﻞ ﻗﻂ ﺟﻴﻞ ﻭﻻ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻻﻥ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﺑﺪﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺧﻄﻮﻁ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﻢ ﺑﺪﺭﺳﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺺ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺎﺧﺮ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﻭﺍﳋﺰ ﻭﻏﲑﳘﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳌﻨﺴﻮﺟﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳌﻨﻈﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺠﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺴﺞ ﻭﺍﳌﻐﺰﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﻄﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺑﺮ ﻭﻧﺴﺠﺖ ﻭﻛﺴﺖ ﺃﻭﻻﺩﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻟﺒﺲ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻏﺰﻝ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺿﻌﻒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻻﺩ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﻌﺘﻜﻔﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻳﺬﲝﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻴﺘﺪﺍﻭﻟﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻇﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﺍﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺷﻴﺦ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺜﺮ ﺷﻴﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺐ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﱂ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﺍ ﺭﺃﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺷﻴﺐ ﻭﻻ ﻇﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺏ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﺎﺭﺏ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻗﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻬﻢ ﺯﺩﱐ ﻭﻗﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﻟﻪ ﺟﻨﺎﺣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳌﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻵﻥ ﳌﻬﻼﻳﻴﻞ ﻭﻟﺪ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺪﻭﺍﹰ ﻟﻶﳍﺔ ﻭﻋﺪﻭﺍﹰ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﺐ ﻓﺴﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﻭﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻜﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻧﺘﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺸﻐﻮﻟﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ‬

‫‪34‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻬﻞ ﺗﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﻼﻛﻪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﺄﺣﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻮﻛﻞ ﺍﷲ ﺑﺈﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻣﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﳛﻔﻈﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺃﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻨﻮﺩﻩ ﻣﻨﻌﻮﻫﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻬﺮ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺬﻭﺍﺋﺐ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻧﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺳﺎﳌﺎﹰ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺮﻳﺼﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﺭﺍﺳﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﺣﱴ ﺷﺐ ﻓﻨﺒﺄﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺭﺃﺱ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻩ ﻭﺭﺍﻳﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺳﻌﻮﺩﻫﺎ ﻭﳓﻮﺳﻬﺎ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﻭﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺍﻥ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﺣﺴﻦ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﺍﷲ ﻓﺮﻓﻌﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﺑﲏ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺻﻲ ﻭﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺮﻓﻌﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻳﻄﻬﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻄﺎﻳﺎﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻼﺯﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺷﻴﻌﺘﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ‬
‫ﻷﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻥ ﺍﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺍﺑﻨﻚ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﻓﺈﱐ ﺳﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻬﺮﻩ ﻧﺒﻴﺎﹰ ﻳﺮﺗﻀﻲ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺼﺔ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺬﻳﻘﻪ ﻃﻌﻢ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺮﻳﻪ ﺭﺿﻮﺍﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻠﻪ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﱂ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻌﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﺑﲏ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻘﺒﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻨﺎﺯﻉ ﻭﺃﺷﺎﻉ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻫﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﺍﳌﺘﻤﺴﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﺪﻳﻨﻪ ﺣﺰﻧﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻇﻬﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺻﻨﻤﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻛﱪ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﻪ ﻓﺰﺍﺩ ﰲ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﲢﻠﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﺑﺎﺋﺢ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺣﻀﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻳﻐﻮﺙ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﻕ ﻭﻧﺴﺮ ﻭﻭﺩ ﻭﺳﻮﺍﻉ ﻭﻣﺰﻳﺔ ﻭﺿﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺘﻌﺒﺪﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﺒﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻟﻴﺬﻛﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻐﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺣﻀﺮﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ ﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﳌﻚ ﻭﻣﻌﲎ ﳌﻚ ﺍﳉﺎﻣﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ ﺍﳌﺨﺘﻮﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻹﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻘﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﺍﱃ ﳌﻚ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﺑﻮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻭﻗﺘﺎﹰ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﲝﺮ ﻻﻏﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﻴﻤﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻃﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮ‪.‬‬

‫‪35‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻳﻐﺮﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻨﻴﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﻗﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﹰﺎ‬
‫ﻟﻴﺤﺼﻨﻮﺍ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻣﻌﺎﻗﻞ ﺑﻌﺪﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﲰﺎﺋﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﱪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻨﺒﺄﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻌﺘﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺁﺩﻡ‬
‫ﺭﻗﻴﻖ ﺍﻟﺒﺸﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻃﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻨﲔ ﺭﻗﻴﻖ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺎﻗﲔ‪ ،‬ﻛﺜﲑ ﳊﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﺨﺬﻳﻦ ﻃﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻠﺤﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻋﺮﻳﻀﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﺟﺴﻴﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺘﲔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻟﺒﺚ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻳﺪﻋﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻹﳝﺎﻥ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﺇﻻ ﲬﺴﲔ ﻋﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﻟﻔﻼﺳﻔﺔ ﺍﻥ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻪ ﻟﺒﻨﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﺮﻳﻌﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺣﻴﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﳊﺞ ﻭﳎﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺀ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳊﻼﻝ ﻭ‪‬ﻰ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻓﺮﺿﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﻜﺎﻡ ﻭﻻ ﻣﻮﺍﺭﻳﺚ ﻭﻻ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻋﻮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳛﺬﺭﻫﻢ ﻋﺬﺍﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮﻫﻢ ﺁﻻﺀﻩ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﻣﺎﺋﱵ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﻫﻠﻚ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﻔﺮﺓ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺸﺪﺩ ﰲ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻇﻬﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﰲ ﳏﺎﳍﻢ ﻭﺃﺳﻮﺍﻗﻬﻢ ﻭﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﻳﺪﻋﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻄﻮﻭﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻠﻴﻜﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺰﺟﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﻬﺪﺩﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻬﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺟﻠﺖ ﻗﺼﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﺎﻣﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﲣﺎﻃﺒﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﲟﻠﻴﻜﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﻩ ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻬﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺎﻭﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻌﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﻪ ﺣﺒﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺒﺴﻪ ﻫﻠﻚ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﱄ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺒﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺳﺐ ﺍﻵﳍﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺻﻨﻢ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﺎﺭ ﻋﻴﺪ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﳛﻀﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻳﻨﺤﺮﻭﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻀﺮ ﻋﻴﺪ‬
‫ﻳﻐﻮﺙ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﻢ ﻭﻧﺎﺩﺍﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﻻ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺿﻌﻮﺍ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻌﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺁﺫﺍ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﲢﺖ ﺛﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﺪﺍﺋﻪ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺛﺒﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻀﺮﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﺷﺠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻭﺳﺤﺒﻮﻩ ﺍﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺩﺧﻠﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ ﻣﺰﺧﺮﻑ ﺑﺄﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺪﺍﺋﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﻭﺍﻷﺻﺒﺎﻍ‪ ،‬ﻣﻔﺮﻭﺵ ﺑﺮﻓﻴﻊ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﺼﻔﺢ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻈﻮﻡ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺃﱂ ﺍﻫﺪ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻵﳍﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﺍﻥ ﺗﺪﻋﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ ﺣﱴ ﺳﺠﺪﺕ ﺍﻵﳍﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺷﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﺰﻫﺎ؟ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻤﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ‬

‫‪36‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳐﻀﻮﺏ ﺑﺪﻣﺎﺋﻪ‪ :‬ﻟﻮ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺁﳍﺔ ﳌﺎ ﺳﻘﻄﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺗﻖ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﻳﺎ ﺩﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﺸﺮﻙ ﺑﺎﷲ ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﺍﻙ ! ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻴﻒ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﺃﻥ ﲣﺎﻃﺒﲏ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﳋﻄﺎﺏ!ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲝﺒﺴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﻋﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻓﻴﺬﲝﻪ ﻟﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﺑﺎ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺮﺩ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺈﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﻭﲣﻠﻴﺔ ﺳﺒﻴﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻫﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳎﻨﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻻ ﺣﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ ﺳﻮﻳﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺑﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﺘﻞ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﷲ ﻳﻌﺼﻤﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﻟﺪ ﻟﻨﻮﺡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻳﺎﻡ ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﺎﻝ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺇﻻ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻳﺴﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻌﻚ ﺍﻷﺭﺫﻟﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﳒﺎﺭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﺖ ﳍﻢ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﺮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻫﻢ ﻭﻳﺪﻋﻮﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺰﺩﺍﺩﻭﻥ ﺇﻻ ﻃﻐﻴﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺘﻮﺍﹰ ﻭﲡﱪﺍﹰ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻜﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﺪﻋﻮﻫﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺳﺒﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﺄﻭﺣﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ " ﺇﻧﻪ ﻟﻦ ﻳﺆﻣﻦ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻚ ﺇﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺪ ﺁﻣﻦ "‬
‫ﻓﺤﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﻳﺌﺲ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺩﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ " ﺭﺏ ﻻ ﺗﺬﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﻳﺎﺭﺍ "‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺜﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺤﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻠﺖ ﻋﻤﺎﺭ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻴﻨﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻨﻔﻌﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﺑﺘﺪﺃ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺧﺸﺒﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺝ ﻭﰲ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺻﻨﻊ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﻣﲑ ﻭﺃﻋﺪ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺭﺟﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ؛ ﻭﻋﺮﺿﻬﺎ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺪﺭ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻩ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﺟﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻬﺰﺀﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺼﻨﻌﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻀﺤﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺮﻣﻮﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺑﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﺟﻨﺒﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺧﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺭﺟﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻓﺬﲝﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺗﻘﺮﺑﺎ ﻟﻴﻨﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺤﻂ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺬﺍﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﳛﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺯﻭﺟﲔ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳊﻴﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻠﻰ ﻟﻠﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﻮﺵ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ ﳍﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﻧﻔﺴﺎﹰ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻭﺣﺎﻡ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺎﺳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﺖ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺑﺘﻬﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﻩ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﻭﲰﻮﻫﺎ ﺳﻮﻕ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺍﳋﱪ‬

‫‪37‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺑﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺭﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺯﺍﺩﻩ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﺃﻳﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﻤﻠﻬﻢ ؟ ﻓﺮﻛﺐ ﰲ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﲨﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﺣﺮﺍﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺎﺩﻯ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺠﺎﺏ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻭﺃﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺘﻚ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﻮ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻚ ﰲ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻋﺠﺐ‪ ،‬ﺇﻧﻚ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺽ ﻳﺒﺲ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻏﻤﺮ ﳛﻤﻞ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﺰﻝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻚ ﻭﺇﻻ ﺃﺣﺮﻗﺘﻜﻢ ﺃﲨﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻏﺘﺮﺍﺭﻙ ﺑﺎﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﻞ ﺍﻹﳝﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﻠﻊ ﺃﻧﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺗﺴﻠﻢ ﻭﺗﺮﺷﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻻ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻟﻌﺬﺍﺏ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻚ‪ .‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﰲ ﳏﺎﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﺇﺫ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲣﺒﺰ ﰲ ﺗﻨﻮﺭ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺒﻊ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﺴﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻧﺒﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻨﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﳛﻚ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺨﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺇﱄ ﺭﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﻳﺔ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺗﺘﺨﻠﺨﻞ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻌﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺯﻝ ﻓﺮﺳﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﻨﺒﻊ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺖ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺯﺍﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺮﺳﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﻨﺒﻊ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺖ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﲣﱪﻩ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻛﺜﺮ ﻭﻓﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺩﺍﺭﻩ ﻟﻴﺄﺧﺬ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﳝﻀﻲ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﻗﻞ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺄﺕ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪.‬ﳌﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﻗﻞ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺍﺩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﺗﻨﺤﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺅﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺘﺤﺖ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﲟﺎ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ ﺇﻻ ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻭﻥ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻬﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺣﺎﺭﺍ ﻣﻨﺘﻨﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻳﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﳑﻦ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺎﺩﺍﻩ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ"ﻳﺎﺑﲏ ﺍﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺗﻜﻦ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻔﺮﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﺂﻭﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻳﻌﺼﻤﲏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ" ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ" ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻋﺎﺻﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺭﺣﻢ "ﻭﻗﺪﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﻮﺭ ﻳﻔﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﲬﺴﲔ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻳﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻻﺛﺮ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺷﻬﺮﺍ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺭﺟﺐ ﻭﻭﻗﻔﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻮﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﶈﺮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺃﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺁﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻻﻳﻌﺬﺏ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﲔ ﻣﻬﺒﻂ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﻓﻮﺭ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﻳﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻔﺘﺢ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺍﺏ ﻟﻴﻨﻈﺮ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻤﻀﻰ‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﺒﺎﻋﺪﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺭﺯﻗﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳋﻮﻑ‪.‬ﰒ ﺍﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﺖ ﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻧﺼﺒﻐﺖ ﺭﺟﻼﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﻟﻔﺎ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﻣﻨﻘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺭﺟﻼﻫﺎ ﻣﺼﺒﻮﻏﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ‬
‫ﺗﻜﻦ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻗﺒﻞ ﰒ ﺃﺭﺳﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﺖ ﻭﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻗﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﺭﻗﺔ ﺧﻀﺮﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺘﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﺸﺐ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺟﻔﺖ ﰲ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﺍﳊﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻭﻭﻗﻔﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻮﺩﻱ ﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺇﱃ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﺎﺋﻢ ﻭﺍﳍﻮﺍﻡ‪.‬‬

‫‪38‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻫﻢ ﺍﻻﺳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺒﺚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻟﻘﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺍﳊﻤﻰ ﰲ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﺁﺫﺍﻫﻢ ﻓﻠﻄﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻞ ﻓﻌﻄﺲ ﺧﱰﻳﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻟﺘﻘﻂ ﺫﺍﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻓﻬﻮ ﻳﻌﻴﺶ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺄﺭ ﺃﺫﺍﻫﻢ ﻓﻠﻄﻢ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ‬
‫ﻓﻌﻄﺲ ﻫﺮﺍﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻭﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻭﳛﻄﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻟﻴﺴﺘﻘﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﲰﻮﻫﺎ ﺳﻮﻕ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﻓﺴﻜﻨﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﻸﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﻋﻤﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺑﺎﺭﻛﺖ ﻓﻴﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻠﻌﻨﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﺫﻧﺖ ﺑﺮﻛﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﲦﺮﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﳑﺎ ﺭﺯﻗﻨﺎﻛﻢ ﺣﻼﻻﹰ ﻃﻴﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻨﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﻭﺛﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﳌﻴﺘﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻡ ﻭﳊﻢ ﺍﳋﱰﻳﺮ ﻭﻣﺎﺫﺑﺢ ﻟﻐﲑ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺗﻘﺘﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺣﺮﻡ ﺍﷲ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺎﳊﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻏﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﱰ ﲟﻜﺔ ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻛﺜﺮ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺏ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻟﲑﻣﻲ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺍﻭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻐﻀﺎﺀ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻟﺒﲏ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺇﻥ ﺍﺑﺎﻛﻢ ﺃﻋﻄﻰ ﺳﺎﻣﺎ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺧﲑﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﻨﻌﻜﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻋﻼﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺣﱴ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﻓﺎﻵﻥ ﻧﺒﺪﺃ ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﺑﲏ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺃﻧﺴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺗﻔﺮﻗﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻟﺪ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺒﺪﺃ ﺑﺬﻛﺮﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﳛﻄﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺬﻛﺮﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻣﺘﺼﻼﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ ﺻﻠﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﲨﻌﲔ‪.‬‬

‫ﺤﺎﻡ ﺒﻥ ﻨﻭﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬

‫ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺇﻥ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺩﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺘﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﻭﺳﻮﺍﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻮﻟﺪ ﺳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻛﻨﻌﺎﻥ ﻛﻮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺘﻞ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺩﻋﺎﺀ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻐﻀﺐ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺰﻍ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻻﺧﻮﺓ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺮﺏ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻔﺮﻕ‬
‫ﺑﻨﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻳﺆﻡ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺑﺄﺻﻴﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺁﺧﺮ‬
‫ﻣﺮﺳﻰ ﺗﺒﻠﻐﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻦ ﳓﻮ ﺍﻷﻧﺪ ﻟﺲ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﻛﺐ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ‪ .‬ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻏﺘﻤﻮﺍ ﳌﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺪﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺮﻛﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺛﺮﻩ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﻮﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻃﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺋﻒ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻗﻄﻨﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺳﻜﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻓﻜﻞ‬
‫ﻃﺎﺋﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺑﻠﻐﺖ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎﹰ ﻓﻴﻄﻠﺒﻪ ﻓﺎﻧﻘﻄﻊ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻭﺗﻨﺎﺳﻠﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺇﻻ ﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﻓﻘﻂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺇﺣﺪﻯ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺩﻓﻨﻪ ﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺻﺨﺮﺓ ﻣﻨﻘﻮﺑﺔ ﰲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺃﺻﻴﻼ‪.‬‬

‫‪39‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻜﻨﻌﺎﻥ ﺍﺒﻥ ﺤﺎﻡ‬

‫ﻫﻮ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺩﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺍﻭﺓ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺑﲏ ﺟﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻨﻌﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻓﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻟﻮﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻓﻬﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻌﺎﻧﻴﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻗﺎﺗﻠﻬﻢ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻮﺷﻊ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻋﲎ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ " ﺍﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﻳﻦ " ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺧﻠﻘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻛﻨﻌﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﺻﻐﺮ ﺭﺗﺒﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﳉﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻓﻮﺳﻄﻦ ﻭﺻﱪﺍ ﻭ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﻭﲰﺴﺎﻭﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻧﺒﻴﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺒﻴﻂ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺍﺩ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﲰﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺒﻄﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻋﻤﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ‬
‫ﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺗﺪﺑﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻛﻨﻌﺎﻥ ﺍﻣﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﺷﺒﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻭﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﻠﺖ ﺑﺎﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﳓﻮ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺟﻨﺴﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻢ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻓﻌﺎﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮﻥ ﺍﳉﻠﻮﺩ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﺰﺭ ﺑﺎﳊﺸﻴﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﻟﺮﺅﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﻗﺮﻭﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻓﺄﺭ ﺍﺑﻴﺾ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ‪ ‬ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻧﺴﻮﺓ ﻳﺒﻴﺖ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺛﻨﺘﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﻬﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﲢﺐ ﻭﺇﻻ ﻃﻠﻘﻬﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺛﺎﻟﺜﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﺒﻨﻤﺎ ﺍﺟﺪﺑﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻭﺍ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺴﻘﻮﺍ ﲨﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻈﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻓﻜﻮﻣﻮﻫﺎ ﻛﺎﻟﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺿﺮﻣﻮﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺍﺭﻭ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺭﻓﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺑﻜﻼﻡ ﻓﻴﱰﻝ ﺍﳌﻄﺮ ﻭﻳﺴﻘﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻋﺮﺱ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻟﻄﺨﻮﺍ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﳊﱪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺟﻠﺴﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻞ ﻭﺍﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ‬
‫ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻗﺼﺒﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺘﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺸﻴﺶ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻧﺒﻴﺬ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻠﻌﺒﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻭﻳﺴﲑ‪‬ﺎﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺳﻜﻨﺎﻩ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮﻥ ﺣﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﻭﺁﺫﺍﻥ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺩﺍﻭﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺼﺒﻎ ﺑﺎﳊﻤﺮﺓ ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻠﺒﺴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﳍﺎ ﻋﻴﺪﺍ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﳚﺘﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﻠﻌﺒﻮﻥ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺴﻘﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﻗﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺘﱪﻛﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﺰﻳﻨﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﲝﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ ﰲ ﺷﻌﺮﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻛﺮ ﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﲰﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻋﻈﻢ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﺃﺟﻠﻬﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﳍﻢ‬

‫‪40‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻳﻌﻄﻲ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻛﺮ ﺣﻖ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺴﺐ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻛﺮ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻋﺎﻧﺔ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﺍﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺄﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻣﻢ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺧﻂ ﻻ‬
‫ﳚﺎﻭﺯﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳋﻂ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﻣﺘﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﻛﺴﻴﺔ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺄﺗﻮﻥ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻓﻴﺘﺮﻛﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻷﻣﺘﻌﺔ ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﰐ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﻣﺘﻌﺔ ﻓﺈﻥ ﺃﺭﺿﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﺇﻻ‬
‫ﻋﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﻭﺭﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻌﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺰﻳﺪﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺘﻢ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﻳﻌﺔ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﺒﺘﺎﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﻔﻞ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺳﻮﺍﺀ ﺑﺴﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺯﻭﺍﳍﻢ ﳐﺘﻔﲔ ﻓﻮﺿﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺴﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻓﺘﺴﺮﻗﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﰒ ﻳﻬﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻷﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻣﻌﺪﻥ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﻓﻄﻨﻮﺍ ﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺈﻥ ﺃﺩﺭﻛﻮﻫﻢ ﻗﺘﻠﻮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺻﺤﺎﺭﻳﻬﻢ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺍﻷﺷﺒﺎﺭ ﺳﻢ ﻭﻳﻜﱪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳊﺼﻰ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﻫﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﳛﺼﻞ ﻟﻠﺘﺠﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮﻧﻪ ﲟﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺳﺠﻠﻤﺎﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺟﻮﺍﻣﻊ ﻭﺷﺎﺭﻉ ﻳﺴﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻧﺼﻒ ﻳﻮﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﳔﻴﻞ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﺎﻧﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲢﺖ ﻳﺪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻋﺎﻧﺔ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺮﺟﻪ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻠﱭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﳌﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺪﻡ ﻳﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺮﻛﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﻃﺊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻐﺮﺑﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ‬
‫ﻭﳛﺎﺭﺏ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻛﺒﲑ ﲢﺖ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻗﻠﻌﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻳﺘﺄﻫﺒﻮﻥ ﳍﺎ ﻭﳛﺠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻏﺎﻭﺓﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﳑﺎ ﳛﺎﺫﻱ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺗﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﺎﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻓﻴﻮﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﻣﻴﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﺑﻴﺎﺭ ﻏﲑ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﺋﺒﻖ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﺑﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺑﻘﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭﻫﺎ ﻧﺼﻒ ﻣﻴﻞ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﺼﻨ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻮﻣﻴﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﻌﺔ ﲟﻐﺮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻧﻮﺑﺎ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻮﻁ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﳌﺎ ﺻﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺟﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺑﻘﻲ ﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﻓﺘﻮﱃ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻗﺒﻄﻢ ﻭﺛﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻻﺩ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻄﻢ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻗﺒﻄﻢ ﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻳﺴﻌﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﻟﻄﻠﺐ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻭﻋﻴﺶ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻧﻮﺏ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻮﻁ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﱪ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﻤﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻫﻨﺎﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳌﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ ﺩﻧﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻼﺩﻫﻢ ﺑﻼﺩ ﳔﻞ ﻭﺯﺭﻉ ﻭﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﺗﺴﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻌﻘﻮﺑﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﻭﺳﻊ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺧﻄﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺃﺻﻔﻰ ﻟﻮﻧﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺴﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﻭﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﻟﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺟﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻟﺒﺎﺱ‬

‫‪41‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﺳﺎﻭﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﳔﻞ ﻭﻛﺮﻡ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ‬
‫ﻭﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﻊ‪.‬‬
‫ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺠﺔ‪ :‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻋﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻣﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻭﻝ‬
‫ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻭﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻭﻣﺪﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺘﺼﻞ ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﳊﺒﺸﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺣﺒﺶ ﺑﻦ ﻛﻮﺵ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﱪ ﳑﺎﻟﻜﻬﻢ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﺎﺷﻲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺼﺮﺍﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻢ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﱪﻯ ﻛﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﱘ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ ﺗﺄﰐ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﺠﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺘﺼﻞ ﲟﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﳊﺒﺸﺔ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﻛﻨﻌﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻭﳑﺎﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻢ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻛﱪ ﻛﻮﺧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻜﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﳛﺪﻭﻥ ﺃﺳﻨﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻛﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻓﻮﺍﻩ ﻧﻈﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺜﻐﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺃﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﺍﻓﻴﻠﺔ ﻳﺒﻴﻌﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﲡﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﱵ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﺩﻉ ﻭﻳﺘﺤﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺒﻴﻌﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﻛﺔ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻣﺔ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻣﻼﻙ ﻣﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻳﻠﺔ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﻭﺑﲎ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﲰﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺧﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺴﻤﻮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻘﺴﻮﻣﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻛﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﳚﻠﺲ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﻷ ﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﳍﻢ ﻭﺍﲰﻬﺎ ﺭﺍﻗﻮﺩﺓ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﲬﺲ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻮﺍ‬
‫ﰲ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﳑﺎ ﰲ ﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺴﻤﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻗﺴﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﺪﻥ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻮﺭ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﲬﻴﻢ ﻭﻗﻔﻂ‬
‫ﻭﻗﻮﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻴﻮﻡ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻴﺎﻓﺙ ﺒﻥ ﻨﻭﺡ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻥ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺎﺕ ﺍﺛﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﻟﻐﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﰲ‬
‫ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ‪ :‬ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﰲ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺛﻨﺘﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻥ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻬﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻟﻐﺔ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ‪‬ﺎﻫﻮ ﻭﻧﺴﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻗﺴﻢ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺃﺭﻣﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺟﺎﻭﺯﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﺑﻮﺍﺀ؛ ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﺷﺒﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﲨﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﳋﺮﺯ‬

‫‪42‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻭﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﻭﻣﺰﻧﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻠﻐﺎﺭ ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﻻ‬
‫ﲢﺼﻰ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻴﺄﺠﻭﺝ ﻭﻤﺄﺠﻭﺝ‬

‫ﻓﺄﻣﺎ ﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺼﺎﺀ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﻢ ﻟﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﻋﺪﺩﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺯﻋﻢ ﺍﻥ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺭﺑﻊ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺬﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻥ ﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻟﻠﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﻟﻠﻌﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻟﺒﻘﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲰﻰ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺃﻣﺔ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﻲ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺪﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻗﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺃﻣﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺯﻱ ﻭﻟﻐﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﱪ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﱪﺍﻥ ﻭﺃﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﺸﻮﻫﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﻔﺘﺮﺵ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﺃﺫﻧﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﻐﻄﻰ ﺑﺎﻷﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻧﺐ ﻭﻗﺮﻥ ﻭﺃﻧﻴﺎﺏ ﺑﺎﺭﺯﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺸﻴﻪ ﻭﺛﺐ ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳊﻴﺘﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳋﺸﺎﺵ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺧﻢ ﻭﺍﳊﺪﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻳﻐﲑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﺇﻻ ﳘﻬﻤﺔ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺷﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﺄﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻐﲑﻭﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﳜﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﺑﻠﺪﺍ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺫﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﺪ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﻔﺘﺤﻮﻧﻪ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﻛﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻻﺯﻝ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﻣﻢ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺳﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺌﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻋﻦ ﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﻐﺘﻬﻢ ﺩﻋﻮﺗﻚ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ " ﺟﺰﺕ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﺃﺳﺮﻱ ﰊ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺪﻋﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﺠﻴﺒﻮﺍ"‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺃﻣﻢ؛ ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﺎﺭﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﺎ‪‬ﻮﺳﻴﺔ ﻭﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﲝﺮ ﺣﻠﻮ‬
‫ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﲝﺮ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺒﺤﺮ ﺁﺧﺮ‬
‫ﳚﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﻐﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﲝﺮ ﻣﺎﱀ ﻷﻥ ﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺑﻌﻴﺪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﺅﻫﻢ ﺣﻠﻮ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺟﺎﻭﺯﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ ﻻﻳﺴﻜﻦ ﻟﱪﺩﻩ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺯﻻﺯﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻗﺒﺎﺋﻠﻬﻢ ﳎﻮﺱ ﳛﺮﻗﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﺪﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺑﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻛﻨﺎﺋﺲ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺟﺮﺍﺱ ﻣﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻟﻨﻮﺍﻗﻴﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺑﺌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻋﻘﻮﻝ ﻭﺻﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‬

‫‪43‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻓﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ‪ .‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺑﺄﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺟﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻋﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻭﻨﺎﻨﻴﻴﻥ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻧﻴﻮﻥ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻣﻦ ﻭﳌﺪ ﻳﻮﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﺎﻣﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﺍﻟﻄﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻨﻄﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻠﻄﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﺣﻜﻢ ﻣﺬﻛﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﻭﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺟﺎﻭﺭﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﻳﺪﻳﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﻄﺎﻋﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺭﻭﻣﻲ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﺩﻳﻘﻄﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﻴﺼﻮ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺳﺤﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﻋﻴﺼﻮ ﳌﺎ ﻓﺎﺭﻕ ﺃﺧﺎﻩ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻭﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻓﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺭﻭﻣﻴﺔ ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺗﻨﺴﺐ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺑﻨﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺻﻔﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻧﲔ ﺃﻳﻼﻭﺑﻄﺮﻩ ﺑﻨﺖ ﺑﻄﻠﻴﻤﻮﺱ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻗﺒﻠﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻛﺜﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺗﻜﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪﺳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺍﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﳚﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﻞ ﺣﻜﻤﺔ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﻘﺮﺍﻁ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺑﻘﺮﺍﻁ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻭﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﻭﺳﻘﺮﺍﻁ ﻭﺃﻓﻼﻃﻮﻥ ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻄﺎﻃﺎﻟﻴﺲ ﻭﺍﻗﻠﻴﺪﺱ ﻭﺟﺎﻟﻴﻨﻮﺱ‬
‫ﻭﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﺬﻛﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﻥ‬

‫ﻭﻗﻄﻊ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻋﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺯﻋﻴﻤﻬﻢ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﺪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻜﺎﻳﺔ‬
‫ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺟﺪﻩ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺮﻛﺐ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻭﺩﻗﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻭﻟﻄﻴﻔﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺻﺎﱐ ﻣﺎﺋﱵ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻪ ﲰﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﰲ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺭﺳﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﳝﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭﻭﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺑﺌﲔ ﰒ ﻋﺒﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻗﺘﺪﺍﺀ ﺑﺎﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﺒﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﻥ ﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ‬
‫ﰲ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻳﺴﺠﺪﻭﻥ ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺗﻜﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﻭﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻠﺪ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﺍﺳﻊ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ‬

‫‪44‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﻧﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﺳﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺳﺎﺗﻴﻖ ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ‬
‫ﲝﺎﺭ ﻟﻜﻞ ﲝﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺭﻳﺢ ﻭﻟﻮﻥ ﲰﻚ ﻟﻴﺲ ﳌﺎ ﻳﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﺃﻭﳍﻤﺎ ﲝﺮ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻌﻘﻮﻓﺰ ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﻰ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻧﺼﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺧﺎﻧﻘﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﺘﺮﺍﺀﻯ ﳍﺎ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﲑ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﻭﺟﻴﻮﺷﻪ ﺧﺪﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺇﺫﺍ ﱂ ﺗﻜﻦ ﳏﺼﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺠﻮﺭ ﺭﻓﻌﺖ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺣﺎﳍﺎ ﻓﻴﺪﻓﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺧﺎﰎ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻮﺍﰎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻟﺒﺴﺖ ﺍﳌﺼﺒﻐﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺷﺎﺀﺕ ﻋﻼﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻮﺭ ﺧﺼﻮﺍ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﻠﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻋﻤﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﺍﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﺃﻧﺜﻰ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺃﻣﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺑﻴﺾ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺮﺓ ﻓﻄﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺗﻈﻠﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻋﻤﺎﻟﻪ ﻛﺸﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺎﺩﻗﺎﹰ ﺃﻧﺼﻔﻪ ﻭﻋﺎﺗﺐ ﻇﺎﳌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﺫﺑﺎﹰ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺑﺎﳋﺸﺒﺔ ﺿﺮﺑﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻻﺟﺘﺮﺍﺋﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺬﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺧﺎﺩﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ ﺿﺮﺏ ﺟﺮﺱ ﻛﺒﲑ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺩﻭﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﻠﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻗﺎ ﺕ ﻟﺌﻼ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺗﻘﺴﻢ ﺍﳌﺪ ﻳﻨﺔ ﻗﺴﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﺣﺸﻤﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻋﻴﺔ ﻭﺃﺳﻮﺍﻗﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻮﺭﺛﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﻧﺜﻰ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺣﻠﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ ﻋﻴﺪ ﻛﺒﲑ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺷﺮﻑ ﺣﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻛﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻮﺷﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﺕ ﻇﻬﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺘﺨﺬﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﻃﻖ ﺗﺒﻠﻎ ﺍﳌﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺍﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﻣﺜﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻛﺜﲑ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﺨﺬﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﳉﻢ ﺩﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺳﻼﺳﻞ ﻛﻼ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻻﻫﺘﺭﺩﺓ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻻﻫﺘﺮﺩﺓ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺟﻠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﻣﺪﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻻﺩﻳﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻫﻢ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ‬
‫ﳚﺎﻭﺭﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻳﻄﺮﻭﺩﻭ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻳﻬﻢ ﺯﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺻﻨﻒ ﳛﺮﻗﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫‪45‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﻻﻓﺭﻨﺞ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﳚﻤﻌﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻭﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﱪﻯ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺩﺭﻳﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﺭﺑﻊ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻗﺒﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﻭﺭﺍﺀﻫﻢ ﺍﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﺧﺮﻯ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻋﺘﺪﺍﺋﻬﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺍﺗﺴﺎﻉ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺍﻻﻫﺘﺮﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺘﺠﺮ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻧﺼﺎﺭﻯ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳎﻮﺱ ﻭﺯﻧﺎﺩﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﳛﺮﻕ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔﺍﻻﻨﺩﻟﺱ‬

‫ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﺍﺭﺑﻊ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﳝﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻥ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺋﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﰲ ﳑﺎﻟﻜﻬﻢ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﰒ ﺍﻧﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻜﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻬﻢ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻭﱄ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺃﻗﻔﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺑﻪ ﻗﻔﻼ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻭﱄ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻟﺬﺭﻳﻖ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻔﺘﺢ ﺍﻗﻔﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﺪ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻗﻔﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﺍﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻓﺄﰉ ﺍﻻ ﻓﺘﺤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﳉﺪ ﺗﺸﺎﺀﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺘﺢ ﺍﻷﻗﻔﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻓﻮﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳋﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﳉﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺋﻢ ﺍﳊﻤﺮ ﻭﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺍﻝ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺲ ﻭﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ" ﺇﺫﺍ ﻓﺘﺢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺘﺤﺖ ﺍﻻﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﰲ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺗﻮﱃ ﻓﺘﺤﻬﺎ ﻃﺎﺭﻕ ﺑﻦ ﺯﻳﺎﺩ ﻣﻮﱃ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﲑ ﰲ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﺛﻨﺘﲔ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺍﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‬
‫ﺑﻦ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻟﺬﺭﻳﻖ ﻭﺳﺒﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﻏﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻃﻮﺍﻕ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﻣﻔﺼﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﺍﳌﺮﺁﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﻗﺎﻟﻴﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻼﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺑﻮﺭ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺧﺎﹰ ﲞﻂ ﻳﻮﻧﺎﱐ ﺟﻠﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺑﲔ ﻭﺭﻗﺎﺕ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻔﺼﻼ ﲜﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﺼﺤﻔﺎ ﳏﻼﺓ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺭﺍﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺼﺤﻔﺎ ﺁﺧﺮ ﳏﻠﻰ ﺑﻔﻀﺔ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻓﻊ ﺍﻷﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻷﺣﺠﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﺒﻐﺔ ﻭﺃﺻﺒﺎﻍ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﺍﻗﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻋﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺃﻛﺴﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻴﻤﻴﺎﺀ ﳐﺘﻮﻣﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺤﻤﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﳌﺎ ﻓﺘﺤﺖ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﻧﺰﳍﺎ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻭﺗﻔﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻣﺪ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲤﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻌﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺑﻦ ﻫﺸﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺳﻨﺔ ﲦﺎﻥ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻓﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﲤﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﻓﺬﺭﻳﺘﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺭﺠﺎﻥ‬

‫‪46‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﱪﺟﺎﻥ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﻮﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻭﻫﻲ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﳋﺰﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺷﺪ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ ﺣﺮﺑﺎ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﺴﻄﻨﻄﻴﻨﻴﺔ ﻭﺑﻼﺩ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﺴﲑﺓ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺳﻴﺎﺝ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﺎﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺸﺐ ﻓﻬﻮ ﻛﺎﻟﺴﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳋﻨﺪﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﺩﻭﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻴﺎﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﳎﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺏ ﺭﺍﺗﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺝ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻛﺒﻬﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﳊﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺭﻛﺐ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﺣﺮﺑﻴﺔ ﰲ ﻏﲑ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻗﺘﻠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺏ‬
‫ﺍﺻﻄﻔﻮﺍ ﺻﻔﻮﻓﺎ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺸﺎﺏ ﺃﻣﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺧﻠﻔﻬﻢ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﺭﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻟﱪﺟﺎﻥ ﺩﻧﺎﻧﲑ ﻭﻻ ﺩﺭﺍﻫﻢ ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﺗﺒﺎﻳﻌﻬﻢ ﻭﺗﺮﻭﳚﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻘﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ‬
‫ﺃﺩﺕ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﺟﻮﺍﺭﻱ ﻭﻏﻠﻤﺎﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺷﺒﻬﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻷﻫﻞ ﺑﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻣﻴﺖ ﻋﻤﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﻡ ﻭﺣﺎﺷﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻤﻌﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻮﻫﻢ ﺑﻮﺻﺎﻳﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺣﺮﻗﻮﻫﻢ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﳓﺮﻗﻬﻢ ﳓﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻓﻼ ﳛﺮﻗﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻵﺧﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻴﺖ ﺃﻧﺰﻟﻮﻩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻭﺣﺸﻤﻪ ﻓﻴﺒﻘﻮﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺣﱴ ﳝﻮﺗﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺫﻧﺐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺧﻄﺄ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻣﻮﻻﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻪ ﺍﻧﺒﻄﺢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﱂ ﳝﺴﻜﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻓﻴﻀﺮﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻮﻻﻩ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺣﺐ ﻓﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺄﺫﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻮﻻﻩ ﻭﺟﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻮﺭﺛﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺭﻙ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﻣﺪﻥ ﻭﺣﺼﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﺍﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺧﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﺒﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﱂ ﻳﺼﺪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﺫﺑﺢ‬
‫ﺩﺍﺑﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺩﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺷﻮﺍﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺃﻟﺮﺧﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﺩﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺍ‪‬ﻮﺳﻴﺔ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﻬﻮﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻛﱪ ﺧﺎﻗﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺗﺎﺝ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻟﺒﺎﺳﻬﻢ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻋﻈﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻇﻬﺮ ﱂ ﻳﻘﻢ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻜﺮ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺣﻘﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﺄﺱ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺗﻮﻗﺪ ﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻧﺎﺭ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﻳﺄﰐ ﻭﻳﻘﻒ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻄﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ‪‬ﻤﻬﻤﺔ ﻓﲑﺗﻔﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻫﺞ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳋﻀﺮﺓ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﻴﺚ ﻭﺍﳋﺼﺐ ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﺽ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳉﺪﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ‬

‫‪47‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳊﻤﺮﺓ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻫﺮﺍﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺮﺓ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻞ ﻭﻭﺑﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺍﺩ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻔﺮ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﺠﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻔﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺭﻭﻡ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻋﻴﺼﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻟﻘﺐ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﱃ ﻗﺴﻄﻨﻄﲔ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺼﺮﺍﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﲨﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺳﺎﻗﻔﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﺩﻳﺔ ﰒ ﺗﻔﺮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﺎﺭﻯ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺒﻘﺎﺕ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻭﺍﻷﺳﻘﻒ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺴﻴﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻄﺮﺍﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻣﺴﺘﻖ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﻔﻄﺮﻭﻥ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺣﺪ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺻﺎﻣﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻔﻄﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻈﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﻳﺘﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻻ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺘﺴﺮﻯ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﻤﺮ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺴﻜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻜﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺣﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻷﺣﺪ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻗﱪﻩ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻷﺣﺪ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺍﺟﺘﻤﺎﻋﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳊﻮﺍﺭﻳﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﻻﻏﺘﺴﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻴﺔ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﳊﻤﻚ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻣﻚ‪ ،‬ﻳﻌﻨﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﻋﻴﺴﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺘﻘﺪﻭﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﻠﺤﻢ ﻭﻻ ﺧﺒﺰ ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻔﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺧﺬﻩ ﻗﺘﻞ‬
‫ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻐﺴﻞ ﻓﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻮﺭﺛﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺟﺰﺋﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ ﺟﺰﺀﺍ ً‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ‬
‫ﳍﻢ ﻃﻼﻕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺳﲑ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻠﺒﺲ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺧﻔﲔ ﺃﲪﺮﻳﻦ ﺇﻻ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﱄ ﻋﻬﺪ ﻟﺒﺲ ﻓﺮﺩﺍﹰ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻭﻓﺮﺩﺍﹰ‬
‫ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺇﻻ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﻭﺍﻷﳊﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﻨﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﺩﻳﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﻗﻘﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻻﺳﺘﺒﺪﻧﺎﺟﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻜﺒﺎﺟﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﻢ ﺍﻷﺭﻏﻦ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳊﺬﻕ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺣﱴ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻟﻴﺼﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺻﻮﺭﺍ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳊﺰﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺡ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺮﻭﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻹﻧﺼﺎﻑ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻨﻮﺡ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺭﺱ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﺗﺪﻓﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻻ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻧﻮﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﺴﺒﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻴﻮﻣﺮﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺁﺩﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻓﺮﻳﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﺳﺒﻬﺒﺪ‬
‫ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﻦ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻃﻠﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻣﻨﻮﺷﻬﺮ ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻏﻠﺐ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﺑﻦ ﺩﺍﺭﺍ ﻭﺭﺗﺐ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺍﺋﻒ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻫﻠﻜﺖ‬

‫‪48‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻷﻛﺎﺳﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻝ ﺃﺭﺩﺷﲑ ﺑﻦ ﺑﺎﺑﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﺎﺀ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻧﺴﺒﻬﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺍﱃ ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺍﻵﺛﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺑﺌﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﲤﺠﺴﻮﺍ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻴﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻜﺴﻲ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺑﻴﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺬﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﱪﻳﺘﺎ ﻭﺯﺭﻧﻴﺨﺎ ﻓﻴﺴﺘﻮﻗﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳊﻄﺐ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﻻ ﺃﻭﻗﻴﺔ ﺃﻭﻗﻴﺔ ﺑﺜﻼﺛﲔ‬
‫ﻓﻀﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻮﺕ ﻳﻘﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺳﻲ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻫﺎﻭﻥ ﺣﺠﺮ ﻛﺒﲑ ﻗﺪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺎﺀ ﻭﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﺩﺳﺘﺞ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻳﻀﺮﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﻭﳛﺮﻛﻪ ﺑﻌﻨﻒ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﻭﻗﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻬﺎﺩ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﻌﺬﺑﻪ ﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﺗﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻤﺎﻟﻚ ﻳﻌﺘﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﻔﺮﺱ ﻭﻳﻘﺮﻭﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺋﺎﺳﺔ ﻭﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﻠﻚ ﻭﺗﺪﺑﲑ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﺏ ﻭﺩﻗﻴﻖ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺄﻟﻴﻒ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺒﺎﺱ ﻭﺗﺮﺗﻴﺐ ﺍﻻﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻭﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻌﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﺗﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﳋﻄﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﻭﻓﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ‬
‫ﻭﲤﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻓﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻜﻞ ﻭﻫﻴﺒﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﻛﻠﻪ ﳍﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺳﲑ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﻬﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺳﻮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺗﺪﺍﺑﲑ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﺎﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺴﺘﻘﺼﻰ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺨﺭﺍﺴﺎﻥ‬

‫ﻓﺎﻣﺎ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺧﺮﺍﺳﺎﻥ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﺪ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺪ ﻏﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﺍﻷﺷﺮﻭﺳﻨﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﺟﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺪ ﻳﻠﻢ ﻭﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻻﻛﺮﺍﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺑﻄﺎﺭﻗﺔ ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﻳﺘﻤﺠﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺍﺭﺩﺷﲑ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻤﲏ ﻋﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻔﻊ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻨﻜﺢ ﺃﻣﻚ ﻓﻬﻲ ﺃﻗﺮﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻫﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺍ‪‬ﻮﺳﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻜﺎﺡ ﺍﻻﺧﻮﺍﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺁﺩﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻃﻠﻖ ﳍﻢ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺯﻧﺎﺩﻗﺘﻬﻢ ﻧﻜﺎﺡ ﺍﻻﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻫﻲ ﺃﺣﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺧﺖ ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻭﺧﻠﻒ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺃﻣﻢ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﻳﻨﺴﻖ ﻟﻮﻥ ﺷﻌﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﻻﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﳍﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﲪﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﺷﻘﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﻮﺭ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻫﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻐﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻳﺄﻭﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻐﺘﺬﻭﻥ ﻧﺒﺎﺗﺎ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺄﺓ ﻭﲰﻚ ﻭﺧﺸﺎﺵ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﺎﺫﻳﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻣﻢ ﺑﻴﺾ ﺷﻘﺮ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﻳﺘﻨﺎﻛﺤﻮﻥ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﺘﻨﺎﻛﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﺎﺋﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﳉﻤﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﳝﻨﻊ‬
‫ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧﺜﻰ ﻟﻴﻨﺎﳍﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺴﺎﻡ ﺒﻥ ﻨﻭﺡ‬

‫‪49‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻣﺎ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﺎﺳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ ﺍﳌﱰﻟﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺒﻴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺻﻴﺔ ﻧﻮﺡ ﰲ‬
‫ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﺧﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻟﺪ ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﺭﻓﺨﺸﺬ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔﻭﲬﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺭﻓﺨﺸﺬ ﺷﺎﱁ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺷﺎﱁ ﻋﺎﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺵ ﻋﺎﺑﺮ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﺎﺑﺮ ﻗﺤﻄﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺤﻄﺎﻥ ﻓﺎﻟﻎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻓﺎﻟﻎ ﻳﻌﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻐﺎ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻳﻌﺮﺏ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﺒﺄ ﲪﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﻲ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻷﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺗﺎﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺟﻠﺲ ﺃﺿﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﻠﻔﻆ ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﲪﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﻬﻼﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﲪﲑ ﺑﻦ ﺳﺒﺄ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﻬﻼﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺒﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﺫﻭﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﺮﻫﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻻﺣﺎﺑﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻐﺎﺭﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻻﳒﺎﺩ‪.‬ﻭﺍﻻﺫﻭﺍﺀ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻏﺰﻭﺍ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ ﻭﲡﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﻓﺮﻳﻘﺲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺁﺧﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺇﺒﺭﺍﻫﻴﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻮﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺳﻴﺪﻧﺎ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻪ ﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﺳﺤﻖ ﻭﺃﻣﻪ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﻨﺖ‬
‫ﻫﺎﺭﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺣﺮﺍﻥ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﺎ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‬
‫ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺫ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻛﻮﺵ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻥ ﺣﺎﺟﻪ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻛﺴﺮ ﺍﻻﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺃﺿﺮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺭﺍ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﺃﻟﻘﺎﻩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺮﺩﺍ ﻭﺳﻼﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺖ ﺭﻳﺢ ﻓﻨﺴﻔﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻗﻔﲔ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺮﺍﻥ ﻓﺂﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﻟﻮﻁ ﻭﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﻨﺖ ﻋﻤﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺻﺤﻒ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﱪﺍﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻐﺘﻪ ﺳﺮﻳﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻭﺗﺴﺒﻴﺢ ﻭ‪‬ﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﲢﻤﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﲑ ﻓﻌﱪ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﻗﺼﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺍﺴﻤﺎﻋﻴﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻘﻄﻦ ﺍﳊﺮﻡ ﻭﻧﺒﻊ ﻟﻪ ﺯﻣﺰﻡ ﺑﺎﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺒﺄﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺍﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻴﻖ ﻭﺟﺮﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺒﺎﺋﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻬﺎﻫﻢ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﻭﺛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺂﻣﻨﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻃﺎﺋﻔﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻛﻔﺮ ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺮﻡ ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ‬
‫ﰲ ﺧﲑﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﺪﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺪﺑﺮ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‪.‬‬

‫‪50‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻤﻦ ﻋﺪﻧﺎﻥ ﻭﻟﺪ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭﺑﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺁﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﻴﺪﺍﺭﺑﻦ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﻠﻔﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻓﺎ ﻛﺒﲑﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺴﺐ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻌﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺪﻧﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻋﺪﻧﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﺃﻋﺮﺍﻕ ﺍﻟﺜﺮﻱ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺪﻧﺎﻥ ﺃﻣﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬

‫ﺤﺩﺙ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺒﻠﺔ‬

‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﳎﺘﻤﻌﲔ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺑﺄﺭﺽ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ ﻭﻟﻐﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﰒ ﺗﻔﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﻓﺴﻠﻚ ﻗﺤﻄﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺎﺩ‬
‫ﻭﲦﻮﺩ ﻭﻋﻤﻼﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﺴﻢ ﻭﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﳍﻤﻬﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻠﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﰊ ﻓﺴﺎﻗﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻗﺪﺍﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭﺕ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺣﻘﺎﻑ ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﲦﻮﺩ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻃﺴﻢ ﻓﱰﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻣﻊ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺷﺨﺺ ﻋﻤﻼﻕ ﻓﱰﻝ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳊﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺿﺨﻢ ﺃﺭﻡ ﻓﱰﻝ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺟﺮﻫﻢ ﻓﱰﻝ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺆﻻﺀ ﻭﻟﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻧﺴﻠﻬﻢ ﻳﺴﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺇﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﻳﺴﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﺘﻌﺮﺑﺔ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﺗﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺑﻠﻐﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻋﺎﺩ‬

‫ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﷲ ﻫﻮﺩﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺎﺩ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﺣﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﺠﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﺑﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﻣﺴﻚ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻄﺮ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻓﺄﺟﻬﺪﻫﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻮﺟﻬﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻜﺔ ﺭﺟﺎﻻ‬
‫ﻳﺴﺘﺴﻘﻮﻥ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺮﻡ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﱂ ﺗﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺗﻌﻈﻢ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺭﺑﻮﺓ ﲪﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻴﻖ ﻭﺳﻴﺪﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻣﻌﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻓﺪ ﻋﺎﺩ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﺴﻘﺎﺀ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻗﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﺮﻭ ﻭﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻌﻴﻢ ﺑﻦ ﻫﺬﺍﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻘﻤﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺪﻣﻮﺍ ﻭﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻌﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻜﺮ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻭﺗﻐﻨﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺍﳉﺮﺍﺩﺗﺎﻥ ﻭﳘﺎ ﻗﻴﻨﺘﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺘﺎ ﳌﻌﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻃﺎﻝ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﺷﻔﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻌﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻜﺮ ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﺧﻮﺍﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺧﺎﻑ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﻨﻊ ﺷﻌﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﻨﺒﻬﻬﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻭﳛﺜﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺘﲔ ﻓﻐﻨﺘﺎﻩ‪:‬‬
‫ﻟﻌﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻴﻤﻁﺭﻨﺎ ﻏﻤﺎﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﺃﻻ ﻴﺎ ﻗﻴﻝ ﻭﻴﺤﻙ ﻗﻡ ﻓﻬﻴﻨﻡ‬
‫ﻗﺩ ﺃﻤﺴﻭﺍ ﻻﻴﺒﻴﻨﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﻓﻴﺴﻘﻲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺇﻥ ﻋﺎﺩﺍﹰ‬
‫ﻨﻬﺎﺭﻜﻡ ﻭﻟﻴﻠﻜﻡ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﻭﺃﻨﺘﻡ ﻫﺎﻫﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻤﺎﺍﺸﺘﻬﻴﺘﻡ‬

‫‪51‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻻ ﻟﻘﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻴﺔ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻤﺎ‬ ‫ﻓﻘﺒﺢ ﻭﻓﺩﻜﻡ ﻤﻥ ﻭﻓﺩ ﻗﻭﻡ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﳌﺎ ﲰﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮ ﻭ‪‬ﻀﻮﺍ ﻳﺴﺘﺴﻘﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺴﻘﻮﺍ ﻧﺸﺄﺕ ﳍﻢ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﺤﺎﺋﺐ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ ﻭﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ‬
‫ﻭﲪﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻮﺩﻱ ﻗﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻟﻘﻮﻣﻚ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﺀ ﺟﻬﺎﻡ ﻗﺪ ﻓﺮﻏﺖ ﻣﺎﺀﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻤﺮﺍﺀ ﺭﻳﺢ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﺀ ﻏﻴﺚ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺕ ﺭﻣﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﺭﻣﺪﺩﺍﹰ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻘﻲ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﻻ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ‪.‬ﻓﺪﺧﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺎﺩ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻭﺍﺩﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻟﻴﺎﻝ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺣﺴﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺋﻤﺔ ﺣﱴ ﻫﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺪﻣﺖ‬
‫ﺩﻳﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﱂ ﳝﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﺟﺪﺍﺭ ﻭﻻﺟﺒﻞ ﺣﱴ ﻫﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺇﻻ ﺭﲰﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭ ﺭﻭﻱ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺴﻘﻰ ﻭﻓﺪﻫﻢ ﲟﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻬﻢ ﻓﻨﻮﺩﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻬﻢ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﻋﺎﺩﺍﹰ ﻗﺪ ﻫﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻷﻧﻔﺴﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﺤﻖ ﺑﻘﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﳓﻮﻫﻢ ﻓﻠﻘﻴﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻓﺄﻫﻠﻜﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻣﺰﻳﺪ ﺑﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺻﺪﻗﺎﹰ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺆﻣﻨﺎﹰ ‪‬ﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻋﻄﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺄﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻧﻌﻴﻢ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻻﳝﺮﺽ ﻭﻻﻳﻬﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺗﺼﻴﺒﻪ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﻓﺄﻋﻄﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺎﺭ ﻟﻘﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ‬
‫ﺃﻧﺴﺮ ﻓﺄﻋﻄﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺧﺘﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺮ ﻓﺮﺧﺎﹰ ﻳﺮﺑﻴﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻫﻼﻙ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺮﺧﹰﺎ ﺁﺧﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﻔﻌﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﺍﺍ‪ 88‬ﺃﻧﺴﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﺒﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺿﺮﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﰲ‬
‫ﺃﺷﻌﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻷﻋﺸﻰ‪:‬‬
‫ﻤﺎ ﻤﺭ ﻤﻥ ﺴﻨﺔ ﻭﻤﻥ ﺸﻬﺭ‬ ‫ﺃﻟﻡ ﺘﺭ ﻟﻘﻤﺎﻥ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻴﺎﻤﻪ ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻨﺴﺭ‬ ‫ﻭﺒﻘﻲ ﻨﺴﺭ ﻜﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻨﻘﺭﻀﺕ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺠﻤﻴﻊ ﻨﺴﻭﺭﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺭ‬ ‫ﻤﺎ ﻤﺭ ﻤﻥ ﺃﻤﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺒﺩ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﺩﻋﺕ ﻟﻘﻤﺎﻥ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺭ‬ ‫ﻗﺩ ﺍﺒﻠﺕ ﺍﻷﻴﺎﻡ ﻨﻀﺭﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺑﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﺬﺑﻴﺎﱐ‪:‬‬
‫ﺃﺨﻨﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺫﻱ ﺃﺨﻨﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺒﺩ‬ ‫ﺃﻤﺴﺕ ﺨﻼﺀ ﻭﺃﻤﺴﻰ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻨﻘﺭﻀﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻗﺴﻢ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﲔ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﺴﺎﻡ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺮﻡ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺣﻀﺮﻣﻮﺕ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻤﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻦ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺎﰿ ﺇﱃ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻣﺪﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﻗﺮﻯ ﻭﺣﺼﻮﻧﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺼﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻭﺑﺴﺎﺗﲔ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺳﺨﻂ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻫﻮﺩ ﻓﺄﻓﺴﺪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﷲ ﰲ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳊﺎﻡ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻋﺎﱄ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺠﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﲪﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻠﺪ ﺍﳊﺒﺸﺔ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻮﻁ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻨﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﻟﻴﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺇﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﺒﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻮﺍﺣﻠﻪ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻴﺤﻄﻮﻥ ﺻﲔ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺤﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺜﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ‬

‫‪52‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﻭﺍﻧﺒﺴﻄﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻮﺭﻙ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﺼﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻧﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺿﺮﺏ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺒﻠﺔ ﻓﺎﻓﺘﺮﻗﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺑﻦ ﻛﻮﺵ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﺃﲪﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻨﲔ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺟﺒﻬﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻟﻘﺮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻟﺪﻋﺎﺀ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺣﺎﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻧﺎﻡ ﻓﺎﻧﻜﺸﻔﺖ ﻋﻮﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺁﻫﺎ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻓﻀﺤﻚ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻐﻄﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻜﺖ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﹰ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﲔ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻮﻟﺪ‬
‫ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﺍ ﺃﺷﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﲨﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﻳﺔ ﻭﺃﲤﻬﻢ ﻛﻤﺎﻻ ﻭﺃﻃﻴﺒﻬﻢ ﺭﳛﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻨﺐ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺄﻫﺎ ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻋﻮﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻏﻠﺒﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻋﺘﻘﺎﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﺖ ﺑﻜﻮﺵ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﺃﺧﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﳘﺎ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻓﺰﻉ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺗﻰ ﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﳘﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﺖ ﻻﻣﺮﺃﰐ ﻫﻞ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﺃﺣﺪ ﻏﲑﻱ ﺃﺗﺎﻙ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺩﻋﻮﺓ ﺍﺑﻴﻚ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻢ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺗﺮﻙ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﺩﻫﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻏﺸﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻗﻮﻃﺎ ﻭﺗﻮﺃﻣﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻫﺮﺏ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﻭﻏﺎﺏ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺪﺭ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻳﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺃﺷﺪ ﲡﱪﺍﹰﻭﺗﻜﱪﺍﹰ ﻭﻋﺘﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﻬﺎﻥ ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻩ ﺍﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺃﺭ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻌﺎﺩﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﺃﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻴﻨﻚ ﻭﻣﺘﻤﻢ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻋﻠﻚ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺬ ﺑﺢ ﱄ ﻭﻟﺪﻙ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺼﻠﻲ ﱄ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺻﻠﻮﺍﺕ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﻠﺪﻙ ﻭﺃﻛﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﻌﻠﻚ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﻛﺎﻣﻼﹰ ﺗﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻗﻴﻤﻚ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﻲ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‬
‫ﺑﻄﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺗﻮﻩ ﺑﻮﻟﺪ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻓﺤﺎﺭ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻋﺎﻭﻧﻪ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻓﻘﻬﺮﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺒﻌﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻘﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺃﻃﺎﻋﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺒﲎ ﻟﻪ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﳌﻜﻠﻠﺔ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺗﻀﻲﺀ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺳﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻳﺘﺄﻟﻖ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﰲ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ‬
‫ﺛﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﳝﺘﺪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﻲﺀ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﺫﻋﻨﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺩﻋﺎﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺒﲎ ﻟﻪ ﺻﺮﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻠﺲ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﺼﻨﺎﹰ ﻟﻜﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺎﻭﻧﺘﻪ ﺍﻷﺑﺎﻟﺴﺔ ﻓﺒﲎ ﺻﺮﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻓﺒﻠﻎ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻋﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻮ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻫﻨﺪﻡ ﺃﻋﻼﻩ ﺑﺄﻏﺮﺏ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﻭﺑﲎ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﳎﺎﻟﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻛﻞ ﺣﺎﺋﻂ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺎﺕ ﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﳐﺎﺯﻥ ﻭﻣﻸ ﲨﻴﻌﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﳜﺎﻑ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﻪ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳎﻠﺴﻪ ﺃﻋﻼﻩ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﲣﺬ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺧﱪﻩ ﺟﻨﻴﺎﹰ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻄﺮﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﺮﺡ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺳﻔﻠﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪53‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺎﺏ ﻭﻳﺼﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﻋﺠﻠﺔ ﻣﻨﺼﻮﺑﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻨﺤﺪﺭ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﻔﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺍﻓﺘﺘﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻋﺒﺪﻩ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪.‬ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺴﺎﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ‬
‫ﻗﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﻳﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻻ ﺗﺪﻉ ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﻻ ﰲ ﻣﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻓﻔﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻷﻋﻈﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻠﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﻋﻲ ﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﻙ ﻭﺑﻌﻴﻨﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺘﻨﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻐﻠﺒﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻬﻮﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﻭﺍﻧﻘﻴﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﱂ ﺗﻐﺜﻬﻢ ﺿﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﻫﻠﻜﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺃﻋﻠﻢ ﲟﺎ‬
‫ﻳﺼﻠﺤﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﻘﻦ ﺩﻣﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﻭﺍﻣﻨﻊ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺬﻩ ﲜﺮﻳﺮﺗﻪ ﻭﺍﻛﻔﻨﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﺍﻻﺭﺑﻊ ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﺮﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺒﻪ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﺩﻛﺎ ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻇﻠﻤﺔ‬
‫ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﻭﺭﺟﻔﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺗﺰﻋﺰﻋﺖ ﳍﺎ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻨﻬﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻭﻥ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻬﻮﻥ ﻭﺿﻌﻔﺖ ﺃﻟﺴﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻠﻌﲔ ﻋﺪﻭ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺸﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻤﺔ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﲔ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﰒ‬
‫ﻻﺣﺖ ﳍﻢ ﺷﻌﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻧﻮﺭ ﻳﺴﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺸﻌﺐ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻌﺐ ﻓﺮﻗﺔ ﻫﺮﺑﺖ ﳓﻮﻩ ﻃﻠﺒﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﻨﺠﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺒﻊ ﻛﻞ ﻓﺮﻗﺔ ﻗﻮﻡ‬
‫ﳛﺜﻮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﻠﻐﺔ ﻏﲑ ﻟﻐﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻗﺔ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻛﻞ ﻓﺮﻗﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﺒﻠﺒﻠﺖ‬
‫ﺃﻟﺴﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﻟﻐﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﺻﻠﺖ ﻓﺮﻗﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻧﺎﺩﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻨﺎﺩ"ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻋﺘﻤﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﲦﺮﻭﺍ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺑﻨﻮ ﺳﺎﻡ ﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺤﺮ ﻭﺣﻀﺮﻣﻮﺕ ﺃﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺧﻂ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺑﻨﻮ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺑﻼﺩ ﺃﺳﻮﺍﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺑﻨﻮ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ؛ ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ﻭﺍﳋﺰﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺑﻨﻮ ﳛﻄﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﺍﻻﻗﺼﻰ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﺻﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻝ ﻛﻞ ﻗﻮﻡ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻬﻢ ﻭﻋﻤﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﺗﻮﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺎ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻧﻘﻠﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳋﻼﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻓﺎﺋﺪﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﺁﺩﻡ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻔﺦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺭﻭﺣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺠﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻨﻪ ﺟﻨﺘﻪ ﺑﻔﻀﻠﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﺒﻄﻪ ﺑﺬﻧﺒﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺎﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺜﺮ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻣﻨﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻓﺎﺿﻠﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺷﺮﺍﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺎﻡ ﻭﺻﻠﻰ ﻭﻗﺮﺃ ﻭﻛﺘﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﳌﺨﻠﻮﻗﲔ ﻭﺟﻬﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻣﺮﺩ ﺃﺟﺮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻮﻓﺎﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻫﺐ ﻟﺪﺍﻭﺩ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﳌﺎ‬

‫‪54‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﺮﺿﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﺻﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ ﻗﺼﲑﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺷﻴﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﰲ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﲝﻘﻮﻕ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﺷﺮﺍﺋﻌﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﻴﺚ ﺗﺴﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺴﻜﻨﻪ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻭﺳﻜﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺃﺳﻔﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺩﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺛﻨﱵ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺃﻧﻮﺷﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻗﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﲔ ﺑﲏ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﺎﻑ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻫﻄﻴﻞ ﻭﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻭﲬﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻳﺮﺩ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﲟﺎ ﳚﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﺪﺙ ﺑﻨﻈﺮﻩ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻯﺂﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﲑﺩ ﺧﻨﻮﺥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻣﻊ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺚ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻌﺚ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻊ؛ ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺟﻴﺸﺎﹰ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺷﻴﺚ ﻭﺣﻲ؛ ﺣﺘﺔ ﻧﺒﺄ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﺮ ﻳﺮﺩ ﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﻗﺪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻭﻏﺰﺍ ﺑﲏ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﳌﻜﻴﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﳌﻴﺰﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﰐ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﺰﳚﺎﺕ ﲝﺴﺎﺏ ﻏﲑ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﺭﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﺭﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻻﺭﻭﺍﺡ ﲣﺎﻃﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﳍﺒﻮﻁ ﻓﺼﻌﺪ ﻭﻫﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺍﺭ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻭﻋﺮﻑ ﺃﺷﻜﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ ﻭﻭﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻑ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺑﺮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻳﺪ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺼﺺ ﺗﻄﻮﻝ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﰒ ﻋﺎﺵ ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﱂ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻓﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺻﺎﺑﻴﺎ ﺍﳋﻂ ﻓﻘﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﳋﻂ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺻﺎﺑﻴﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺧﱪﺑﺎﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﺤﻒ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺻﺎﺑﻴﺎ‬
‫ﲟﻌﻮﻧﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺎﺑﻴﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻣﺒﻠﻐﺎﹰ ﺟﻠﻴﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺵ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﻠﺦ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺛﻨﺘﲔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻘﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻴﺔﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﳌﻚ ﻓﺄﺧﺬ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻭﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﲏ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﺠﻤﻌﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻭﺣﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻮﺭ ﻟﻮﻟﺪ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻫﻢ ﻋﻦ ﻗﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻋﻦ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻼﻁ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺩﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﺑﻦ ﺧﻨﻮﺥ ﺑﻦ ﳛﻤﻮﺭ ﺑﻦ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬

‫‪55‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﲡﱪ ﻭﻗﻬﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﻴﺪ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻫﻨﺎ ﳌﺎ ﻭﺭﺩ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳋﱪﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻻﺳﺘﻘﺼﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺩﻋﺎﻩ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺑﺌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻮ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺃﺟﺪﺍﺩﻙ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻪ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﺒﺪﻭﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺮﺝ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﳑﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻭﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﳛﻔﻈﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻋﺎﺵ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺛﻠﺜﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺒﺄ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻓﻠﺒﺚ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﲬﺴﲔ ﻋﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺵ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻧﱯ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺷﺮﻳﻌﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺣﻴﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻛﺎﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﳊﺞ ﻭﺟﻬﺎﺩ ﺍﻷﻋﺪﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‬
‫ﻭﺣﺬﺭﻫﻢ ﻋﺬﺍﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺩﻋﺎﻫﻢ ﻋﻨﻔﻮﻩ ﻭﺣﺬﺭﻭﻩ ﻭﺃﺧﻔﻮﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻭﺑﻴﻮﺕ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻗﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﻻﺇﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺃﱐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺭﺳﻮﻟﻪ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻌﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺁﺫﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺍﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺛﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺗﱪﺀﺍﹰ ﳑﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻗﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﻻ ﺍﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ ﻓﻘﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻀﺮﺑﻮﻩ ﺣﱴ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻑ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﻩ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻠﻐﲏ ﻋﻨﻚ ﻣﻦ ﳐﺎﻟﻔﺘﻚ ﻟﺪﻳﲏ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻨﻮ‬
‫ﺃﺑﻴﻚ ﻭﺳﺒﻚ ﻵﳍﺘﻨﺎ؟ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻦ ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻴﻬﺎ؟ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻤﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ؟‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻟﻮ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺁﳍﺔ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﻣﺎﺳﻘﻄﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺭﺳﻮﻟﻪ ﻓﺎﺗﻖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﺗﺸﺮﻙ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﺍﻙ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲝﺒﺴﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﻋﻴﺪ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﺬﲝﻪ ﺗﻘﺮﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺮﺩ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺡ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻐﲑ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺪ ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻓﻨﺎﺩﻯ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻥ ﳚﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻟﲑﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺄﺻﺎﺑﻪ ﺻﺪﺍﻉ ﰲ ﺩﻣﺎﻍ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺃﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﺳﺒﻮﻋﺎ ﰒ‬
‫ﻫﻠﻚ ﻓﺤﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻴﻒ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺒﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰒ ﺩﻓﻨﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺘﻤﻮﺍ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﺄﻟﺴﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻗﺒﻴﺢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺒﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺯﻋﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳎﻨﻮﻥ ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻻﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻌﻞ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻋﻴﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻋﻜﻮﻓﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺗﻰ ﲨﻌﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻗﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﻻﺇﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺇﱐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺭﺳﻮﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺴﺎﻗﻄﺖ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻀﺮﺑﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺷﺠﻮﻩ ﻭﺳﺤﺒﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﺗﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﱂ ﺃﺻﻔﺢ ﻋﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺮﺣﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺒﺲ ﺍﰊ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺗﻌﺎﻭﺩ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﱐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﻣﺄﻣﻮﺭ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﳍﻲ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺇﳍﻚ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻪ‬

‫‪56‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺧﺎﻟﻖ ﺍﳋﻼﺋﻖ ﺍﲨﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﲟﺎﺫﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺩﻋﻮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﱃ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺧﻠﻊ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻋﻤﻞ ﲟﺎ ﻓﺮﺿﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻛﺎﺓﻭﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻡ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻥ ﱂ ﻧﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﻫﻠﻜﻜﻢ ﻭﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﻣﻬﻠﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﺗﺮﻙ ﺇﳍﻚ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ ﻭﻛﻒ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻋﻨﺎ ﻧﻔﺴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻣﺎﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﱄ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻛﻒ ﻭﻻﺃﻗﺪﺭ ﻷﱐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﻣﺄﻣﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲝﺒﺴﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻘﺮﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﺣﺮﻭﺏ ﺷﻐﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺸﺎﺀﻡ ﲝﺒﺴﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺘﺴﺮﳛﻪ ﺣﱴ ﳜﻠﻮ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﰒ ﺻﺎﱀ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ؛ ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﳛﺮﺿﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺘﻞ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﻳﻨﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﲨﻴﻊ ﳑﺎﻟﻚ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻟﻴﻮﺟﻬﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻛﻞ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻋﺮﺍﻑ ﳌﻨﺎﻇﺮﺓ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻓﺸﺨﺼﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻓﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺎﻇﺮﻭﻩ ﻓﻐﻠﺒﻬﻢ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﻫﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺂﻣﻦ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻓﻴﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺇﱃ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻥ ﺍﺻﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﺑﺄﻋﻴﻨﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺃﺻﻨﻌﻪ؟ ﻓﺄﻫﺒﻂ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺭﺍﻩ ﺇﻳﺎﻫﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺒﻨﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺻﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺔ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻋﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻃﺒﻘﺎﺕ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺍﻣﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻬﺰﺀﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻳﻀﺤﻜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﺄﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﲑ ﻓﻴﺤﺬﺭﻩ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺭﻣﺎﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻓﺂﺫﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺟﻌﻞ ﺑﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﺟﻨﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺣﻀﺮ ﻋﻴﺪ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺭﺟﻞ ﳑﻦ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺫﲝﻮﻫﻢ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺬﺍﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻧﻮﺣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺯﻭﺟﲔ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﺎﺭﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﱄ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺍﲨﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﻟﻯﺎﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﻓﺤﺸﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﺩﺧﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺯﻭﺟﲔ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻃﺒﻘﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻠﻰ ﻟﻠﺒﻬﺎﺋﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻄﻰ ﻟﻄﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﰲ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻴﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻭﳌﻦ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻓﺎﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﻴﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺸﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﲟﺎ ﺷﺤﻨﺖ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺣﺮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﺎ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻭﺍﻳﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﻤﻠﻬﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﻮ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻚ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻓﺮﻣﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺟﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺖ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﺘﺤﺖ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺑﺎﳌﻄﺮ ﻭﺣﻴﻞ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺻﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻬﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ‬
‫ﲢﻤﻞ ﻭﻟﺪﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻨﻘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﳉﺠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻕ ﻃﺮﺣﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻟﻮ ﺭﺣﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﺮ ﻟﺮﺣﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﱯ ﻭﺃﻣﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪57‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺳﻠﻤﺖ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﱂ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﳓﻦ ﻻ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﻟﻌﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﷲ ﻻ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﻻ ﺑﻨﺒﻮﺓ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻻ ﻧﻘﻮﻝ ﺑﻘﻮﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺑﺒﻠﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺳﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮﻭﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺳﺎﺭﺕ ﺷﺮﻗﺎًﻭﻏﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﺗﺖ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺧﺮﺯﺓ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻮﺍﻗﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﻮﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﺭﺍﻋﺔ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻔﻘﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻣﺔﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﺳﺮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺮﻛﺔ ﻓﺎﻗﺘﺴﻤﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺍﻋﻄﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﺑﻊ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻔﻴﻪ ﻓﺰﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻋﻄﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻳﻜﻔﻴﻪ ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺜﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻨﻌﻢ ﺇﺫﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﺎﻃﺒﺦ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺼﲑ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺬﻫﺐ ﺛﻠﺜﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻼﻻﹰ ﻟﻚ ﻭﻟﺬﺭﻳﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻧﻘﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺗﺒﺎﻋﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻟﻨﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﻥ ﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﺪﻱ ﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﺃﺭﻋﺎﻫﺎ ﻟﻚ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻣﻜﺎﻓﺄﺗﻚ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﺻﻴﺔﺃﻭﺻﻴﻚ ‪‬ﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﻲ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻳﺎﻙ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺪ ﻭﺍﳊﺮﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﻠﺔ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﳊﺴﺪ ﲪﻠﲏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻋﺼﻴﺖ ﺭﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻮﻳﺖ ﺁﺩﻡ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﺮﺹ ﲪﻞ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺣﱴ ﺃﻛﻼ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻀﺐ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﲪﻠﺘﻚ ﻋﻠﻯﺄﻥ ﺩﻋﻮﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﻣﻚ ﻓﺄﻫﻠﻜﺘﻬﻢ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻋﻨﺎﻕ ﺒﻨﺕ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬

‫ﻧﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻵﻥ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎﳚﺐ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﻋﻨﺎﻕ ﺑﻨﺖ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻣﻔﺮﺩﺓ ﺑﻐﲑ ﺃﺥ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺔ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﳍﺎ ﺭﺃﺳﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﺎ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﺪ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻊ‪ ،‬ﻟﻜﻞ ﺃﺻﺒﻊ ﻇﻔﺮﺍﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﻨﺠﻠﲔ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺎﺩﻳﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻦ ﺃﰊ ﻃﺎﻟﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻫﻲ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻐﻰ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﺠﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻫﺮ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳌﻌﺎﺻﻲ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﺗﻄﻴﻌﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻓﺘﻌﻠﻘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﺮﺯﺍﹰ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﺗﺼﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﲢﺘﻔﻆ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻔﻠﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﺎﻕ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻧﺎﺋﻤﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺧﺬ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺠﻠﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺑﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﲰﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻤﺖ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻭﺟﺎﻫﺮﺕ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳌﻌﺎﺻﻲ ﻭﺃﺿﻠﺖ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻨﺖ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ‬

‫‪58‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﷲ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻬﺎ ﺃﺳﺪﺍﹰ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻞ ﻓﻬﺠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻐﺎﻭﺭ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺰﻕ ﺃﻋﻀﺎﺀﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺡ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺁﺩﻡ ﻭﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﻋﻮﺟﺎ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻫﺎ‪:‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻐﺮﻗﻪ ﻭﻻ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻣﺎﺅﻩ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻟﻴﻐﺮﻗﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﻋﻤﺎﻩ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻄﻊ ﺻﺨﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﻋﺴﻜﺮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺘﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺍﻟﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻟﻴﻄﺮﺣﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﷲ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻪ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻃﲑﺍﹰ ﻧﻘﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺛﻘﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻛﺘﻔﻴﻪ ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻣﻀﻐﻮﻃﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﺬﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﳊﺮﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳌﻮﺳﻰ ﺍﻳﺪ ﻗﻮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﻭﺛﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺫﺭﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻮﻝ ﻋﺼﺎﻩ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎﻭﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻓﻮﺛﺐ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻀﺮﺏ ﺑﻄﺮﻑ ﻋﺼﺎﻩ ﺇﻻ ﻋﺮﻗﻮﺑﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﻘﻂ ﻟﺜﻘﻞ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﺍﻓﻖ ﺳﻘﻮﻃﻪ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻛﺎﳉﺴﺮ ﻳﻌﱪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﻨﻄﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺟﺮﻭﻩ ﰲ ﲬﺴﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺛﻮﺭ ﻣﻘﺮﻧﲔ ﺑﻌﺠﻼﺕ ﻣﻊ ﺗﻌﺎﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻧﺼﻒ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﺣﱴ ﻃﺮﺣﻮﻩ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺰﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺑﻞ ﻗﻄﻌﻮﻩ ﻗﻄﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﺮﻭﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺳﻘﻮﻃﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺘﺮﻙ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻭﺭﺩﻡ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﺣﱴ ﺻﺎﺭ ﻛﺎﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﺃﺨﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻤﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺭﺏ‬

‫ﺑﻠﻎ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻣﺎﱂ ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳜﱪ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻴﻮﺏ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻓﻘﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺇﻥ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻠﺨﻤﻲ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻓﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺟﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺣﻀﺮﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺇﱐ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﲏ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﱐ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺼﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﳔﱪﻙ ﺑﺘﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻃﻤﺌﻦ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺼﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺃﺻﺪﻕ ﰲ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎﺇﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻗﺼﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ :‬ﻻ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﻮﺛﻖ ﺑﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺬﺋﱯ ﻭﺷﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﺸﻜﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻤﺎ ﺃﻋﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺳﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﻟﻴﻘﺪﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻘﺪﻡ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺷﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﺭﺑﻴﻊ ﺑﻦ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺫﺋﺐ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻛﺮﻣﻪ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﱐ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﲏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﲣﱪﱐ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺑﺘﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ :‬ﺃﻗﺴﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﻔﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻏﺴﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺎﺭﻕ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻟﻘﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﲪﻤﺔ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻠﻤﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﻗﻌﺖ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ‪‬ﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻛﻠﺖ ﻛﻞ ﺫﺍﺕ ﲨﻤﺔ‪.‬‬

‫‪59‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﻠﻒ ﲟﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳊﺮﺗﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻨﺶ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﻄﺄﻥ ﺃﺭﺿﻜﻢ ﺍﳊﺒﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻤﻠﻜﻦ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ‬
‫ﺃﺑﲔ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺮﺵ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻟﻐﺎﺋﻆ ﻣﻮﺟﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻨﺎ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﺑﻞ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﲝﲔ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻨﲔ ﺍﻭ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﳝﻀﲔ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﻘﺘﻠﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﲨﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﻦ ﻳﻠﻲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺭﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﻔﻄﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻝ ﺫﻱ ﻳﺰﻥ‪ ،‬ﳜﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺪﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺘﺮﻙ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹸ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺗﺼﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳝﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺫﻭﻭ ﺃﺧﻄﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺟﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﺮﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻓﻴﺪﻭﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻭ ﻳﻨﻘﻄﻊ؟‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻞ ﻳﻨﻘﻄﻊ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﻄﻌﻪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻧﱯ ﺫﻛﻲ ﺃﻣﲔ ﻗﻮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻲ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻲ‪ :‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﳑﻦ‬
‫ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻏﺎﻟﺐ ﺑﻦ ﻓﻬﺮ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﻟﻚ ﺑﻦ ﻣﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻫﻞ ﻟﻠﺪﻫﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺧﺮ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻧﻌﻢ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻧﻔﻄﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻗﻮﻑ ﻟﻠﺠﺰﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻌﺎﺩﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻘﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﺃﻱ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻫﻮ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﻮﻡ ﳚﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻵﺧﺮﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻌﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﶈﺴﻨﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺸﻘﻰ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺌﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﻖ ﻣﺎ ﲣﱪﻧﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺎﺳﻄﻴﺢ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻧﻌﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻔﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺴﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺗﺴﻖ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻧﺒﺄﺗﻚ ﺑﻪ ﳊﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭﻩ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ‪ :‬ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻌﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﻦ ﻫﺎﺷﻢ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﺋﻒ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻭ ﺍﳍﺪﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺩﻋﺘﻪ ﺛﻘﻴﻒ ﻓﺠﺎﺀﻭﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺣﺘﻔﺮﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﻓﻌﻈﻢ ﺧﺼﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺎﻓﺮﻫﻢ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﱃ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﳊﺎﺭﺙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻌﻪ ﲨﺎﻋﺔﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺧﺼﻤﻪ ﺟﻨﺪﺏ ﺑﻦ ﺍﳊﺎﺭﺙ ﰲ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺛﻘﻴﻒ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻧﻔﺬ ﻣﺎﺅﻫﻢ ﻓﻄﻠﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﻴﻔﻴﲔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻘﻮﻫﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻝ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻻ ﻳﺸﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺠﺮ ﺍﷲ ﻋﲔ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻋﺬﺏ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺖ ﺟﺮﺍﺕ ﺑﻌﲑ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﻓﺸﺮﺑﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﻮﺍ ﻭﲪﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﻭﺷﻜﺮﻩ ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻬﻢ ﻓﻨﻔﺪ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﻴﻔﻴﲔ ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﺒﺪ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻘﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳊﺎﺭﺙ‪ :‬ﻷﻥ ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺳﻴﻔﻲ ﰲ ﺑﻄﲏ ﺃﺧﻒ ﻋﻠﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ! ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻟﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺑﲏ ﺍﺳﻘﻬﻢ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻡ ﺛﻘﻴﻞ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻘﺎﻫﻢ ﻓﺴﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻓﻘﻄﻌﻮﺍ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺟﺮﺍﺩﺓ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺧﺮﺯ ﻣﺰﺍﺩﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻘﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺟﻠﺪ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻖ ﻛﻠﺐ ﳍﻢ ﺍﲰﻪ ﺳﻮﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻘﻪ ﻗﻼﺩﺓ ﻻ ﺗﻌﺎﺭﻗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺗﻮﺍ ﺳﻄﻴﺤﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻧﺎ ﺃﺗﻴﻨﺎﻙ ﺳﺎﺋﻠﲔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﺎﺫﺍ ﺗﺴﺄﻟﻮﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻧﺴﺄﻝ ﻋﻦ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺒﺄﻧﺎﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳓﺘﻜﻢ ﻋﻨﺪﻙ ﰲ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﺎﺻﻢ ﺑﻴﻨﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺧﺒﺄﰎ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺟﺮﺍﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺧﺮﺯ ﻣﺰﺍﺩﺓ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻖ ﺳﻮﺍﺭ ﺫﻱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻼﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻧﺎ ﻋﻤﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﺼﻤﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺣﻠﻒ ﺑﺎﻟﻀﻮﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻈﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﺫﻱ ﺍﳊﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﻓﲔ ﺫﺍ ﺍﳍﺪﻡ‪ ،‬ﳍﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﰊ ﺫﻱ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻗﻀﻰ ﻟﻌﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﻄﻠﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ ﺍﺑﺮﻭﻳﺰ ﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻧﻮﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﺳﺖ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺷﺮﻓﺔ ﺍﺭﺗﺎﻉ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺑﺬﺍﻥ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺪ ﻫﺎﻟﲏ ﻭﺃﻓﺰﻋﲏ‪ .‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻮﺑﺬﺍﻥ‪ :‬ﺃﻳﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﺴﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‬

‫‪60‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺧﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﱐ ﺃﻳﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺃﺭﻯ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﺣﺔ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ ﻗﺪ ﲬﺪﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻠﻌﺖ ﺑﻴﻮ‪‬ﺎﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﺳﺪﻧﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﻏﻤﲏ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻨﺖ ﻋﺰﻣﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺃﺧﱪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻮﺟﻪ ﺇﱄ ﻓﺄﺗﻴﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﻋﻲ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻮﺑﺬﺍﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻐﲏ ﺍﻥ ﺑﺄﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﳜﱪ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻞ ﻛﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻮ ﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺭﺳﻮﻻﹰ ﻳﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻌﻠﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳜﱪﻩ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﺍﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻟﻨﺎ ﲝﺼﻴﻒ ﻳﻨﻔﺬ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ؟ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻤﻦ ﻭﻓﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺭﺟﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻫﻂ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺷﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻮﺑﺬﺍﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﻩ ﻭﱂ ﳜﱪﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺭﺁﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻧﻄﻠﻖ ﺇﱃ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﺧﱪﻙ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳜﱪﻙ ﺑﺘﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺃﺧﱪﻙ ﻓﺎﺭﺟﻊ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺮﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﻻ ﺗﺘﺨﻠﻒ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻓﻌﻞ ﺃﻳﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﻟﻪ ﲟﺎﻝ ﻭﺟﺎﺋﺰﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻪ ﺟﺎﺋﺰﺓ ﺍﱃ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﻛﺐ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﺭﺍﺣﻠﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻣﺒﺎﺩﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﳌﻔﺎﻭﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻴﺎﰲ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﳊﻖ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺑﻠﻎ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﳌﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﺮﲡﺰ ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻴﺴﻤﻌﻪ‪:‬‬
‫ﻴﺎﻓﺎﺼﻝ ﺍﻟﺨﻁﺔ ﺍﻋﻴﺕ ﻤﻥ ﻭﻤﻥ‬ ‫ﺍﺼﻡ ﺍﻡ ﻴﺴﻤﻊ ﻏﻁﺭﻴﻑ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻥ‬

‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﳎﻴﺒﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻞ ﻓﺴﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭﰱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺷﻔﻰ ﻋﻠﻯﺎﻟﻀﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﺭﲡﺎﺝ ﺍﻻﻳﻮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﳌﻮﺑﺬﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﲬﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻓﺎﻟﺘﺄﻭﻳﻞ ﻳﺎ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺗﻨﻘﻀﻲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﻘﻄﻊ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲤﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺩﻳﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻨﺪ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻼﻭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻀﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﳍﺮﺍﻭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻭﻣﱴ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺎ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻓﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻘﻀﻲ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﻭﻳﻮﺍﺭﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﻭﻱ ﻫﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ ﻭﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻛﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﳌﺴﻴﺢ ﺇﱃ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺩﻋﻰ‬
‫ﻛﻼﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﻛﺴﺮﻯ ﻭﺳﺮﻩ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﻲ ﻣﻨﺎ ﺳﺘﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﻌﺔ ﻟﺪﻓﻊ ﺍﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺓ ﰲ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻗﻠﻴﻠﺔ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﻘﻀﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺧﻼﻓﺔ ﻋﺜﻤﺎﻥ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻣﻮﻟﺪ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺳﻄﻴﺤﺎ ﻋﺎﺵ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺷﻖ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﻖ ﺑﻦ ﺣﻮﻳﻞ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺭﻡ ﺑﻦ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺭﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﻡ ﺍﺑﻮ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ ﻭﲦﻮﺩ ﻭﻃﺴﻢ ﻭﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻋﲔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﰲ‬
‫ﺟﺒﻬﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺸﻖ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻧﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻴﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﺃﻧﻈﺮﻩ ﺍﷲ ﺇﱃ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﳏﺒﻮﺱ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ‬

‫‪61‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﲤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭﻱ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺳﻔﺎﺭ ﻓﻮﻗﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺁﻩ ﻭﺧﺎﻃﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﻇﻬﻮﺭﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﻩ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﻻ‪ ،‬ﻣﺸﺪﻭﺩﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺻﺨﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺗﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﲟﺎﻳﺄﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺧﱪ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻐﺬﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺁﻩ ﲤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﻋﲔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ؛ ﻭﺣﺪﺙ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻭﻳﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ‪ :‬ﺣﺪﺛﲏ ﲤﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻃﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺃﻣﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻋﺸﻘﺖ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﺣﻮﻳﻼ؛ ﻓﺘﺰﺭﺣﺘﻪ ﻓﺄﻭﻟﺪﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﺪﺟﺎﻝ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺧﻮﺹ ﺑﻦ ﺣﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺎﹰ ﻣﺒﺪﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺳﻠﻴﻤﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺩﻋﺎﻩ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺒﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺤﺒﺴﻪ ﰲ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺘﻬﻮﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﺎﺭﻳﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻏﻠﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﳉﻦ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺧﻮﺻﺎﹰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺭﻕ ﻓﻴﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺮﺩ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻓﻌﻞ ﻭﺇﻻ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻓﻴﻠﺘﻮﻱ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻘﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﲟﺎ ﺧﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺣﻜﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﺽ ﺣﻜﻤﻪ ﺑﺼﺒﺺ ﺃﺣﺬﻗﺘﻪ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﺣﺪﻯ ﻋﻴﻨﻴﻪ ﻓﺮﺩﻩ ﺃﻋﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳎﻠﺴﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺑﻮﺍﺩﻱ ﺑﺮﻫﻮﺕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳛﺠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﻨﻢ ﻗﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻋﻴﻨﻴﻪ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺴﺠﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻳﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻧﺎﺭ ﻣﻀﻴﺌﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺩﺧﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺷﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﺸﻜﺮﻱ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻜﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻫﻠﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﺮ ﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎﻩ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺷﻖ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻩ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺷﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﻨﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﰲ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﻖ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻳﺎ ﺷﻖ ﺍﱐ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﲏ ﻓﻤﺎﻫﻲ؟ ﻭﻛﺘﻤﻪ ﻗﻮﻝ ﺳﻄﻴﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺷﻖ ﺭﺍﻳﺖ ﲪﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻇﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻌﺖ ﺑﲔ ﺭﻭﺽ ﻭﺃﻛﻤﺔ ﻓﺄﻛﻠﺖ ﻛﻞ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻧﺴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺗﺄﻭﻳﻠﻬﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﺣﻠﻒ ﲟﺎ ﺑﲔ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺮﺗﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﻄﺄﻥ ﺃﺭﺿﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻐﻠﱭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﻃﻔﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻤﻠﻜﻦ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺃﺑﲔ ﺍﱄ‬
‫ﳒﺮﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺑﻞ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺑﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﺴﺘﻨﻘﺬﻛﻢ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺫﻭ ﺷﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻭﳑﻦ ﻫﻮ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻏﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺫﻱ ﻳﺰﻥ؛ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻴﻤﻦ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻓﻬﻞ ﻳﺪﻭﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺑﻞ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻘﻄﻊ ﺑﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﻳﺮﺳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺪﻝ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﻞ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻳﻮﻡ ﻳﺪﻋﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺑﺪﻋﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻷﺣﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻤﻊ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻠﻤﻴﻘﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﳌﻦ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻭﺍﳋﲑﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﻦ ﻛﻔﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻳﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﺣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﺣﻖ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﻳﺎ ﺷﻖ؟‬

‫‪62‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﻱ ﻭﺭﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺭﻓﻊ ﻭﺧﻔﺾ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻧﺒﺄﺗﻚ ﺑﻪ ﳊﻖ ﳏﺾ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺬﺏ‬
‫ﻭﻻ ﻧﻘﺾ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺯﻩ ﺭﺑﻴﻌﺔ ﲜﺎﺋﺰﺓ ﺳﻨﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺻﻠﻪ ﻭﺻﺮﻓﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﺨﺒﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺯﺭﻗﺎﺀ‬

‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﺔ ﺟﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﻴﺖ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻣﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﺎ ﺭﺋﻲ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﻭﻃﺴﻢ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﻓﻐﻠﺒﺖ ﻃﺴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﻤﻴﻊ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﻕ‬
‫ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻔﺘﺮﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺯﻭﺍﺟﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻟﺖ ﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻮﻩ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻮﺍ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻃﺴﻢ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻨﺼﺮﺕ ﺑﻘﺎﻳﺎ ﻃﺴﻢ ﲝﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﺗﺒﻊ ﺍﳊﻤﲑﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﺰﺍ ﺟﺪﻳﺴﺎﹰ ﻃﺎﻟﺒﺎ ﺑﺜﺎﺭ ﻃﺴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻗﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻛﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻏﻠﻘﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﱪﻯ ﺍﺑﺼﺮﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻐﺮﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺳﺦ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺮﻯ ﻓﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺨﱪ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺑﺄﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﲜﺪﻳﺲ ﺍﺳﺘﻨﺼﺎﺭ ﻃﺴﻢ ﲝﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﺗﺒﻊ ﺍﳊﻤﲑﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻄﻨﻮﺍ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻠﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ‪ :‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻱ ﻓﻨﻈﺮﺕ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪ :‬ﺍﻗﺴﻢ ﲟﻬﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻵﻛﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﺒﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﺎﺗﲔ ﻣﻦ ﲪﲑ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﺍﻟﺮﺩﺍﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳋﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﺗﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﻓﻼﺡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺻﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ‪ :‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻱ ﻓﻨﻈﺮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﻥ ﳌﺎ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮ ﺑﺄﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺍﻳﺎﻡ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻻﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﺳﺘﺮﺍﻛﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑ ﻓﺘﻨﺬﺭ ﺑﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻴﺤﻤﻞ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻜﻢ ﻏﺼﻨﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻟﻴﺴﺪﻝ ﺍﻏﺼﺎﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻧﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﺕ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ :‬ﻳﺎﺟﺪﻳﺲ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺗﺘﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﲣﺒﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳊﺬﺭ ﻓﻜﺬﺑﻮﻫﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ‪ :‬ﺍﺗﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ؟ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ‪ :‬ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻈﺮﺕ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ‪ :‬ﺍﺭﻯ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﰲ ﻛﺘﻔﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺘﻒ‪ ،‬ﺍﻭ ﻧﻌﻞ ﳜﺼﻔﻪ ﻓﻜﺬﺑﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻗﺪ ﺗﻐﲑ ﻧﻈﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﺗﺮﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻌﺪ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺧﱪﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺣﺴﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﲑ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﻳﻜﻤﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﺇﻟﻯﺄﻥ ﺻﺒﺤﻬﻢ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻬﻢ ﺃﺑﺮﺡ ﻗﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺪﻡ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺒﺎﺡ‬
‫ﻧﺴﺎﺀﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻻ ﻋﺮﻓﺘﻴﻬﻢ ﲟﺴﲑﻱ؟ﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪ :‬ﻗﺪ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﻟﻮ ﻗﺒﻠﻮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻋﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺮﻭﻗﺎﹰ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ‪ :‬ﰈ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺗﻜﺘﺤﻠﲔ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﲝﺠﺮ ﺍﻷﲦﺪ‪ ،‬ﻣﺮﰉ ﲟﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻄﺮ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻗﻄﻊ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺭﺟﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻠﻊ‬
‫ﻋﻴﻨﻬﺎﻭﺻﻠﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ‪:‬ﺇﻥ ﺭﺋﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻟﻄﻤﻪ ﻓﺄﻋﻮﺭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻳﻨﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﻌﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﻓﺄﻛﺜﺮﻭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻷﻋﺸﻰ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﻴﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻭﳍﺎ‪:‬‬

‫‪63‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺒﺎﻨﺕ ﺴﻌﺎﺩ ﻓﺄﻤﺴﻰ ﺤﺒﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻨﻘﻁﻌﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻧﻈﺮﻫﺎ‪:‬‬
‫ﺤﻘﺎﹰ ﻜﻤﺎ ﻨﻅﺭ ﺍﻟﺭﺒﻰ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺸﺠﻌﺎ‬ ‫ﻤﺎ ﻨﻅﺭﺕ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺃﺸﻔﺎﺭ ﻜﻨﻅﺭﺘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺠﻴﻭﺵ ﺤﺴﺎﻥ ﺘﺯﺠﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻭﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻠﻌﺎ‬ ‫ﻓﻜﺫﺒﻭﻫﺎ ﺒﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﺕ ﻓﺼﺤﺒﻬﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺇﻳﺎﻫﺎ ﻋﲎ‪:‬‬
‫ﺇﻟﻰ ﺤﻤﺎﻡ ﺸﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﺍﺭﺩ ﺍﻟﺜﻤﺩ‬ ‫ﻭﺍﺤﻜﻡ ﻜﺤﻜﻡ ﻓﺘﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﺤﻲ ﺇﺫ ﻨﻅﺭﺕ‬
‫ﻤﺜﻝ ﺍﻟﺯﺠﺎﺠﺔ ﻟﻡ ﺘﻜﺤﻝ ﻤﻥ ﺍﻟﺭﻤﺩ‬ ‫ﺘﺤﻔﻪ ﺠﺎﻨﺒﺎﹰ ﺒﻴﺭ ﻭﻴﺘﺒﻌﻪ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻰ ﺤﻤﺎﻤﺘﻨﺎ ﺃﻭ ﻨﺼﻔﻪ ﻓﻘﺩ‬ ‫ﻗﺎﻟﺕ ﺍﻻ ﻟﻴﺘﻤﺎ ﻫﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﺤﻤﺎﻡ ﻟﻨﺎ‬
‫ﺘﺴﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺘﺴﻌﻴﻥ ﻟﻡ ﺘﻨﻘﺹ ﻭﻟﻡ ﺘﺯﺩ‬ ‫ﻓﺤﺴﺒﻭﻩ ﻓﺄﻟﻔﻭﻩ ﻜﻤﺎ ﺤﺴﺒﺕ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺴﺭﻋﺕ ﺤﺴﺒﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺫﻟﻙ ﺍﻟﻌﺩﺩ‬ ‫ﻓﻜﻤﻠﺕ ﻤﺎﺌﺔ ﻤﻨﻬﺎ ﺤﻤﺎﻤﺘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺼﺘﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻡ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺳﺠﻌﺖ ﻫﻲ ﺑﻪ‪:‬‬
‫ﺇﻟﻰ ﺤﻤﺎﻤﺘﻴﻪ‬ ‫ﻟﻴﺕ ﺍﻟﺤﻤﺎﻡ ﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺘﻡ ﺍﻟﺤﻤﺎﻡ ﻤﻴﻪ‬ ‫ﺃﻭ ﻨﺼﻔﻪ ﻗﺩﻴﻪ‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻋﺠﺎﺌﺏ ﻤﺼﺭ ﻭﺃﺨﺒﺎﺭ ﻤﻠﻭﻜﻬﺎ ﻭﻜﻬﺎﻨﻬﺎ‬

‫ﳌﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﺍﻥ ﻧﺬﻛﺮ ﻛﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻗﺪﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﻠﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻤﺎﹸ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﻳﺼﻔﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺃﺧﱪﻧﺎ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﻜﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻔﺪﻧﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻛﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﻳﻨﺤﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﺘﻬﻢ ﳓﻮ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻔﻴﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻭﲣﱪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻐﻴﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻠﻤﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﺎﺋﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻟﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﳌﻜﺘﻮﻣﺔ ﻓﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﺍﳉﻠﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﻻﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻃﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﳌﺘﺤﺮﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱄ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ؛ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺐ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺮﺩﻭﺍ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻼﺳﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻧﻔﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻷﻋﺪﺍﺀ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺑﻼﺩﻫﻢ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﻢ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺿﺤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺼﺮ ﲬﺴﺎﹸ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺄﺳﻔﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲬﺲ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﺋﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺔ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ"‬

‫‪64‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﺑﻌﺚ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺣﺎﺷﺮﻳﻦ ﻳﺄﺗﻮﻙ ﺑﻜﻞ ﺳﺤﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻢ " ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﺳﺎﺀ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻟﻜﻮﻛﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﳌﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻳﺴﻤﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎﻫﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﲰﻲ ﻗﺎﻃﺮ ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﳚﻠﺲ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻳﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻦ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺁﻩ ﻗﺎﻡ ﺇﺟﻼﻻ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺯﻳﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﺠﻠﺲ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻪ ﻓﺘﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﻘﻔﻮﻥ ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻃﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩ‬
‫ﺑﻜﻮﻛﺐ ﳜﺪﻣﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻌﺪﺍﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺳﻮﺍﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﺑﻌﺒﺪ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺗﺴﻤﻲ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻃﺮ ﻷﺣﺪ ﺍﳌﺎﻫﺮﻳﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻚ؟ ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪﺝ ﺍﻟﻔﻼﱐ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﻼﻧﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻛﺬﺍ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﰲ ﺣﺬﺍﺋﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻋﺮﻑ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻛﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﺍ؛ ﻭﻳﺄﻛﻞ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﺎﻣﻊ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﺍﻩ ﺻﻼﺣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﺗﺐ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‬
‫ﻳﻜﺘﺐ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻳﻠﺘﻔﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻧﻘﺶ ﺍﻧﺖ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺠﺮ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻓﻤﱴ ﺭﺳﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻀﻌﻮﻥ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪:‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻃﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺆﺭﺥ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻭﺷﺒﻬﻪ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻄﻮﻯ ﻭﺗﻮﺩﻉ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻌﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺟﺮﺕ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺣﺰﺑﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﳚﻤﻌﻬﻢ ﲞﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﻄﻒ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﲞﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﰒ ﻳﻘﺪﻣﻮﻥ ﺭﻛﺒﺎﻧﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻳﺘﻘﺪﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻀﺮﺏ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺑﻄﺒﻞ ﺍﻻﺟﺘﻤﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺪﺧﻞ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺄﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻌﻠﻮ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻧﻮﺭ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻭﺍﲪﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺛﻮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺭﺍﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺪ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﺤﺎﹰ ﲝﻴﺎﺕ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﰲ ﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﳕﺎ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻛﻮﻛﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻌﺒﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻧﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻷﻣﺮ ﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺿﻤﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺍﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﳝﺔ ﻭﺍﲰﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻴﻘﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻓﺘﺤﻜﻲ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻪ ﺣﻜﺎﻳﺎﺕ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻛﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺗﻄﻴﻌﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻨﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﺧﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺧﻂ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﲝﻴﺚ ﻻ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻓﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻨﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻔﺢ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻗﺼﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﲤﺜﺎﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻠﻮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺐ‬

‫‪65‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﱃ ﺑﻄﺤﺎﺀ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺃﺣﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﺍﻩ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﰲ ﻗﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻨﺎﻗﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻩ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺣﻜﻤﺔ ﺑﻨﺎﺋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺧﺮﻓﺔ ﺣﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻮﺵ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻷﻓﻼﻙ؛ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺑﻴﺢ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺋﺪ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﻃﻌﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻻ ﺇﻧﺲ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺟﺎﻣﺪ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﻫﺮ ﺗﺮﻯ ﺣﺮﻛﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﻣﺎ ﲨﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻌﲎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﺒﻮ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻋﺠﺒﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﻭﺃﻭﺻﺎﻩ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻮﺟﺐ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﻫﻮ ﺍﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻫﻠﻚ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺗﻌﺰﻯ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﳜﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﻗﻭﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻨﺔ‬

‫ﻭﰲ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲡﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺮﺵ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺭ؛ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﻜﻢ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺎﺩﻗﺎ ﺷﻖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﱂ ﺗﻀﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺘﺼﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺃﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺷﺎﺀﺕ ﰒ ﺑﻨﺖ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺠﺒﺖ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺣﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﳎﻮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺃﻧﺒﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻨﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺘﺤﺎﻛﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﺤﺎﻛﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻔﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﲟﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺪﻟﻪ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﺧﺎﻓﺾ ﻏﲑ ﻋﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻼﻣﻪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻫﻮ ﺃﺫﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻷﻧﺒﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﺍﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﲔ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺧﺮﺏ ﲞﺖ ﻧﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﻋﻴﻘﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺪ ﺗﻜﻬﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺖ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻏﺼﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﲞﻄﺎﻃﻴﻒ ﺣﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻘﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﱂ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺗﻘﺪﻣﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳋﻄﺎﻃﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﻠﻘﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺷﺒﻜﺖ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﻔﺎﺭﻗﻪ ﺣﱴ ﳛﺪﺙ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺪﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺘﺮﻑ ﺑﻈﻠﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻼﻣﺔ ﺧﺼﻤﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﲰﺎﻩ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺃﻓﺮﻭﻳﺲ ﺃﻱ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺯﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳜﺘﺼﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺯﺍﻍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳊﻖ‬
‫ﺛﺒﺖ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻨﺼﻒ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻭ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻭ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻡ ﻟﻴﻼ ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﺳﻢ‬
‫ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﻭﺗﻀﺮﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺼﺒﺢ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺣﺎﺟﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﱰﻟﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪66‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﲟﺎ ﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﺃﻃﻴﺎﺭ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﺘﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺮ ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ ﻓﻴﺰﺩﺍﺩﻭﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﻭﻫﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻤﻸ ﻣﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻗﺬﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺣﻮﺵ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺳﺒﺎﻋﻬﺎﻭﻫﻮﺍﻣﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻬﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺷﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻳﻮﻗﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻄﻠﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻧﺎﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳌﻌﺠﺰﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﻜﻦ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍ‪‬ﻮﺳﻲ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﺎ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺗﻨﻄﻘﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎﹰﻷﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻧﻘﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺳﻮﺭﻧﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻀﺤﻚ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ‬
‫ﺍﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺰﻧﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻔﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻕ‪.‬‬

‫ﺨﺒﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺒﻌﺩ ﺍﻟﻁﻭﻓﺎﻥ‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻜﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻜﻬﻦ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻓﻠﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺭﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺯﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻨﺼﻮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺣﺪﻳﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻋﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﺑﻞ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻛﺎﳊﺎﻛﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺼﻰ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﲢﻘﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﻭﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﺑﻦ ﻳﻨﺼﻮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻔﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﻛﻬﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳑﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺑﲎ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺧﺎﻃﺒﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﺳﺘﺘﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ ﻭﻗﺘﺎﹸ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻣﺮﺓ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﰲ ﺑﺮﺝ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻴﺨﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﻨﻬﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﳛﺬﺭﻫﻢ ﳐﺎﻟﻔﺔ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳚﻠﺲ ‪‬ﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻓﻴﺨﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﻬﺎﻫﻢ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻜﻠﻤﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻏﲑ ﺧﻔﻲ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺒﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﺔ ﳑﻮﻫﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‬
‫ﻭﺯﺧﺮﻑ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳚﻠﺲ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺨﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﲟﺜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﳜﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳚﻠﺲ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺎﺏ ﺑﻮﺟﻪ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﺓ ﰒ ﻏﺎﺏ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﻭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﺮﻫﺔ ﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﻠﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻟﻌﺪﱘ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﻭﺃﻋﻠﻤﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪67‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺪﻳﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻨﺔ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﻲ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﻓﻬﻲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻃﻘﺔ ﲟﻨﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻧﺔ ﰲ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻫﺎ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﺑﺮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﻛﺎﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺣﻜﻰ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﻬﺎﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ‬
‫ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻮﺵ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻄﺸﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ‪‬ﺎ ﺻﻴﺤﺔ ﺍﺭﲡﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺗﺸﻘﻘﺖ ﺟﺒﺎﳍﺎ ﻓﻤﺎﺗﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺤﺔ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻄﲑ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﺗﻀﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺄﺟﻨﺤﺘﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺷﺆﻭﻥ ﺍﻷﴰﻮﱐ ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻫﻴﻜﻠﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲢﻜﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺣﻜﺎﻳﺎﺕ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﻜﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳜﻔﻰ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﺍﻻﴰﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻣﻴﻼ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﺼﻨﺎ ﺑﲎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﲎ ﺃﻧﺼﻨﺎ ﻭﺍﲣﺬ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﻼﻋﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﲣﺬ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺢ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻃﻬﺮﺍﻃﻴﺲ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺍﺑﻮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻧﺴﺮ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﰊ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﺳﺪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﱄ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﻠﺐ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﻄﻖ ﺇﺫﺍ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺻﺪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﺌﺬﺍﻥ ﺍﳌﻮﻛﻠﲔ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﲢﻤﻞ ﻛﻞ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺗﺘﻠﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻟﻮﻧﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻨﻘﻀﻲ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺑﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﰒ‬
‫ﺗﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ ﻭﺗﻜﺴﻲ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﻪ ﲰﻚ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪ ﻳﻨﺔ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻒ ﺗﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻀﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺳﻖ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﳌﻨﺼﻮﺑﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﺃﻭﻝ ﻤﻥ ﺒﻨﻰ ﺍﻻﻫﺭﺍﻡ‬

‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺑﺜﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻧﻘﻠﺒﺖ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﻬﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﺗﺘﺴﺎﻗﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﺪﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎ‬
‫ﺑﺄﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﻫﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻣﻔﺰﻋﺔ ﻓﺮﺟﻒ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﺃﺯﻋﺠﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﺭﻋﺒﻪ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻩ ﻻﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺳﻴﺤﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‬

‫‪68‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﻣﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺭﺍﻯ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻃﻴﻮﺭ ﺑﻴﺾ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﺎ ﲣﻄﻒ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻠﻘﻴﻬﻢ ﺑﲔ ﺟﺒﻠﲔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﳉﺒﻠﲔ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﻘﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺓ ﻣﻈﻠﻤﺔ ﻛﺎﺳﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﺬﻋﻮﺭﺍ ًﻓﺰﻋﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﺘﻀﺮﻉ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﳝﺮﻍ ﺧﺪﻳﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﻜﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺭﺅﺳﺎﺀ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ؛ ﻓﺨﻼ ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺣﻜﻰ ﳍﻢ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎﺭﺁﻩ ﻓﺄﻋﻈﻤﻮﻩ ﻭﺃﻛﱪﻭﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺄﻭﻟﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﳛﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺇﺫ ﺫﺍﻙ ﻛﺒﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻻ ﻳﱪﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻀﺮﺓ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻷﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻛﻬﻨﺔ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﺠﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺍﹰ ﻛﺒﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﻼﻡ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻻ ﲡﺮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳏﺎﻝ ﻭﻻ ﻛﺬﺏ ﻟﻌﻈﻢ ﺃﻗﺪﺍﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺒﲑ ﺃﺧﻄﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﺧﱪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺬ‬
‫ﺳﻨﺔ ﱂ ﺃﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻷﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪:‬ﻗﺼﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻲ‪ ‬ﻳﺎ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﻛﺄﱐ ﻗﺎﻋﺪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﳌﻐﺎﺭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﰲ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻗﺪ ﺍﳓﻂ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻗﺎﺭﺏ ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻨﺎ ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺍﶈﻴﻄﺔ ﺑﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺭﺍﻓﻊ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻮﺍﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺎﻟﻄﺘﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺷﱴ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﻴﺜﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﳒﻔﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺭﺍﻓﻊ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﱐ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻓﻌﻞ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﺫ‬
‫ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻧﻔﺘﺢ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺿﻴﺎﺀ ﻳﻀﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻓﻜﺄﻧﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻐﺜﻨﺎ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺒﺘﻨﺎ‬
‫ﺑﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﺳﻴﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﻀﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺛﻼﺙ ﻭﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﺩﻭﺭﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻛﺎﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﺼﻖ ﺑﺎﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﰒ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻬﺖ ﻓﺰﻋﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ :‬ﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻫﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺎﺩﺙ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻠﻐﻮﺍ ﻏﺎﻳﺘﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺼﺎﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﻩ ﺑﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲤﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺩﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﺣﻜﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺣﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻓﺰﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻜﻤﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺷﺮﻑ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻠﻭﻙ ﻤﺼﺭ ﻗﺒﻝ ﺍﻟﻁﻭﻓﺎﻥ‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺑﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ ﳌﺎ ﺑﻐﻰ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﲢﺎﺳﺪﻭﺍ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺑﻨﻮ ﻗﺎﺑﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﲢﻮﻝ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﻛﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ ﺩﺍﻭﻳﻞ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ‬

‫‪69‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﻧﻴﻒ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺭﺍﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺟﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎﹰ ﻳﻨﻘﻄﻌﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺑﲏ‬
‫ﺁﺩﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﺍﻟﻮﺍ ﳝﺸﻮﻥ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﺄﻃﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺸﻲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﺳﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺣﺴﻨﻪ ﺃﻋﺠﺒﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‪ :‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﻠﺪ ﺯﺭﻉ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻮﻃﻨﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺑﻨﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﺍﶈﻜﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺗﱪﻛﺎﹰ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻟﻪ ﻗﻮﺓ ﺯﺍﺋﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﻄﺶ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﺎﳌﺎﹰ ﻟﻪ ﺭﺋﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻠﻚ ﺑﲏ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻣﻄﺎﻋﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﺩﺭﺍﺑﻴﻞ ﻵﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻬﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺿﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻬﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﻭﺃﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻄﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻃﺎﻣﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺟﻠﻴﻞ ﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﲔ‪ ،‬ﺇﳕﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﺴﺮﻫﺎ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﺧﱪﻫﺎ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﺣﲔ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﲰﻮﻫﺎ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺳﺎ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻃﻮﺍﻻﹰ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺭﻋﻮﺍ ﻭﻋﻤﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺑﻴﺖ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺽ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺣﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺟﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﺎﺀﻩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻌﺘﺪﻝ ﺍﳉﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻨﺒﻄﺢ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﻔﺮﻕ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﺣﱴ ﻫﻨﺪﺳﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻘﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻨﻮﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺷﻘﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪‬ﺮﺍﹰ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﳚﺮﻱ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺳﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻭﺱ ﻭﻛﺜﺮ ﺧﲑﻫﻢ ﻭﻋﻤﺮﺕ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺿﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲡﱪ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﳌﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺧﻠﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺈﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭﺩﺨﻭﻟﻬﻡ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻜﻴﻑ ﺨﺭﺠﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻨﺯﻟﻭﺍ ﺒﻬﺎ‬

‫ﻭﺣﺮﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﳌﻦ ﺣﺎﺭ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀﻗﺒﺔﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﻣﺜﺒﺘﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻗﺪﺭﻫﺎ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺷﺒﺎﺭ ﺗﺮﻯ ﺧﻀﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺪ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﲔ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﰊﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﱃ ﺷﺎﻃﻲﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻤﻠﻪ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺃﺟﻠﺴﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻒ ﺧﻂ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺰﻓﱵ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳋﻴﻮﻁ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﲢﺖ‬
‫ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺍﱃ ﺑﻄﺎﺋﺢ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪.‬‬

‫‪70‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﲎ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﺑﲔ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻟﺒﻘﺮﺍﻧﺲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺴﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻷﺻﻐﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﻳﺮﺑﻴﺎﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻨﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ‪‬ﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻏﺮﻭﺳﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺄﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ ﻳﺼﻔﺮ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻃﻠﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﺮﺗﲔ ﻭﻋﻨﺪ ﻏﺮﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺮﺗﲔ‪،‬‬
‫ﺗﺼﻔﲑﺍﹰ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻳﺴﺘﺪﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺍﺩﺙ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺘﺄﻫﺒﻮﻥ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﳍﻢ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳎﺮﻯ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻘﺴﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻗﺴﻤﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻨﻤﲔ ﺣﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺳﺎﺭﻕ ﱂ ﳝﻜﻨﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﻘﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻤﲔ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻏﲑ ﻫﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﳎﻮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻸﻫﺎ ﻛﱪﻳﺘﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻗﺎﺻﺪ ﺑﺴﻮﺀ ﺃﺭﺳﻠﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﺎ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺪ ﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺴﺎﺗﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﺩ ﻋﻠﻮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺑﻄﺮﺱ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﻔﻮﺭ ﺑﺎﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻳﺴﻘﻲ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺰﺍﺭﻉ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻟﻄﺨﻮﺍ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻷﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﻤﺴﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﺼﻔﺤﺎﹰ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍﹰ ﻻ ﲢﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﻭﻻﲢﺼﺮ ﻗﻴﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻴﺴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺜﲑﺍﹸ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻛﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﻔﺮﻭﻍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻷﻭﺍﱐ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻟﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﻌﻠﻢ ﻗﻴﻤﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻮﺕ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻃﻠﻤﺴﺎﺕ ﺗﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻪ‬
‫ﺍﳍﻮﺍﻡ ﻭﺍﳊﺸﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﻛﻞ ﻃﺎﻟﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻧﺲ ﻭﺍﳉﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺑﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﻋﺘﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻋﻼ ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺟﻠﺠﻠﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺟﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻔﺢ‬
‫ﺣﻴﻄﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺼﻔﺎﺋﺢ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﻭﺱ ﲢﻔﻬﺎ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺃﲰﺎﺀﻫﺎ ﻭﻣﻨﺎﻓﻌﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻓﻬﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻫﻴﻜﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﲡﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﻓﻊ ﻭﺍﳌﻀﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻟﻠﻬﻴﻜﻞ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﺳﺪﻧﺔ‪.‬‬

‫‪71‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻐﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﶈﻴﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺅﻭﺳﻬﺎ ﺍﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ‬
‫ﻋﻴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﳌﺼﺎﺑﻴﺢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﺣﺎﺋﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﺷﻔﺎﻓﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻟﻠﺤﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺃﻏﺮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻲ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﺻﻨﻢ‬
‫ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ‪.‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺷﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺟﺴﺪ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﻭﻋﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺗﺎﻥ ﺻﻔﺮﺍﻭﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺟﺎﻟﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻐﻨﻄﻴﺲ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺟﺴﺪ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺟﺎﻟﺴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ ﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺫﺅﺍﺑﺘﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺭﺍﻓﻌﺔ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﺁﺓ ﺍﱃ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﻈﻬﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺋﻞ‪ .‬ﻻ ﲣﺘﻠﻂ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺆﺫﻱ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻟﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻐﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎﺷﻴﺦ ﺟﺎﻟﺲ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﲑﻭﺯﺝ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺻﺒﻴﺔ ﺟﻠﻮﺱ ﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﻧﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻜﺐ ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺸﺎﺩﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﺍﺋﻢ ﻛﱪﻳﺖ ﺃﲪﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻔﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺯﻣﺮﺩ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻋﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﺃﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﺯﺭﻗﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﺔ ﻗﺪ ﻟﻮﺕ ﺫﻧﺒﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻌﺖ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻥ ﺗﻨﻔﺦ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺻﻔﺔ ﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﺭﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﺱ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ‬
‫ﺳﻴﻒ ﻣﺴﻠﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻭﺭﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺬﻉ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺳﻘﻔﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻳﺘﺤﺪﺛﺎﻥ ﰲ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭﰐ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻭﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﱪﻳﺖ ﺍﲪﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﳑﺴﻜﺔ ﺑﻀﻔﲑ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﲢﺘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﻘﺮﺅﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﳊﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﳝﻨﻊ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﳐﺘﻠﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻸ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻴﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺍﳋﻄﲑ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﱪﻳﺖ ﺍﻷﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻛﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﺍﻻﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﺆﻟﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺗﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻼﻣﺔ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺬ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺧﺎﺯﻧﺎ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺖ ﺟﻠﺠﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺙ ﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻴﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺙ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻣﻴﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﺳﺮﺍﺏ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻳﺼﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻔﺎﺕ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻔﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﳝﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ‬

‫‪72‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﻱﺀ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﺵ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻜﻞ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺎﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎﻩ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺃﺯﺍﻟﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﻟﺰﻭﺍﻝ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﺵ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﱃ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﲎ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺮﻣﺮ ﻭﻣﻮﻫﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ‬
‫ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻛﺎﻟﻔﺮﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺃﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺧﻲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﻠﻞ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻮﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻄﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﳛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻗﻨﺪﻳﻼ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﰲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﺠﺮﺍ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺍ ﻳﻀﻲﺀ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﳑﺎ ﻳﻀﻲﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺍﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻟﻪ ﺳﺪﻧﺔ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻣﺼﺮ ﲰﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﻰ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺼﺮﱘ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻓﻠﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﳜﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﺄﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻗﺪ ﺫﻟﻞ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺮﻛﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺤﺒﻪ ﺍﳉﲏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺮﺻﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺰﻭﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺑﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﳛﺘﺠﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺤﺮﻩ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺩﻋﺎﻩ ﺇﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺠﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﳌﺎ ﺭﻛﺐ ﰲ ﻋﺮﺷﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻌﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻀﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﺻﻔﺔﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ"ﺍﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﺷﻒ ﺍﻷﺳﺮﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﻐﺎ ﻟﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﻬﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﻤﺴﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﻤﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻃﻘﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺒﺖ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﺍﳍﺎﺋﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺋﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻱ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻻ ﳝﻠﻚ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻠﻜﻲ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺃﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺟﻨﺘﻪ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻮﻟﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﺗﺆﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﺜﻤﺎﺭ‪.‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﲪﺮ ﻋﻠﻯﺮﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺧﺘﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﻈﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﳜﺮﺝ‬
‫ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﺇﻻ ﻫﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺐ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺮﻭﻩ ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻮﺍ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺘﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﳚﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ‬
‫ﻋﺎﻝ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻭﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻈﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻣﻸﺕ ﻗﻠﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺭﻋﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻭﺩﻋﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺈﺣﻀﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ ﻓﺄﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻭﺭﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﱂ ﻳﺮﻭﻩ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﰲ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺑﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﺃﺟﺪﺍﺩﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻋﻴﻘﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺪﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺶ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﳍﻢ ﺣﺮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻃﻼﺳﻢ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺍﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺭﻓﻊ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻄﻞ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ‪.‬‬

‫‪73‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﻋﻴﻘﺎﻡ ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﺍﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺃﻏﺼﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻄﺨﻬﺎ ﺑﺪﻭﺍﺀ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﲡﻠﺐ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺘﻤﻜﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻴﺪﻫﺎ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺷﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﲔ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺎﺭﻭﺕ ﻭﻣﺎﺭﻭﺕ ﻛﺎﻧﺎ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻘﻼ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ ﻭﺗﻌﻠﻢ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻤﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻟﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻐﺼﻮﺑﺎﺕ ﻓﺴﻤﺘﻪ ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﻭﺑﻘﻲ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻻﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﲰﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺧﻼ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺮﺑﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﺄﺧﺮ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻫﺠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﱴ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺑﻘﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻟﻮﺣﻴﻢ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻩ ﻣﻠﻘﻰ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﺍﺷﻪ ﺟﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻮﻗﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﺭ ﳛﺮﻕ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ ﺍﻟﻼﰐ ﻛﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﺃﺣﺮﻗﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻐﺼﻮﺑﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﺳﺮﺣﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﳌﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ‪‬ﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻟﻮﺣﻴﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻭﻟﺒﺲ ﺗﺎﺝ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺧﻄﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺍﻷﺛﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﲑﺓ ﻭﺍﻏﺘﺼﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺳﻔﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻓﺾ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻻﺳﺘﺨﻔﺎﻑ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﳌﲑﺍﺙ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﻩ ﻭﺃﺣﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑﻩ ﻭﺿﻤﻦ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻹﺣﺴﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺑﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺫﻯ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺮﺿﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺃﻧﺖ ﺃﺣﻖ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻼ ﺯﻟﺖ ﺩﺍﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻣﺴﺮﻭﺭﻳﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺘﺠﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺗﻌﻈﻴﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻡ ﲨﻴﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺪﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﺍﻧﻴﻖ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻓﺄﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﺭﺑﻊ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺐ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻏﺮﺍﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺯﺍﻝ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺣﺼﻠﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺧﺖ ﺣﻜﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﺭﻳﻬﺎ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻓﺎﺋﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ ﻭﺍﳉﻤﺎﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﺸﻘﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﺍﻥ ‪‬ﺒﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺑﺖ ﻓﺄﱀ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻀﺒﺖ ﻭﺍﻋﺰﻟﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻨﺖ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻌﺒﺪﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻟﻠﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻣﺪﺓ ﰒ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﺃﺕ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﺗﻨﺎﺟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺄﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﻠﻢ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺧﻴﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻨﻬﺎﻫﺎ ﺃﻥ ﲤﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻠﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺣﻈﻴﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻀﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻓﺤﺴﺪ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﺍﹰ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺍﺩ ﺣﺴﺪﻫﻦ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻦ ﻳﻄﻠﱭ ﺃﺫﺍﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻄﻠﱭ ﺍﻟﻐﻮﺍﺋﻞ ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺟﻞ ﻭﺯﺭﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳌﺎ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﳏﺒﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳍﺎ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻓﻴﻘﻀﻲ ﻣﺎﻋﺮﺽ ﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻮﺍﺋﺠﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﺇﺟﻼﻻ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺼﺪﻥ ﺿﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﺫﺍﻳﺘﻬﺎ ﱂ ﳚﺪﻥ ﺃﳒﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻣﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﺴﺪﺍ‬

‫‪74‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺑﻐﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻘﻘﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻬﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﺸﺎﻭﺭ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﻭﻻ ﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﻔﺬ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﺩﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﻓﺎﻋﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺳﺮﻋﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻬﻤﺎ ﺗﺄﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺒﻘﺎﺋﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻣﺮﳘﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﻙ ﻭﺟﺎﺭﻳﺘﻚ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﰊ ﻋﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻛﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺃﲢﺪﺙ ﺣﺪﺛﺎ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﺗﺘﺤﻘﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﻏﲑ ﻣﺸﻮﺭﺓ ﻷﻫﻞ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻘﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﱂ ﺃﻣﻠﻚ ﺻﱪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺇﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻟﻴﺲ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻥ ﺗﻌﺠﻞ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﺒﲔ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻻﻣﺮ! ﻓﺎﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺒﻘﺎﺋﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲝﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻣﺮﳘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺬﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻌﻰ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺿﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺎﺧﺮﺟﻦ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﺼﻠﻴﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻘﻴﺎﺳﺎﹰ ﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻧﻪ ﲨﻊ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺑﻴﺘﹰﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺻﻐﲑﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻣﻮﺯﻭﻥ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ ﻋﻘﺎﺑﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻭﺃﻧﺜﻰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﻭﺣﻀﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﺍﻣﲑ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺼﻔﺮ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺒﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺻﻔﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺗﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺯﺍﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﺇﻥ ﺻﻔﺮﺕ ﺍﻷﻧﺜﻰ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻧﺎﻗﺼﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻌﱪﻭﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﺃﺻﺒﻊ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ ﻓﻬﻮ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﻔﺮﻭﺍ‬
‫ﻟﻠﺰﺭﻉ ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺤﻮﺍ ﺍﳉﺴﻮﺭ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻄﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﺒﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﺃﻱ‬
‫ﺧﺎﺩﻡ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻟﻠﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺭﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻔﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﻋﻤﺘﻪ ﻭﺍﺩﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺩﻳﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻭﺟﺘﻪ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻨﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﺣﺘﻔﻠﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻳﻨﺘﻬﺎ ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﺶ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲪﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﻳﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺣﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﻭﻗﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﺣﺼﻠﻴﻢ ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﰲ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﻮﻝ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺏ ﻓﺴﻜﻨﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻫﻲ ﺇﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺫﻭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﻴﺖ ﻣﻐﺮﺑﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺼﺒﺢ ﻣﺸﺮﻗﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﲣﺬ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺘﻨﻜﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﺸﻖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻢ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﺎﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻋﺎﺟﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺣﺎﻝ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻭﺳﲑﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳎﺎﺭﻱ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻟﺪ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﳍﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻊ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻗﺎﻃﺮﺍﹰ‬

‫‪75‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻟﺰﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻗﻄﻌﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻻ ﻳﺸﺮﻛﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻭﻗﻊ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻻﺧﻮﺓ ﺗﺸﺎﺟﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺧﺘﻼﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﲨﻊ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻗﺴﻤﺘﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻡ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻓﺘﻜﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﻭﻓﻀﺎﺋﻠﻪ ﻭﺳﻌﺎﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﴰﻠﻬﻢ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪ ﲟﺎ‬
‫ﺭﺃﺗﻪ ﺍﳉﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻘﻠﻴﺪ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﺣﻴﺎ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﱂ ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻷ‪‬ﻢ ﱂ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﺍ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﺣﻔﻆ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﺭﻩ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﱂ ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺳﻠﻒ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺤﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﻭﺭﺿﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺃﻳﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﻘﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺳﻨﺎ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻓﺪﺭﺷﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺳﲑﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﺤﻤﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻭﻧﻘﺸﻪ ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻮﺵ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﲜﻠﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﺮﻭﺵ ﻭﲪﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺘﱰﻩ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺒﻴﻨﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺇﺫ ﻫﺒﺖ ﺭﻳﺢ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻓﺎﻧﻜﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻭﻏﺮﻕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻧﻔﻰ ﺇﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻗﺘﺼﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﻋﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﻓﺴﺤﺮﺗﻪ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻫﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺮﺩ ﲝﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﺯﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻟﺬﺍﺗﻪ ﻭﳍﻮﻩ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻼﻛﻪ ﻛﺘﻤﺘﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭ‪‬ﻴﻪ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﺗﺴﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺑﺄﻣﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺇﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ ﲨﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻮﻋﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﻗﺪﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳕﺮﻭﺩ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻗﺪﺭﺷﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺎﺩ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﲟﺤﺎﺭﺑﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻮﻩ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻮﻩ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻮﺍ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﳑﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻭﺃﺗﻮﺍ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺧﱪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻳﻘﻨﻮﺍ ﲟﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳕﺮﻭﺩ ﺑﻦ ﻫﻮﺻﺎﻝ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻭﻋﺪﻫﻢ ﲝﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﲑﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺗﻘﻴﻴﺪ ﻣﺎﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻜﺮﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻌﺎﻝ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻮﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻟﻪ ﻭﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ ﻓﻔﺮﻗﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﺍﻗﻄﻌﻬﻢ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ‬
‫ﺍﺩﺧﺮﻩ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺑﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﻘﺘﻠﻬﻤﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﻊ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﱪ ﻷﻥ ﺃﻣﻪ ﺫﻫﺒﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ‬

‫‪76‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﺳﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﻛﻬﺎﻧﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻌﺖ ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺩﺍﺧﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻋﻠﻤﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺑﻨﻬﺎ ﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻻﻥ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﻗﻠﺪﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺪﺑﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻋﻠﻤﺘﻬﻢ ﻓﺼﺪﻗﻮﻫﺎ ﻭﺃﺟﺎﺑﻮﻫﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﻣﺘﻐﻠﺐ ﻏﺎﺻﺐ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﻣﻦ ﲪﺎﻳﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻧﺼﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺸﺮ ﻛﺜﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﺣﻒ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﺍﱃ ﳕﺮﻭﺩ ﲜﻤﻮﻉ ﻛﺜﲑﺓﻭﻗﺪﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻓﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻬﻠﻜﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﶈﺮﻗﺔ ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﳕﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﻦ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺟﻨﺎﺩ ﻭﺍﻻﺗﺒﺎﻉ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺰﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﻠﻘﻮﺍ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ‬
‫ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﺑﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮﻩ ﻭﻟﺒﺲ ﺗﺎﺝ ﺍﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﻃﺎﻓﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻄﺎﺭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﲰﻪ ﺗﻮﺳﺪﻭﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺣﺪﺙ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻣﻪ ﺗﺪﺑﺮ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺤﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﺟﺪ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﳏﺎﺭﺑﺘﻪ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻇﻔﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻴﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﺳﲑﺍ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﻴﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺸﺪﺕ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺑﺮﺃﺱ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻭﺷﺪﺕ ﺭﺟﻠﻪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔﺍﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺗﺬﻛﺮﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﻭﺍﻭﺩﻋﺘﻪ ﺑﻴﺘﺎ ﻭﻭﻛﻠﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺭﺟﺎﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺮﺳﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻟﺘﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻋﻴﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﻮﻳﺎ ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﺻﻴﺤﺔ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳊﺮﺱ ﻭﻫﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻠﻐﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﺎﻧﺰﺍﻟﻪ ﻭﺍﺣﻀﺮﺗﻪ ﻭﺍﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﻨﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﻗﺪ ﻓﺄﻭﻗﺪﺕ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺗﺄﻣﺮ ﻓﻴﻘﻄﻊ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻀﻮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﻀﻮ ﻓﻴﻠﻘﻰ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﱪ ﺍﺑﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﺠﻤﺎ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻛﺮﻳﺔ ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﺩﺍﺋﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﺭﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻭﺻﻮﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﺎﺋﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺑﻄﻠﻮﻋﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻓﻮﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻣﺎﺗﺖ ﺃﻣﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺻﺖ ﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪﻫﺎ ﲢﺖ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﻠﻰ‬
‫ﲟﺎ ﻳﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﱳ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻴﺘﺔ ﲣﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﲡﺎﻭ‪‬ﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺄﻟﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻻﺑﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻓﺰﻋﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﺼﻮﺭ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﺣﻀﺮﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺷﻜﻞ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ‪ ،‬ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺷﻔﻴﻔﺎ ﻭﻳﻄﻠﻰ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﻷﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﻤﺴﻜﺔ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﺤﺪﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺸﻔﺘﲔ ﻭﻳﻨﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻋﻴﺪ ﺗﻘﺮﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺑﲔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺪﻓﻦ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ‪ ،‬ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺴﲑﺓ ﺍﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺣﻒ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻃﺮﺑﻴﺲ ﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻕ ﻓﺘﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﺣﻒ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻌﺮﻑ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﺴﺤﺮ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺍﺩ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺘﻨﻜﺮﺍﹰ ﻟﻴﻌﺮﻑ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺤﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻧﻔﺮ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺼﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﳍﻢ ﺍﳌﻮﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻮﻫﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﲡﺎﺭ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻭﻥ ﺑﻠﺪﺍ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻟﻴﺤﺘﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻇﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺒﺴﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﲞﱪﻫﻢ‪.‬‬

‫‪77‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺭ ﳍﻢ ﻋﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﻃﺎﺋﺮﺍﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻧﻘﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻴﺨﺘﻄﻔﻪ ﻓﺤﺎﺩ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻛﺎﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻘﻂ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺎﻭﺯﻩ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﺮ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻀﺮﻩ ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻣﺬﻋﻮﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺚ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺺ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺭﺅﻳﺎﻩ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻭﻭﺍﻓﻖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺼﻦ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﲜﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻮﺛﻘﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﲪﻠﻮﻫﻢ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻟﲑﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺠﺰﺍﺕ ﻓﺒﻠﻐﻮﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻭﻗﻔﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ ﰒ‬
‫ﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﻇﻬﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻳﺘﻌﺠﺒﻮﻥ ﳑﺎ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺃﻇﻬﺮﻭﺍ ﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻻ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺇﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺎﺻﺘﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﻀﺮ ﺍﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺿﻤﺮ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻏﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﻣﺮ ﻓﺸﻘﻮﻫﺎ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻀﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﺣﺪﺍ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﺩﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﺧﺬﺗﻪ ﻓﻮﱃ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺎ ﻓﺄﺗﻰ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﺗﻮﻋﺪﻩ ﻓﺄﻗﺮ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳊﺼﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺧﺬ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺼﻠﺐ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺄﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻓﻼﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻓﻼﻥ ﺍﳌﺘﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺄﻡ ﺃﺿﻤﺮ ﻏﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻭﻃﻠﺐ ﻣﺎﱂ ﻳﺼﻞ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻇﻠﻤﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻌﻮﻗﺐ ‪‬ﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﻃﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﲔ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﳍﻢ ﻗﺪ ﻭﺟﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻟﺼﺤﺒﺘﻜﻢ ﳌﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ .‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺑﻔﻀﻠﻪ ﻋﻔﺎ ﻋﻨﻜﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﲣﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻼﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﻌﻮﺩﻭﺍ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﲔ ﻣﺴﺮﻭﺭﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻻ ﳝﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﺄﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺣﺪﺛﻮﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ .‬ﻓﺎﻧﻘﻄﻌﺖ ﺍﻃﻤﺎﻉ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﳍﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﺮﺑﺎﻕ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﺑﻄﺔ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺻﻔﻘﺖ ﲜﻨﺎﺣﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺮﺧﺖ ﻓﻴﺆﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﻭﻳﻜﺸﻒ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻣﻘﺼﺪﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺷﻖ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ‪‬ﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﱪﻳﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﻭﺍﻋﻼﻣﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻏﺮﻭﺳﺎ ﻳﺘﱰﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﻦ ﺳﺮﻳﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﻋﺎﳌﺎ ﻣﻨﺠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻓﺎﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻗﺴﻤﺎ ﻣﻮﺯﻭﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﺻﺮﻑ ﺍﱃ ﻛﻞ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻗﺴﻄﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﻟﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻃﺒﻘﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫" ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ " ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﻠﻲ ﻋﺪﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﻻﻛﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺧﺎﰎ‬

‫‪78‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫" ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ " ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﳌﺘﻮﻟﲔ ﳉﺒﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﺷﺮﺍﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻘﺎﺕ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺼﺎﱀ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺴﻤﺔ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫" ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ " ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺧﺪﻣﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺘﻮﱄ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺵ ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻮﺍﺩﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺎﻛﻬﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ ﻭﺻﻐﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﻨﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺭﻳﺞ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻃﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻭﺧﻮﺍﰊ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳑﺎﻳﺸﺒﻬﻪ‪.‬‬
‫" ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻌﺔ " ﺍﳌﻨﺠﻤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﻃﺒﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻼﺳﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﻮﻫﻢ "ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺴﺔ" ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﺘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﺍﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﺱ‪.‬‬
‫" ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺩﺳﺔ" ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳌﺆﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﻴﺪﻭﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻓﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺮﻓﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻯﺄﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﺤﺴﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫" ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ " ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﻭﺍﳍﻮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻯﺄﺧﺬ ﺩﻣﺎﺋﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺮﺍﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺷﺤﻮﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻷﻃﺒﺎﺀ ﻻﺻﻼﺡ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺄﻟﻴﻒ ﺍﻷﺩﻭﻳﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﻻ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺻﻨﺎﻋﺔ ﰲ ﺩﻟﺴﺔ ﻭﻻ ﻣﻬﻨﺔ ﰲ ﻏﲑ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻗﺼﺮ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻋﻮﻗﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﺟﻮﺯﻱ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺭﺗﺒﺔ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻼﻫﻲ ﻭﺍﻷﳊﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻗﺴﻤﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﰲ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺑﺘﺪﻉ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺟﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪ‬
‫ﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺍﻻﺷﺠﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﺎﱄ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﺳﺤﺮﺓ ﻳﻘﺴﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳝﻨﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ ﺑﺄﺫﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﳝﻨﻌﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﻭﺣﺶ ﻭﻫﻮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺮﻯ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺪﺍﺩ ﻭﺍﻻﻋﺘﺪﺍﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺻﻨﻔﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺑﺌﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻭﻳﺮﻓﻊ ﻛﻞ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻧﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺖ ﺫﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺋﻤﺔ ﺗﻌﻈﻴﻤﺎ ﻟﻠﻨﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻟﺘﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﲪﲑ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﺑﲎ ﺑﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﻠﻔﺮﺱ ﺍﻗﺘﺪﺍﺀ ﺑﺴﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﲟﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻥ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻧﻄﻠﻖ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﻮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺘﻬﺎ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﻭﺍﺟﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺓ ﺃﻓﻌﻰ ﳍﺎ ﺭﺃﺳﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺎﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺃﺗﻚ ﻛﺸﺮﺕ ﰲ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻬﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻴﻜﻦ ﻣﻌﻚ ﻃﺎﺋﺮﺍﻥ ﺻﻐﲑﺍﻥ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻭﺃﻧﺜﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺍﻷﻓﻌﻰ ﻓﺎﺫﺑﺢ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﺮﻳﻦ ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﺗﺄﺧﺬ ﺑﺮﺃﺳﻴﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺤﺎﺵ ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺳﺮﺏ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺓ ﻓﺘﺪﺧﻞ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻏﺎﺑﺖ ﻋﻨﻚ ﻓﺎﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺓ ﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﰲ‬

‫‪79‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺁﺧﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺣﺎﺭ ﻳﺎﺑﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻮﻑ ﻳﺴﻄﻊ ﻟﻚ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﻭﲢﻤﻰ ﲝﺮﺍﺭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﺗﺪﻧﻮ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺘﺤﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻒ ﺣﺬﺍﺀﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﲣﺎﻃﺒﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻦ ﺍﱃ ﺧﻄﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻟﻪ ﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﺗﺘﺸﺮﻑ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﺣﺎﻓﻈﺔ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﺟﺪﻙ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺭﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﲢﺖ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﳌﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺪﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻨﺎﻝ ﻣﻊ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺷﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﻭﻃﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻚ ﻭﺭﻋﻴﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻀﻰ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻪ‪.‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﺘﻔﻜﺮ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻭﺗﻌﺠﺐ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻋﺰﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻔﺬ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺸﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﺜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻭﻗﻒ‬
‫ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻓﺴﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺗﻌﺮﻓﲏ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ‪ ،‬ﻷﱐ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻚ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻭﻗﱵ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺃﻧﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﻌﺒﻮﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﳋﺎﻟﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺭﺩﺕ ﺃﻥ ﲢﻴﻲ ﺫﻛﺮﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﱄ ﺑﻴﺘﺎ ﻭﺗﻮﻗﺪ ﱄ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﱄ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﲢﻀﺮﻩ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻭﻗﻮﻣﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﺪﻱ ﺃﻧﻠﻚ ‪‬ﺎ ﺷﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺷﺮﻓﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻣﻨﻊ ﻋﻨﻚ ﻭﻋﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﻚ ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺩﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ‬
‫ﺟﺪﻙ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻀﻤﻦ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺪﻟﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﱰﻫﺎ ﺟﺪﻩ ﲢﺖ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﺼﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ؛‬
‫ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﳝﺘﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﻭﺍﺡ ﺍﳌﻮﻛﻠﺔ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻨﺠﻴﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﳑﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻓﻜﻴﻒ ﱄ ﺑﺄﻥ ﺃﺭﺍﻙ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﻭﺃﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺳﺄﻟﻚ ﻋﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻄﺮﺃ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ ﻓﺄﺳﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﻓﻼ ﺗﻘﺮﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻗﺘﻚ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺣﺒﺒﺖ ﺍﻥ ﺗﺮﺍﱐ‬
‫ﻓﺪﺧﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻠﻤﺘﻪ ﻟﻚ ﺑﻜﺬﺍ ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﺍﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﺫﻛﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺑﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﺑﺎﺋﺢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻤﻮﻍ ﺍﻷﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻓﺎﱐ ﺍﲣﻴﻞ ﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺧﱪﻙ ﺑﻜﻞ ﺣﻖ ﻭﺑﺎﻃﻞ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺑﻠﺪﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻭﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺎﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﺍﻻﻓﻌﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﳒﺎ ﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺓ ﺳﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺆﺧﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﺟﺪﻩ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺄﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺍﳌﺮﻛﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﰲ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺟﺎﺭ ﰲ ﻗﻀﻴﺔ ﻗﻀﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﻳﺸﻜﻮ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﺄﺑﺎﻩ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳛﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﺒﻐﻀﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﻮﻣﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻻﻇﻬﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺎﳍﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺯﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺘﺨﻠﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺒﺴﻪ ﻭﺷﺪﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺻﻨﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻋﺮﻑ ﺣﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻇﺎﳌﺔ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳍﺎ ﻣﻨﺼﻒ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻇﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻌﺪﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﻩ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻤﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻭﻩ ﻓﺬﻛﺮ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﳛﻜﻢ‬

‫‪80‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺇﻻ ﺑﻮﺍﺟﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺭﺅﺳﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻇﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺷﻬﺪﻭﺍ ﻟﻠﺮﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺒﺲ ﻭﺣﺒﺲ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻌﺎﻗﺐ ﻭﺗﺮﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻓﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﳛﺒﺲ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻫﺘﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺧﺎﻑ ﺍﻥ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺑﺮﻣﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻭﺍﻫﻠﻬﺎﻻ ﻳﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻟﻪ ﺣﺴﺒﻤﺎ ﺃﺣﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺎﺕ ﻣﻬﻤﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻔﻜﺮﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺍﺻﻄﺒﺢ ﻭﺗﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﻭﺩﺧﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﺧﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻣﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺘﺠﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺧﺎﻃﺒﺘﻪ ﻓﺴﺄﳍﺎ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻤﻼﹰ ﻳﻘﻒ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻢ ﻭﺧﻔﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮﺗﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲏ ﺑﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺭﻛﻦ ﺑﺎﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ‬
‫ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻼﻫﺎ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺍﺳﺪ ﺭﺍﺑﺾ ﻭﺣﺬﺍﺀﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻟﺒﻮﺓ ﺭﺍﺑﻀﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﳍﻤﺎ ﺟﺮﻭ ﺃﺳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮﳘﺎ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺛﻮﺭ ﻭﺑﻘﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﺑﺢ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻋﺠﻼ ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮﳘﺎ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻩ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺧﱰﻳﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﺜﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﺑﺢ ﳍﻤﺎ ﺧﻨﻮﺻﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮﳘﺎ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻊ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﲨﻞ ﻭﺷﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﺑﺢ ﳍﻤﺎ ﺳﺨﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮﳘﺎ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺛﻌﻠﺐ ﻭﺣﺪﺃﺓ ﻭﺍﻧﺜﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﺑﺢ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﺥ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮﳘﺎ ﺑﺮﻳﺸﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﻄﺦ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ‬
‫ﲨﻴﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳛﺮﻕ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺑﲔ ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﺭﻣﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﲢﺖ ﻋﺘﺒﺔ ﺍﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺳﺪﻧﺔ ﻳﻮﻗﺪﻭﻥ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺑﻴﺢ ﻟﻴﻼ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻓﺮﻏﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﺴﻤﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻃﺒﻘﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﺑﹸﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻜﻦ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻻﺳﺪ ﻻﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻭﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﻟﺴﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺗﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳋﺼﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﻖ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﱂ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺪﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﺪﺍﹰ ﻋﻨﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻭﺁﺫﺗﻪ ﻭﺁﳌﺘﻪ ﺣﱴ ﳜﺮﺝ‬
‫ﳋﺼﻤﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮ ﻟﻠﺬﻛﺮ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﺜﻰ ﻟﻼﻧﺜﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﱂ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺣﻖ ﻭﺩﻋﺎﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﻲﺀ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻫﺎ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻮﻡ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﻗﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﱂ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺧﺮﺱ ﻟﺴﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻨﺼﻒ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺆﺧﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺷﺮﻉ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﲤﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﻴﺌﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺻﻼﺣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻫﺘﻤﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺘﻈﻠﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬

‫‪81‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﳚﻮﺯ ﻟﺒﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻇﻠﻢ ﺑﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻣﻊ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﺰﻝ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺎﻗﻴﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺯﺍﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺯﺍﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﺳﲑﺗﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﻋﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﺩﻭﻳﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﺘﺤﺮﻛﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻥ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﺼﺤﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺘﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺳﲑﺗﻪ ﻭﻣﻊ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻩ ﻭﺫﺧﺎﺋﺮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳚﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻭﻭﺿﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﻣﺎﺕ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ ﻭﺭﻋﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﺰﻧﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﱂ ﳛﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺩﻭﻟﺘﻪ ﻭﺭﻋﻴﺘﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﻨﻮﺣﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺒﻜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﳜﺪﻣﻮﻥ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ ﻭﺳﺪﻧﺔ‬
‫ﳛﻔﻈﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺐ ﺣﻔﻈﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻗﺘﻔﻰ ﺳﲑﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺡ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ؛ ﻭﺳﻴﺎﺳﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻻﻧﺼﺎﻑ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﺧﺬ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺟﱮ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺰﻡ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻗﺪﺍﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﻻﻧﻔﺎﻕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺮﺿﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻣﲎ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺴﻦ ﻋﻤﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﻟﺴﻮﺍﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﲪﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻼﻁ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﲑﻯ ﺍﻻﻗﺎﻟﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺃﺧﺼﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﺟﺪﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﳌﺼﺮ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‬
‫ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺃﻫﺒﺘﻪ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻳﻜﺘﺐ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻳﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﰒ ﺗﺮﻓﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺗﻮﺩﻉ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ ﻳﻮﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻮﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻣﻀﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ ﻧﻘﻠﺖ ﺻﺤﺎﺋﻒ‬
‫ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺧﺘﻢ ﲞﺎﲤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻠﺪ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺻﻠﺢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﺑﺮﻩ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺯﺑﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﺋﻊ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﺣﺪﺙ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻄﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﻏﺎﺋﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻮﺭﺓﺍﻣﺮﺍﺓ ﺟﺎﻟﺴﺔ ﰲ ﺣﺠﺮﻫﺎ ﺻﱯ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﺮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻞ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺟﺴﻤﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﻤﺜﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺰﻭﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﲡﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﻥ ﻗﻞ ﻟﺒﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻣﺴﺤﺖ‬
‫ﺛﺪﻳﻬﺎ ﻓﻜﺜﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﻥ ﺃﺣﺒﺖ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻌﻄﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺯﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﺤﺖ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﺑﺪﻫﻦ ﻃﻴﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻓﻌﻠﻲ‬
‫ﻛﺬﺍ ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﻥ ﻗﻠﺖ ﺣﻴﻀﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻓﺮﻗﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺴﺤﺖ ﲢﺖ ﺭﻛﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﺻﺎﺏ ﻭﻟﺪﻫﺎ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﱯ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻓﻴﱪﺃ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﻥ ﻋﺴﺮﺕ ﻭﻻﺩ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺴﺤﺖ ﺭﺃﺳﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﱯ ﺳﻬﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻜﺮ ﻳﺴﻬﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻓﺘﻀﺎﺿﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻭﺿﻌﺖ‬

‫‪82‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺰﺍﻧﻴﺔ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﺭﺗﻌﺪﺕ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻜﻒ ﻋﻦ ﻓﺠﻮﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﳛﺪﺙ ﻟﻴﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﳛﺪﺙ ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺯﺍﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﻭﻋﺒﺪﻭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺑﺮﺍﰊ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻣﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺮﲰﻬﺎ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺩﳍﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻗﺮﺍﺑﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻟﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﺧﱪﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻳﻀﺎ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻜﻮﺱ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺧﻼﻁ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻄﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻻ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﰲ ﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻷﺳﻘﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻠﻞ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻳﱪﺃ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻌﺎﳉﻮﻧﻪ ﻓﻴﻌﻴﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﳝﻮﺕ ﺑﻌﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﺼﺮﻭﻥ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻼﺟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺰﻳﻞ ﺍﻻﻭﺻﺎﺏ‬
‫ﺑﺄﻥ ﻳﻐﺴﻞ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﺄﺯﺍﺀ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻘﻲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺎﺀﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻐﺴﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻟﺼﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺀ ﻓﻴﺰﻭﻝ ﻋﻨﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻻﺑﺮﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻻﻳﺮﻭﻧﻴﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﺍﳍﺮﻣﲔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﲔ ﺍﳌﻨﺴﻮﺑﲔ ﺍﱃ ﺷﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﻨﻜﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﺩﺧﻠﺖ‬
‫ﺑﻠﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺳﺤﺮﻫﻢ ﻭﻣﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺭﺍﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺸﺮﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻧﻪ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﻧﻴﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻧﻘﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﺑﻮ ﻣﻌﺸﺮ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﻑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﻟﻠﻬﺮﻣﲔ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺃﺛﺒﺘﻬﺎﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮ ﻛﻬﻨﺘﻪ ﻭﻣﻨﺠﻤﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺺ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﻧﺰﻭﻝ ﺍﳌﺮﺁﺓ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻭﺍﻧﻘﻼﺏ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻜﺴﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺑﺄﺳﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻩ ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺬﻛﻮﺭ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻳﺮﻭﻳﻪ ﺍﳌﻘﺮﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺁﺧﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻭﺟﺪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺫﺭﺍﺭﻳﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭ ﻣﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻷﻭﺍﺋﻞ‬
‫ﳑﻦ ﳒﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳑﻦ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮﺍﻡ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﺪﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻬﻤﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺑﲎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪﺛﻼﺙ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻫﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﻷﺧﻮﻳﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺳﻬﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ‪ ،‬ﺃﺧﱪ ﻓﻠﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﺭﺃﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﲟﺎﺭﺁﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ؛ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺗﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺼﻴﺐ ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺘﻪ ﺍﻳﺎﻫﻢ ﻣﺴﺄﻟﺔ ﺍﻣﻌﻨﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻟﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺗﱰﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﺘﻌﻢ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻵﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻻﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﺑﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬

‫‪83‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻫﻞ ﻳﻨﺠﺰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺃﻡ ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻻ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎﹰ ؟ ﻓﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻈﻬﺮ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻭﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺣﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﺑﺮﰉ ﻭﺃﻋﻼﻡ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻟﻪ ﻭ ﻷﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﲢﻔﻆ‬
‫ﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﻭﺩﻋﻮﻩ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﰲ ﺳﻘﻮﻓﻬﺎ ﻭﰲ ﺣﻴﻄﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻣﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺪﻋﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﲔ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺳﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻌﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﻌﻠﻢ ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﻭﻣﻨﺎﻓﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺃﺷﻜﺎﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﳍﻨﺪﺳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳑﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻨﺘﻔﻊ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﻣﻔﺴﺮﺍﹰ ﳌﻦ ﻋﺮﻑ ﻛﺘﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻟﻐﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻧﺎﺯﻟﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﺋﻨﺔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻗﻄﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﲑ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﺎﺋﻦ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻧﺰﻝ‬
‫ﻗﻠﺐ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﺑﺄﻭﻝ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ ﻭﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﰲ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺍﻭﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﰲ ﲦﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﻭﲬﺲ ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﺮﻭﺩﻳﻦ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺳﺒﻊ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺳﺘﻊ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺣﻞ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺯﺍﺀ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻴﺰﺍﻥ ﻭﺃﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲬﺲ ﺩﺭﺟﺎﺕ ﻭﺩﻗﺎﺋﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﲢﻘﻘﻮﻩ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻫﻞ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﻓﺔ ﺁﻓﺔ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺗﱰﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺿﺪ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﱰﻝ ﺃﻭﻻ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢﺮﻕ ﺃﻗﻄﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﱴ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻀﻤﺮ؟ ﻓﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﺫ ﻧﺰﻝ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺟﺔ‬
‫ﺍﳋﺎﻣﺴﺔ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻓﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﺘﺼﻠﺔ ﺑﺰﺣﻞ ﺗﺜﻠﻴﺚ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻏﲑ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻮ ﻣﺘﺼﻼﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻧﺐ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺟﺰﺀﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺍﻷﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﲑ ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﰲ ﺍﻷ ﺳﺪ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﲑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺗﻨﻄﺒﻖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﺎﻗﺎﹰ ﱂ ﻳﻌﻬﺪ ﻣﺜﻠﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﲟﺎ ﻇﻬﺮ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻥ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺩﻭﺍﺭ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﺇﻻ ﺗﻠﻒ ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺫﺍ ﺍ ﺳﺘﺘﻢ ﺃﺩﻭﺍﺭﻩ ﲢﻠﻠﺖ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺑﻨﺸﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﻃﺎﺕ ﺍﳍﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺣﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﺳﻮﺍﻥ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ ﻋﻈﺎﻣﺎ ﺗﺴﺎﻕ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺁﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻭﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﲨﻴﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﻭﺍﻷﺑﻴﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳍﻢ ﺻﺤﺎﺋﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻮﺍﺹ ﺍﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﳊﺠﺮ ﻭﰎ ﺍﺣﻜﺎﻣﻪ ﻭﺿﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬

‫‪84‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺿﺮﺑﻮﻩ ﻓﻴﻐﺪﻭ ﺑﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﺑﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻐﻴﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﰒ ﻳﻌﺎﻭﺩﻭﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺼﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺿﻌﺖ ﺁﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻫﺸﻮﺭ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻭﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻭﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳝﺪﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﻃﺔ ﻭﳚﻌﻠﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻗﻀﻴﺐ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﺮﻛﺒﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻼﻃﺔ ﺍﺧﺮﻯ ﻣﺜﻘﻮﺑﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺳﻂ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺪﺧﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﺬﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﻭﻳﺼﺐ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﻃﺔ ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ‪‬ﻨﺪﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﺗﻘﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﺄﻟﻴﻒ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻮﺵ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻐﻮﻫﺎﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎ ﳛﺎﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﺑﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺄﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﰲ ﺁﺯﺍﺝ ﻣﺒﻨﻴﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻝ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺯﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻴﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺣﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﺏ‬
‫ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻓﻤﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻳﻀﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻴﺎﺱ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳊﺎﺋﻂ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺗﱰﻝ ﺍﱃ ﺑﺎﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺯﺝ ﺍﳌﺒﲏ ﻓﺘﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﻠﻮﻧﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻓﻤﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺑﻴﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﺱ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳊﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﰊ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻔﺮ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻮﺻﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﺯﺝ ﻭﺍﳌﺒﲎ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻮﻯ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﺭﺍﻉ ﺍﳌﻠﻜﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ ﺑﺬﺭﺍﻋﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺿﻠﻊ ﻛﻞ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺗﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﺭﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻫﻨﺪﻣﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ‬
‫ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺣﱴ ﲢﺪﺩﺕ ﺃﻋﺎﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺑﺘﺪﺍﺅﻫﻢ ﻟﺒﻨﺎﺋﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺳﻌﺪ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﲣﲑﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻛﺴﺎﻫﺎ ﺩﻳﺒﺎﺟﺎﹰ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺃﺳﻔﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﺎ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺣﻀﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﳐﺰﻧﺎﹰ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﺌﺖ ﺑﺂﻻﺕ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻟﺔ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﻻﺕ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺧﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻻ ﻳﺼﺪﺃ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻄﻮﻯ ﻓﻴﻨﻄﻮﻱ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻜﺴﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﺍﳌﻔﺮﺩﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﳌﺆﻟﻔﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺗﻼﺕ‬
‫ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳑﺎ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﻭﺻﻔﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﻋﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻜﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﺟﺪﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺧﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻘﺮﺏ ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﺣﻔﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﺭﻳﺦ ﻭﺍﳊﻮﺍﺩﺙ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻣﻀﺖ ﻭﺍﻷﻭﻗﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﲢﺪﺙ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻨﺘﻈﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻣﻦ ﻳﻠﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻮﻥ ﺃﺩﻭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ‬
‫ﰲ ﺩﻭﺭﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﺎﹰ ﻭﻗﺘﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻄﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﺑﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﺷﺒﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﰲ ﺗﻮﺍﺑﻴﺖ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻊ ﻛﻞ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻭﺳﲑﺗﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺐ ﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻃﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺗﻌﺒﺪﻭﺍ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻛﻮﻛﺐ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﲎ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻃﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺟﺎﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ‪.‬‬

‫‪85‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﳌﻦ ﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﻟﺴﺘﺔ ﻭﻟﻪ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺍﺳﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ ﳌﻦ ﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﳋﻤﺴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻌﺔ ﳌﻦ ﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﻻﺛﻨﲔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﳌﻦ ﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻭﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﺳﻢ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺟﻬﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺗﺐ ﰲ ﺗﻮﺍﺑﻴﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩﻫﻢ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻔﻬﻢ ﻛﺘﺒﻮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺭﻕ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳊﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻓﻨﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺻﻔﺔ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻌﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻼﺟﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭﺍ ﻋﻠﻯﺎﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻋﻼﺟﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻠﻢ ﰒ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻫﺪﻳﺖ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﻗﺪﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻋﺪﺩﺍﹰ ﻭﻻﻭﺯﻧﺎﹰ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻫﺮﻡ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺧﺎﺯﻧﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺻﻨﻢ ﳎﺰﻉ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺰﻉ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻭﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻴﻨﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻔﺘﻮﺣﺘﺎﻥ ﺑﺮﺍﻗﺘﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺟﺎﻟﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺳﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﳊﺮﺑﺔ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻧﺎﻇﺮ ﲰﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺘﻪ ﺻﻮﺕ‬
‫ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻳﱰﻉ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻭﳜﺘﻠﺲ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻳﻔﺎﺭﻗﻪ ﺍﳍﻢ ﺣﱴ ﳝﻮﺕ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺧﺎﺯﻥ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﳎﺰﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﻗﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﳊﺮﺑﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻄﻮﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺛﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻗﺼﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻄﻮﻗﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻨﻘﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﺘﻪ ﰒ ﻋﺎﺩﺕ ﺇﱃ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺧﺎﺯﻥ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﺻﻐﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﺟﺘﺬﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻳﻠﺼﻖ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﻔﺎﺭﻗﻪ ﺣﱴ ﳝﻮﺕ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺿﻤﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻷﺭﻭﺍﺡ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﺑﺢ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﺑﺎﺋﺢ‬
‫ﻟﺘﻤﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﺏ ﳍﺎ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺑﺎﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻘﻮﺷﺎﹰ ﺗﻔﺴﲑﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﺑﻴﺔ" ﺃﻧﺎ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﰲ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺖ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﲤﻤﺖ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﺳﺖ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺑﻌﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺜﻠﻲ ﻓﻠﻴﻬﺪﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ‬
‫ﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳍﺪﻡ ﺃﻳﺴﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﱐ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺝ ﻓﻠﻴﻜﺴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺑﻌﺪﻱ‬
‫ﺣﺼﲑﺍﹰ!"‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ‪‬ﺪﻣﻬﺎ ﺷﻲﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻛﺴﻮ‪‬ﺎﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺡ ﳑﺎ ﻳﺸﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺘﻌﺬﺭ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻔﺴﺎﺩ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲟﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻼﺡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺷﻴﺪ ﳌﺎ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺃﺣﺐ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻬﺪﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻧﻚ ﻻ ﺗﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﻔﺘﺤﺖ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﳌﻔﺘﻮﺣﺔ ﺑﻨﺎﺭ ﺗﻮﻗﺪ ﻭﺧﻞ ﻳﺮﺵ ﻭﳎﺎﻧﻴﻖ ﻳﺮﻣﻰ ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺣﺪﺍﺩﻳﻦ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻓﺴﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﻔﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﻻﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﳊﺎﺋﻂ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺁ ﺧﺮ ﺍﳊﺎﺋﻂ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺧﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﺐ ﻣﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﺧﻀﺮﺍﺀ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻀﺮﻭﺏ ﻭﺯﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺩﻳﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﻭﻗﻴﺔ‬

‫‪86‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﺍﻗﻴﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺪﺩﻫﺎ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺩﻳﻨﺎﺭ ﻓﻌﺠﺒﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺷﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺗﻮﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳌﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻳﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﺩﺗﻪ ﻭﺣﺴﻨﻪ ﻭﲪﺮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺭﻓﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱄ ﺣﺴﺎﺏ‬
‫ﻣﺎ ﺃﻧﻔﻘﺘﻤﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﻤﺔ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﻩ ﺑﺄﺯﺍﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻮﻩ ﻻ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺘﻬﻢ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﻔﺘﺤﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﻌﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﻋﺠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻨﻔﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺗﺮﻛﻬﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻮﺍﺯﻱ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻋﺠﺒﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻛﺄﻥ ﳍﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻣﱰﻟﺔ ﻻ‬
‫ﻧﻮﺍﺯﻳﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻧﺪﺭﻛﻬﺎﳓﻦ ﻭﻻ ﺃﻣﺜﺎﻟﻨﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺍﳌﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﲝﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﺎ ﲪﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺷﻴﺪ ﳌﺎ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻭﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﱰﻟﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻻﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺴﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺣﺪﺍﺙ‬
‫ﺍﺗﻔﻘﻮﺍ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﱪﺣﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻯﺄﻥ ﻳﺼﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﺘﻬﻰ ﺁﺧﺮﻩ ﺃﻭ ﳝﻮﺗﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻔﻴﻬﻢ ﻟﺸﻬﺮﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻗﻴﺪﻭﺍﻟﺸﻤﻊ ﻭﺍﳊﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺆﻭﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﺎﺟﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﻭﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﻟﻠﺤﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺰﻻﻗﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﻮﺍ‬
‫ﳝﺸﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻭﺍ ﺧﻔﺎﻓﻴﺶ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺒﺎﻥ ﺗﻀﺮﺏ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻬﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺛﻘﺐ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺭﻳﺢ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺭﺩﺓ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻔﺘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﻩ ﻓﺎﻧﻄﻔﺄﺕ ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺟﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﻟﻴﺪﺧﻠﻮﻩ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺔ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻓﺎﺭﻏﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﻣﻮﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺍﻣﻮﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﱰﻟﻮﻩ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻴﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ‪ :‬ﺷﺪﻭﱐ ﺑﺎﳊﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺰﻟﻮﱐ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺻﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻌﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻌﻠﻲ ﺃﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺎﺗﺮﻳﺪﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﺼﺎﺣﺒﻬﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﳊﺒﺎﻝ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ﻓﺄﺑﻄﺄ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ‬
‫ﳝﺴﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳊﺒﺎﻝ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﻄﺒﻖ ﺍﻟﺜﻘﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺬﺑﻪ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﲜﻬﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻗﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﺰﻋﻪ ﻭﲰﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻈﺎﻣﻪ ﺗﺘﻜﺴﺮ ﻭﲰﻌﻮﺍ ﺻﻴﺤﺔ ﻫﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﺳﻘﻄﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻘﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻭﻃﻠﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﺎﻕ‬
‫‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻭﺻﻌﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﺴﻘﻂ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻻﻗﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺻﻌﻮﺩﻫﻢ؛ ﻓﺘﺮﻙ ﻭﻫﻠﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻘﻲ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺻﻴﺤﺔ ﻣﺘﻌﺠﺒﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻴﻨﻤﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﺫ ﺍﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ ﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﺑﻜﻼﻡ ﻛﺎﻫﲏ ﱂ ﻳﻔﻬﻤﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮﻩ ﳍﻢ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺭﺍﻳﺎﺕ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﺑﺄﻧﻪ" ﻫﺬﺍ ﺟﺰﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻠﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻴﺲ ﻟﻪ" ﰒ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻣﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻄﻦ ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ‬

‫‪87‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﱄ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺪﺛﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺣﺪﻳﺚ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻬﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺳﻔﻠﻪ ﻭﻃﺎﻓﻮﻩ ﻓﻌﺮﺽ ﳍﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻛﺎﳌﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﻳﻘﻄﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻳﺴﲑ ﰒ ﻳﻔﻴﺾ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎﹰ ﻛﺎ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﳌﺮﺑﻊ‬
‫ﺣﻴﻄﺎﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﺮﺑﻌﺔ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﺻﻐﺎﺭ ﰲ ‪‬ﺎﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻠﻊ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﰲ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺴﺪﺕ ﺃﺫﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻳﺘﺼﱪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﻮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ‬
‫ﻣﻀﺮﻭﺏ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﺃﻋﻤﺪﺗﻪ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻏﺎﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺗﻘﺎﻥ ﺯﻧﺔ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺩﻳﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺤﺮﻛﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺍﻥ ﳝﺸﻮﺍ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺼﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻛﺎﻟﺼﻔﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺷﻴﺦ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻣﺸﺘﻤﻞ ﴰﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺻﻐﺎﺭ‬
‫ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﻴﺎﻥ ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺣﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺤﺮﻛﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺑﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻣﺴﺪﻭﺩﺍﹰ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺩﻭﻱ ﻫﺎﺋﻞ ﻭﺯﻣﺰﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺘﻌﺮﺿﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﳌﺮﺑﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺩﻳﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ ﺧﻀﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﻋﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﺮﺝ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺻﻮ‪‬ﺕ ﺑﺼﻮﺕ ﻣﻔﺰﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻔﻖ ﲜﻨﺎﺣﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺮﻛﻮﻩ ﻭﻣﻀﻮﺍ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ‬
‫ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻜﺴﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺳﺪﺍﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﺍﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﺘﻘﻤﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻳﺘﻌﻮﺫﻭﻥ ﻭﻳﻘﺮﺃﻭﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﲡﺎﻭﺯﻭﳘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻻﺡ ﳍﻢ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺳﺎﻃﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺗﺒﻌﻮﻩ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﻫﻢ ‪‬ﻮﺓ ﻣﻔﺘﻮﺣﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳍﻮﺓ ﲤﺜﺎﻻﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻣﻌﻬﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﳌﺰﺭﺍﻗﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺒﻮﺍﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﺎﻣﻼﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺍﱄ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﻩ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻌﺪ ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﳍﻮﺓ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻃﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺪﻭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺷﻜﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﳍﻢ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺳﺒﻴﻞ ﻭﻻ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺓ ﻧﻔﻴﺴﺔ ﺑﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﲟﺎﻝ ﺧﻄﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺃﲪﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻃﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻕ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺑﻴﻮﺗﻪ ﺃﺷﻨﺎﻧﺔ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﻫﺎ ﻭﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺎﻓﺘﻘﻮﺍ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺒﻪ ﺇﺫ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻋﺮﻳﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻳﻀﺤﻚ ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ" ﻻﺗﺘﻌﺒﻮﺍ‬
‫ﰲ ﻃﻠﱯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍﺃﻥ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻬﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﺷﺎﻉ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﺳﻌﻰ ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻻﺷﻨﺎﻧﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺯﻧﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻷﺷﻨﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺭﻃﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺻﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻌﺮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﱂ ﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﻟﺒﺎﻃﻞ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺇﻻ ﻟﺸﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻸ ﺍﻷﺷﻨﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﳌﺎﺀ ﰒ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻩ ﻣﻼﺀً ﻣﺜﻞ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﻓﺎﺭﻏﺎﹰ ﻻﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻏﻼﻡ ﻳﻌﺒﺜﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻋﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬ‬

‫‪88‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻳﻀﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﺿﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﻴﻌﺎﹰ ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﲔ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻮﺍ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺷﺮﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺛﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺻﺎﺏ ﻗﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ‬
‫ﺍﲬﻴﻢ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻭﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺩﺧﻼ ﻟﻠﻔﺠﻮﺭ ﻓﺼﺮﻋﺎ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﺍﻻ ﻣﺼﺤﻮﺑﲔ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﻳﻦ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻣﺎﺗﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﻛﻬﻨﺘﻪ ﲞﱪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﶈﺮﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﱵ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺮﺝ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ‬
‫ﻓﺘﺤﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺏ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻨﻴﻪ ﰒ ﻳﻔﻴﺾ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻭﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻸ ﺗﻠﻚ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺗﻨﻄﻖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﻣﻨﺠﻤﻮﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺃﺧﱪﻭﻩ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﻠﺪﻧﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﺁﻓﺔ؟‬
‫ﻓﻨﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﰐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺧﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻳﻘﺘﻞ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﻐﻨﻢ ﻣﺎﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﰒ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻤﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﰒ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﻴﻤﻠﻜﻮﻥ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﰒ ﻣﺎﺫﺍ؟‬
‫ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﻊ ﻧﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﲣﻠﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﺘﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﺰﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﻭﺍﻻﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﳑﻦ ﳜﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻻﲰﺎﻙ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺑﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﺯﺍﻝ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﻄﻐﻄﺔ ﻓﻬﺎﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺒﺎﻋﺪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﲜﻤﻠﻪ ﺫﺍﻙ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺣﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ ﺗﺘﺄﻟﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻣﺬﻋﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻏﻠﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﻴﻨﺎﻩ ﻓﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ‬
‫ﺭﺃﻯ ﲰﺎﻛﺎﹰ ﺁﺧﺮ ﲝﻴﺎﻟﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﹰ ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺷﺪ ﲰﻜﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻠﻪ ﻭﻛﺮ ﺭﺍﺟﻌﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﻄﺎﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻠﻒ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻻﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ ﻓﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﺷﺮﺣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﻜﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﰲ ﺃﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﺍﻟﻐﺎﻟﺒﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺬﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﰊ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻋﺮﻳﺎﻧﺔ ﻣﻜﺸﻮﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺝ ﺣﺴﻨﺎﺀ ﳍﺎ ﺫﺅﺍﺑﺘﺎﻥ ﻓﺈﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺗﺴﺘﻬﻮﻱ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺿﺤﻜﺖ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻠﺒﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﺪﻧﻮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﺴﺘﻬﻮﻳﻪ ﻭﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ ﻭﻳﻬﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻨﺪ ﻏﺮﻭﺏ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺃﻣﺮﺩ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﻋﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺫﺅﺍﺑﺘﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻭﻩ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺮﺍﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺷﻴﺦ ﻧﻮﰐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺮﻃﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﳎﻤﺮ ﻣﻦ ﳎﺎﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺒﺨﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﺑﺮﻭﻧﻴﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﺃﲬﻴﻢ ﻓﻤﻌﺮﻭﻑ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻥ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻋﺮﻳﺎﻥ‪.‬‬

‫‪89‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﺑﺮﺑﺎﲰﲑﺍ ﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺷﻴﺦ ﺃﺩﻡ ﻃﻮﺍﻝ ﺃﺷﻴﺐ ﺻﻐﲑ ﺍﻟﻠﺤﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﻗﻔﻂ ﻓﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﲢﻤﻞ ﺻﺒﻴﺎﹰ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﺻﻐﲑﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﺩﻧﻮﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺃﺳﺪ ﻭﻟﻪ ﻗﺮﻧﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﺑﻮﺻﲑ ﻓﻬﻮ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺷﻴﺦ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺯﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻫﺒﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﳛﻤﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﻋﺪﻧﺎ ﻓﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﺍﻉ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻛﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻋﺼﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺩﻫﺸﻮﺭ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﻮﻥ ﻳﺮﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺍﳛﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻠﻬﺎ ﻗﺮﺍﺑﲔ ﻭﲞﻮﺭ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺆﻟﻒ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺳﻮﺭﻳﺪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﻪ ﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳝﻮﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻭﺻﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ‬
‫ﻫﻮﺟﻴﻒ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﲟﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﳚﻌﻠﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻋﺪﻩ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﻳﻐﺸﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺑﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻋﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺎﺧﺮ ﺍﳌﺘﺎﻉ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ ﻭﺍﻵﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺘﺜﻞ ﻫﻮﺟﻴﺖ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻮﱃ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺃﺑﻨﻪ ﻫﻮﺟﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺳﲑﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻗﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺃﻓﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﺄﺣﺒﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺩﻫﺸﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻏﺮﺿﻪ ﲨﻊ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻴﻤﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺇﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ‪‬ﻴﺄ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺼﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺟﻮﺍﺭﻳﻪ ﻓﻨﻔﺎﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﺒﻨﻴﺖ ﳍﺎ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻢ ﻭﻳﺰﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﲰﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺼﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻦ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﺴﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺷﺞ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻓﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﻄﻊ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺮﻕ ﺳﺎﺭﻕ ﻣﺎﻻﹰ ﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻓﻤﻠﻚ ﺭﻗﻪ ﻟﻠﺬﻱ ﺳﺮﻕ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺗﺴﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻣﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺬﺍﺑﺎ ﺃﻟﻴﻤﺎ ﻓﺂﺫﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻔﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻏﺘﺼﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺮﺝ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻗﺼﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺑﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﻓﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺠﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﺒﺎﺀﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻮﻑ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭﲤﺨﺮﻕ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺒﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻏﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺑﺎﺡ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻏﺼﺐ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻮ ﻳﻔﺘﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﺯﻭﺍﺣﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻃﺎﻑ ﺑﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺑﻐﻀﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻛﺮﻫﻮﺍ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺭﻳﻦ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺮﻧﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ‬
‫ﺇﺩﺭﻳﺲ ﺑﻦ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳏﺎﺭﺑﺔ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﺎﳌﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺷﺠﻊ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻫﻠﻚ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺑﻞ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﺛﻼﺛﺎ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺟﺪﺍﺩﻩ ﰲ ﺣﻮﺽ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ‬

‫‪90‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻣﺼﻔﺢ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺫﺧﺎﺋﺮﻩ ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﻟﻪ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﳌﺎﹰ ﳏﻨﻜﺎﹰ ﻓﺨﺎﻟﻒ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﰲ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺪﻝ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺭﺩ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻼﰐ‬
‫ﻏﺼﺒﻬﻦ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺯﻭﺍﺟﻬﻦ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﲬﺴﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺮﺿﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺒﻬﺎ ﺃﻃﻴﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺗﺼﻔﺮ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﳌﻄﺮﺑﺔ ﻻ ﺗﻔﺘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻀﺖ ﺳﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺻﺎﺡ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ ﻓﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﺼﻴﺎﺣﻪ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺳﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﲰﻌﻪ ﻋﺪﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﻟﻄﺨﻪ ﺑﻠﻄﻮﺧﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻏﺮﺑﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﺷﺘﻌﻠﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻓﻴﻀﻲﺀ ﳍﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﺸﺒﻬﺎﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻻ ﺗﻄﻔﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺍﻷﻣﻄﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﻗﻞ‬
‫ﺿﻮﺅﻫﺎ ﻟﻨﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻫﺪﻯ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺒﺎﺑﻞ ﻣﺪﻫﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻗﺪﺭ ﲬﺴﺔ ﺃﺷﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﻬﺪﺍﻩ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻟﻴﺠﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﺕ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﺼﺒﻮﻏﺎﹰ‬
‫ﺑﻠﻄﻮﺥ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﳑﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻐﺮﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﰒ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻟﻴﻼﹰ ﺣﱴ ﳛﺎﺫﻱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﺢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺃﻓﺮﻭﺳﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﺪ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻓﻨﻜﺢ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻳﺒﺘﻐﻲ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻮﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻋﻘﻤﺖ ﺃﺭﺣﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻬﺎﺋﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻗﻊ ﺍﳌﻮﺕ ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻼﻙ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻷُﺳﺪ ﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻛﺎﺩﺕ ﺍﻥ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﺎﻧﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻀﺮﺓ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻭﺗﻌﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻓﻌﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﻣﻜﺮﻭﻫﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﳍﺎ ﺃﺧﺎﺩﻳﺪ ﻭﲤﻸ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﺟﻠﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﺧﻦ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲡﺬﺏ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻘﻮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺮﻗﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﺗﻠﻔﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﺪ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﻌﺖ ﺍﻷﻣﻄﺎﺭ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻞ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﺄﺟﺪﺑﻮﺍ ﻭﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻭﻉ ﺑﺎﳊﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﺍﳊﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺿﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﺪﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺑﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺬﻫﺐ ﰒ ﺗﻌﻮﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ‪‬ﻢ ﺳﺎﺣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺤﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﻗﺪ ﻏﺼﺐ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﻗﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﻗﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﰲ‬

‫‪91‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻃﻠﺴﻢ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻳﻘﻮﻱ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻳﻔﺴﺪﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﺔ ﺩﺧﻞ ﲞﺖ ﻧﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺭﺳﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳑﺘﻨﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻓﺴﺪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﺳﻠﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻵﻓﺎﺕ ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪ ﻃﻠﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺳﻴﺢ ﻓﻬﺎﺟﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻣﻨﻌﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺬﺑﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﺬﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻓﻄﻨﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬﻩ ﻻﻣﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻀﺮﺓ ﺑﻘﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻬﺮﻩ ﻭﻧﻔﺦ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻇﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺼﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺮﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻤﻴﺬ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﱃ ﻭﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﻷﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻤﻴﺬ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﳊﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻧﻔﺬ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ ﺟﻴﺸﺎﹰ ﻟﻴﺎﺗﻮﻩ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﻣﻘﺒﻠﲔ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺩﺧﻦ‬
‫ﺑﺪﺧﻨﺔ ﺃﻏﺸﺖ ﺃﺑﺼﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﻌﺖ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺟﺔ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹶ ﻣﻀﺮﻣﺔ ﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺎﳍﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﺧﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﺣﻀﺎﺭ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺎﻫﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﺍ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺎﻟﻔﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻭﻫﻢ‬
‫ﲟﻜﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺒﻐﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﻐﻮﺍﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﻠﺐ ﻣﱰﻟﺘﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﳝﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻔﻚ ﺩﻣﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻡ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﺎﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﺗﻌﻬﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﻀﻮﻥ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻬﺪﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﺧﱪﻫﻢ ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩﻭﻧﻘﻀﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻠﻌﻬﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺇﻥ ﱂ ﲢﻀﺮﻭﻩ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﲨﻴﻌﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬ ﺃﻭﻻﺩﻫﻢ ﻭﻧﺴﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﺭﻫﺎﺋﻦ‬
‫ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﻧﻈﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺗﻜﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻧﻜﻢ ﺗﻌﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺷﺪﺓ ﺳﺤﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻃﺎﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻧﻘﺾ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﺪﻯ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻏﺼﺒﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﳔﻠﺺ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﲨﻌﻮﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺄﺫﻧﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺎﺏ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﺪﺍﺭﺍﺗﻪ ﻭﺗﻮﺑﻴﺨﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻓﻖ ﺑﻪ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻳﺄﺗﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﺄﻣﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻧﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺠﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﻬﺪ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﺟﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻀﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻟﻄﻔﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻧﺎ ﻣﺎ ﳒﻬﻞ ﺣﻘﻚ ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ ﻭﺇﻧﺎ ﺑﻘﺪﺭﻙ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﻋﻤﻠﻚ ﻋﺎﺭﻓﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﰲ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺟﻨﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﻗﺪﺭﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺿﺮﺍﺭ ﺑﺄﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﻙ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺟﺐ ﺃﻥ ‪‬ﻠﻚ ﻋﺎﳌﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﳉﻨﺎﻳﺔ ﺟﻨﺎﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﳚﺐ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻨﺎ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻬﺪﻩ ﻻﺯﻡ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻭﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﺑﻚ ﻭﺑﺴﻮﺍﻙ ﻋﻘﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﺴﻨﺎ ﻧﺄﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻤﻚ ﻭﺗﺼﲑ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻗﺒﺢ ﻋﻤﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﺬﻣﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﲤﻀﻲ ﻏﲑ ﻣﻔﻘﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﺍﻟﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﺃﺟﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺒﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻜﺘﺐ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﺪﺩ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻬﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪92‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻃﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺣﺴﻦ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﺩﺕ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﺄﻛﺮﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺭﺩﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻯ ﰲ ﺩﻳﻨﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻼﻣﺲ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻻﻣﺴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻃﺎﻋﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﻳﻌﻈﻤﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻘﻮﻗﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺠﺒﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﻪ ﻭﺻﻠﺢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺅﺱ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻭﻻ ﺃﺥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺫﺧﺎﺋﺮﻩ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮﻩ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﺋﻊ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲤﻠﻴﻚ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﺭﻣﺎﻓﻴﻮﺱ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺃﻣﺮﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ‪ :‬ﺇﱐ ﺃﺭﻯ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻮﻟﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﻣﺴﺎﺭﻋﺔ ﺇﻟﻴﻜﻢ ﻭﻏﺎﻟﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺪﺍﻭﺗﻜﻢ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﻣﺎﻧﻊ‬
‫ﺑﻠﺪﻛﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺣﺎﻡ ﺩﻳﺎﺭﻛﻢ ﻭﺩﻣﺎﺀﻛﻢ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻄﺮﻓﺖ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻴﻜﻢ ﻭﻳﻮﺷﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﲑ ﺇﻟﻴﻜﻢ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﻣﻨﻌﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪﻭﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻼﺩﻫﻢ ﻭﲣﻮﻳﻠﻜﻢ ﺇﻳﺎﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺋﻜﻢ ﺑﺎﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﳍﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻓﺸﻜﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﺩﻋﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻮﻓﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻌﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪ :‬ﳓﻦ ﳔﺮﺝ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻧﺒﻠﻐﻪ ﳏﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﳔﺪﻡ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺒﺬﻝ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻨﺎ ﺩﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺸﺮﻉ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺎﺭﺏ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍ؟ﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻜﺎﻫﻢ ﻧﻜﺎﻳﺔ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﻏﺎﳕﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻠﻒ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺟﻴﺸﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺄﻟﻔﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻣﻐﻠﻮﺑﲔ ﻓﻐﺎﻇﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻐﲑ ﺍﻷﻫﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺗﺒﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻧﻔﺬ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﻢ ﻟﻪ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﺑﻦ ﻣﻴﺴﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻻ ﻳﻄﺎﻗﻮﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﺳﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﺇﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ ﺑﻔﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺩﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻴﻘﻲ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻫﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻻﻩ ﳌﺎ ﺭﺟﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﻭﲢﺼﻦ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻭﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﺧﱪﻩ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﻔﺬ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺟﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﻭﻧﻔﺎﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻛﺮ ﺭﺍﺟﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ‬
‫ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﻛﺜﲑ ﺃﺳﺎﺭﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻨﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﺀﻭﺱ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻠﺢ ﻟﻠﻘﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﻣﺮﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺸﺮ‬
‫ﲟﻨﺸﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻣﻪ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻪ ﺣﻠﻼ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﻣﺔ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺎﻑ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻓﻀﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ‬
‫ﺃﻧﺰﻟﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻗﺼﻮﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﺰﻳﺰﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﺸﻘﺖ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺗﺪﻋﻮﻩ ﺍﱃ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬

‫‪93‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻃﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﻻﻃﻔﺘﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺃﻧﺴﺖ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻛﺮﺕ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﺎ ﲡﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺒﺒﻪ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﻨﺎﻋﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻀﻤﻨﺖ ﳍﺎ ﺑﻠﻮﻍ ﳏﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺤﺮﺗﻪ ﺑﺪﺧﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻠﺘﻪ ﻟﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻫﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺩﻫﺎ ﻭﺳﻬﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺻﻌﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺳﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﺟﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ ﻭﲤﻜﻦ ﺣﺐ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺍﻡ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﲤﺎﺩﻯ ﺍﻻﻧﺲ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺫﺍﻛﺮﺗﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻻﺗﺄﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺧﱪﳘﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﻠﻜﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﻧﺄﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﺸﺪﺓ ﺣﺒﻪ ﳍﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﺤﺴﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺪﻋﻰ ﺑﺴﻢ ﻓﺪﻓﻌﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺳﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺷﺮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﻟﻮﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺒﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺝ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻨﺎﺯﻋﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﲟﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺪﺓ ﻭﺍﳉﺮﺃﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻋﻼ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﲡﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻢ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺮﻑ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﺜﻞ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺐ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﺑﻦ ﳝﺤﻮﻳﻞ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ ﻳﺸﲑ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻘﺘﻞ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻵﻓﺎﻕ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻠﻢ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻫﻞ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ ﺁﳍﺔ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ؟ ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻗﺼﺔ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺗﻐﻴﲑ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺇﳍﺎﹰ ﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻓﻜﻞ ﺃﻧﻜﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺃﺧﺬ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻛﺘﺐ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻳﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻘﺘﻞ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻭﺣﺮﻗﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺷﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﺯﺭﺍﺋﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻋﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻧﻮﺡ ﺣﻘﺎﹰ ﺭﻛﺒﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻓﻘﺒﻞ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺑﻘﺘﻞ‬
‫ﻧﻮﺡ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻛﺜﺮﺗﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﲣﺬﻭﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺍﺩﻳﺐ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺻﻔﺤﻮﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﻭﺣﺒﺴﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺘﺪ ﺑﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﲣﺬ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺭﺃﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﺪﺓ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻷﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﺃﻗﺼﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻭﺑﺎﻋﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻥ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻣﺴﻮﺱ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻧﻘﻠﺒﺖ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻻﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻧﻘﻠﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﻧﺎﺳﺎ؟ً ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻳﱰﻟﻮﻥ ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻘﺎﻣﻊ‬
‫ﻳﻀﺮﺑﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺗﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺄﺣﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ‪ :‬ﻷﻱ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺗﻔﻌﻠﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻻﺗﺮﲪﻮ‪‬ﻢ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻻ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﻛﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﺈﳍﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﻠﻘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﳍﻢ ﺧﻼﺹ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻧﻌﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﳋﻼﺹ ﻓﻌﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺼﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻣﺮﻋﻮﺑﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻡ ﺣﲑﺍﻧﺎ ﻻﻳﺪﺭﻱ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺍﻥ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻭﺍﻧﺜﻰ ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬ ﻓﺄﲨﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ‬

‫‪94‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﺤﻖ ﺑﻨﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻧﺎﻡ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻧﻮﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺭﻭﺿﺔﺧﻀﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻃﻴﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ ﻳﻔﻮﺡ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺭﻳﺎﺡ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺴﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫ ﺗﻜﻠﻢ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺳﲑﻭﺍ ﺑﻨﺎ ﻟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﻧﻨﺠﻮ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻫﻢ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻣﺮﻋﻮﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﺧﱪ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬﻩ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻜﺘﻤﻬﻢ ﺇﻳﺎﻩ ﰒ ﻧﻈﺮ ﰲ ﲣﻔﻴﻒ ﺍﺛﻘﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺑﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺐ ﺑﻴﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺘﺘﺮﺍﹰ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﳑﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻩ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻔﺬﱐ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﻷﺭﻯ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻧﺎﻇﺮﻩ ﻭﺃﺟﺎﺩﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻈﻬﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺗﺒﲔ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻓﻠﻴﻔﻌﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺴﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﻫﻼﻛﻪ ﻭﺩﻓﻌﻪ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻳﺪﻋﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻋﺠﺐ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﳋﺮﻭﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻣﻌﻪ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬﻩ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ ﻓﻘﺼﺪ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻩ ﲟﺎ ﻗﺼﺪﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺸﺮﺡ ﻟﻪ ﺩﻳﻨﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺂﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺼﺪ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺭﻣﺸﻴﻞ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺪﻓﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻭﻻ ﺭﺁﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ" ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﺑﻪ ﺧﲑﺍﹰ ﱂ ﻳﺼﺮﻑ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﳜﺪﻣﻪ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺗﻼﻣﻴﺬﻩ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺭﻛﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﺘﻤﻜﻨﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺿﻼﻟﻪ ﻭﻇﻠﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﺪﻣﻨﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳍﻮﻩ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻒ ﺑﺎﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻀﺎﻗﺖ ﺃﺭﺿﻬﻢ ‪‬ﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻈﻠﻢ ﻭﺍﳍﺮﺝ ﻭﻓﺴﺪﺕ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻭﻉ ﻭﺍﺟﺪﺑﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻇﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺪﺕ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ ﻭﻃﺒﻘﺖ ﺃﺑﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺎﺀﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻄﺮ ﰲ ﺍﺭﺑﻊ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﺳﻜﺮﺍﻧﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﻢ ﺇﻻ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻈﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺛﺐ ﻣﺒﺎﺩﺭﺍﹰ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻓﺘﺨﻠﺨﻠﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﻖ‬
‫ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﻓﺨﺎﻧﺘﻪ ﺭﺟﻼﻩ ﻭﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ؛ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳜﻮﺭ ﻛﻤﺎ ﳜﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﻪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﺳﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺑﻐﻤﻬﺎ ﻭﳊﻖ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻠﻰٍ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺑﻴﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﺮﻩ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺳﻠﻤﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻻ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ‬
‫ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻻﺗﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﺧﺘﻼﻑ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﳉﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬‬

‫ﺫﻜﺭ ﻤﻠﻭﻙ ﻤﺼﺭ ﺒﻌﺩ ﺍﻟﻁﻭﻓﺎﻥ‬

‫‪95‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺃﲨﻊ ﺍﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻴﺼﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺑﺪﻋﻮﺓ ﺳﺒﻘﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﺳﺄﻝ ﻧﻮﺣﺎﹰ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﻄﻪ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻳﺎﻧﱯ ﺍﷲ ﺇﻧﲏ ﺗﺮﻛﺖ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻲ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻱ ﻓﺎﺟﻌﻞ ﱄ ﺭﻓﻘﺔ ﺃﺫﻛﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﰐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﻭﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻴﺼﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻨﺖ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪﺍﹰ ﻓﺴﻤﺎﻩ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﺟﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻗﺴﻤﺔﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﲔ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ‪ :‬ﺍﺑﻌﺚ ﻣﻌﻲ ﻳﺎﻧﱯ ﺍﷲ ﺍﺑﲏ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺃﻣﻀﻲ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ ﻭﺃﻇﻬﺮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻗﻔﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻠﻮﻣﻪ ﻭﺃﻓﻬﻤﻪ ﺭﻣﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻌﺜﻪ ﻣﻊ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻏﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﺮﺍﻫﻘﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﲎ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺮﺷﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻏﺼﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺘﺮﻩ ﲝﺸﻴﺶ ﰒ ﺑﲎ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‬
‫ﺑﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﺩﺭﻣﺎﻥ ﺃﻱ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺯﺭﻋﻮﺍ ﻭﻏﺮﺳﻮﺍ ﺍﻻﺷﺠﺎﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﲔ ﺩﺭﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺯﺭﻭﻉ ﻭﺃﺟﻨﺔ ﻭﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺟﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻄﻌﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺎﱂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﺭﻏﺪ ﻋﻴﺶ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﻜﺢ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻨﺘﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﺪﺍ ﻓﺴﻤﺎﻩ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻓﻮﻟﺪﺕ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﻧﻔﺮ‪ :‬ﻳﻘﻄﻮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﴰﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﰊ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺜﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﻋﻤﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺑﻮﺭﻙ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﺑﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻨﻮﺍ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﲰﻮﻫﺎ ﻧﺎﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻠﻐﺘﻬﻢ ﻣﻌﻨﺎﻫﺎ‬
‫ﺛﻼﺛﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺸﻒ ﻓﻴﻠﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﳌﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﻋﻦ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻗﺮﺍﺀﺓ ﺧﻂ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﰊ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﺽ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﲑﻭﺯﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺻﻒ ﳍﻢ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺭﺟﻞ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﺴﻨﻄﺎﺱ ﺛﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻤﻲ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﳌﻘﻄﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻬﻢ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﻭﺗﻔﺴﺪ ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﺭﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺟﻬﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﻼﺳﻢ ﻓﻐﺎﺑﺖ ﻭﱂ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﺪﻧﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺭﻗﻮﺩﻩ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ‬
‫ﻣﺬﻫﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻮﺍ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﻣﻌﻤﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻼﻁ ﺷﱴ ﻗﻄﺮﻫﺎ ﲬﺴﺔ ﺃﺷﺒﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲬﺴﻤﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ ﻗﺎﺻﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺑﺄﺫﺍﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺁﺓ ﻋﻤﻼ ﻓﺄﻟﻘﺖ ﺷﻌﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺻﺪ ﻭﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﲨﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻬﺪﻣﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫‪96‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﺇﳕﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺗﺸﺒﻴﻬﺎ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺯﺍﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺟﺔ ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ ﻋﻬﺪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺴﻢ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﺼﺮﺑﲔ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻔﻂ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺳﻮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻻﴰﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺳﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺑﺮﻳﺖ ﺍﳊﻮﻑ ﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺼﺎﰊ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﺍﱃ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺑﺮﻗﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻓﺮﻳﻘﻴﺔ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺍﻻﻓﺎﺭﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲏ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﻳﻔﺮﺷﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﻓﻨﻮﻩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻳﺪﻓﻨﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺰﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﺎﻧﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻮﺍﺩﺙ‪ .‬ﻓﺤﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻃﻮﻻﹰ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﲬﺴﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ ﻣﺼﻔﺤﺎﹰ ﺑﺼﻔﺎﺋﺢ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻟﻠﻤﺠﻠﺲ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ‬
‫ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺗﺎﺝ ﻣﺮﺻﻊ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﺟﺎﻟﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺳﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻗﺪﺍﻣﻪ ﺁﻧﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﺸﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺻﺪﺭ ﻛﻞ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﺎﻧﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﻠﺴﻮﺍ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ "‬
‫ﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻦ ﺑﻴﺼﺮ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﺒﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻀﺖ ﻻﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻌﺒﺪ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺣﻴﺚ ﻫﻮ ﻻ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻫﺮﻡ ﻭﻻﺳﻘﻢ ﻭﻻﺣﺰﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﻭﻣﺎﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺏ ﻭﺣﺼﻨﻪ ﺑﺎﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﲟﺎ ﻻﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺇﻻ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺪﻭﺩﻩ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻳﺄﰐ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻳﺪﻳﻦ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺆﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳌﺒﻌﻮﺙ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‪ ،‬ﺍﻟﺪﺍﻋﻲ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻻﳝﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻋﻮﺍﻗﺐ ﺍﻷﺯﻣﺎﻥ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻗﻄﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺍﳌﺨﺮﻭﻁ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻒ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻒ ﺑﺮﻧﻴﺔ‬
‫ﺫﻫﺐ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺩﺭﺍﻳﻖ ﲰﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﻒ ﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﺍﻹﳍﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﺎﺋﻚ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻜﺪﺳﺔ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻘﻔﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﺣﱴ ﺳﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺟﺒﻠﲔ ﻣﺘﻘﺎﺑﻠﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﻻ ﲣﻔﻰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﱄ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺑﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺛﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻖ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﳊﻖ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺒﻠﺔ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻠﺴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻪ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﻢ ﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻨﻮﻩ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺳﺮﺏ ﲢﺖ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻔﺢ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻓﺬ ﻟﻠﺮﻳﺢ ﻓﻬﻲ ﺗﺘﺨﺮﻕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺑﺪﻭﻱ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻫﺎﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺮﻭﺱ ﳓﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻣﻄﻠﻴﺔ ﺑﺄﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺗﻀﻲﺀ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ ﻛﺄ‪‬ﺎ ﺳﺮﺝ ﻻ ﺗﻄﻔﺄ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻄﺨﻮﺍ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﻣﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﳌﻮﻣﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺟﺮﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺸﻔﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﰲ ﺟﺮﻧﻪ ﲢﺖ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺮﻣﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺓ ﻣﻌﻠﻘﺔ ﺗﻨﲑ ﻛﺎﻟﺴﺮﺍﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻳﻦ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺃﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﲢﺖ‬

‫‪97‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳉﺮﻥ ﺗﻮﺍﺑﻴﺖ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺫﻫﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻮﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺪﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻮﱃ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻫﺸﻮﺭ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻟﻴﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺯﺭﻧﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻣﺎﱂ ﻳﺜﺮﻩ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳚﺪ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻻﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﺭﺡ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺨﻠﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻗﻔﻂ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻫﻨﺎﻟﻚ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ‬
‫ﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻴﻞ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ ﺃﺛﺎﺭ ﺍﺑﻠﻴﺲ ﻭﺃﻋﻮﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﻏﺮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻳﻨﻮﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﳝﺎ ﺑﲎ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻔﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻢ ﻛﺎﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﺤﻞ‬
‫ﻭﻻ ﻳﺬﻭﺏ ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﻓﻠﻄﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻴﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻧﺼﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﲑ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﺃﻥ ﻳﱪﺡ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻳﺆﺧﺬ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﻭﺍﻷﺳﺪ ﻭﺍﳊﻴﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻔﺮ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺋﺮ ﺻﻔﲑﺍﹰ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺮﺟﻊ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﻤﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻻ ﻳﻌﱪ ﻏﺮﻳﺐ ﺍﻻ ﺃﻟﻘﻰ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻨﺎﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﻓﻼ ﻳﱪﺡ ﻧﺎﺋﻤﺎﹰ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻨﻔﺨﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻧﺎﺋﻤﺎﹰ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻣﻠﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ‬
‫ﻛﺒﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﻣﻲ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻳﻨﻪ ﻏﺮﻳﺐ ﻭﻗﻒ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻭﱂ ﻳﱪﺡ ﺣﱴ ﳚﻴﺌﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻬﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﺍﻻﺭﺑﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻋﻠﻯﺤﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﲢﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﻫﺮﺓ ﺧﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﻗﻊ‬
‫ﻋﲔ ﺍﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺰﺍﻝ ﻧﺎﺋﻤﺎﹰ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻋﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻠﻌﻪ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺍﻻﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻠﻒ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ ﻣﺪﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ‬

‫‪98‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﳝﻨﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻧﻮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻋﻘﺪﺍﹰ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻭﻟﺌﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﺼﻞ ﺣﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﺎﺧﺬ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺣﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﻣﺸﻘﺔﻭﻻﺿﺮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﳕﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﻭﻗﺖ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ‬
‫ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺳﺮﺏ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺯﺝ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﻴﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ ﰲ ﺳﻌﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺣﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺩﻭﺭﻫﺎ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻣﻨﻘﻮﺭﺓ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺳﻘﻮﻓﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺏ ﻟﻠﺮﻳﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻠﻄﺖ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺏ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺎﳌﺮﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺼﻔﺤﺎﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﺒﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ‬
‫ﺳﻘﻔﻪ ﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺭﻛﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻛﺎﻟﱪﻕ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﱪﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﻣﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺣﻮﺍﺷﻲ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻭﻓﺮﺵ ﺣﺮﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻟﻄﺦ ﺑﺎﻷﺩﻭﻳﺔ‬
‫ﺍ‪‬ﻔﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺪﻟﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻣﻜﺸﻮﻑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺗﺎﺝ ﻣﻜﻠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻣﺴﺒﻮﻙ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﰲ ﺃﻟﻮﺍ‪‬ﻦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻦ ﻛﺎﳌﺮﺍﻭﺡ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ ﺳﻴﻒ ﻓﺎﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﺨﺮ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﺧﺎﺋﺮ ﻭﺳﺒﺎﺋﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺍﱐ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﳊﺎﻭﻳﺔ ﳉﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺩﻳﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻧﺎﺷﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺣﲔ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ ﻣﺎﻧﻌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺪﺧﻞ ﺃﺯﺝ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﲔ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻣﺸﻮﻫﺘﲔ‪ ،‬ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻤﺎ ﺳﻴﻔﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻟﱪﻕ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻤﺎ ﺑﻼﻃﺔ ﲢﺘﻬﺎ ﻟﻮﺍﻟﺐ ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻃﺌﻬﺎ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻧﻮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﻃﺄﻫﺎ ﺿﺮﺑﺎﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺴﻴﻔﻬﻤﺎ ﻓﻘﺘﻼﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺯﺝ ﻛﻮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻄﻮﺥ ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﺗﺴﺮﺝ ﻭﺗﻀﻲﺀ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺪﺕ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻷﺯﺝ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﺎﻃﲔ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺮﺻﻌﺔ ﻭﺭﺻﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﻘﻒ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﻃﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺩﻣﻮﺍ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻷﺯﺝ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﰲ ﺣﺠﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ " ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﳌﻬﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ‬
‫ﺫﻱ ﺍﻻﻳﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺨﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﻠﺒﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﺣﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﲜﺴﺪﻩ ﻭﺑﻘﻲ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻮﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﲝﻴﻠﺔ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺪﺩ ﻭﺩﻭﺭﺍﺕ ﲤﻀﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﺗﻜﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺠﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻣﻪ‬
‫ﺻﺎﰊ ﻭﺃﺑﺮﻳﺖ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﱪﻫﻢ ﺳﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﺬﻟﻚ ﺃﺫﻋﻨﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪99‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻱ ﻓﺒﻌﺜﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻨﺎﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻫﻴﻜﻼﹰ ﻟﻠﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﺪﻝ ﺟﻨﱯ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻔﻴﺾ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﻊ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﲑ ﻣﻐﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﻟﻴﻨﻈﺮ ﻣﺎﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻭﺍﺳﻌﺔ ﻣﺘﺨﺮﻗﺔ ﺑﺎﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺸﺐ ﻓﺒﲎ ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻨﺎﺋﺮ ﻭﻣﺘﱰﻫﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﺮﻭﺍ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻭﺑﻨﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﺃﺭﺿﺎﹰ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻭﺧﺎﻟﻄﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﻭﻧﻜﺢ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﲢﺎﺳﺪﻭﺍ ﻭﺗﺒﺎﻏﻮﺍ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﺮﻭﺏ ﺍﻓﻨﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﺧﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺑﺎﺩ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺍﻻ ﺑﻘﻴﺔ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﺗﺴﻤﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺎﺕ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﺎﻗﺒﺔ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻛﻮﺓ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺩﺧﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﺘﻒ ﰲ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺷﱴ ﰲ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺳﻨﺘﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﺎﻥ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﳋﺼﺐ ﻭﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ ﻭﺻﻼﺡ ﺍﻟﻨﺒﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﺪﺏ ﻭﻗﻠﺔ ﺍﳋﲑﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺃﲪﺮ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﻭ ﺍﳊﺮﻭﺏ ﻭﻗﺼﺪ ﺍﻷﻋﺪﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺍﻷﻣﻄﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻴﻮﻝ ﻭﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺁﻓﺎﺕ ﲢﺪﺙ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﳜﺮﺝ ﳐﺘﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺩﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻈﺎﱂ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻭﺇﳘﺎﻝ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﺗﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﺏ؛ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﰒ ﻫﺪﻣﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻮﺵ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪﺕ‬
‫ﺯﺭﻋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺧﻨﺎﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﱂ‬
‫ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻊ ﺍﳊﺮﻛﺔ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻟﱪﺍﺡ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺆﺧﺬ ﻗﺒﻀﺎﹰ ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺗﺴﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﳊﻮﻡ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﻮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﻭﺭﻳﻦ ﳌﺼﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﻝ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻓﻘﻠﻌﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺣﺘﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﻀﻌﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻓﻴﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﻌﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﻄﻞ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻨﺘﻔﻊ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻵ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻄﺎﻟﻊ‬
‫ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭﻧﻪ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺰﺍﻝ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻐﲑ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﻳﻨﻘﻞ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻏﺮﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻧﻘﺮ ﻋﲔ ﺻﱯ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻻﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻓﻘﻠﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻏﺮﺍﺏ ﰲ ﻣﻨﻘﺎﺭﻩ ﺣﻴﺔ ﺑﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻓﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻧﺎﺷﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻇﻬﺮﻩ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﻌﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﺣﱴ ﳝﱳ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺆﺧﺬﻥ ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻠﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻭﺍﻧﺘﻔﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺻﺎﺭ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺩﺍﺀ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺩﻭﺍﺀ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺒﺦ ﻟﻪ ﻏﺮﺍﺏ ﻓﻴﺄﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪100‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﳊﻤﻪ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﺮﻗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﻠﺐ ﻟﻪ ﻏﺮﺍﺏ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﺩﻩ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﻪ ﺑﻐﺮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺑﻄﺄ ﻭﺯﺍﺩﺕ ﻋﻠﺘﻪ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﺎﻅ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﱰﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻓﱰﻋﺖ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻓﺄﺧﺬ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﺎﰿ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﻌﺪ ﺭﺳﻮﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﺣﱴ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﺣﱴ ﺭﲟﺎ ﻃﻤﺖ ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻛﺎﻟﻘﻔﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﺤﺎﺓ ﻭﻧﻘﺶ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺒﻬﺘﻪ ﻭﺻﺪﺭﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺫﺭﺍﻋﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﺎﻗﻴﻪ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻓﺎﻧﻜﺸﻔﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﻭﺯﺣﻔﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻵﻛﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻳﻨﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺭ ﲝﻴﺚ ﻻ ﻳﺆﺫﻳﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻀﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﻣﺪﺓ ﰒ ﺍﺣﺘﺠﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﺠﻠﻰ ﳍﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺩﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺧﺎﻃﺒﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﺚ ﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ ﻭﺻﱪﻭﺍ ﻭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺁﻩ ﻋﺪﱘ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺎﻣﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳉﻠﻮﺱ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮﻩ ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻓﺘﻮﱃ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﺪﱘ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻻ ﻳﻄﺎﻕ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ ﻭﳓﺘﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﺒﲏ ﻫﺮﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﺍﻥ ﺃﻫﺒﻄﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻋﺪﳝﺎﹰ ﺍﺳﺘﻜﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻤﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻼ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺎﺑﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﻳﻦ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻧﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻣﻬﻠﺔ ﻭﻣﻬﺎﻟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻜﲔ ﺑﺒﺎﺑﻞ ﰲ ﺑﺌﺮ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‬
‫ﻳﻐﺸﺎﻫﺎ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻋﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻋﺒﺪﺕ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﲣﺬﺕ ﺍﻷﻭﺛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻓﺘﻨﺼﺒﻬﺎ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻗﻮﻡ ﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻨﺼﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺪﱘ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻠﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺯﻧﺖ ﺑﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﺎ ﺯﻭﺝ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺑﺼﻠﺒﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺮ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻇﻬﺮ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻇﻬﺮ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺑﺮ ﺍﲰﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻼﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺃﺭﺑﻊ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﺃﻭﺩﻋﻬﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍًﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﱰ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻮﺟﻬﺎﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﺑﺎﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻴﺪﻳﻦ ﳝﻨﻊ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺠﺎﻭﺯ ﺣﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻧﺼﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻭﻗﺘﻨﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮﻻ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ ﻟﻐﻠﺐ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺭﺽ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻗﻨﻄﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻣﻮﺟﻬﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺑﻊ ﺟﻬﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻳﺪ ﻛﻞ‬

‫‪101‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﻴﻒ ﻳﻀﺮﺏ ﺑﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺁﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﻬﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﺎ ﻣﺪﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ‪‬ﺪﻣﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺫﻛﺮﻧﺎ ﻫﺎ‬
‫ﺣﻮﺿﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﻣﺪﻯ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺘﻐﲑ ﲟﺎ ﺍﺟﺘﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺭﻃﻮﺑﺔ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﻴﻼﹰ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﻨﻔﻘﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ‬
‫ﻣﺎﺅﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳍﻢ ﻟﺒﻌﺪﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﻗﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﳕﺎ ﰎ ﻟﻘﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﻳﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﳓﻮﻫﺎ ﲞﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻋﺬﻭﺑﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺤﺒﺲ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺨﺎﺭ ﺟﺰﺀﺍﹰ ﺑﺎﳍﻨﺪﺳﺔ ﻭﺑﺎﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﻳﻨﺤﻂ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳊﻮﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﳝﺪﻩ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ‬
‫ﺑﺮﻃﻮﺑﺘﻪ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﻣﺎﺅﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮ ﺷﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺎ ﺣﻮﺿﺎﹰ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﺪﻭﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻭﻣﻸﻩ ﻣﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺒﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺟﺰﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺨﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻃﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﳋﻠﻖ ﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻗﺪﺣﺎﹰ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﺪﺍﻩ ﺣﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﱐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﺫﻭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﰲ ﺃﺯﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺧﺎﻡ ﻣﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﺒﻄﻦ ﺑﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻠﻲ ﺟﺴﻤﻪ‬
‫ﲟﺎ ﳝﺴﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺫﺧﺎﺋﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﳏﺮﻭﺳﺔ ﲟﻦ ﳝﻨﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﻋﺪﱘ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﻗﻔﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﺑﺮﺍﻕ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺁﺯﺍﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻔﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﻛﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎﻃﺎﺋﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺷﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺣﲔ ﻣﻮﺷﺢ ﲜﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﲤﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻗﻄﺮﻫﺎﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺸﺒﻚ ﲜﻮﻫﺮ ﻋﻘﻴﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺟﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‬
‫ﻣﻜﺸﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻵﺯﺍﺝ ﻣﻔﺘﻮﺣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻃﻮﻝ ﻛﻞ ﺍﺯﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺃﺫﺭﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻳﻠﻘﻲ‬
‫ﻧﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻟﺼﻔﺎﺀ ﻟﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺑﺮﻳﻘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﺼﺤﻔﹰﺎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﻊ ﻣﻮﺍﺋﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﺃﲪﺮ ﳜﻄﻒ ﺍﻷﺑﺼﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺗﻴﺠﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﳌﻀﻲﺀ ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳜﻄﻒ ﻟﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮ ﻭﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺷﻌﺎﻉ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻧﻈﺮﺕ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻓﺎﻋﻲ ﺳﺎﻟﺖ ﻋﻴﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺁﻧﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻛﱪﻳﺖ ﺃﲪﺮ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺫﻛﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺪﺑﲑﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﺢ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺑﺮﺍﻕ‬

‫‪102‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺻﺎﻑ ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻟﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻳﻌﺸﻲ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮ ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ ﺣﺎﻓﺘﺎﻫﺎ ﻭﻗﻮﺍﺋﻤﻬﺎ ﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﺍﺻﻔﺮ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺑﺮﺍﱐ ﺑﻠﻮﺭ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺑﻐﺮﺍﺋﺐ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﺳﻴﺎﻑ ﺻﺎﻋﻘﻴﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻫﻨﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺗﺮﺍﺱ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺱ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻠﺠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺗﻮﺍﺑﻴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﺎﻧﲑ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺿﺮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﻷﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺃﻭﺍﱐ‬
‫ﺍﳊﻨﺘﻢ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﺮﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﺜﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﺸﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ‬
‫ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﺃﺫﺭﻉ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺃﳝﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﴰﺎﺋﻠﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﱴ ﺩﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺩﺍﺭﺕ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺁﺧﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺷﺄ‪‬ﺎ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳛﺎﺫﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺯﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺄﻣﻠﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺯﺟﺎﹰ ﺃﺯﺟﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺯﺝ ﺇﻻ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺯﺝ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﲎ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ .‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﺭﺍﻭﺍ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺼﻒ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳊﻴﺘﻪ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻣﻜﺸﻮﻓﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﺑﺪﻧﻪ ﺑﻄﻮﻝ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﺫﺭﻉ ﻭﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺻﻨﻮﻓﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﱂ ﻳﺮ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺬﺑﺢ ﳍﺎ ﺩﻳﻚ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺃﻓﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺒﺨﺮ ﺑﺮﻳﺸﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﺳﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺨﻮﺭ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻧﺼﺒﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺯﺣﻞ ﻭﺍﳌﺸﺘﺮﻱ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﻳﺦ ﰲ ﺑﺮﺝ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻭﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﰲ ﺑﺮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺼﻼﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺳﺒﻊ‬
‫ﻣﺮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﻄﺦ ﺣﺎﺋﻄﻬﺎ ﺑﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺫﺑﺢ ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺤﺴﻦ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻜﺜﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻠﻮﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻥ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺭﺃﻭﻫﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻮﻧﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﻮﻥ ﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺳﺄﻟﻮﺍ ﺃﻫﻞ‬
‫ﻗﻔﻂ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﻏﲑ ﺷﻴﺦ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺑﻨﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻻﻣﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﲨﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻑ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ ﺟﺎﺀﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺐ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺑﻘﻔﻂ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎ ﻭﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﺭﺟﻊ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻭﻻ ﻋﺮﻑ ﳍﻢ ﺧﱪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺪﱘ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺪ ﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﻣﺎﺷﻴﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺑﻼﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺰﺀ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﺰﺍﺀ ﻋﻤﻮﻣﺘﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺰﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻣﻼﻋﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﺫﺍ ﺭﺃﺳﲔ ﻣﻘﺘﺮﻧﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺰﺀ ﺇﺑﺮﻳﺖ ﻓﺒﲎ ﺑﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ‬

‫‪103‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﻤﺪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﺎﻃﲔ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻼﻫﺎ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﺻﻐﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺒﻌﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻣﻀﻰ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺟﺰﺀ ﺻﺎﰊ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻯﺮﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻼﻁ ﺗﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻇﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻻﻗﺎﻟﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﻮﻻﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﻋﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﲟﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻭﻭﺻﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻭﺩﻋﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻭﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻨﻪ‬
‫ﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻫﺸﻮﺭ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺠﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻗﻄﻌﺖ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺍﺑﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﻨﻜﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﳕﺎ ﻏﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺷﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ ﻟﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﳚﺮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻟﺴﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﺷﺪﺍﺩ ﻭﻗﻠﺔ ﻣﺎﳚﺮﻱ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻗﻂ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻻ ﻋﺒﺪ ﻟﺒﺨﺖ ﻧﺼﺮ ﲟﺎ ﻗﺪﻣﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﻟﺰﳚﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺭﻣﻮﺯﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﻛﻬﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺟﻬﺪ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﰲ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﻧﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻑ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﺒﺐ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻮﻋﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻐﲎ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺩﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺷﺘﺎﻗﺘﻪ ﺍﻷﻧﻮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﺷﺘﺎﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻓﻌﺘﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺮﻭﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﳌﺆﳌﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﻧﻮﺭﺍ‬
‫ﺳﺎﲝﺎ ﺩﺍﺧﻼ ﰲ ﻧﻮﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻳﺘﺼﺮﻑ ﺑﺘﺼﺮﻓﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻄﻮﰉ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻋﺮﻓﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺻﲑ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺒﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﺧﻄﺘﻪ ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﲟﺜﺎﺑﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﻭﺷﺒﻴﻬﻪ ﺗﻀﻠﻴﻞ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻻ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪﻭﻥ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺗﺮﻏﻴﺒﺎ ﰲ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻮﺣﻴﺪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺍﻥ ﻣﺪﺣﻬﻢ ﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﺑﺮﺍﺕ ﻻ ﻳﻀﺮ ﺧﺎﻟﻘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻳﻌﻈﻤﻮ‪‬ﺎ‬
‫ﺗﻘﺮﺑﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﻭﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺃﺭﻣﻨﺖ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻓﻀﺔ ﻭﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺑﻴﺾ ﻭﺭﺻﺎﺹ ﻣﺼﻔﻰ‬
‫ﻭﺯﺋﺒﻖ ﻣﻌﻘﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻻﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﺍﳌﻌﺪﻧﻴﺔ ﰲ ﻃﺒﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻗﺴﻤﺘﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺯﻳﻦ ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﺶ ﺑﺎﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﻮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﺰﻳﻦ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﺍﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺴﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺷﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﺮﻙ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ ﺍﻻ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺟﺰﺀ ﺻﺎﰊ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﻣﺜﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﲜﺰﺀ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﺑﺸﺮﻕ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﺰﺣﻞ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﺳﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﱪ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﺣﺪﺍﳘﺎ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ ﻟﻪ ﺍﺣﻠﻴﻞ ﻇﺎﻫﺮ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺍﺗﺎﻩ ﺍﳌﻌﻘﻮﺩ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﺴﺤﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻻ ﻳﻨﺘﺸﺮ ﺍﺣﻠﻴﻠﻪ ﺑﻜﻠﺘﺎ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺯﺍﻝ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﻧﺘﺸﺮ ﻭﻗﻮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺍﺣﺪﺍﻫﺎ ﺑﻘﺮﺓ ﳍﺎ ﺿﺮﻋﺎﻥ ﻛﺒﲑﺍﻥ ﺍﺫﺍ ﻣﺴﺤﺘﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻧﻘﺺ ﻟﺒﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﻌﻘﺪ ﺿﺮﻋﻬﺎ ﺩﺭ ﻭﺻﻠﺢ‪.‬‬

‫‪104‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺑﻨﺎﻫﺎ ﻻﺑﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺨﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻓﺤﻮﳍﺎﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﻋﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻥ ﺳﻔﻂ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺗﲔ ﺍﻟﻠﺘﲔ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﺘﺼﻘﺘﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﻤﻬﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﳊﺒﺸﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻋﺎﺛﻮﺍ ﰲ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻨﻘﺎﻭﺱ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺳﺒﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺒﺎﻩ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺒﺪﻩ ﻓﺼﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﻗﺘﻄﻊ ﻣﻌﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺒﺎﻩ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﳛﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺰﻡ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﳛﺮﺳﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺪ ﻭﺍﲣﺬ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺭﺡ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻮﻗﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﺋﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻼﺏ ﺍﻷﻫﻠﻴﺔ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻴﻄﺮﺓ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﺎﰿ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻼﺳﻢ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺳﻴﺢ ﰲ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﺳﻴﻮﻁ ﺑﻄﻠﺴﻢ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﺼﺒﺎﺑﺎ ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺟﻠﻮﺩﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻦ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﳊﻮﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺷﺤﻮﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻻﻏﺬﻳﺔ ﻭﻣﺆﻟﻔﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﲢﻜﻲ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺍﺛﻨﱵ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺍﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺑﻠﺪ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ‪‬ﻴﺄ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﺮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻣﻌﺎﳌﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﻗﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺪﱘ ﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻓﻄﺮﺩ ﺻﻴﺪﺍ ﻓﺎﻛﺐ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺳﻪ ﰲ ﻫﻮﺓ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﺧﺬ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺧﺪﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻣﻮﺭ ﻓﺄﻟﻘﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺳﻔﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺘﻘﻄﻊ ﰒ ﻧﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺳﻴﺼﻴﺒﻪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﻮﻗﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺼﻌﺪ ﺟﺒﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺍﺻﺎﺑﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺍﻥ ﳚﻌﻞ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻳﺰﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ " ﻟﻴﺲ ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﺍﻥ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺟﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻻﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻻﳚﻮﺯ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﺷﺪﺍﺕ ﺑﻦ ﻋﺪﱘ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻻﳛﻞ ﻓﻜﻮﰲﺀ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ"‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻫﻠﻚ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺳﺮﺏ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺢ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳎﻠﺲ ﻗﺪ ﺻﻔﺢ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﻀﺔ ﻭﺍﺟﻠﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻟﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﱄ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻨﻘﺎﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻡ ﻣﻘﺎﻡ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﲝﺰﻡ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺔ ﻓﺎﻇﻬﺮ ﻣﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﻭﺍﻥ ﺗﻨﺴﺦ ﲞﻂ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻟﻴﻔﻬﻤﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻤﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺜﲑ ﺍﻟﻨﻜﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻧﺴﻮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺻﻠﺤﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﳌﻮﻧﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺵ ﺍﳊﺴﻨﺔ‪،‬‬

‫‪105‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻨﻬﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻫﻮﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﻣﻨﻒ ﻟﺒﻨﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻦ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺑﻨﺘﺎﹰ ﻭﺭﺣﻠﻬﻦ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺪﻧﺎ ﻏﲑﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻫﻴﻜﻼﹰ ﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻓﺮﺍﺳﺦ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺃﻏﺮﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻔﻀﻞ ﺣﻜﻤﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺟﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻠﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﺛﲏ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻴﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺍﻓﻘﺎﹰ ﻟﱪﺝ ﺍﻟﺸﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﻈﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻋﻴﺎﺩ ﻭﻳﻮﺳﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﺃﺣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻭﺃﺭﺯﺍﻗﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺮﻭﻩ ﻣﻊ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺘﺢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﻳﻔﺘﺢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺪ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻟﺰﻡ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻜﻴﻤﻴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻻ ﻳﻔﺘﺮﻭﻥ ﻟﻴﻼ ﻭﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮ‬
‫ﻛﺜﲑﻭﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻣﺴﺒﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺩﺭﻙ ﻭﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺐ ﻛﱰﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﺃﺧﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻜﺮﻣﻪ ﻭﳛﺒﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻠﻨﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺩﺧﺮﻧﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﺴﺖ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺴﺎﻣﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺑﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﺫﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﺘﺄﻟﻔﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﺰﻭﻧﺎ ﻓﺨﺬ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﺟﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﻌﻦ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﺣﺮﻳﺰﺍﹰ ﺧﻔﻲ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺣﺮﺯﻩ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﺳﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺑﻌﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻛﺘﺐ ﺻﻔﺔ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﻼﻣﺎﺗﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺪ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺍﻧﻪ ﲪﻞ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺇﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻋﺠﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﻔﻴﺴﺔ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺋﺮﻫﺎ ﺫﻫﺐ‬
‫ﺇﺑﺮﻳﺰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻔﺎﺋﺢ ﻣﻀﺮﻭﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﺮﺍﺋﻒ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻻ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺳﻼﺣﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﻭﺍﻧﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﺎﻣﻼﹰ ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻣﻨﻴﻊ ﻟﻴﺲ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺼﻌﺪ ﺑﲔ‬
‫ﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻣﺴﺘﺪﻳﺮﺓ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﲢﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺃﺳﺮﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﻣﻐﺎﻳﺮ ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺃﺧﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺃﺗﻘﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺟﻬﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﻋﻠﻤﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻜﺚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﺭﺑﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻳﺒﻌﺚ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻋﺠﻼﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻓﻴﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺃﻛﻮﺍﺥ ﺷﱴ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺑﻴﺘﹰﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺗﻨﻔﻊ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﻛﻞ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﺎﰿ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻔﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ‪‬ﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻓﺴﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺑﺎﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﻣﺒﺘﺴﻤﺔ ﻻ ﻳﺮﺍﻫﺎ ﻣﻬﻤﻮﻡ ﺇﻻ ﺗﺒﺴﻢ ﻭﻧﺴﻲ ﳘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻳﺘﻨﺎﻭﺑﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻋﺒﺪﻭﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﲤﺜﺎﻻﹰ ﻃﺎﺋﺮﺍﹰ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻔﺮ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﺸﲑ ﲜﻨﺎﺣﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺿﻌﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻻ ﳝﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺯﺍﻥ ﻭﻻ ﺯﺍﻧﻴﺔ ﺇﻻ ﻛﺸﻒ ﻋﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﲝﻀﺮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﳝﺘﺤﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺮﻗﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﻓﺎﻛﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻔﺴﺪ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﺑﻄﻠﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪106‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﻈﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻋﺸﻘﺖ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺧﺎﻓﺖ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻗﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻴﻤﺘﺤﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻓﺘﻔﺘﻀﺢ ﻓﻴﻘﺘﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﺖ ﻣﻔﻜﺮﺓ ﰲ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺧﻼ ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺎﱄ ﻭﳘﺎ ﻳﺸﺮﺑﺎﻥ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﺕ ﰲ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻭﺍﱐ ﻭﺳﺒﻬﻦ ﻭﺫﻣﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻨﺎﻓﻊ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﺤﻖ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺜﻨﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﳊﺴﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻟﻜﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻏﲑ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻘﺎﻭﺱ ﱂ ﻳﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻭﻛﻴﻒ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪:‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﺃﺗﻌﺐ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀﻩ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﻟﺼﻼﺡ ﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻛﱪ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻜﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺣﻴﺚ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻧﺴﺎﺅﻩ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﺭﻳﻪ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﻗﺘﺮﻓﺖ ﺇﺣﺪﺍﻫﻦ ﺫﻧﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺟﺎﺯﻯ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺳﺘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺭﺩﻋﺎﹰ ﳌﻦ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﻋﻤﺎ ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻐﺘﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻏﻠﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﺷﻬﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺭﲟﺎ ﰲ ﻋﻤﺮﻫﺎ ﻷﻥ ﺷﻬﻮﺍﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺷﻬﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻏﻠﺐ ﻟﻨﻘﺼﺎﻥ ﻋﻘﻮﳍﻦ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻵﻥ ﻓﻠﻮ ﺣﺪﺙ ﺷﻲﺀ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﻮﺫ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻮﺭ ﺍﻷﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺐ ﺍﻣﺘﺤﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﻀﺢ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﺎﻉ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﳋﺎﺻﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻋﺎﻗﺐ ﺑﻐﲑ ﺍﻣﺘﺤﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﻳﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺻﱪ ﺻﱪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻜﺮﻭﻩ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﺖ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﺰﻝ ﻗﻮﳍﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻴﺤﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﺪﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﱂ ﺗﺸﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﻻ ﻷﻣﺮ ﻭﻗﻔﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺮﺩ ﻛﺸﻔﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﻧﺰﻉ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻭﻭﺿﻌﻪ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﰲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺃﻋﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻼ ﻣﻬﻠﺔ ﻭﻻ ﻣﺸﺎﺭﻭﺓ ﺣﻜﻴﻢ ﻭﻻ ﻋﺎﱂ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﺼﺐ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺍﻣﺘﺤﻦ ﻣﺮﺍﺭﺍﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻻﻣﺘﺤﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲢﺮﻳﻜﻪ ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻠﺖ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﳘﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺠﻮﺭ ﻭﺍ‪‬ﻤﻜﺖ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺇﳕﺎ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺭﺻﺪ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺒﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺃﻣﺎﻛﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺟﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﺧﻴﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻠﺰﻡ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺎ ﻭﻳﺄﰐ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺑﺒﺨﻮﺭ ﻭﺧﻠﻮﻕ ﻓﻴﺒﺨﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻄﻴﺐ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﻋﻀﺎﺩﺓ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺎ ﻓﻴﺠﺪ ﲢﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺩﻳﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻓﻴﺄﺧﺬﻩ ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻭﺷﻰ ﺑﻪ ﻏﻼﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺒﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺒﺬﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﺎﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻨﻘﺎﻭﺱ ﺑﲎ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﻟﻠﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﻬﻤﺲ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍﻻ ﻳﻄﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺢ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﳌﻘﻠﻌﺔ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻐﺮﺍﻣﺔ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭ‪‬ﺎﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﻛﺐ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﳍﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻓﻴﺠﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻳﺘﻌﺠﺒﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲎ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﻟﻠﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺧﺼﻮﺻﺎﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻼ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﳘﺎ ﺑﺎﻗﻴﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﲔ ﴰﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﻣﻨﻘﺎﻭﺱ ﺇﱃ ﻋﲔ ﴰﺲ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍﹰ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﻋﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﻭﺩﻓﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻨﻮﺍﺣﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫‪107‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻗﺴﻢ ﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﺃﺭﺑﺎﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺑﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ﻳﻨﻔﻘﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﺸﺎﺀ ﻭﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺑﻊ‬
‫ﻷﺭﺯﺍﻕ ﺍﳉﻨﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺑﻊ ﻳﻨﻔﻘﻪ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺎﱀ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺟﺴﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺣﻔﺮ ﺧﻠﺠﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺃﺟﱪ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺑﻊ ﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﳊﺪﺙ ﳛﺪﺙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻳﻮﻣﺌﺬ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﻗﺴﻤﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﻛﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﺃﺳﻔﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﲬﺴﺔ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﻮﻥ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻳﺪﻳﺮ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺣﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻃﺎﻋﻮﻥ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺳﻢ ﰲ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﰲ ﻏﺮﰊ ﻗﻮﺹ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺼﺎﺣﻒ ﻭﺃﻛﺎﺳﲑ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﻤﻮﻟﺔ ﻭﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﳌﻀﺮﻭﺏ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﺜﲑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﺎﺗﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﺣﻈﻰ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﺒﻬﺎ ﺣﺒﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﲤﺜﺎﳍﺎ ﺑﺬﺅﺍﺑﺘﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺍﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻪ ﺣﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﻣﻨﻈﻮﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺟﺎﻟﺴﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺮﺳﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲢﻤﻞ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﳚﻠﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻟﻴﺘﺴﻠﻰ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻓﻨﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻛﺄﳕﺎ ﳜﺎﻃﺒﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺟﻠﺲ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ‪ ،‬ﻣﺜﻞ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻡ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﺬﻝ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺋﺰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﱵ ﱂ ﻳﺘﻘﺪﻡ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﳌﻦ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﺒﺖ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺐ ﺗﻮﺍﺭﳜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﰲ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻞ ﻋﻠﺔ ﻓﻴﺌﺲ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ‬
‫ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺎﹸ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﳜﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻻﳜﺮﺟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﺘﻚ ﺇﻻ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺗﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻻﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻟﻊ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺣﻠﻮﳍﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺛﻮﺭ ﺑﻘﺮﻧﲔ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﺎﻫﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺛﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺃﺑﻠﻖ ﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ‬
‫ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﻭﺳﻘﻔﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﺬﻫﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺒﺨﺮﻩ ﻭﻳﻄﻴﺒﻪ ﻭﳛﺴﻦ ﻋﻠﻔﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺎﻳﺴﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﻣﻪ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻨﻈﻔﻪ ﻭﻳﻜﻨﺲ ﲢﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻟﻪ ﺳﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﳑﻠﻜﺘﻪ ﻓﱪﻯﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﺘﻪ ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺃﺣﻮﺍﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺠﻞ ﳑﻮﻫﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻔﺮﺵ‬
‫ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺵ ﻭﺗﺴﺎﻕ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﳌﺘﱰﻫﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻋﻠﺘﻪ ﻻﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻻﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻛﻮﺏ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ ﲡﺮﻩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻠﺔ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺮ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﻧﺰﻩ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻣﺮ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﺧﺮﺏ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﻤﺎﺭﺗﻪ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻧﻈﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺍﱃ ﺛﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ ﺍﻟﱵ ﲡﺮﻩ ﺃﺑﻠﻖ ﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﳋﻠﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻧﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺘﻮﻗﻴﻔﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﺾ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﻗﻪ ﺑﲔ‬
‫ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻧﺰﻫﺘﻪ ﺇﻋﺠﺎﺑﺎﹰﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺣﻠﻼ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺝ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻻﻳﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺧﻼ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻔﺮﺩ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﻩ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﺠﺪ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪108‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻟﻮ ﺩﺍﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺮﺑﻴﱵ ﻭﺍﻛﺮﺍﻣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﺒﺪ ﱄ ﻛﻔﻴﺘﻪ ﻣﻬﻤﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻮﻳﺘﻪ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺯﻟﺖ ﻋﻨﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻋﻠﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺭﺗﺎﻉ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻟﻘﻮﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺄﻥ ﻳﻐﺴﻞ ﻭﻳﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﻳﻜﺴﻰ ﺑﺎﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﻳﻮﻗﻒ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﳜﺪﻣﻪ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ ﻭﻳﺘﻌﺎﻫﺪﻩ ﺑﺎﳌﺴﺢ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻄﻴﻴﺐ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﻌﺒﺎﺩﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﻳﻌﺒﺪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻓﺘﱳ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺻﻼ ﻟﻌﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻛﱰﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺩﳝﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﻛﱰ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻵﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺟﺎﺯﻭﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻓﺴﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺰﻑ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻧﲑﺍ‪‬ﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﻢ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻩ‬
‫ﺃﺟﻮﻑ ﻭﻳﺆﺧﺬ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺷﻌﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺫﻧﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺆﺧﺬ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺗﺔ ﻗﺮﻧﻪ ﻭﺃﻇﻼﻓﻪ ﻭﳚﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻠﺤﻖ ﺑﻌﺎﳌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﰲ ﺟﺮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﲤﺜﺎﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﺣﻞ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻓﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻧﺎﻇﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺜﻠﻴﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻘﺶ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ‬
‫ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻛﻠﻠﺖ ﺑﺄﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻬﺎ ﺳﻮﺍﺩ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺎﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺟﺴﺪ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﳊﺪﻭﺩ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺣﺪﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳜﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﲟﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﻭﻗﺘﺎﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻭﳚﻴﺒﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺎﻟﻮﻧﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ ﻭﻧﺬﺭﺕ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺬﻭﺭ ﻭﻗﺮﺑﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺑﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺼﺪﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳜﱪﻫﻢ ﲟﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻨﺎﻭﺱ ﻣﻠﻜﺎﹰ ﲬﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻞ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﲢﺖ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ‬
‫ﰲ ﺟﺮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻭﺻﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﺮﻳﺪﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻀﻌﻔﺎﹰ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﱭ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻭﻻﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺃﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻣﻊ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺟﺮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺻﺎﺹ‪.‬ﻭﻭﱄ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﺃﺧﻮ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺣﺎﺫﻯ ﺑﺮﻗﺔ ﺍﳊﻤﺮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺣﺪ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﺍﲬﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﱰﻝ ﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﻻﻧﻪ ﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﲰﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻭﻃﻮﳍﺎ ﺍﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻣﻴﻼﹸ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﴰﻮﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﲣﺬ ﺍﳌﻼﻋﺐ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﳉﺎﻥ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺋﺮﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪.‬‬

‫‪109‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺧﱪ ﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺫﻛﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﺳﺤﺮﺍﹰ‪.‬ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺢ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‬
‫ﲰﺎﻫﺎ ﺃﻓﻄﺮﺍﻃﺲ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺛﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﳉﻨﻮﰊ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﻠﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﱄ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺃﺳﺪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺑﺴﺤﺮﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﻄﻖ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺻﺪ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺈﺫﻥ ﺍﳌﻮﻛﻠﲔ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺗﺜﻤﺮ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﻛﻬﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺗﺘﻠﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻟﻮﻧﺎ ﺣﱴ ﲤﻀﻲ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺑﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺗﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺗﻜﺴﻮ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻟﻮﻧﺎﹰ ﺷﻌﺎﻋﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺳﺎﻗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﲰﻜﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﺭﺀﻭﺳﻬﺎ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﺃﺑﺪﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﺪﻓﻊ ﻣﻀﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻼﺏ ﻣﻨﻔﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﲢﺖ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﺒﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺑﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺻﻨﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﻭﻟﻜﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻭﲞﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻼﻡ ﻳﻮﺻﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻜﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﻢ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺎﺑﺔ ﲤﻄﺮ ﻣﻄﺮﺍﹰ‬
‫ﺧﻔﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﺷﺘﺎﺀ ﻭﺻﻴﻔﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﺖ ﻛﻞ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻳﺘﺪﺍﻭﻯ ﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺩﺍﺀ ﻓﻴﱪﻳﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺷﺮﻗﻬﺎ ﺑﺮﺑﺎ ﻟﻄﻴﻒ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﻀﺎﺩﺗﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻀﺎﺩﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ‬
‫ﳜﺎﻃﺐ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻜﻠﻤﻪ ﺑﻜﻼﻡ ﻳﻔﻬﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﱪﻩ ﲟﺎ ﺣﺪﺙ ﰲ ﻳﻮﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﻃﻬﺎﺭﺓ ﻧﻔﺨﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﺻﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﻓﻈﻴﻌﺔ ﻻ ﺗﻔﺎﺭﻗﻪ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻮﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎﺍﺑﺪﺍ ﻣﻬﺒﻂ ﻧﻮﺭ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﻨﻘﻪ ﱂ ﻳﻐﺮﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻈﺮﻩ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﲰﻊ‬
‫ﻛﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﺍﻫﺐ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻛﺎﳌﺼﺤﻒ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺃﺣﺐ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻓﻤﺴﺤﻬﺎ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﻓﻴﺜﺒﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ ﰲ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻫﺎﺗﲔ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺘﲔ ﲰﻴﺘﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻢ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﻤﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﻋﻦ ﺭﺟﻞ ﺃﺗﻰ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺮﻭﺍﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻭﺍﱄ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﻭﻏﻞ‬
‫ﰲ ﻃﻠﺐ ﲨﻞ ﻟﻪ ﺿﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﲢﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺎﻛﻬﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺃﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻣﺪﻥ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪،‬‬

‫‪110‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺛﻘﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺩﻭﺍ ﺯﺍﺩ ﺷﻬﺮ ﻭﻣﺸﻮﺍ ﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺭﻯ‬
‫ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺛﺮﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ ﺃﻋﺪﻝ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﺭﻏﺒﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺻﻨﻴﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺒﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻳﺒﻘﻲ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﲎ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﻟﺲ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﲎ ﺳﺮﺑﺎﹰ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻣﻦ ﺍﴰﻮﻥ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻧﺼﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻟﻨﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻷ‪‬ﻦ ﻛﻦ‬
‫ﳝﻀﲔ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﺏ ﻣﺒﻠﻂ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳊﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻃﻮﻝ ﺇﺧﻮﺗﻪ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺍﻧﺘﺰﻋﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﺘﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﰒ ﻛﺮﻫﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻮﺑﺆﻭﻩ ﻓﺮﺣﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻫﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﺮﻭﻫﺎ ﻭﺍﲣﺬﻭﺍ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻫﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﺯﺓ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ‬
‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﺟﺎﺀ ﻟﻴﺪﺧﻞ ﺻﺎﺣﺖ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﺓ ﻭﺻﻔﻘﺖ ﲜﻨﺎﺣﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﺑﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﺣﺒﻮﺍ ﺃﺩﺧﻠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺃﺣﺒﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﺍﳊﻴﺎﺕ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﲝﻴﻠﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺄﺧﺬﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺤﻮﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﳊﻮﻣﻬﺎ ﺃﺩﻭﻳﺔ‬
‫ﻭﺩﺭﻳﺎﻗﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﻭﺯ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﺇﻛﺮﺍﻣﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺑﺰﻋﻤﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻬﻨﺴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻄﺮﺍﻧﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﺬﻫﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﺃﻟﻘﺖ ﺷﻌﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺍﺣﺪﻯ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻠﻴﺔ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺑﻞ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻃﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺃﴰﻮﻥ ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﺎﻝ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﺧﺎﺋﺮ ﻣﺎﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻨﺖ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﰲ ﻫﻴﻜﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺳﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻓﻀﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺁﻻﻑ ﺟﺎ ﻭﻧﻀﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻓﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﻣﺴﺒﻮﻙ ﻭﺃﻟﻒ ﺑﺮﻧﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﺍﳌﺪﺑﺮﺓ ﻟﻘﺒﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﻣﺪﺓ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺧﻠﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﱄ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻏﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﺑﻦ ﲬﺲ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﺠﱪﺍﹰ ﻣﻌﺠﺒﹰﺎ ﻃﻤﺎﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺑﺘﺰ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻜﺸﻒ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻋﺮﻑ ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﱪ ﳘﻪ ﺍﻟﻠﻬﻮ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﻌﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻣﻠﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻭﻗﺼﺪﻩ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﳌﻼﻫﻲ ﻭﺍﳌﻼﻋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺮﺩ ﻟﻠﻌﺐ ‪‬ﻢ‬

‫‪111‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺗﺮﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺃﻣﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻗﺼﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﺒﺎﺏ ﻣﻨﻘﻮﺷﺔ ﳑﻮﻫﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﻳﺘﱰﻩ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻦ ﳛﺐ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﺧﺪﻣﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﻠﻬﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﻭﻗﺔ ﺍﳌﺬﻫﺒﺔ ﻭﻓﺮﺷﻬﺎ ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺵ ﻭﻓﺎﺧﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﱰﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﲡﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﻧﺰﻫﺘﻪ ﺷﻬﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻻ ﳝﺮ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮ ﺗﻮﻟﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻨﻔﺬ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻫﺐ ﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﰲ ﺟﺮﺍﺋﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻬﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻔﻘﺎﺕ ﰲ ﻏﲑ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺳﺮﻑ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﻜﺮﻭﺍ ﺣﺎﻟﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﻣﺴﺎﺀﻟﺘﻪ ﻭﺍﻻﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﺎﻻﻗﻼﻉ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻀﻤﻦ ﳍﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻓﺎﻭﺿﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺐ ﺗﺒﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺣﺬﺭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺍﻗﺐ ﺍﻟﻼﺣﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺮﻳﻂ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻜﺮﻩ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻨﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﺄﺳﺎﺀﻭﺍ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺿﺮﻭﺍ ‪‬ﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺘﱰﻩ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺻﻔﺢ ﳎﺎﻟﺴﻪ ﺑﺼﻔﺎﺋﺢ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻧﻔﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺷﻪ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺵ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻧﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺣﺐ ﺍﻥ ﳜﻠﻮ ﺑﺎﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﺧﻠﻰ ‪‬ﺎ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺘﱰﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﺇﺫ ﺧﺮﺝ‬
‫ﻏﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺧﺪﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭ ﰲ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺧﺎﺩﻡ ﻓﺄﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﺧﺬﻫﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺑﻐﲑ ﲦﻦ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﻮﺛﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺿﺮﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺿﺮﺑﻮﻩ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺳﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺩﻣﻪ ﻭﲪﻞ ﻭﻗﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﻛﺒﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻭﺍﻧﻜﺮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﻭﺃﲰﻌﺎﻫﻢ ﻓﺄﻏﻠﻈﻮﺍ‬
‫ﳍﻤﺎ ﻭﺃﲰﻌﻮﳘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺼﺮﻓﺎ ﻣﻐﻀﺒﲔ ﻭﻗﺎﻻ ﻣﺎ ﻧﺮﻯ ﺳﺘﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﺎﻩ ﺍﳋﱪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳛﻔﻞ ‪‬ﻤﺎ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺪﺍﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻌﺮﺿﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻗﺘﻠﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻤﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﺷﻜﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺗﻮﺍﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﻮﺛﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﻀﻰ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﺳﺒﻮﻉ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﻩ ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻋﺰﻡ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﺇﱃ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻳﺘﺼﻴﺪ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺰﻭﺩﻭﺍ ﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﺍﻳﺎﻡ ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺪﻋﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺟﻴﺸﻪ ﰲ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ‬
‫ﺯﻱ ﻭﻫﻴﺌﺔ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻏﲑ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﻈﻼﻡ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺑﺎﳉﻴﺶ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺍﰱ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻀﻌﻮﺍ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﲝﺮﻕ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺘﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻨﺎﺩﻯ‪ :‬ﻫﺬﺍ ﺟﺰﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻗﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺭﻋﺎﻳﺎﻩ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﻣﻬﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻐﺎﺙ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺳﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﻩ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻄﺮﺡ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻭﻳﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻓﺎﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﻋﺎﺩ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻜﻢ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺃﺣﻞ ﺩﻣﻪ ﻓﺸﻜﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻋﻈﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺠﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺤﻠﺖ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻓﺄﺑﻐﻀﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﳋﺎﺻﺔ ﻭﺍﺑﺘﻐﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﻮﺍﺋﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬

‫‪112‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺧﺎﺻﺘﻪ ﺑﻄﺒﺎﺧﻪ ﻭﺳﻘﺎﺗﻪ ﻓﺴﻤﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﲬﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺻﺎﺻﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺻﺎﺻﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﺧﻮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺩ ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﺑﻦ ﻣﺮﺑﻴﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺟﻠﺲ ﺻﺎﺻﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻳﻬﻨﺌﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻋﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﳍﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﻜﻦ ﻣﻨﻒ ﻭﻧﻔﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻬﲔ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﻻﺕ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺮ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺼﺤﺐ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺭﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﲟﻨﻒ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻭﺷﺮﻑ ﻫﻴﻜﻠﻪ ﻭﺩﻋﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﲟﻨﻒ ﻣﺮﺁﺓ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ‪‬ﺎ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﺍﳋﺼﺐ ﻭﺍﳉﺪﺏ ﻭﻣﺎ ﳛﺪﺙ ﺑﺒﻠﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺎﺕ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺮﺱ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﳔﻼ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻏﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺧﻠﻒ ﺍﳌﻘﻄﻢ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﺠﺰﻩ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﻳﺴﺄﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺨﱪﻩ ﻭﻳﺒﲔ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻋﺰﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﻳﺮﻓﻌﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﳚﺮﻱ ﰲ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﺃﺭﺿﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﺮﰊ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﺎﺑﺮﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ ﻗﺎﺻﺪ ﻳﻮﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻴﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﳋﱪ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻴﻠﻪ ﺃﻭ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻮﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻛﻞ ﲜﻤﻌﻬﺎ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﳛﺮﺳﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﲣﺬﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﲎ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻮﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﺑﺄﺳﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﲨﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﺣﺎﺫﻗﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻜﺎﺩ ﻳﻐﺮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳛﺪﺙ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪﻱ ﺭﺟﻞ‬
‫ﻳﺄﰐ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺠﻤﻊ ﻛﻞ ﻓﺎﻋﻞ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻭﺟﻬﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺑﲎ ﰲ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﺡ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺟﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻻﺭﺗﻔﺎﻉ ﲬﺴﲔ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺩﻋﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳊﻜﻢ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﲑ ﰲ ﺯﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺃﻣﻴﺔ ﳌﺎ‬
‫ﻗﻠﺪ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﳌﺎﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﺃﺧﺬ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺡ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺠﻮﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻳﺴﲑ ﰲ ﺭﻣﺎﻝ ﺑﲔ ﲰﺖ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻭﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﺼﻦ ﻭﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﺣﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺍﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻔﺘﺢ ﺑﺎﺑﺎﹸ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻋﻴﺎﻩ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﻐﻠﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺻﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺷﺮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺛﺐ ﺩﺍﺧﻠﻬﺎ ﻻﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻳﻘﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻣﺎﻳﺼﻴﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﱂ ﳚﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ ﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﻀﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺮﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻪ ﻣﻨﺼﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﻬﺎﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺑﻦ ﻧﺼﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﻗﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺭﻯ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﺘﱰﻫﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻣﺪﺍﺋﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﻝ ﻏﻠﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬ﻭﱂ‬
‫ﻳﻜﻦ ﳌﺼﺮ ﻣﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﺍﻻ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻠﺮﻣﻞ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ ﻳﺒﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﻳﻮﻗﻔﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﻔﺴﺪ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻘﺎﺩﻡ ﺍﻷﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬ﻭﻻ‬

‫‪113‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻷﺣﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﻣﺪﺍﺋﻨﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻧﺼﺒﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﻄﺶ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻟﻐﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﺑﻴﺎﻥ ﲢﻘﻴﻖ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺑﺎﻗﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻨﺤﻮﺗﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﻢ ﻓﻮﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻷﻭﺩﻳﺔ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻨﺤﻮﺗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻧﻘﺸﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻜﻤﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻟﻮ ﺗﻌﺎﻃﻰ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲏ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﳍﺮﻣﲔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻭ ﲨﻴﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﺎ ‪‬ﻴﺄ ﳍﻢ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻟﻮ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻘﺸﻮﺍ ﺛﻮﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻄﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﻋﻦ ﻗﻮﻡ ﰲ ﺿﻴﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﺍﻥ ﻋﺎﻣﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ ﻋﻨﻖ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺯﺍﺩﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺼﻠﺢ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﻳﺮﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺁﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﳉﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻋﲑﺍ ﺃﻫﻠﻴﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺷﻌﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺒﻌﻪ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻦ ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﳔﻞ ﻭﻣﻴﺎﻩ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻢ ﻳﺴﻜﻨﻮﻥ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻨﺎﺳﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺰﺭﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻄﺎﻟﺒﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﺪ ﲞﺮﺍﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻭﻫﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﱂ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺿﻴﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﳓﻮﻫﻢ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻣﻮﺍﺷﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺓ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻭﻗﻔﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺗﺄﺗﻰ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﺁﻳﺴﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻳﻦ ﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﺿﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻮﺍﺷﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺨﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺿﺎﻓﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﺑﺎﺗﻮﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻃﺎﺣﻮﻧﺔ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳋﻤﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺸﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺳﻜﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﻧﺎﻣﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﻬﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻃﻠﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻟﻴﺲ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻧﻴﺲ ﻭﻻ ﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺗﺎﻋﻮﺍ ﻭﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ ﻛﺎﳍﺎﺭﺑﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻳﻮﻣﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﲰﺖ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻈﻬﺮﺕ ﳍﻢ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻛﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﻤﺮ ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺃﻫﻼﹰ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﳔﻼﹰ ﻭﺷﺠﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺯﺭﻋﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻮﺍﺷﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻧﺴﻮﺍ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﻫﻢ ﲞﱪ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻳﻌﺠﺒﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﻀﺤﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﻟﻴﻤﺔ ﻓﺎﻧﻄﻠﻘﻮﺍ ‪‬ﻢ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﻃﻌﻤﻮﻫﻢ‬
‫‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻘﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﻏﻨﻮﻫﻢ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﳌﻼﻫﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻭﻫﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺿﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﰲ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﺎﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻜﻢ ﻭﺍﺿﺢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﳝﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻐﻠﻄﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺃﺣﺒﺒﺘﻢ ﺍﳌﺴﲑ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻬﻨﺎ ﻣﻌﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﻳﻮﻗﻔﻜﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲰﺖ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺆﺩﻳﻜﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺃﺣﺒﺒﺘﻢ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﻴﻤﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﺭﻓﺪﻧﺎﻛﻢ ﻭﺯﻭﺟﻨﺎﻛﻢ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻨﺘﻢ ﺃﺻﻬﺎﺭﻧﺎ ﻭﺇﺧﻮﺍﻧﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﲨﻊ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﲨﻊ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻓﻴﺴﲑ ﳓﻮﻫﻢ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‬

‫‪114‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﺒﺘﻨﺎ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺧﲑ ﻣﺒﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳕﻨﺎ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻐﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﺒﻬﻨﺎ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻧﺎ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻨﺎ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺸﻌﺚ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺾ ﺣﺼﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻥ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ ﳔﻼ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻗﺪ ﺗﺴﺎﻗﻂ ﲦﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻜﺪﺱ ﺣﻮﳍﺎ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﺤﻘﻨﺎ‬
‫ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﻮﻑ ﻭﺍﻻﺭﺗﻴﺎﻉ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺸﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﺩ ﻳﺘﻠﻔﻨﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻔﻜﺮﻳﻦ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻋﺎﻳﻨﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻧﺎ ﻟﻨﺠﺪ ﺭﻭﺍﺋﺢ ﺍﳋﻤﺮ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﻭﻣﻌﺎﱐ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺮ ﻓﻴﻨﺎ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻧﺰﻝ ﻧﺴﲑ‬
‫ﻳﻮﻣﻨﺎ ﺃﲨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺑﻨﺎ ﺟﻮﻉ ﻭﻻ ﻋﻄﺶ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻓﻴﻨﺎ ﺭﺍﻋﻴﺎﹰ ﻳﺮﻋﻰ ﻏﻨﻤﺎ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻨﺎﻩ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻗﺮﻳﺐ ﻣﻨﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﳓﻦ ﺑﺄ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻟﻨﺎ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺑﺘﻨﺎ ﰒ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺒﺤﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﳓﻦ ﰲ ﻏﲑ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﻨﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﻌﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻣﺸﻴﻨﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻠﻨﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻷﴰﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻨﺎ ﳓﺪﺙ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻘﺒﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﳝﺔ ﻗﺪ ﻏﻠﺒﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳉﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺳﺘﺮ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﺍﻩ ﺃﺣﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻗﺘﻠﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺩ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﻓﺬﻛﺮ ﳌﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻤﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻮﺻﻠﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺇﱃ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺪﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﺎﺣﱴ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﺰﻡ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﺰﻭ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺟﻬﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺼﺎﺣﺐ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﲡﻬﺰ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻋﻤﺪ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ ﻭﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺻﻌﺪ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻔﺢ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﻫﺎ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﻨﺤﺘﻮﺍ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﺘﻬﻰ ﲬﺴﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﳌﻨﺤﻮﺕ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺭﺯﺓ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﺔ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺖ ﺑﻘﺪﺭ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻣﺪﻭﺭ ﰲ ﺟﺮﻣﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﻓﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺄﻫﺐ ﲟﺎﻗﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﲟﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﺣﺸﺪ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻣﻜﻨﻪ ﻭﻗﺼﺪ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻻﳝﺮ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﻃﻼﲰﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻤﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺇﻻ ﻗﺪﺭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻏﲑﻩ ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪ ﻣﺎ ﺻﺎﺩﻑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ ﲟﻌﻮﻧﺔ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﻓﻌﺎﺙ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﺪﻡ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻭﻏﲑ ﻣﻌﺎﳌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺭﺷﻴﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻮﻧﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻨﺘﻬﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪ ﻣﻨﻔﺎ ﳑﺘﻨﻌﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺪﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻴﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺮﺍﺩﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻓﺤﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻃﻤﻌﺎﹰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻳﺰﻳﺪﻭﻥ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻳﻨﻘﺼﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻏﺘﺎﻅ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﳝﻜﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻓﺴﲑﻭﻩ ﺣﱴ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻭﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻈﻬﻮﺭ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻛﺜﲑ‪،‬‬

‫‪115‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﻓﺄﲨﻊ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳍﺮﻭﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﺍﳓﺸﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﲟﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻇﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﺄﻛﺜﺮ‬
‫ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﻏﺮﻗﻮﺍ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﻣﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﳜﻠﺺ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺳﺮﻉ ﺍﳍﺮﺏ ﰲ ﻣﺮﻛﺐ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺠﺎﺩﻩ ﳌﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳊﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻔﺮ ﻭﺳﻠﻂ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻬﻢ ﺭﻳﺎﺣﺎ ﻏﺮﻗﺖ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻋﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﺇﻻ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻗﺪ ﺛﻘﻞ‬
‫ﺑﺎﳉﺮﺍﺣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻭﻗﺮﺍﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺗﺮﻙ ﻣﺎ ﻛﱰﻩ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻋﺘﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻳﻐﺰﻭ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻌﺒﺚ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﳜﺮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﺳﺒﻌﺎ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻚ ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﲟﻨﻒ ﰲ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺖ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻬﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺑﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻻ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‬
‫ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺃﺟﺪﺍﺩﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺷﱴ ﺑﺮﻳﺔ ﻭﲝﺮﻳﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺗﻨﲔ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺴﺒﻮﻙ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﺳﲑﺗﻪ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻬﺪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺪﺍﻭﻧﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺎﺩ ﻭﺻﻔﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﺪﺍﻭﻧﻴﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﳏﻨﻜﺎ‬
‫ﳎﺮﺑﺎ ﺫﺍ ﺃﻳﺪ ﻭﻗﻮﺓ ﻭﻣﻌﺮﻓﺔ ﺑﺎﻷﻣﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻇﻬﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺭﺩ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﰲ‬
‫ﺃﻟﻄﺎﻓﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺑﻐﺮﰊ ﻣﻨﻒ ﺑﻴﺘﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﺰﻫﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺘﺒﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻭﻛﺴﺎﻩ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ‬
‫ﻛﺒﲑﺍﹰ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﺟﻨﺎﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻭﺭﺩ ﻣﻮﺷﺤﺎ ﺑﺬﻫﺐ ﻳﱪﻕ ﻣﺴﻮﺭﺍ ﺑﺴﻮﺍﺭﻱ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﳍﺎ ﺿﻔﲑﺗﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺭﺟﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺧﻠﺨﺎﻻﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻛﺎﻟﻴﺎﻗﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻌﻼﻥ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻗﻀﻴﺐ ﻣﺮﺟﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺸﲑ ﺑﺴﺒﺎﺑﺘﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﳌﺴﻠﻤﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺣﺬﺍﺀﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﺑﻘﺮﺓ ﺫﺍﺕ ﻗﺮﻧﲔ ﻭﺿﺮﻋﲔ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺃﲪﺮ ﳑﻮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻣﻮﺷﺤﺔ ﲝﺠﺮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻭﺭﺩ ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺓ ﳏﺎﺫ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺻﻨﻢ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻼﻁ ﺍﻷﺟﺴﺎﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ‬
‫ﺭﺧﺎﻡ ﳎﺰﻉ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﺑﻘﻮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻳﺴﺘﺸﻔﻰ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺩﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺵ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﲝﺸﻴﺸﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﺗﻨﺎﻟﻮﻫﺎ‬
‫ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺮﺍﺳﻲ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺭﺃﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻀﺄﻥ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ‬

‫‪116‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻟﻄﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﻀﺮﻩ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻭﻳﻄﻮﻑ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻓﺮﺵ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﻭﺳﺘﺮﻩ ﻋﻦ ﳝﲔ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﺮﺓ ﻭﴰﺎﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﺟﻞ ﺭﺍﻛﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﺱ ﻟﻪ ﺟﻨﺎﺣﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺣﺮﺑﺔ ﺳﻨﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺇﻧﺴﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻠﻖ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻘﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺯﻣﺎﻥ ﲞﺖ ﻧﺼﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻫﺪﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﺑﺪﺍﻭﻧﺲ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺣﻔﺮ ﺧﻠﻴﺞ ﲞﺎﺭﻯ ﻓﺎﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﰲ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺍﻟﻒ ﻭﲬﺴﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻒ ﺍﻟﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺼﺪﻩ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﻏﺎﺯﻳﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻊ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻘﻴﻪ ﻭﻫﺰﻣﻪ ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻓﻠﺴﻄﲔ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﺒﺎ ﺧﻠﻘﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺒﺎ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺣﻜﻤﺎﺋﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻬﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻃﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﰲ ﺍﺭﺿﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻻﻃﺮﺍﻑ‬
‫ﻓﻌﺎﺛﻮﺍ ﻭﺍﻓﺴﺪﻭﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﺪ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻠﻮﻃﺲ ﻭﰲ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺃﻟﻒ ﺑﲔ ﺭﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺭﺍﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﺑﻘﺎﺋﺪ ﺁﺧﺮ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺃﺛﺮﳘﺎ ﻓﻴﻤﻦ ﺑﻘﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻘﻮﺍ ﺟﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺯﻫﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺍﻟﻒ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻮﻫﻢ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺳﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺒﻌﻬﻢ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺰﻧﺞ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻋﺪﺓ‬
‫ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺣﺶ ﻭﺳﻴﻘﺖ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺩﻩ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺴﲑﻩ ﻭﻇﻬﻮﺭﻩ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻏﺰﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﺮ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﺍﻋﺘﻞ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺗﺪﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﺧﺎﺋﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻻﻳﻌﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺟﻮﺩﺗﻪ ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻫﻠﻚ ﺩﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺟﻌﻠﺖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻃﻼﺳﻢ ﲤﻨﻊ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻬﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﳑﺎﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺩﻳﺒﺎﹰ ﻋﺎﻗﻼﹰ ﻛﺮﳝﺎﹰ ﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﳎﺮﺑﺎ ﳐﺎﻟﻔﺎ ﻷﺑﻴﻪ ﰲ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻣﻮﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﻢ ﻭﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺬﻣﻪ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺒﺒﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺫﻛﺮ‪ ،‬ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺋﻢ‪ ،‬ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﺭﺟﻼﻥ ﳍﻤﺎ ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﻓﺎﺧﺘﻄﻔﺎﻩ ﻭﺍﺣﺘﻤﻼﻩ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﻗﻔﺎﻩ ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﺷﻴﺦ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ ﺃﺑﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻠﺤﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻞ ﺗﻌﺮﻓﲏ؟ ﻓﺪﺧﻠﺘﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺭﻭﻋﺔ‬
‫ﳊﺪﺍﺛﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﻨﻪ ﻧﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﺃﻋﺮﻓﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﺎ ﺑﺸﺮ‪ ،‬ﻳﻌﲏ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻗﺪ‬

‫‪117‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﺮﻓﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺖ ﺇﻻﻫﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻚ ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺗﺪﻋﻮﱐ ﺇﳍﺎﹰ ﻓﺎﱐ ﻣﺮﺑﻮﺏ ﻣﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳍﻲ ﻭﺇﳍﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﻠﻖ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺧﻠﻘﲏ ﻭﺧﻠﻘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻓﺄﻳﻦ ﻫﻮ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﰲ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﺍﻷﻋﻠﻰ‪ ،‬ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻻ ﺗﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﺍﻟﻈﻨﻮﻥ ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﺗﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺸﺒﻬﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺟﻌﻠﻨﺎ ﺳﺒﺒﺎﹰ ﻻﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﺍﻷﺳﻔﻞ ﻭﺗﺪﺑﲑﻩ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﻛﻴﻒ ﻧﻌﻤﻞ ﺇﺫﺍﹰ ؟‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺗﻀﻤﺮ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻚ ﺭﺑﻮﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﲣﻠﺺ ﻭﺣﺪﺍﻧﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺗﻌﺘﺮﻑ ﺑﺄﺯﻟﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻠﲔ ﻓﺄﻧﺰﻻﻩ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻴﻘﻆ ﻣﺬﻋﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﺍﺷﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻓﻘﺺ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺭﺅﻳﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﻋﺎﻫﺪﺗﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺁﳍﺔ ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻻ ﺗﻀﺮ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻨﻔﻊ‪،‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﻦ ﺃﻋﺒﺪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﺃﻗﺪﺭﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺩ ﻧﻔﻮﺱ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻋﻤﺎﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺍﻋﻘﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻧﻴﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﻠﺺ ﺿﻤﲑﻙ ﻭﺻﻒ‬
‫ﺑﻪ ﻗﻠﺒﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻏﺒﺖ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻴﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺮﺩﺕ ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻡ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻈﺎﻫﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺟﺪﻭﺩﻙ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺒﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺍﻋﺘﻘﺪﻩ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﻟﻠﻬﻴﻜﻞ ﻭﻳﺴﺠﺪ ﻟﻠﺼﻨﻢ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﺤﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺑﻘﻠﺒﻪ ﻣﺒﻐﻀﺎﹰ ﻟﻪ ﻛﺎﻓﺮﺍﹰ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻀﻤﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺳﺠﻮﺩﻩ ﷲ ﻋﺰ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻞ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻐﺰﻭﺍﺕ ﻭﻣﻮﺍﻻﺓ ﺍﻷﺳﻔﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻻﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻟﺘﻄﻮﻝ ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻳﺒﻌﺪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺃﻳﺪﻩ ﲟﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻼﺋﻜﺔ ﻳﻌﻀﺪﻩ ﻭﻳﺮﺷﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﰲ ﻧﻮﻣﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﲟﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻣﻌﺮﻓﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﺎﲣﺎﺫ ﻛﻞ ﺟﺎﺩﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﻴﻞ ﻭﻛﻞ ﺟﻴﺪ ﻭﲨﻴﻞ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﲣﺬ ﰲ ﲝﺮ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺎﺋﱵ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻘﻴﻪ ﲨﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺃﻓﺮﻳﻘﻴﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺄﺻﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻻ ﳝﺮ ﺑﺄﻣﺔ ﺇﻻ ﺃﺑﺎﺩﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻏﺰﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻓﺮﻳﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺸﺪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﳛﺎﺭﺑﻪ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﹰ ﰒ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺻﻠﺤﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﺪﻯ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻭﺩﻋﺎ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﳌﺘﺼﻠﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﻓﺄﻃﺎﻋﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺮ ﺑﺄﻣﺔ‬
‫ﳍﺎ ﺣﻮﺍﻓﺮ ﻭﳍﻢ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﺻﻐﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺷﻌﻮﺭ ﻛﺸﻌﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺬﺋﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳍﻢ ﺃﻧﻴﺎﺏ ﺩ ﻟﻒ ﺑﺎﺭﺯﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﺗﻠﻮﻫﻢ‬
‫ﻗﺘﺎﻻﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺛﺨﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻏﲑﺍﻥ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻈﻠﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﻜﻦ ﳍﻢ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺍﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ ﺳﻨﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﲰﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺏ ﻣﺪﻥ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﺣﻴﺚ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﳉﺄﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﳉﺒﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﻓﺘﻠﻘﺎﻩ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﺼﻨﻮﻑ ﺍﻟﻠﻬﻮ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺷﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﻣﻮﻓﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺍﹰ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻓﺴﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﺑﺘﻬﺞ ﻭﻛﻤﻞ ﻓﺮﺣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪﻩ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻓﻬﺎﺑﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﳍﺪﺍﻳﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻠﻐﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﳍﻢ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﲞﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻳﻀﻠﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺎﻳﻴﻞ ﻭﻫﻢ ﰲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﳍﻢ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﳍﺎ ﻗﺮﻣﻮﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻣﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺳﻄﺎ‪.‬‬

‫‪118‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ ﺃﺫﺍﻫﻢ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﺰﺍﻫﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺳﺘﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻭﺳﺤﺮﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻃﻤﺴﻮﺍ ﻣﻴﺎﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻋﻄﺸﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺪ ﳍﻢ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺍﻝ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﰒ ﺻﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻏﲑ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻭﻻ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺮ ‪‬ﻢ ‪‬ﻴﻜﻞ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳛﻀﺮﻭﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻴﺎﺩﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ‪‬ﺪﻣﻪ ﻓﻬﺪﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻘﻂ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﳑﻦ ﺗﻮﱃ ﻫﺪﻣﻪ ﻓﺎﻫﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺗﺮﻛﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻴﻜﻠﻬﻢ ﻓﺒﻨﻮﻩ ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺤﻮﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻓﺴﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺣﺮﺳﻮﻩ‬
‫ﺑﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ ﳏﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻗﺒﺘﻪ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺻﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺻﻴﺎﺣﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻜﺮﺍﹰ ﻳﺮﻋﺐ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻛﻞ ﺫﻱ ﺭﻭﺡ ﻭﻳﺒﻬﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺟﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﻴﺼﻄﻠﻤﻮﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻠﻜﺘﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﺬﻕ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺤﺮ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﻧﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﺍﻓﺴﺎﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺃﻳﺬﺍﺀ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻧﻌﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺃﻧﺖ ﺍﻗﺪﺭﻣﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻠﻲ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻴﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻌﻤﻠﺖ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺩﻭﻳﺔ ﺳﺤﺮﺕ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺩﻓﻌﺘﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻀﻮﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ ﰲ‬
‫ﺣﻘﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺆﺧﺬ ﻓﻴﻄﺮﺣﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻐﺮﻕ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻗﻄﺎﺭ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻴﺚ‬
‫ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻔﺮﻗﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﻠﻴﻞ ﻏﺒﺎﺭ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﰲ ﻏﲑ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻌﻬﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻃﻮﻳﻼﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺰﺍﺭﻋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪ‬
‫ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ ﻭﻏﻼ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺜﺮ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺳﻴﺢ ﻭﺍﻟﻀﻔﺎﺩﻉ ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻧﺒﺜﺖ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺜﻌﺎﺑﲔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺭﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺧﱪﻭﱐ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﻮﺍﺩﺙ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺣﺪﺛﺖ ﰲ ﺑﻼﺩﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺬﻛﺮﻭﻩ‬
‫ﰲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻟﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺿﻌﺘﻤﻮﻩ ﳍﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻨﺎ ﻧﺘﺄﻫﺐ ﳍﺎ‪ .‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﲝﺜﻮﺍ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﺃ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻭﺗﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳌﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻋﻤﻠﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﻟﻘﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﻗﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺟﻬﺪﻭﺍ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻜﻢ ﰲ ﻫﻼﻛﻬﺎ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺑﻠﻐﺖ ﻓﻴﻜﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺫﺍﺋﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳍﻴﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﻜﻨﻪ ﺍﳋﻼﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﺴﻰ‬
‫ﻟﺒﺲ ﻣﺴﺤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺵ ﺭﻣﺎﺩﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﻣﺼﻼﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺪﻋﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻻﺑﺘﻬﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻀﺮﻉ ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‪:‬‬
‫ﻳﺎ ﺭﺏ ﺃﻧﺖ ﺇﻟﻪ ﺍﻵﳍﺔ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺎﻟﻖ ﺍﻟﻜﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺷﻲﺀ ﳑﺎ ﺩﻕ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺄﻣﺮﻙ ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﺃﺳﺄﻟﻚ ﲜﻤﻴﻊ ﻓﻀﺎﺋﻠﻚ ﻭﺁﻳﺎﺗﻚ ﻭﺃﲰﺎﺋﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻔﻴﻨﺎ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻏﻠﺒﺘﻪ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﺎﻡ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻛﺄﻥ ﺁﺗﻴﺎﹰ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺣﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻀﺮﻋﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺿﻤﲑﻙ ﻭﺃﺟﺎﺏ ﺩﻋﻮﺗﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻬﻠﻚ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﻭﻣﺪﻣﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭﻑ ﻋﻨﻚ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ‬

‫‪119‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳌﻀﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻷﻣﺮﺍﺽ ﺍﳌﻬﻠﻜﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻏﺪﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻩ ﺣﻀﻮﺭ ﻫﻴﻜﻠﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻗﺪ ﻛﻔﻴﺘﻢ ﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﻋﺪﻭﻛﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺯﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﻀﺮﺓ ﻋﻨﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻦ ﺗﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﺗﻜﺮﻫﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻜﺘﻮﺍ ﻭﻧﻈﺮ‬
‫ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﺎﳌﻨﻜﺮﻳﻦ ﳌﺎ ﲰﻌﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺳﺮﺭﻧﺎ ﲟﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺩﺍﻡ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﻀﻤﺮﻭﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻜﺬﻳﺐ ﻭﺍﻻﺳﺘﻬﺰﺍﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻮﻟﻮﺍ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﻘﺎﹰ ﻇﻬﺮ ﺳﺮﻳﻌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻃﻼ ﺍﺗﺴﻊ ﻟﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﻔﻆ ﰲ ﺫﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻴﺘﺒﲔ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻳﻮﻣﲔ ﺍﻧﻜﺸﻒ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻔﺴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻔﻔﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﻀﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﺻﺪﻕ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺧﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﻪ‪.‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﺍﺩﻩ ﻭﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔﺃﻥ ﳝﻀﻮﺍ ﲜﻴﺶ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺗﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﻭﺍ ﻣﻜﺮﻭﻫﺎﹰ ﻭﻻ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﺎﻧﻌﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺳﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ ﻣﻮﺗﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺮﻕ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻮﺩﺕ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺳﺎﻗﻄﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺓ ﺑﲔ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻄﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﻓﺘﺸﻮﻫﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﳚﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻏﲑ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻥ ﳐﺎﻟﻔﺎﹰ ﻟﺪﻳﻨﻬﻢ ﺑﺴﺒﺐ ﺭﺅﻳﺎ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﻰ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ؛ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﻟﻪ ﻗﻴﻤﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﳍﻢ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪﻭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺭﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻭﻟﻪ ﺟﻨﺎﺣﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻣﺼﺤﻒ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻮﻡ ﻣﺼﺮ ﰲ ﺩﻓﺘﲔ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺮﺻﻌﺘﲔ ﺑﺬﻫﺐ ﻣﻠﻮﻥ‪.‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻄﻬﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻣﺴﺒﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻀﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﻓﻊ ﻟﻸﺳﻘﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻓﺮﺳﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺑﻌﺰﺍﺋﻤﻪ ﻭﺩﺧﻨﻪ ﺑﺪﺧﻨﻪ ﻭﺭﻛﺒﻪ ﻃﺎﺭ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻵﻻﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺘﺨﺬﻭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻒ ﲪﻠﻪ ﻭﺛﻘﻞ ﲦﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺮﻭﺍ ﺑﻪ ﺩﻭﺍ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺷﻜﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻌﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺑﺘﻬﺞ‬
‫ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﲪﺪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻭﻻﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭ‪‬ﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻛﻬﻨﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﺃﺻﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺩﻭﺍﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﺴﻜﺮﺍﹰ ﻭ‪‬ﺾ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺑﺄﴰﻮﻥ ﻭﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻘﻠﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺗﺒﻘﻰ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻟﻪ ﺧﻄﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺭ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻛﺜﲑ‬
‫ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻃﻮﻳﻼﹰ ﻣﻄﻠﺒﺎﹰ ﳌﻦ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ ﺍﳌﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺸﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺧﺎﺋﺒﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺤﻀﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺨﱪﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺣﺎﺩﻳﺜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺪﺛﻪ ﺑﺄﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻣﻌﺠﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ‪:‬‬

‫‪120‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻋﺠﺐ ﻣﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻗﺼﺪ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻨﺬ ﺩﻫﺮ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﺟﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺖ ﲡﱪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺎﺀ‬
‫ﲜﻤﻮﻉ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺟﻴﻮﺵ ﻛﺜﻴﻔﺔ ﻭﲣﺎﻳﻴﻞ ﻫﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻓﺄﻏﻠﻖ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻨﺎ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺗﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻫﻘﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺳﻮﺍﺭﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﳉﺄﻭﺍ ﺃﱃ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺷﻴﻮﺧﻬﻢ ﻭﻛﻬﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﳜﻀﻌﻮﻥ ﳍﺎ ﻭﻳﺘﻀﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺄﻥ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﺃﻥ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻣﱰﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺭﺅﺳﺎﺅﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻜﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺩﻫﺎﻫﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺪﻭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺑﺮﻛﺔ‬
‫ﳍﻢ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺑﻌﻴﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻘﻌﺮ‪ ،‬ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻳﺰﻣﺰﻡ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﱴ ﻓﺎﺽ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻓﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ ﻧﺎﺭ ﺗﺘﺄﺟﺞ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻪ ﻛﺪﺍﺋﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺿﻮﺋﻬﺎ ﻓﺨﺮﺕ ﺍﳉﻤﺎﻋﺔ ﺳﺠﻮﺩﺍ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﻭﺟﻠﻠﻬﻢ ﻧﻮﺭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﻌﺰﻡ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻣﻸ ﺍﻟﱪﻛﺔ ﻭﺍﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﺣﱴ ﺻﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﰒ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻓﺴﻤﻌﻮﻩ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻗﺪ ﻛﻔﻴﻨﺎﻛﻢ ﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﻋﺪﻭﻛﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻓﺨﺬﻭﺍ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻨﺎ ﺑﺄﲨﻌﻨﺎ ﻣﺘﺨﻮﻓﲔ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺻﻠﻨﺎ ﻣﻀﺮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻧﺎﻫﻢ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﺗﺎ ﱂ‬
‫ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺬﻧﺎ ﲪﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﻝ ﻭﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﻭﺁﻟﺔ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻠﺖ ﻟﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻟﻘﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﻋﺠﺒﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺗﺒﺪﺕ ﻓﻤﺎﺗﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻫﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺍﻵﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﺃﺩﺭﻱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻏﲑ ﺃﱐ ﺃﻓﻘﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﻣﻲ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻓﺴﻤﻌﺖ ﻫﺪﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔﺇﺫ ‪‬ﺪﻡ ﺍﳊﺼﻦ ﻓﺄﺭﺩﺕ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻭﻻ ﻋﻠﻢ ﱄ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺑﺄﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻧﻜﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺿﻮﺀ ﻧﺎﺭ ﻭﺭﻭﺍﺋﺢ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻨﺖ ﺳﺎﻛﻨﺎﹰ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﺎﳋﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺧﻠﻖ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺤﺖ‬
‫ﺑﻜﺜﲑ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺴﺘﺠﺐ ﱄ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮﺕ ﺃﻓﺘﻘﺪ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﱰﻝ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﺗﻪ ﻣﻐﻠﻘﺎ ﻓﺪﺧﻠﺖ ﺑﻴﱵ ﻭﺃﻭﻗﺪﺕ ﺳﺮﺍﺟﺎ‬
‫ﺑﻨﺎﺭ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺸﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺭ ﺭﺟﺎﻻ ﻭﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺻﻐﺎﺭﺍ ﻛﺒﺎﺭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺃﺟﺪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﻴﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻗﻤﺖ ﰲ ‪‬ﺎﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻋﺐ ﺍﺑﺘﻬﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﻭﺃﺩﻋﻮ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺤﺖ ﺃﻗﻤﺖ ﺣﱴ ﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭ ﺑﺪﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺃﲰﻊ ﺻﻮﺗﺎ ﻭﻻﺣﺮﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﺖ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﺕ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﻫﺎ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻋﺎﻗﻼ ﳎﺮﺑﺎ ﻓﺎﲣﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﻭﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻭﺃﻧﻴﺴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﳑﺎﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺣﻴﺪ ﷲ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻭﺍﻻﳝﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺴﺎﻳﺲ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻼﺩﻩ ﻭﻳﺪﺍﺭﻳﻬﻢ ﻋﻤﺎ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺧﻮﻓﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﺒﲏ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻻﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ‬
‫ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﻻ ﻓﻀﺔﻭﻻ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﲞﻄﻪ ﺻﺤﻴﻔﺔ " ﻫﺬﺍ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﳑﺎﻟﻴﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺃﻋﻤﺎﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻣﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﺎﷲ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺒﺪ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺘﱪﻱﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﻋﺒﺎﺩ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻌﺚ ﻭﺍﳊﺴﺎﺏ ﻭﺍ‪‬ﺎﺯﺍﺓﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻋﺎﺵ ﺑﻜﺬﺍ ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺍﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺠﺎﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻴﺪﻥ ﲟﺎ ﺩﺍﻥ ﺑﻪ "‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺩﻓﻦ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ ﺁﺧﺮ‬
‫ﻛﻨﻮﺯﺍ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎﺍﻧﻪ ﻻ ﳜﺮﺟﻬﺎ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﱯ ﺍﳌﺒﻌﻮﺙ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻳﻌﲏ ﳏﻤﺪﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻼﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺴﺘﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﺍﻻﺣﺘﻔﺎﻅ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻫﻮ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺯﺑﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪121‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺣﻴﺎﺗﻪ ﻳﻘﺼﺪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺴﺘﺘﺮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﻭﳌﺎ ﺃﻳﻘﻦ ﺑﺎﳌﻮﺕ ﺩﻋﺎ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻓﺄﺳﺮ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺣﻴﺪ ﻭﺃﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺩﻳﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻩ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﺓ‬
‫ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻓﺪﻓﻨﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﰲ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻴﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﺧﺮﻳﺘﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﻠﺪ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻴﻨﺎ ﺳﻬﻼ ﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺭﺟﻊ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺣﻴﺪﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺭﺟﻮﻋﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺑﻨﺖ ﻛﺒﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻓﻔﺘﻨﺘﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﺕ ﺍﺑﻴﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻏﻠﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﻳﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﺘﺠﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺷﺪﺩﺕ ﰲ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﺒﻬﺎ ﺣﺒﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍ ﻓﻬﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺎﻓﺴﺪﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺷﺘﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﻬﺮﻣﺎﻧﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺃﺳﻴﻮﻁ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺓ ﻻ ﺗﻄﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲤﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻷ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻌﺸﻖ‬
‫ﺃﺧﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺍﺩﺕ ﰲ ﺳﺤﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻭﺃﻭﺣﺸﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺑﲔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﻣﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺭﻓﻀﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻒ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩﺕ ﰲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺔ ﺣﱴ ﺣﻠﻒ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻻ ﳚﺎﻭﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﻳﻐﺰﻭ ﻭﻳﺘﺼﺮﻑ ﻭﻻﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺧﱪ ﻣﻮ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻏﺰﺍ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻴﺴﻮﺭ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻛﺜﲑ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﻳﺮﺗﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻔﺘﺢ ﺑﻠﺪﺍﻧﺎ ﻭﺟﺰﺍﺋﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﱯ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮﺕ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎﰒ ﺍﻋﺘﻞ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﺧﺮﻳﺘﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺍﳌﺼﺮﻳﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺛﻼﲦﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺳﻔﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺒﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻻﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻭﲰﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻓﻤﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺎﺣﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻋﺎﺛﺖ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺒﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻻﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﺍ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﺳﲑﺗﻪ ﻭﻭﻗﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺳﺮﻧﺪﻳﺐ ﻓﺄﻭﻗﻊ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻨﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﺃﻣﻮﺍﻻ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﲪﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﻜﻴﻤﺎ ﳍﻢ ﺑﺎﺭﻋﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺟﺰﻳﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺑﲔ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﲔ ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﻃﻮﺍﻻ ﲰﺮﺍ ﳚﺮﻭﻥ ﺷﻌﻮﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ ﺍﻟﻠﻌﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻻ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺮﻑ ﻭﺷﺠﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭﺟﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻻ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﻻ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺫﻋﻨﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻻ ﻭﻫﺪﺍﻳﺎ ﻓﻘﺒﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻳﺘﻨﻘﻞ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺰﺍﺋﺮ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻏﺎﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﰲ‬
‫ﺳﻔﺮﻩ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻏﺎﳕﺎ ﻣﻮﻗﻮﺭﺍ ﻓﻮﺟﺪ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻫﻠﻜﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻗﺪ ﺃﻳﺴﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺭﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪122‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺭﺟﻮﻋﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻣﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻗﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻈﻬﻮﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎﺗﺮﻛﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﺴﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﻫﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ ﰲ ﺃﻋﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺑﲎ‬
‫ﻋﺪﺓ ﻫﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺯﻳﻨﻬﺎﻭﺣﻼﻫﺎ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﺯﻋﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻳﺪﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮﻩ ﺣﱴ ﻇﻔﺮ‬
‫ﻭﻏﻨﻢ ﻭﳒﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﲪﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻃﺒﻴﺒﺎ ﻭﺣﻜﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻼ ﻣﻊ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻤﺎ ﻛﺘﺒﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﻋﺰﺍﺋﻤﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻇﻬﺮﺍ‬
‫ﲟﺼﺮ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲪﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﻘﺮﻃﺎ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﻗﺎﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺣﻜﻴﻢ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﳜﺪﻣﻪ ﻭﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳜﱪﻫﻢ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺃﺧﺮﻳﺘﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻨﺼﺮﻓﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳍﻨﺪ ﻣﺪﺓ ﰒ ﻏﺰﺍ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻓﺄﺩﻯ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻏﺰﺍ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻓﺼﺎﳊﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻯﻬﻴﺎﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﺑﺄﺗﺎﻭﺓ ﺃﺩﻭﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺘﺮﻛﻬﻢ ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﲬﺴﺎ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺕ ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﺭﻓﻮﺩﺓ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻣﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﲟﻨﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﻣﺎﺕ ﺿﻤﺪ ﺟﺴﻤﻪ ﺑﺎﳌﻮﻣﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﳌﺮ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﻪ ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﺎﻝ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﻧﻔﻴﺲ ﻭﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺳﻼﺡ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ ﻭﻋﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﺧﻄﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﻮﺭﺕ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻭﻭﺱ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﲔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻏﺰﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﻭﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻓﺘﺤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﻏﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﺪﻭﺍ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻭﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺑﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﻣﺪﺗﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﲨﻴﻼ ﲰﺢ ﺍﻻﺧﻼﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻦ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻏﺘﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻻﺗﺒﺎﻋﻪ ﺩﻳﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻌﻘﺪ ﺗﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﺕ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﺑﺎﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﺷﻬﺮﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻦ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺒﺸﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻻﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﳛﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺇﻇﻬﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻭﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻜﺜﺮ ﺟﻮﺍﺋﺰﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﻓﺨﺰﻥ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻻ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺻﻒ ﻛﺜﺮﺓ‪ .‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻇﻬﺮ ﺻﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻴﻤﻴﺎﺀ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻜﺘﻮﻣﺔ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻄﺮﺡ ﺍﳌﺜﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﺎﻃﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﺜﲑﺓ ﻓﻴﺼﻨﻌﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﺫﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺫﻫﺒﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ ﺭﺃﻭﺍ ﻛﺘﻢ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﺌﻼ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺮﻙ‬
‫ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻴﻤﻴﺎﺀ ﻭﻣﻸ ﺩﻭﺭ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻗﻂ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻨﻪ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻻﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﻻﻧﻪ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﺣﻜﺎﻩ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻐﻨﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺇﺛﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻟﻘﻠﺔ ﺣﺎﺟﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﳌﺴﺒﻮﻛﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻨﺸﻒ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ‬
‫ﻛﺜﲑﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺷﻔﺎﻓﺔ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﲑﻭﺯﺝ ﻭﺍﻟﻴﺸﻢ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲢﻜﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﻉ ﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ ﺣﱴ ﲰﺘﻪ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﺣﻜﻴﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻠﺐ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﰲ‬

‫‪123‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﻠﻤﻬﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳜﱪﻫﻢ ﲟﺎ ﻳﻐﻴﺐ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺨﺎﻓﻮﻩ ﻭﺍﺣﺘﺎﺟﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳕﺮﻭﺩ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳌﺎ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺘﻪ ﻭﺳﺤﺮﻩ ﺍﺳﺘﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍ‬
‫ﻣﺸﻮﻩ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﺳﻜﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺁﺗﺎﻩ ﻗﻮﺓ ﻭﺑﻄﺸﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﳌﺎ‬
‫ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺳﺘﺰﺍﺭﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﻘﺎﻩ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻭﺣﺸﻤﻪ‬
‫ﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﺬﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﻟﻠﻮﻋﺪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺍﻓﺮﺍﺱ‪ ،‬ﺫﻭﺍﺕ ﺍﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﲢﻤﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺣﺎﻁ ﺑﻪ ﻧﻮﺭ ﻛﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﺣﻮﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺻﻨﻮﻑ ﻫﺎﺋﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﺘﻮﺷﺢ ﺑﺘﻨﲔ ﻣﺘﺤﺰﻡ ﺑﺒﻌﻀﻪ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻓﻐﺮ ﻓﺎﻩ ﻭﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻗﻀﻴﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺱ‬
‫ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻓﻜﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﲔ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺿﺮﺑﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﻀﻴﺐ ﻓﺄﻣﺎﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﻫﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﻣﻌﻈﻤﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻌﺘﺮﻓﺎ ﲜﻠﻴﻞ ﺣﻜﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﻇﻬﲑﺍ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺳﻌﻒ ﺭﻏﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰒ ﺍﻓﺘﺮﻗﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻥ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻭﳚﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻟﻮﻥ ﺍﻳﻀﺎ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﳍﺮﻡ ﻣﺪﺓ‬
‫ﰲ ﻗﺒﺔ ﺗﻠﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻃﻤﻌﺖ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻩ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺳﺎﺩﻭﻡ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻦ ﳓﻮ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﻫﻴﺖ ﻟﻴﻜﺒﺲ ﺃﺭﺽ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮ‪ .‬ﻓﺎﻗﺒﻞ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻐﻬﻢ ﰒ ﺟﻠﻠﻬﻢ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺤﺮﻩ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﻤﺎﻡ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﳊﺮﺍﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﲢﺘﻪ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻭﻥ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻬﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﲑﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻫﻮ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺘﻴﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﲟﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻟﻴﻌﺮﻓﻮﺍ ﺧﱪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﻫﻢ ﻗﺪ ﻣﺎﺗﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻘﻠﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻔﻮﻩ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﺟﺪﺍ‪ .‬ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻫﺎﺑﺘﻪ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻫﻴﺒﺔ ﱂ ﻳﻬﺎﺑﻮﻫﺎﻷﺣﺪ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭﻭﺍ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﰲ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﻫﻴﻜﻼ ﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﺍﻥ ﺃﺳﻮﺝ ﰲ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻴﺪﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻪ‬
‫ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺣﻜﻢ ﻭﻋﻘﺎﻗﲑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻴﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻭﺻﻰ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻣﺎﻟﻴﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺷﺮﻳﺒﺎ ﻛﺜﲑ ﺍﻷﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻔﺮﺩﺍ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻓﺎﻫﻴﺔ ﻏﲑ ﻧﺎﻇﺮ ﰲ ﺷﻲﺀ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺇﱃ ﻭﺯﻳﺮ ﻟﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻪ ﺻﺎﳊﺔ ﳍﻴﺒﺔ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻛﻠﻜﻠﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﺪﻣﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﳝﺖ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﻟﻴﻨﺘﻈﺮ ﻣﺎ ﲡﺮﻱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺎﻟﻴﺎ ﻣﻌﺠﺒﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ ﳏﺒﺎ ﻟﻠﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﻣﻌﺎﺷﺮ‪‬ﻦ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺃﻣﺮﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﲣﺬ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﺎﻗﻠﺔ ﺳﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﻓﺤﻤﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻌﺠﺒﺎ ﻭﳍﺎ ﳏﺒﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻨﻮﻥ ﻭﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻛﱪ ﺑﻨﻴﻪ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺠﻬﻞ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﺮﺫﻝ ﺳﲑﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﰲ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ‪،‬‬

‫‪124‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﲪﻠﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻣﻪ ﻭﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﺯﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﻓﻬﺠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﰲ ﺭﻭﺍﻗﻪ ﺳﻜﺮﺍﻥ ﻭﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻮﱃ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﺒﺎﺭﺍ ﺟﺮﻳﺌﺎ ﺷﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﺄﺱ ﻣﻬﻴﺒﺎ ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺷﺮﺍﻑ ﻓﻬﻨﺄﻭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻋﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﻗﺒﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺼﺎﳊﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﻙ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻌﻨﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻭﻋﺪﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺴﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻭﳍﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺬﺍﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﺄﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﻜﺮﻭﻩ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺤﻮﺍ ﺻﻠﺒﻪ ﻟﻠﻤﺮﺃﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻌﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﻧﺰﳍﺎ ﻭﺩﻓﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻒ ﺑﺄﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺧﱪ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﻥ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﳌﺎ ﻫﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﻔﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻟﺌﻼ ﻳﻠﺤﻘﻪ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻓﲑﺩﻭﻧﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻤﺮﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺍﻕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻣﺮﺍﺗﻪ ﻭﺧﻠﻒ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺍﺧﻴﻪ ﻟﻮﻃﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﲨﻞ‬
‫ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﱂ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻭﺭﺙ ﺣﻮﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺴﻨﻬﺎ ﻷ‪‬ﺎﺟﺪﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻼ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳊﺮﺱ ﺍﳌﻘﻴﻤﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺣﺴﻦ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻋﺠﺒﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﻭﺭﻓﻌﻮﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﱂ ﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﲨﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﺃﻛﻤﻞ ﺣﺴﻨﺎ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺯﻳﺮﻩ ﻓﺎﺣﻀﺮ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻭﺑﻠﺪﻩ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻨﻚ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﺧﱵ‬
‫ﻓﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺣﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺭﺍﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺼﻌﺐ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ‬
‫ﳝﻜﻨﻪ ﳐﺎﻟﻔﺘﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻻ ﻳﺴﻮﺀﻩ ﰲ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﺴﺎﺭﺓ ﺳﲑﻱ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺪﻃﻠﺒﻚ ﻟﲑﺍﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻣﺮﺅ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺼﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻨﻊ ﰊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺭﺁﱐ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻭﺇﱐ ﻟﻔﺎﺯﻋﺔ ﻣﻨﻪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺭﺟﻮ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﱐ ﲞﲑ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻘﺎﻣﺖ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺩﺧﻼ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻧﻈﺮ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻈﺮ ﺭﺍﻋﻪ ﻭﺃﻓﺘﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﺧﺮﺍﺝ‬
‫ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻭﻧﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺇﳕﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﻭﻗﻊ ﰲ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﻊ ﰲ ﻗﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲤﲎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺪﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﺍﻟﻠﻬﻢ ﻻ ﺗﻔﻀﺢ‬
‫ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﰲ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﺸﻒ ﺍﷲ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺍﳊﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﺣﱴ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻛﺎﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻴﻖ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﰲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺭﺁﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﺍﻭﺩﻫﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺬﻫﺐ ﻟﻴﻤﺪ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻧﻚ ﺇﻥ ﻭﺿﻌﺖ ﻳﺪﻙ ﻋﻠﻲ‬
‫ﺃﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﻧﻔﺴﻚ ﻷﻥ ﱄ ﺭﺑﺎ ﳝﻨﻌﲏ ﻣﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻠﺘﻔﺖ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﳍﺎ ﻭﻣﺪ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺠﻔﺖ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺩﻭ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻘﻲ‬
‫ﺣﺎﺋﺮﺍ‪.‬‬

‫‪125‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺯﻭﱄ ﻋﲏ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺻﺎﺑﲏ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻻ ﺃﻗﺪﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺸﺎﺀ ﺭﰊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺿﻤﻨﺖ ﺍﻥ ﻻ ﺗﻌﺎﻭﺩ‬
‫ﺩﻋﻮﺗﻪ ﻓﻌﺴﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺰﻳﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺑﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻟﺴﺖ ﺃﻋﻮﺩﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻓﺄﺫﻫﺐ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻪ‪.‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﺛﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﺤﺔ ﺭﺍﻭﺩﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻨﺎﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻌﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻋﺮﻓﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ ﻟﻚ ﰒ ﻣﺪ ﻳﺪﻩ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺠﻔﺖ ﻭﺍﺿﻄﺮﺑﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻀﺎﺅﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻐﺎﺙ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺃﻗﺴﻢ ﺑﺂﳍﺘﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺃﺯﺍﻟﺖ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺎﻭﺩﻫﺎ ﻓﺪﻋﺖ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ‪ ،‬ﻓﺰﺍﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻨﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﺇﻥ ﻟﻚ ﺭﺑﺎ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻀﻴﻌﻚ ﻭﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﻗﺪﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﳍﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﻮ ﺯﻭﺟﻲ ﻭﻗﺮﻳﱯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺫﻛﺮﺃﻧﻚ ﺃﺧﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺻﺪﻕ ﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﺧﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻳﻨﻨﺎ ﻓﻬﻮ ﺃﺥ ﻟﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻧﻌﻢ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺩﻳﻨﻜﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﻬﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﺘﻪ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻤﺎﻝ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﻛﺒﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻟﻘﻰ ﺍﷲ ﳏﺒﺔ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﰲ ﻗﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﻛﺮﻣﺘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻋﻈﻤﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺿﺎﻓﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺣﺴﻨﺖ ﺿﻴﺎﻓﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻫﺒﺖ ﳍﺎ ﻣﺎﻻ ﻭﺟﻮﺍﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺭﺩﻳﻪ ﻓﻼ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺩﺗﻪ ﻓﺬﻛﺮﺕ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻷﺑﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﻟﻘﻮﻡ ﻛﺮﺍﻡ ﻭﺑﻨﻴﺔ‬
‫ﻃﺎﻫﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺘﺤﻴﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺑﺮﻫﺎ ﺑﻜﻞ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻘﺒﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻫﺒﺖ ﳍﺎ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻗﺒﻄﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺰﻣﺖ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﻗﺒﻮﳍﺎ ﻓﻘﺒﻠﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﺃﻡ ﺇﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺣﻠﻮﻯ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺮ ﻭﺍﳋﺒﺰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻌﺎﻡ ﻭﻣﻸﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﻼﻻﹰ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻛﺖ ﲢﺖ ﺍﳊﻠﻮﻯ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻠﺔ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻧﻔﻴﺴﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻠﻴﺎ ﻣﺼﻮﻏﺎﹰ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺟﺎﺀ‪‬ﺎ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﻮﺩﻋﺔ ﳍﺎ‬
‫ﺩﻓﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻌﻚ ﺗﺘﺰﻭﺩﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ‪ .‬ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺷﺎﻭﺭ ﺻﺎﺣﱯ ﻓﺸﺎﻭﺭﺗﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺄﻛﻮﻻﹰ ﻓﺨﺬﻳﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺒﻠﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻭﺩﻋﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻓﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﻌﻨﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﲑ ﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻝ ﻟﻴﺄﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺃﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﻳﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺟﺪﺕ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺘﺸﺖ ﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻝ ﻭﺟﺪ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﲨﻴﻌﻪ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﺖ‬
‫ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﻋﺮﺿﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺒﺎﻉ ﺑﻌﻀﻪ ﻭﺣﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﲦﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﺌﺮ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻟﻠﺴﺒﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﻕ ﺑﻌﻀﻪ‬
‫ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻭﺍﻟﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻀﻴﻒ ﺑﻪ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺮ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺩﺧﺮﺕ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺳﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺎﺵ ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻭﺟﻬﺖ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻫﺎﺟﺮﻣﻦ ﻣﻜﺔ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﲟﻜﺎﻥ ﺟﺪﺏ ﻭﺗﺴﺘﻘﺘﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲝﻔﺮ ‪‬ﺮ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﰒ ﺑﺴﻔﺢ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺮﻓﺄ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳊﻨﻄﺔ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺘﺼﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺪﺓ ﻭﲢﻤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻄﺎﻳﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺣﻴﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﻣﺪﺓ‪.‬‬

‫‪126‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﺎﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﻭﻻﺩ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺴﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﻫﺒﺎ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮﺍ ﺗﺘﺨﺬ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺯﻳﻨﺔ ﻟﻮﻟﺪﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺤﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ ﺑﺒﻌﻀﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎﺣﻠﻴﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻌﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺮ ﺇﳕﺎ ﺃﻫﺪﺍﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﺎﻟﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻟﻜﺜﺮﺓ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﲪﻠﻪ ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺯ ﲰﺘﻪ ﻫﺎﺟﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﺩﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻳﺴﻤﻴﻪ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ ﺳﺄﻝ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﺎﺭﻙ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﱪﻛﺔ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ ﺳﻴﻤﻠﻜﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻳﺼﲑ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻗﺮﻧﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻗﺮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻃﻮﻃﻴﺲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ ﺣﱴ ﰲ ﻗﺮﺍﺑﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺑﲏ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻭﺧﺪﻣﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻧﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﰲ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺮﻳﺼﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻔﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﺣﺮﻳﺼﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺮﺯﻕ ﻏﲑ ﺍﺑﻨﺘﻪ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻋﺎﻗﻠﺔ‬
‫ﺣﻜﻴﻤﺔﺗﺄﺧﺬ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻭﲤﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻔﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻣﺎﺀ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻨﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺎﻓﻪ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻓﺎﺑﻐﻀﺘﻪ ﺍﺑﻨﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺑﻐﻀﻪ ﺍﳋﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺧﺎﻓﺖ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺑﺴﺒﺒﻪ ﻓﺴﻤﺘﻪ ﻓﻬﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺘﻠﻔﻮﺍ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﻠﻴﻚ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﳍﻮﺍ ﻟﻦ ﳝﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩﻭﺍ ﲤﻠﻴﻚ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﺭﺍﺀ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻤﺘﻢ ﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﺑﻨﺘﻪ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻨﻜﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺑﻴﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺃﻓﻌﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺻﻨﻌﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺭﺍﺣﺖ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺄﻳﻦ ﺗﺬﻫﺒﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ؟ ﻭﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﺎﺭ ﻓﺘﻢ ﳍﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺖ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﻬﻨﺄﻭﻫﺎ ﻭﺩﻋﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻛﺮﻣﺘﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻭﻭﻋﺪ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺧﺬﺕ ﰲ ﲨﻊ ﺍﻻﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﰲ ﺣﻔﻈﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻠﺒﺚ ﺇﻻ ﻳﺴﲑﺍﹰ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻵﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳊﻠﻰ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ ﻣﺎ ﱂ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺒﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪﻣﺖ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺭﺅﺳﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻌﺖ ﺍﻗﺪﺍﺭﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﺘﺠﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺇﻋﻈﺎﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﱂ ﻳﺮﺿﻬﺎ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﺿﻰ ﺑﻔﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻳﺸﻴﻊ ﺧﱪﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺐ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻘﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﺗﺎﺟﺎﹰ ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﻋﻤﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻔﺬﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺟﻴﺸﺎ ﲢﺎﺭﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻃﺎﻗﺔ ﻟﻪ ‪‬ﺎ ﺩﻋﺎﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ ﻭﺧﻄﺒﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻻ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻮﻓﻬﺎ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﺑﺴﺒﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﻜﺎ‪‬ﺎﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﻤﻠﺖ ﺻﻨﻴﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺍﻥ ﳛﻀﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻓﺤﻀﺮﻭﺍ ﻭﺍﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻭﺑﺬﻟﺖ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺮﻓﺘﻬﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺟﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻄﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﺒﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺻﻮﺏ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻧﻮﱄ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎ‬
‫ﻏﲑﻫﺎ ﳌﻌﺮﻓﺘﻨﺎ ﺑﻌﻘﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻓﻀﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻭﺍﺭﺛﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪127‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻭﺛﺒﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺮ ﳑﻦ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﻬﻢ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻘﻮﺍ ﺟﻴﺶ ﺍﳋﺎﺭﺝ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﺑﺮﻳﺖ‬
‫ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻮﺍ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺮﺏ ﻫﻮ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻌﺎﻧﻴﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻋﻤﻼﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺠﺎﺭ‬
‫ﲟﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻩ ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻏﺒﻪ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺧﺬﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻤﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺠﻬﺰﻩ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﲜﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻛﻠﻬﻢ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻭﺟﻬﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻓﻔﺘﺤﺖ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺃﺑﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻓﺮﻗﺖ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻓﺎﺣﺒﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺫﻋﻨﻮﺍ‬
‫ﳍﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﻗﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺑﺎﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﻭﻋﺪ‪‬ﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺴﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﲜﻴﻮﺵ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻤﻼﹰ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻘﺪﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ‬
‫ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﺟﻠﻴﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻈﻤﺎﺀ ﻗﻮﺍﺩ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺟﲑﻭﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻧﺰﻝ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﻌﺜﺖ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻇﺌﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻘﻼﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﺪ ﺟﲑﻭﻥ ﺳﺮﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﺗﻌﺮﻓﻪ‬
‫ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﺍﻏﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺗﺰﻭﳚﻬﺎ ﺇﻳﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻻ‪‬ﺎ ﻻ ﲣﺘﺎﺭ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻥ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﻛﻴﻔﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ ﺗﺰﻭﺟﺘﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﻠﻤﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﻨﻌﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﻏﺐ ﺟﲑﻭﻥ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺡ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﰲ ﻣﻀﺮﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺴﺐ ﻋﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻛﺮﺍﻣﻪ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﺳﻢ ﻓﺄﻛﻠﻪ ﻓﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﻨﺠﺰﻫﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻭﻋﺪﺗﻪ ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻻﳚﻮﺯ ﱄ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺗﺰﻭﺟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﰲ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ ﻗﻮﺗﻚ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺘﻚ ﻭﺗﺒﲏ ﱄ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻓﺘﺨﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﺣﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﻭﺇﻗﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﻏﺮﰊ ﺑﻠﺪﻧﺎ ﻓﺜﻢ ﻟﻨﺎ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻓﺎﻗﺘﻒ‬
‫ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻵﺛﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﻏﲑﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺣﻴﺚ ﺃﻣﺮﺗﻪ ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﺼﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﺗﺪﻋﻰ ﺃﻧﺪﻭﻣﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ‪‬ﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻏﺮﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﺻﻔﺤﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻔﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺧﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﳌﺴﺒﻮﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺑﺪﻉ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻷ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﻣﺪﺗﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﺼﻨﺎﻉ ﻭﺑﺎﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻜﺎﺗﺐ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ ﲟﺎ ﺗﺮﺍﻩ ﻭ‪‬ﺎﺩﻳﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻌﻠﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻋﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻥ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺣﺼﻴﻨﺔ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻷﻭﺍﺋﻠﻨﺎ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﺑﺖ‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺏ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻈﺮ ﰲ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻬﺎ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺡ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺗﻘﻦ ﺍﻣﻮﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﻧﺎ‬
‫ﺧﻼﻝ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻨﻴﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻓﺮﻏﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺻﻼﺡ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﻧﻔﺬ‬
‫ﺇﱄ ﺣﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﻓﺄﺳﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ ﻷﺑﻌﺪ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﱵ ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﱐ ﺃﻛﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻀﻰ ﺣﻴﺚ ﺍﻣﺮﺗﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ‪ ‬ﰲ ﺍﺻﻼﺡ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻣﺮﺗﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻀﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﻻ ﻳﻌﺮﻓﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺧﱪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺼﺪ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺩﻣﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻼﻗﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺛﺎﱐ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ‪.‬‬

‫‪128‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺳﺒﺐ ﻗﺼﺪﻩ ﳍﺎ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻋﺘﻞ ﻋﻠﺔ ﻃﺎﻟﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺛﻘﺎﺗﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ ﻭﺍﱃ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻟﻴﺤﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻴﺎﻫﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻳﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻼﺋﻢ ﺟﺴﻤﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﺎﺗﻰ ﻏﻼﻡ ﻟﻪ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﺳﻌﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﻓﻮﺍﺋﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺃﻟﻄﺎﻓﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺎﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺄﻋﻠﻤﻪ ﲝﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﺟﻠﻰ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺋﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺒﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ ﺣﱴ ﺣﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﺗﺐ ﺍﳌﻠﻜﺔ ﻭﺧﻄﺒﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﻓﻮﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺷﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺣﺎﻟﻪ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻗﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻻﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﲝﺮ‪‬ﻢ؛ ﻓﺎﺟﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺘﺰﻭﻳﺢ ﻭﺷﺮﻃﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲏ ﳍﺎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺍﻧﺰﺍﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺷﻘﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻟﻴﺒﲏ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺑﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﺄﻥ ﻳﻠﻘﻰ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ ﻭﺃﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ ﻓﻤﻀﻰ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﺑﺖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﺮﻭﺝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻨﻘﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺎﺭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻣﻌﺎﳌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺿﻊ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﺑﻌﺜﺖ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻌﻠﺔﻭﺍﳋﺪﻡ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﺑﻨﻴﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﻔﻖ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﺿﻊ‬
‫ﻃﻮﻝ ﻳﻮﻣﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﰲ ﺍﻻﺳﺎﺱ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻘﻠﻌﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺑﺘﻪ ﻭﻏﲑﺗﻪ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﰲ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺩﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻓﺎﻏﺘﻢ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻏﻤﺎﹰ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺍﹰ ﻭﺷﻐﻠﻪ ﺍﻟﻔﻜﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﺃﻧﻔﺬﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻒ ﻟﺒﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﻟﻴﺸﺮﺏ ﻟﺒﻨﻬﺎﻭﻳﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﻪ ﰲ ﻣﻄﺒﺨﻪ ﻓﺪﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺭﺍﻉ ﻳﺜﻖ ﺑﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﻳﻄﻮﻑ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻳﺮﻋﺎﻫﺎ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻫﻨﺎﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺫﺍ ﺭﺟﻊ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‬
‫ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺣﺴﻨﺎﺀ ﻓﺘﺘﻮﻕ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻛﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﺷﺮﻃﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺼﺎﺭﻋﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺻﺮﻋﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺇﻥ‬
‫ﺻﺮﻋﺘﻪ ﺃﺧﺬﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻓﻴﺤﻤﻠﻪ ﺣﺒﻪ ﳍﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﻤﻊ ﰲ ﻏﻠﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﺼﺮﻋﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻄﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪﺓ ﻧﻘﺼﺖ ﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﳓﻮ ﻧﺼﻔﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻐﲑﺕ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﻗﻴﺎﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﺸﻐﻠﻪ ﲝﺐ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻻﻫﺘﻤﺎﻡ ﺑﺮﻋﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻐﲑ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﺃﻳﻀﺎﹰ ﰲ ﺟﺴﻤﻪ ﻭﻟﻮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻻﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﻣﺘﻐﲑﺍﹰ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﻋﺠﺎﻓﺎ ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻗﻠﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻘﺼﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺻﻒ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺧﻮﻑ ﺳﻄﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻱ ﻭﻗﺖ ﲣﺮﺝ ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﺒﺲ ﻫﻮ ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﱃ ﻫﻮ‬
‫ﺑﻨﻔﺴﻪ ﺭﻋﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﳌﻌﺰ ﻳﻮﻣﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻓﻌﺎﺭﺿﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺸﺮﻃﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﺮﻃﻬﺎ ﻓﺄﺟﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﺼﺎﺭﻋﺎ ﺻﺮﻋﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺒﺾ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎﻭﺷﺪ‬
‫ﻭﺛﺎﻗﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺬﻱ ﻓﺴﻠﻤﲏ ﺇﱃ ﺻﺎﺣﱯ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﺃﻟﻄﻒ ﰊ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﺬﺑﺘﻪ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻃﻮﻳﻼﹰ ﻓﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺧﻠﻮﺕ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺴﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻨﻴﺘﻪ ﻓﻴﺰﺍﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻴﻠﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ؟‬
‫ﻓﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺴﻠﻬﺎ ﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺩﻓﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺣﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻪ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺳﺎﳍﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻛﻞ ﻟﻴﻠﺔ ﻓﺘﱰﻉ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻧﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻓﻬﻞ ﰲ ﺩﻓﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪129‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺣﻴﻠﺔ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻧﻌﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻫﻲ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﺃﻋﻠﻤﻚ ﻛﻼﻣﺎ ﺗﻜﺘﺒﻪ ﰲ ﻗﺮﺍﻃﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﺑﻄﻪ ﰲ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺻﻐﺎﺭ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﺼﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﰲ ﻣﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺻﻐﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻃﻴﺲ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﻘﺎﺱ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻠﻘﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺮﻣﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻃﻴﺲ ﺍﳌﻜﺘﻮﺑﺔ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﳝﻴﻨﺎﹰ ﻭﴰﺎﻻﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳝﻜﺜﻮﻥ ﺳﺎﻋﺔ ﻓﻼ ﺗﺒﻘﻰ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﺃﺗﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻭﺩﺍﺭﺕ ﻭﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺼﻮﺭ ﺍﳌﺼﻮﺭﻭﻥ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﻃﻴﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺤﺮﻭﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺸﺒﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﻭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﺜﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﺎﻭﻳﺮ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻦ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳜﺮﺟﻮﻥ ﻭﲤﺜﻞ ﺃﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺮ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﺗﻨﺼﺐ ﺍﻣﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻥ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﻭﺭﺃﺕ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺷﻜﺎﻝ ﻫﺮﺑﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﻌﺪ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﻭﻋﻠﻤﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺣﻔﻈﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﺎﺡ ﺇﱃ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺍﳋﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﺐ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﻧﻘﻄﻌﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﰎ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﲎ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﲤﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻛﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺇﻥ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﳌﻌﺰ‬
‫ﻫﻮ ﺟﲑﻭﻥ ﺍﳌﺆﺗﻔﻜﻲ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺼﺪﻫﻢ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺃﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻓﻘﻬﺮﻫﻢ ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻣﻊ ﺟﲑﻭﻥ ﻧﻔﺬﺕ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺴﺄﻝ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻋﻦ ﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﳍﺎ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﻥ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺧﺮﺑﺖ ﻣﻠﻌﺒﺎ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺘﺪﻳﺮﺍ‪ ،‬ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﺻﻔﺮ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺮﺏ ﻟﻜﻞ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎﺛﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﲰﻴﻨﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻟﻄﺦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﲢﺘﻪ ﺑﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﻭﲞﺮﻩ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻧﺒﻪ ﻭﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺗﺔ ﻗﺮﻧﻪ ﻭﺃﻇﻼﻓﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻗﺮﺑﺎﻧﻚ‬
‫ﻓﺎﻃﻠﻖ ﱄ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻙ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺍﻧﺖ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻘﺲ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻬﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﺘﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺜﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ ﻭﺍﺣﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﻜﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻣﺘﻼﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﺎﻣﺔ ﺯﺣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﲬﺴﲔ‬
‫ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻼﻃﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻓﺄﻟﻄﺨﻬﺎ ﲟﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ ﻭﺃﻗﻠﻌﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﲡﺪ ﲢﺘﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﺗﱰﻝ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺳﺮﺩﺍﺏ ﻃﻮﻟﻪ‬
‫ﲬﺴﻮﻥ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻘﻔﻞ ﻭﻣﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻘﻔﻞ ﲢﺖ ﻋﺘﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺬﻩ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺦ ﺍﻟﻘﻔﻞ ﺑﺒﻘﻴﺔ ﻣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺜﻮﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺩﻣﻪ ﻭﲞﺮﻩ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻩ ﻭﺑﻨﺤﺎﺗﺔ ﺃﻇﻼﻓﻪ ﻭﻗﺮﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﺩﺧﻠﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻮﺛﻖ ﺭﺗﺎﺟﻪ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻠﺘﻪ ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﺗﺮﻯ‬
‫ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺒﻠﻚ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﰲ ﻋﻨﻘﻪ ﻟﻮﺡ ﺻﻐﲑ ﻣﻌﻠﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ ﻣﻜﺘﻮﺏ ﻓﻴﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻭﺫﺧﲑﺓ ﻭﺩﻭﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺬ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺷﺌﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﻓﻌﻞ ﺑﻜﻞ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﻭﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﲡﺪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﻧﺔ ﺳﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﻧﻮﺍﻭﻳﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﻋﻲ ﻟﺼﺎﺣﺒﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﺘﻪ ﺍﳉﺎﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﻭﺭﺍﹰ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺎﹰ ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﺃﺳﺮﻉ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﺪ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﻭﺻﻔﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻓﺄﰎ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﲝﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻓﺎﺳﺎﺀﻫﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﺭﺍﺩﺕ ﺇﺗﻌﺎﺑﻪ ﻭﺇﺷﻐﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﺇﺫﻫﺎﺏ ﻣﺎﻟﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪130‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﻳﺐ ﺩﺭﺝ ﺫﻫﺐ ﳐﺘﻮﻡ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻜﺤﻠﺔ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺫﺭﻭﺭ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻋﺮﻕ‬
‫ﺟﻮﻫﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺍﻛﺘﺤﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﺭﻭﺭ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﺷﻴﺐ ﻋﺎﺩ ﺷﺎﺑﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﻮﺩ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﻭﳊﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﺿﺎﺀ ﺑﺼﺮﻩ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻳﺪﺭﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﺪ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻏﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺳﺌﻞ ﻋﻦ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺏ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﺔ‬
‫ﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻋﺠﻮﺑﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻬﺎ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﳛﺜﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﻭﻡ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻳﺘﺸﻜﻰ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺍﻷﻣﺪ ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﻘﺎﺀ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻷﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺮﺷﺎ ﻓﺎﺧﺮﺍ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﻓﺮﺷﻪ ﰲ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﲡﻠﺲ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻗﺴﻢ ﺟﻴﺸﻚ‬
‫ﺃﺛﻼﺛﺎ ﻓﺄﻧﻔﺬ ﺍﱄ ﺛﻠﺜﻪ ﻓﺄﻧﺎ ﻣﺎﺷﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻭﺻﻮﻟﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻱ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻭﺻﻠﺖ ﻣﺴﺎﻓﺔ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎ ﻋﻴﻨﺘﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺎﻧﻔﺬ‬
‫ﺇﱄ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺚ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺑﻠﻐﺖ ﺛﻠﺜﻲ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻔﺬ ﺇﱄ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺚ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﻟﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﲨﻠﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻲ ﻟﺌﻼ ﻳﺮﺍﱐ ﺃﺣﺪ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﻻ ﺻﺒﻴﺔ ﳜﺪﻣﻮﻧﻚ ﳑﻦ ﺗﺜﻖ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﱐ ﺃﻭﺍﻓﻴﻚ ﰲ ﺟﻮﺍﺭ ﺗﻜﻨﻔﻚ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺧﺪﻣﻨﺎ ﻻ ﺍﺣﺘﺸﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﲢﻤﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﺍﻻﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻣﺴﲑﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺛﻠﺚ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﺖ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻃﻌﻤﺔ ﻭﺍﻻﺷﺮﺑﺔ ﺍﳌﺴﻤﻮﻣﺔ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﳊﺎﺟﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﺷﻐﻠﺘﻬﻢ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺭﻱ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﻟﺪﺍﻥ ﺑﺎﻻﻃﻌﻤﺔ ﻭﺍﻻﺷﺮﺑﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺼﺒﺢ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺃﺣﺪ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺣﻴﺎﹰ ﻗﺘﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﻛﻠﺖ ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﻮﺷﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻬﺖ ﺍﱃ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻕ ﻭﳛﺮﺳﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺣﱴ ﻻ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺧﱪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺧﺬﺕ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎﺧﻠﻔﻮﻩ ﻭﻧﻘﻠﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭﺕ ﻓﻠﻘﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺚ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻓﻔﻌﻠﺖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻛﺘﺒﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺗﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺃ‪‬ﺎﻭﺟﻬﺖ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﳑﻠﻜﺘﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺕ ﻟﻴﺤﻔﻈﻮﻫﺎ ﺧﻼﻝ ﻛﻮ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺚ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻨﺪﻩ ﻓﺠﺮﻯ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﳎﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﺜﻠﺜﲔ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﲔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻭﺻﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻋﺴﻜﺮ‬
‫ﳎﺮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﺛﻘﺎﺕ ﺭﺟﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﺃﻋﻴﺎﻥ ﺟﻴﺸﻬﺎ ﻭﻓﺮﺳﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺸﻌﺮ ﺇﻻ ﻭﻫﻢ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺣﺎﻃﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻨﺎﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻫﻲ ﻭﻇﺌﺮﻫﺎﻭﺟﻮﺍﺭﻳﻬﺎ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻓﻨﻔﺨﺖ ﻇﺌﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻧﻔﺨﺔ ﺫﻫﺐ ‪‬ﺎ ﻟﺒﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺭﺷﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﺭﺗﻌﺒﺖ ﻣﻔﺎﺻﻠﻪ ﻭﺧﺬﻟﺖ ﻗﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻣﻦ ﻇﻦ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﻐﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻓﻘﺪ ﻛﺬﺑﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻠﺒﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻓﺼﺪﺕ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻋﺮﻭﻗﻪ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻣﻪ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺩﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺷﻔﺎﺀ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﺕ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﻓﻮﺟﻬﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻧﺼﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲪﻠﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻨﺖ ﻣﻨﺎﺭ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﻭﺯﺑﺮﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﲰﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﲰﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﺘﻪ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺎﺭﻳﺦ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭ‪.‬‬

‫‪131‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﺘﺰﺍﲪﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻼﺩﻫﺎ ﻓﻬﺎﺑﻮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺫﻋﻨﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ ﻭﻫﺎﺩﻭﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺼﻨﻌﻮﺍ ﳍﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﲎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ ﺣﺼﻦ ﻭﻗﻨﻄﺮﺓ ﳚﺮﻱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﻋﺘﻠﺖ ﺣﻮﺭﻳﺎ ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻮﻫﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﻠﺪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﺗﺮﺿﺎﻩ ﻟﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻜﻢ ﰲ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﺑﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﻠﺪﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﻋﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻠﻜﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﻣﺎﻣﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺟﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻋﺬﺭﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻘﻼﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻭﻛﱪﺍﺋﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﺬﺕ ﳍﺎ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﺛﻴﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮﻭﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺑﻼﺩﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺴﻠﻤﻮﻫﺎ ﻟﻌﺪﻭ ﻭﺃﻥ ﳝﻨﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻳﺘﻌﺮﺽ‬
‫ﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻠﻤﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻃﻠﻌﺘﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯ ﺁﺑﺎﺋﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻣﺎﺗﺖ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻀﻤﺪ‬
‫ﺟﺴﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻓﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﲢﻤﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﳍﺎ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺑﻨﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻋﺠﻴﺒﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻧﻘﻠﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﻜﻮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﺯﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﺑﺄﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﻭﺳﺪﻧﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻨﺖ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﻜﻨﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﺟﻴﺸﺎﹰ ﳛﻤﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻌﻤﺮﺕ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﺎ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺧﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﲞﺖ ﻧﺼﺮ ﻭﲪﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻠﺴﺖ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﺄﻟﻔﺖ ﻛﻠﻤﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﺣﺴﻨﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻭﻭﺿﻌﺖ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﳝﻦ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﻳﻄﻠﺐ ﺛﺄﺭ ﺧﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻨﺼﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﲟﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﻓﻨﺼﺮﻩ ﳌﻜﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﲜﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻗﻮﺍﺩﻫﺎ ﻓﺎﻟﺘﻘﻮﺍ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ‬
‫ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﺮﻳﺶ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﺳﺤﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻳﻘﲔ ﻳﻈﻬﺮﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻔﺰﻉ‬
‫ﺍﻷﲰﺎﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺆﱂ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻗﻔﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺏ ﰒ ﻳﺘﺮﺍﺟﻌﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﺎﱂ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰒ ﺍ‪‬ﺰﻡ‬
‫ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ ﻭﺃﳝﻦ ﰲ ﺃﺛﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻀﺖ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﰲ ﲨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﺸﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﱰﻟﺖ ﺑﺄﴰﻮﻥ ﻭﺃﻧﻔﺬﺕ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻗﻌﺖ ﺍﳊﺮﺏ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﲜﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻮﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺿﻌﻒ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻟﻜﺜﺮ‪‬ﻢ ﻭﺷﺪﺓ ﺻﱪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻨﺼﺮﺕ ﺑﺄﻫﻞ ﻣﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﻓﺤﺎﺭﺑﻮﺍ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ‬
‫ﺃﳝﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺯﺍﻟﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻇﻔﺮﻭﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻋﺎﺛﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﺰﻣﻮﻫﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺭﻛﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻋﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺳﺎﺣﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻗﻔﻂ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻇﻬﺮ ﺳﺤﺮﻩ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﺃﺣﺎﻟﺖ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ‬
‫ﻓﺎﳓﺎﺯﻭﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﻭﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﻠﺐ‪.‬‬

‫‪132‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻓﺰﻉ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻟﻄﻮﻝ ﺍﳌﺪﺓ ﻭﻋﺠﺰ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻘﺎﺗﻠﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺷﻔﻘﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻬﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺳﻔﺮﺍﺀ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻗﺴﻤﺎﹰ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺏ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻥ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﺟﺎﺑﺘﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ ﻏﺪﺭﺕ ﻭﺧﺎﻟﻔﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺟﺖ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻓﻔﺮﻗﺘﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻻﻣﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺼﻠﺢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺟﻌﺖ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳊﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺷﺘﺪ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻳﻘﲔ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﺷﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻇﻬﺮ‪.‬ﺃﳝﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﺰﻣﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳉﺄﺕ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻗﻮﺹ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺧﻠﻔﻬﺎ ﻭﲤﻜﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﺕ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻭﻧﻜﻮﻝ ﺟﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﻋﺠﺰ‬
‫ﻛﻬﻨﺘﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﺤﺮ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﳍﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻐﻠﺐ ﲰﺖ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﻠﻜﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﺃﳝﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻻﻧﺪﻟﺲ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﻋﺘﺎ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﳑﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻳﻦ ﺩﻭﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻼﻗﻲ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻳﺘﻨﻘﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻳﻐﻠﺐ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﺎ ﻟﻴﺴﻜﻦ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻏﺮﺿﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻌﺘﺪﻝ ﺣﺎﻝ ﺟﺴﻤﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﻠﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺧﱪ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺟﻼﻟﺔ ﻗﺪﺭﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻭﺑﺎﺩ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻏﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻟﻪ ﻳﺴﻤﻰ ﻋﻮﻧﺎ ﲜﻴﺶ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺻﻞ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺃﳝﻦ ﻭﺩﻟﻴﻔﺔ ﻳﻘﺘﺘﻼﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﺘﺤﻬﺎ ﻭﺣﻮﻯ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﺎ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﺎﺏ ﺧﱪﻩ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺸﻚ ﰲ ﻫﻼﻛﻪ ﻭﻫﻼﻙ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻃﻼﺳﻢ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﻜﺮ ﻛﻬﻨﺘﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻥ ﻋﺒﺪﻩ ﻗﺪ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺗﻠﻘﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺒﺪ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﺇﳕﺎ ﺃﺧﺮﻩ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ ﻓﻘﺒﻞ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺩﻭﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﻲ ﻭﻣﻠﻜﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺒﺎﺡ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﺧﺬ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺘﺒﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻨﻮﺯﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﳝﻦ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﻭﻣﺪ‪‬ﺎ ﺳﺎﻣﻌﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺇﺫ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺴﻜﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﺎﻧﻪ ﲟﻠﻜﻪ ﻭﺟﻴﺸﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺧﺬ ﺑﺜﺄﺭ ﺧﺎﻟﻪ ﺍﻧﺪﺍﺣﺲ ﻭﰎ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻟﻠﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻈﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺳﻨﺢ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻥ ﳝﺸﻲ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻘﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳐﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻐﺰﻭ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺣﻴﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻣﻢ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﺪ‬
‫ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺍﺻﻠﺢ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺣﺘﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﻋﺒﺪﻩ ﻋﻮﻧﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺪﺩ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﺮ ﺑﺄﻣﺔ ﺇﻻ ﺃﺑﺎﺩﻫﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮﻩ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﻭﺟﺎﻭﺯﻫﻢ ﻭﻣﺮﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﺪ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻗﻀﺒﺎﻥ ﺛﺎﺑﺘﺔ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﻼﺩ ﻋﺎﻧﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﱂ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻳﺴﲑ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭﺍﻟﱵ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﺒﻞ ﺷﺎﻣﺦ ﻋﺮﻳﺾ ﻃﻮﻳﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﲰﻲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻷﻥ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻻ ﻳﻄﻠﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻷﻧﻪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺧﻂ‬

‫‪133‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻛﻴﻒ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻓﻴﻤﺮ ﰲ ﻃﺮﺍﺋﻖ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻛﺎﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﺼﲑ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺣﻈﲑﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺼﲑ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺣﻈﲑﺓﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺣﻈﲑﺓ ‪‬ﺮ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺣﻈﲑﺓ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮﺍﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺧﻂ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻻﻗﻠﻴﻢ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺔ ‪‬ﺮ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻮﺯ ﺧﻂ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ ﻭﳚﺮﻱ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﳝﺪﻩ ‪‬ﺮ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻜﺮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻳﺼﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻭﻝ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻣﻌﻈﻢ ﰲ ﺛﻠﺚ ﺍﻻﻗﻠﻴﻢ ﺍﻷﻭﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺬﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻫﺬﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮﻳﻦ ﻳﺰﻳﺪﺍﻥ ﻭﻳﻨﻘﺼﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺳﻴﺢ ﻭﲰﻚ ﻛﺄﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﲰﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻪ ‪‬ﺮ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻘﺮﺑﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻭﺟﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﻤﺎﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﻫﺮﻣﺲ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺩﺷﲑ ﺍﻻﻭﻝ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻔﻄﻮﱘ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﺮﺍﱘ ﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﲬﺲ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﻮﻥ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺟﺎﻣﻌﺔ ﳌﻦ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﲟﻌﺎﻗﺪ ﻭﲟﺼﺎﺏ ﻣﺪﺑﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﳚﺮﻱ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻠﻮﻗﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻴﺎﺱ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻡ ﻭﺍﺫﺭﻉ ﻣﻌﺪﻭﺩﺓ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﰲ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺍ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺘﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﻠﻨﺎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﻴﺤﺔ ﺍﳉﺎﻣﻌﺔ‬
‫ﻟﻠﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻫﻨﺪﺱ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﻭﺭﺗﺐ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭﺍًﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻣﺎ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺻﻼﺡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﱵ ﳝﺮ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻨﻔﻊ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺴﺎﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻄﺢ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺴﻄﺢ ﲦﺎﻧﻴﺔﻋﺸﺮ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺬﺭﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﺫﺭﻋﻬﺎ ﻣﻘﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺃﺻﺒﻌﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻓﻀﻞ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﺪﻝ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻦ ﳝﲔ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﻳﺴﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺴﺎﺭﺏ‬
‫ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﳝﲔ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻭﻳﺴﺎﺭﻩ ﺗﻨﺼﺐ ﺇﱃ ﻏﻴﺎﺽ ﻭﺭﻣﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻋﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪ ﺫﻛﺮ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﺍﻻﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﺔ ﰲ ﺍﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺳﻴﺤﺎﻥ ﻭﺟﻴﺤﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻥ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ ﺃﺣﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺴﻞ ﻭﺃﻃﻴﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺍﺋﺤﺔ ﺍﳌﺴﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳑﻦ ﺟﺎﺀ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺻﺎﱀ ﻛﺎﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺚ ﻭﻏﲑﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﶈﺪﺛﲔ ﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺺ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﺇﺳﺤﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻭﺻﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻪ ﺧﱪ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳋﱪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﺃﺛﺒﺘﻪ ﻫﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻫﻮ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ ﻻﻧﻪ ﲟﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻤﺔ ﺭﻭﺍﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺒﻐﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻔﻘﻴﻪ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺍﳊﺴﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ ﺑﻦ ﺳﺮﺣﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳛﺪﺙ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻵﻥ ﻋﻦ ﺷﻴﻮﺧﻪ ﺑﺒﻐﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﺄﺳﺎﻧﻴﺪ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻋﻦ‬
‫ﺃﰊ ﻫﺮﻳﺮﺓ ﺭﺿﻲ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ‪ :‬ﲰﻌﺖ ﺭﺳﻮﻝ ﺍﷲ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﻟﻮ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺴﺘﻢ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺣﲔ ﳝﺞ ﻟﻮﺟﺪﰎ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﻗﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﺣﺪﺛﲏ ﺃﺑﻮ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﺃﲪﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺭﻭﺡ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺣﺪﺛﲏ ﻋﻠﻲ ﺑﻦ ﺩﺍﻭﺩ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺣﺪﺛﻨﺎ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﷲ ﺑﻦ ﺻﺎﱀ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺣﺪﺛﲏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺚ ﺑﻦ ﺳﻌﺪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺯﻋﻤﻮﺍ ﻭﺍﷲ ﺍﻋﻠﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺺ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ ﺃﰊ ﺳﺎﻟﻮﻡ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪134‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺺ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺳﺤﻖ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﻢ ﺣﱴ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻧﻴﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺄﰐ ﺑﻪ ﺟﻌﻞ ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻔﺎﺭﻕ ﺳﺎﺣﻠﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺒﻠﻎ ﻣﻨﺘﻬﺎﻩ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺣﻴﺚ ﳜﺮﺝ ﺃﻭ ﳝﻮﺕ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫‪-‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﰲ ﻋﱪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﲬﺲ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻭﲬﺲ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻛﺬﺍ‪ -‬ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﲝﺮ ﻓﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻣﻘﺒﻼ ﻓﺼﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺎﺣﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﺫﺍ ﻫﻮ ﺑﺮﺟﻞ ﻗﺎﺋﻢ ﻳﺼﻠﻲ ﲢﺖ ﺷﺠﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺗﻔﺎﺡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻩ ﺍﺳﺘﺄﻧﺲ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻧﺖ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﺃﰊ ﺳﺎﻟﻮﻡ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺺ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺳﺤﺎﻕ ﺑﻦ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﻧﺖ ﺃﺻﻠﺤﻚ ﺍﷲ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺟﺎﺀ‬
‫ﺑﻚ ﻫﺎﻫﻨﺎ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻴﺖ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺃﻭﺣﻰ ﺇﱄ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻗﻒ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺣﱴ ﻳﺄﰐ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮﻩ؟ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺃﺧﱪﱐ ﻳﺎ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺧﱪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻞ ﺑﻠﻐﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺍﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺁﺩﻡ‬
‫ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻪ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺑﻠﻐﲏ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﺺ ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺃﻇﻨﻪ ﻏﲑﻙ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻳﺎ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻛﻴﻒ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻟﺴﺖ ﺃﺧﱪﻙ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﲡﻌﻞ ﱄ ﻣﺎ ﺳﺄﻟﺘﻚ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺎ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﺟﻌﺖ ﺇﱄ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺣﻲ ﺃﻗﻤﺖ ﻋﻨﺪﻱ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻳﻮﺣﻰ ﺇﱄ ﺑﺄﻣﺮﻙ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﻮﻓﺎﱐ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻓﺘﺪﻓﻨﲏ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻲ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﺮ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﻧﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﻧﻚ ﺗﺼﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﺗﺮﻯ ﺃﻭﳍﺎﻭﻻ ﺗﺮﻯ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻼ ﻳﻬﻮﻟﻨﻚ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﻛﺒﻬﺎ ﻓﺈ‪‬ﺎ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ‪ ،‬ﺇﺫﺍ ﻃﻠﻌﺖ ﺍﻫﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﺘﻠﺘﻘﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﳛﻮﻝ ﺑﻴﺘﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺣﺠﺒﺘﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻏﺮﺑﺖ ﺃﻫﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻟﺘﻠﺘﻘﻤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍﺭﻛﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻓﺴﺮ ﺭﺍﺟﻌﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻓﺎﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺈﻧﻚ ﺳﺘﱰﻝ ﻭﺗﺒﻠﻎ ﺃﺭﺿﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻳﺪ ﺟﺒﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺳﻬﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺟﺰ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻀﺔ ﺟﺒﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﺃﺷﺠﺎﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﺳﻬﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺟﺰ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻗﻌﺖ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺟﺒﺎﳍﺎ ﻭﺳﻬﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻨﺘﻬﻲ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻋﻠﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺳﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻭﺷﺮﻓﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﻨﺤﺪﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻳﺴﺘﻘﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻔﺮﻕ ﻓﻴﺨﺮﺝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﺍﻻﺭﺑﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﻣﺎ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﻓﻴﻔﻴﺾ ﰲ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻳﺸﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺸﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺮﺍﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻫﻮﻯ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺭ ﻟﻴﺼﻌﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺎﻩ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻳﺎﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻚ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﱰﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﱐ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻚ ﻟﻦ ﺗﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻳﺎﺣﺎﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻱ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺭﺍﻩ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻔﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺷﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻰ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﱐ ﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺭﻛﺒﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﺩﻭﺭ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺭﻛﺒﻪ ﰲ ﺩﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺇﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺮﻛﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺇﻧﻪ‬

‫‪135‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺳﻴﺄﺗﻴﻚ ﺭﺯﻗﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻓﻼ ﺗﺆﺛﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻓﺎﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻟﺸﺊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺆﺛﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﺊ ﻓﺈﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻘﻴﺖ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺒﻴﻨﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺇﺫ ﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﻘﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﻟﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻟﻠﺆﻟﺆ‬
‫ﺍﻻﺑﻴﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻮﻥ ﻛﺎﻟﻴﺎﻗﻮﺕ ﺍﻻﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻳﺎﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻋﻠﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺜﻼﺛﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺗﻔﻴﺾ ﰲ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﱐ ﺳﻴﺤﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺚ ﺟﻴﺤﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺑﺔ ﻓﺮﻛﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻫﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻟﻠﻐﺮﻭﺏ ﻗﺬﻓﺖ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺭﻛﺒﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻗﺒﻞ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻩ ﻗﺪ ﻣﺎﺕ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﱪﻩ ﺛﻼﺛﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﺷﻴﺦ ﻣﺘﺸﺒﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻏﺮ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻜﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﰒ ﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻓﺴﻠﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻠﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ؟ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ ﻫﻜﺬﺍ ﳒﺪﻩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻜﺘﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺎﺡ ﻗﺪ ﻇﻬﺮ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺷﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻏﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺦ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳊﺎﻳﺪ ﺃﻻ ﺗﺄﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻣﻌﻲ ﺭﺯﻗﻲ ﻗﺪ ﺃﻋﻄﻴﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻭ‪‬ﻴﺖ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﺃﺅﺛﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺻﺪﻗﺖ ﻳﺎ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ‬
‫ﻟﺸﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺆﺛﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻞ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻔﺎﺡ؟ ﻭﺇﳕﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺸﺠﺮﺓ‬
‫ﺃﺧﺮﺟﻬﺎ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﻟﻴﻌﻴﺶ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻓﺎﻧﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻵﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﺇﻻ ﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻮ ﻭﻟﻴﺖ ﻟﺮﻓﻌﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺰﻝ ﺑﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺍﺧﺬ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺗﻔﺎﺣﺔ ﻓﺒﻌﻀﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﺾ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺗﻌﺮﻓﻪ؟‬
‫ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺃﺑﺎﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﻣﺎ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻟﻮ ﺳﻠﻤﺖ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﻘﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻣﻌﻚ‪ ،‬ﻷﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻨﻔﺬ‬
‫ﻓﻬﻮ ﺍﻵﻥ ﳎﻬﻮﺩﻙ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳎﻬﻮﺩﻩ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻠﻐﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﺣﺎﻳﺪ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺄﺧﱪﻫﻢ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﳋﱪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺕ‬
‫ﺭﲪﻪ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻭﰎ ﺍﳋﱪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﺛﺒﺘﻪ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻼﻡ ﺍﱃ ﺣﻴﺚ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﻊ‪.‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺗﻨﻘﺴﻢ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﻗﺴﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﻟﺴﺎﻧﺎﹰ‪.‬ﻟﻸﻣﻢ ﺍﳌﺬﻛﻮﺭﺓ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺁﺧﺮﻭﻥ ﺇﳕﺎ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺛﻠﻮﺝ ﺗﱰﻝ ﰲ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺘﻜﺎﺛﻒ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻓﺘﺤﻤﻠﻬﺎ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺑﻠﻄﻒ ﻭﻣﺮﺓ ﺑﻘﻮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺴﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﻩ‬
‫ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺴﻘﻲ ﳌﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺍﷲ ﺟﻞ ﻭﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺪﺑﲑ ﺧﻠﻘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﳌﺎ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺟﺒﻼﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﳊﻴﻠﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺻﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻟﲑﻯ ﻣﺎ ﺧﻠﻔﻪ‬
‫ﻓﺄﺷﺮﻑ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﻟﺰﻓﱵ ﺍﻟﻨﱳ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻛﺎﻟﻸ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﺎﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﺭﻭﺍﺋﺢ ﻣﻨﺘﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻫﻠﻚ ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﺄﺳﺮﻉ ﺑﺎﻟﱰﻭﻝ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻥ ﻛﺎﺩ ﻳﻬﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺮ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﴰﺴﺎﹰ ﻭﻻ ﻗﻤﺮﺍﹰ ﺍﻻ ﻧﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻛﻨﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻏﺮﻭ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺪﺓ ﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻥ ﻋﻮﻧﺎ ﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﲡﱪ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺴﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺩﻋﻰ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺩﻋﻰ ﺍﻧﻪ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‪،‬‬

‫‪136‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺍﻧﻪ ﺃﺧﻮﻩ ﻭﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﻭﺭﻳﺐ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺳﲎ ﺟﻮﺍﺋﺰ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﳝﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﳏﺎ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻭﺛﻘﻮﺍ ﺑﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﻧﻜﺤﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻣﺎﻻﹰ ﺇﻻ ﺃﺧﺬﻩ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﻜﺮﻡ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﳝﺴﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﺷﻔﺎﻗﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﺃﻃﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻙ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺘﺴﻤﻰ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ؟ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻤﺖ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻞ‬
‫ﺍﺳﺘﺤﻖ ﺍﻟﻘﺘﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻜﺤﺖ ﺇﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﺕ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﺑﻐﲑ ﻭﺍﺟﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻘﺪﻭﺭ ﻓﻤﻠﺌﺖ‬
‫ﺯﻓﺘﺎﹰ ﰒ ﻏﻠﻴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﺃﲪﻴﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﻳﻐﻤﺴﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻏﻠﻴﺖ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﱰﻉ ﺛﻴﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﻰ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‬
‫ﻋﻘﺎﺏ ﻓﺎﺧﺘﻄﻔﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﻭﻋﻠﻖ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻪ ﰲ ﻫﻮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺟﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺃﺱ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﻭﺍﺩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﲪﺄﺓ ﻣﻨﺘﻨﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻣﺬﻋﻮﺭﺍ ﻃﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﲤﻠﻜﻪ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺧﻄﺮﺕ ﺑﻘﻠﺒﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺧﻄﺮﺓ‬
‫ﻳﻜﺎﺩ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﻭﻝ ﻓﺮﻗﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﳌﺎ ﻳﻌﻠﻤﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻈﺎﻇﺘﻪ ﻭﺑﻄﺸﻪ ﻭﻗﻮﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﺩ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻳﻮﻗﻦ ‪‬ﻼﻛﻪ ﻟﻄﻮﻝ ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ ﻭﺍﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺮﺓ ﳜﺎﻑ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺣﻲ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺸﻚ‬
‫ﰲ ﺣﻴﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺿﻤﺮ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ ﺍﳍﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﰲ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻃﻠﻊ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﳑﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺜﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺃﻣﻮﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﱐ ﺧﺎﺋﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﺰﻣﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳍﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻛﻢ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﳓﻦ ﳓﻤﻴﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺗﻘﺒﻞ ﻣﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻟﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻧﻌﻤﻞ ﻋﻘﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﻭﺗﻌﺒﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﻠﺼﻚ ﻣﻨﻪ ﰲ ﻧﻮﻣﻚ ﻫﻮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻣﻨﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺗﻪ ﻓﺘﻌﺒﺪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻋﻮﻥ ﺃﺷﻬﺪ ﻟﻘﺪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﱄ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺃﲰﻊ‪ :‬ﺍﻋﺮﻑ ﱄ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻘﺎﻡ ﻭﻻ ﺗﻨﺴﻪ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻘﺪ ﺑﻴﻨﺎ ﳓﻦ ﻟﻚ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﻤﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻋﻘﺎﺑﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻴﻨﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻮﻫﺮﺗﲔ ﻣﻮﺷﺤﺘﲔ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻴﻜﻼﹰ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﰲ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺧﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺳﺘﻮﺭ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﺪﻣﺘﻪ‬
‫ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺨﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺮﺑﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻄﻖ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻋﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺎﺩﺗﻪ ﻭﺩﻋﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﱃ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺄﺟﺎﺑﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻣﻀﺖ‬
‫ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﺪﺓ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﺑﺒﻨﺎﺀ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﳛﻮﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﺮﺯﺍﹰ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﻌﻘﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﻞ ﻓﺎﻋﻞ‬
‫ﲟﺼﺮ ﺃﻥ ﳚﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺃﻥ ﳜﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺻﺤﺎﺭﻯ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻭﻳﻄﻠﺒﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﺭﺿﺎ ﺣﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻮﺍﺀ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﺧﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﲔ ﻓﺠﻮﺝ ﺻﻌﺒﺔ ﻭﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻋﺮﻭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻮﺧﻰ ﺍﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻐﺎﺹ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻐﻴﺾ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻮﻡ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻐﻴﻀﺎً ﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺃﺻﻠﺤﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﳕﺎ‬
‫ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﻋﻮﻥ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻐﻴﺾ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﻟﻴﺠﺮﻱ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻳﻄﻮﻓﻮﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪،‬‬

‫‪137‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺷﻬﺮﺍﹰ ﺣﱴ ﻭﺟﺪﻭﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺑﻐﻴﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺒﻖ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻓﺎﻋﻞ ﻭﻻ ﻣﻬﻨﺪﺱ ﳑﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻔﺘﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﺨﻮﺭ‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﻄﻌﻬﺎ ﻭﻳﻌﻤﻞ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﳑﺎ ﻳﺼﻠﺢ ﻟﻠﺒﻨﻴﺎﻥ ﺇﻻ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻔﺬ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﻔﺬ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﲨﻴﻊ‬
‫ﺍﻵﻻﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﺗﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺰﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﺷﻬﺮﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﻇﺎﻫﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺿﺤﺔ ﰲ ﺻﺤﺮﺍﺀ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻠﻒ ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﱵ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻫﺎ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻄﺎﻟﺐ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺑﻨﻴﺔ ﻣﺸﻬﻮﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻜﺎﻣﻞ ﳍﻢ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻭﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﳓﺘﻬﺎ ﺃﻋﺪﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻄﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﻩ‬
‫ﻓﺮﺳﺨﲔ ﰲ ﻣﺜﻠﻬﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻔﺮﻭﺍ ﰲ ﻭﺳﻄﻬﺎ ﺑﺌﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺒﺌﺮ ﲤﺜﺎﻻﹰ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺧﱰﻳﺮ ﻭﳓﺎﺳﺔ‬
‫ﺑﺄﺧﻼﻁ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺑﻄﺎﻟﻊ ﺯﺣﻞ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻘﺎﻣﺘﻪ ﻭﺳﻼﻣﺘﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺘﻀﺎﺩﻳﻦ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻓﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺧﱰﻳﺮﺍﹰ ﻓﺬﲝﻮﻩ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﻄﺨﻮﺍ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺑﺪﻣﻪ ﻭﲞﺮﻭﻩ ﺑﺸﻌﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬﻭﺍ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﻋﻈﺎﻣﻪ ﻭﳊﻤﻪ ﻭﺩﻣﻪ‬
‫ﻭﻣﺮﺍﺭﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺟﻮﻑ ﺧﱰﻳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﻭﻧﻘﺸﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﺯﺣﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺷﻘﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺌﺮ ﺃﺧﺪﻭﺩﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺷﻮﺍﺭﻉ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺷﺎﺭﻉ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﺒﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺻﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﳌﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﺍﳊﺴﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻄﺮﻗﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺣﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻮﻫﻬﺎ ﻣﻘﺎﺑﻠﺔ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﺑﻮﺍﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﺃﺳﺎﺱ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﺳﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺍﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻮﻗﻪ ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﻮﻕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻜﻞ ﺍﺑﻴﺾ ﺷﻔﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﻣﺜﻘﺒﺔ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺻﺎﺹ ﺍﳌﺼﺒﻮﺏ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻗﻠﻮ‪‬ﺎﺃﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻔﺔ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻃﻮﻝ ﺣﺼﻨﻬﺎ ﺳﺘﲔ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎﹰ ﻭﻧﺼﻒ ﺫﺭﺍﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺑﺎﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺑﻮﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳊﺼﻦ ﲤﺜﺎﻝ ﻋﻘﺎﺏ‬
‫ﻛﺒﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻔﺮ ﻭﺃﺧﻼﻁ‪ ،‬ﺃﺟﻮﻑ ﻧﺎﺷﺮ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺣﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻓﺎﺭﺱ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﺣﺮﺑﺔ‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﻕ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻳﻨﺤﺪﺭ ﰲ ﺻﺒﻴﺐ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮﻱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺑﻄﺎﺋﺢ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﰊ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺎﱄ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺮﺏ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺒﺎﻥ ﻋﻘﺒﺎﻧﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﺍ ﻭﻟﻄﺨﻬﺎ ﺑﺪﻣﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﺍﱃ ﺃﺑﻮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺡ ﺇﺫﺍ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻠﺘﻬﺎ ﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺻﻮﺍﺕ ﺷﺪﻳﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻻﻳﺴﻤﻌﻬﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﻫﺎﻟﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﻤﺪﻫﺎ ﺑﻌﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﻣﻄﻠﺴﻤﺔ ﲤﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻮﳍﺎﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻟﻪ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﰲ ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﳍﺎ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﺭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺭﻛﻦ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺷﻴﻄﺎﻥ ﻣﺸﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﻮﺩ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﺟﻬﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﺭﺑﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﲪﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﺍﳌﺨﺰﻭﻧﺔ ﲟﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻭﺟﺪ ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﻤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﻭﺍﳊﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﺍﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﻗﲑ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ ﻭﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪138‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻛﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﺋﻊ ﻭﺍﳌﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﳌﺴﺎﻛﻦ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺑﻨﺎﻫﺎ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﳜﺘﻠﻂ‬
‫ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺳﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﺭﺑﻀﺎ ﳛﻴﻂ ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻦ ﻷﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﻣﻬﻦ ﺍﳊﺮﺙ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ ﻭﻏﲑ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻘﺪﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺟﺮﺍﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻗﻨﺎﻃﺮ ﳚﻮﺯ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳋﺎﺭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﺣﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺮﺑﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﰒ ﻏﺮﺱ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺑﺄﺟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻷﺷﺠﺎﺭ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺒﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺎﺕ‬
‫ﻛﻞ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺣﺴﻨﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﺋﺪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺟﻌﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺀ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺰﺍﺭﻉ ﻟﻜﻞ ﻧﻮﻉ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺒﻮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻐﻞ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻋﻈﻢ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻔﻴﻪ ﻋﺸﺮ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲔ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻣﻨﻒ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﳜﺮﺝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻴﻘﻴﻢ ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻳﻌﻮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺃﺭﺑﻌﺔ ﺃﻋﻴﺎﺩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻳﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺏ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﻷﺭﺑﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﰎ ﻟﻌﻮﻥ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻃﻤﺄﻥ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻭﺳﻜﻨﺖ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ .‬ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻭﺍﻓﺎﻩ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻔﺬ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﺯﻭﺩﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﻟﻪ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺍﻕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﻋﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻭﺃﲤﻪ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻈﻬﺮ‪.‬ﻭﺣﻮﻝ ﲨﻴﻊ‬
‫ﻋﻴﺎﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺍﺻﻄﻔﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻨﺎﺕ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻛﱪﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﺒﻨﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺩﺧﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﲢﻮﻝ ﻫﻮ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﻓﺘﺤﺼﻦ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺧﻠﻒ ﻟﻠﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺔ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺘﻠﻘﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺷﻜﻮﺍ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻋﻮﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎﺣﻞ ‪‬ﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‪:‬ﻭﺃﻳﻦ ﻋﻮﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ‪ :‬ﻓﺮ ﻋﻨﻚ‬
‫ﻭﲢﺼﻦ ﺩﻭﻧﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﻏﺘﺎﻅ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻨﻔﺬ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻪ ﻭﺃﻣﻜﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﺎﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺻﻌﺐ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺇﻻ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻧﻈﺮ ﺷﺎﻑ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻛﺎﻑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺘﺐ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻳﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺪﻭﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﺬﺭﻩ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻠﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺇﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﻇﻔﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻳﺒﻀﻊ ﳊﻤﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﳌﺒﺎﻟﻐﺔ ﰲ ﻋﺬﺍﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺮﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻋﻮﻥ ﺟﻮﺍﺑﺎ ﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ :‬ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﲏ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ؟ ﻭﻻ ﺃﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﺒﻠﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺃﻋﺒﺚ ﰲ ﺷﻲﺀ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻪ ﻷﱐ ﻋﺒﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳉﻬﺔ ﺣﺎﻡ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﻋﺪﻭ ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺃﻗﺪﺭ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺴﲑ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﳋﻮﰲ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﻔﺴﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻴﻘﺮﱐ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﱄ ﻛﺄﺣﺪ ﻋﻤﺎﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻭﻗﺖ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻳﻠﺰﻣﲏ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻫﺪﺍﻳﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﳉﻮﺍﺏ ﻣﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﻻ ﺟﺰﻳﻠﺔ ﺟﻠﻴﻠﺔ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮﺍ ﻧﻔﻴﺴﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﻨﻊ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻒ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺒﺎﺡ ﺣﺮﳝﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺑﻐﻀﻮﻩ ﻭﺷﺘﻤﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﺭﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻻﻳﺎﻡ ﻣﺘﺼﻴﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻟﻘﺎﻩ ﻓﺮﺳﻪ ﰲ ﻫﻮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺡ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪139‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻳﻨﻜﺮ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﺿﺎﻩ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻫﻠﻚ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻪ ﻧﺎﻭﻭﺳﺎﹰ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺃﺣﺪ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻫﺮﺍﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺑﻌﺪﻩ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺗﺴﻤﻴﻪ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﲨﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻋﺎﻗﻼ ﻣﺘﻤﻜﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻨﺄﻭﻩ ﻭﺩﻋﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﻜﻠﻢ ﲜﻤﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﲎ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻭﻋﺪﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺣﺴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺃﺛﻨﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺷﻜﺮﻭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻔﺘﺢ ﺍﳋﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﻓﺮﻕ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳋﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ ﳑﻦ ﺣﻀﺮ ﳎﻠﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺷﺎﻛﺮﻳﻦ ﻟﻪ ﳏﺒﲔ ﻓﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﺣﺴﻦ‪.‬ﻭﲤﻜﻨﺖ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﺭﳛﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﺒﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺘﻪ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳌﻌﲔ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻳﺴﻤﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻻﺩ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﺭﺍﺀ ﻋﺎﻗﻼ ﻣﺘﻤﻜﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ ﺣﺼﻴﻒ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ‪ ،‬ﻛﺜﲑ ﻧﺰﺍﻫﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﻔﺲ‪ ،‬ﻣﺴﺘﻌﻤﻼﹰ ﻟﻠﻌﺪﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻼﺡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺼﺐ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﻀﺔ ﳚﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻳﻐﺪﻭ ﻭﻳﺮﻭﺡ ﺇﱃ ﺑﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﳜﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﺭﺍﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﺘﺎﺏ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﺴﲑﻩ ﻭﻋﻨﺪ‬
‫ﺭﺟﻮﻋﻪ‪.‬ﻓﻘﺎﻡ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻔﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻬﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻃﺄ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ ﻭﺃﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺳﻮﻕ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﳌﻠﻚ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻣﻨﻐﻤﺲ ﰲ ﻟﺬﺍﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻣﻌﺘﻜﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﳍﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻻ ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻔﻜﺮ ﰲ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺣﻴﻨﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻋﺎﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﻣﺪﺭ‪.‬‬
‫ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﻠﻎ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻣﺜﻘﺎﻝ ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻬﺎ ﺃﻗﺴﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﻨﺴﺎﺋﻪ ﻭﳌﺎﺋﺪﺗﻪ ﲪﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺯﺍﻕ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻼﺳﻔﺔ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺎﺋﻊ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺡ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻭﺍﳊﺮﺙ ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺮﺱ ﻭﺃﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻬﻦ ﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻀﻞ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﲪﻞ ﺍﱃ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻏﲑ ﻧﺎﻇﺮ ﰲ ﺷﺊ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻻ ﺳﺎﺋﻞ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﺘﱰﻫﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺪﺓ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺪ ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺍﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺁﺧﺮ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺵ ﻭﺍﻵﻧﻴﺔ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻴﺲ ﰲ ﻏﲑﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﲟﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﻃﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻀﻌﻔﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺼﺪﻩ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻋﺎﺑﺪ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﺳﺠﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻜﲎ ﺑﺄﰊ ﻗﺎﺑﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﻗﺎﺻﺪﺍﹰ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺣﱴ ﻧﺰﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻭﺩﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻧﻔﺬ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﺟﻴﺸﺎﹰ ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺩﻭﻧﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻫﺰﻡ ﻋﺴﻜﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ‬
‫ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻬﺪﻡ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﻧﻊ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺷﺘﺪ ﻃﻤﻌﻪ ﰲ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺟﻬﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪﻩ ﺑﺄﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺎﻋﻈﻤﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﻛﱪﻭﻩ ﻭﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺮ ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﲑﻭﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪،‬‬

‫‪140‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﺄﺗﻮﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻮﺍ ﻳﺼﻴﺤﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻐﻴﺜﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻤﻌﻬﻢ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻝ ﻋﻦ ﺣﺎﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﱪ ﺧﱪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﻲ ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻋﺎﺙ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪ ﻣﺰﺍﺭﻋﻬﺎ ﻭﻏﲑ ﻣﺼﺎﻧﻌﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺪﻡ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﻬﺎ ﻭﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻣﻘﺒﻞ ﲜﻴﻮﺷﻪ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺗﺎﻉ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﻧﻒ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺘﺒﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻏﻔﻠﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﲰﻊ ﻧﻴﺎﺡ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺭﺗﺎﻉ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﻓﻌﺮﺽ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﻲ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻓﺴﺪ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻉ ﻭﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻷﺷﺠﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﺎﺭ ﻭﺻﻠﺐ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺃﺳﺮﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻠﻐﻪ ﺃﻱ ﳌﻦ ﺟﺎﻭﺯ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻧﻪ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﳌﻮﺻﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺿﺮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﺧﺮﺍﺟﺎﹰ ﻭﺑﲎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺶ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻭﺷﺤﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻭﻣﻸ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺑﺎﳉﻨﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻫﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺰﻋﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺃﻋﻈﻤﻮﻩ ﻭﻫﺎﺩﻭﻩ‬
‫ﻭﺻﺎﳊﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺮ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺣﺸﺪ ﺟﻨﻮﺩﻩ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪ ﻟﻐﺰﻭ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﺏ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺗﺴﻌﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻟﻒ‬
‫ﻣﻘﺎﺗﻞ ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻨﺤﻰ ﻋﻦ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻞ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺬﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺬﺧﺎﺋﺮ ﻭﺻﺎﱀ ﺑﻠﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻬﺮﻩ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺒﺎﺣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺮ ﺑﺄﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ ﻓﺄﺧﺬ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺮﻳﻄﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺳﻔﻦ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺳﻮﺍﺣﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺃﺭﺿﻬﻢ ﻭﺻﺎﳊﻪ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺇﻓﺮﻳﻘﻴﺔ ﻭﻗﺮﻃﺎﺟﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﳊﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻟﻄﺎﻑ ﻭﺃﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﲪﻠﻮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﻣﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﺇﱃ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﳓﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﳝﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﲢﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻤﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻭﺗﺎﺭﻳﺦ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻔﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺿﺮﺏ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ ﺧﺮﺍﺟﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﱪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﲑﺓ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﳒﺔ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻷﻧﺪﻟﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺒﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻼﺫﺭﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺎﺭﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺻﺎﳊﻮﻩ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻫﺐ ﻛﺜﲑ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻐﺰﻭ ﺃﺣﺪﺍﹰ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ‬
‫ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺪﻭﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﰲ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﺣﻲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻨﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺍﻡ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻳﻐﺎﻟﺒﻬﻢ ﻋﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﺭﺍﺟﻌﺎﹰ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﱪ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻣﺸﺮﻗﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻼﺩ ﺍﻟﱪﺑﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﺮ ﲟﻮﺿﻊ ﺇﻻ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺃﻫﺪﻭﻩ ﻭﺩﺧﻠﻮﺍ ﰲ ﻃﺎﻋﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺸﻮﺍ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳉﻨﻮﺏ ﻓﻤﺮ ﺑﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﻓﺎﺱ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻓﺤﺎﺭﺑﻮﻩ ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻌﺚ ﻗﺎﺋﺪﺍﹰ ﻟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺎﺣﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﻭﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻳﺴﺄﻟﻮﻧﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺼﺪﻩ؟ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﺪ ﲝﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻭﺇﺫﻋﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻣﺼﺎﳊﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﻳﺎﻩ‪.‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺎﳓﻦ ﻓﻤﺎ ﺑﻠﻐﻨﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ‬

‫‪141‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻗﻂ ﻭﻻ ﺭﺃﻳﻨﺎﻩ ﻭﻻ ﺿﺮﻧﺎ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻭﻻ ﺿﺎﺭﺭﻧﺎﻩ‪.‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺎﻻ ﻭﺟﻮﻫﺮﺍﹰ ﻭﺻﺎﳊﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺒﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺳﺄﳍﻢ ﻫﻞ ﺭﻛﺐ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻗﻂ ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﲨﻴﻌﻬﻢ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺴﺘﻄﻴﻊ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﱪﻭﻩ ﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﺭﲟﺎ ﺃﻇﻠﻪ ﺍﻟﻐﻤﺎﻡ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﻭﻧﻪ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃﺗﺎﻫﻢ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻓﺘﻠﻘﻮﻩ ‪‬ﺪﺍﻳﺎ ﻭﻓﺎﻛﻬﺔ ﺃﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺕ ﻭﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺳﻮﺩ ﻓﺎﺫﺍ ﺟﻌﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺻﺎﺭﺕ‬
‫ﺑﻴﻀﺎﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﻢ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺩﺍﻥ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺇﱃ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻳﻦ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻋﺮﺍﺓ ﺑﺄﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﺣﺮﺍﺏ‬
‫ﺍﳊﺪﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﺍﺑﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﳍﺎ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﺴﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﺃﲪﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻨﲔ ﻓﺼﱪ ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺏ ﺻﱪﺍﹰ‬
‫ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﰒ ﻇﻔﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎ‪‬ﺰﻣﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺃﻭﺣﺎﻝ ﻭﺃﺩﻏﺎﻝ ﻭﻏﲑﺍﻥ ﻭﺟﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﻋﺮﺓ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺘﻬﻴﺄ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺗﺒﺎﻋﻬﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻓﺠﺎﻭﺯﻫﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻭﺩ ﳍﻢ ﺃﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﺧﻔﺎﻑ ﻳﻠﺘﻔﻮﻥ ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻏﲑ ﺭﻳﺶ ﻭﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻣﻌﻦ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﲑ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻏﺸﻴﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻏﻤﺎﻡ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﻣﺘﻴﺎﻣﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻧﺒﺎﺭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻓﻮﻗﻪ‪ ،‬ﲤﺜﺎﻻﹰ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺣﺠﺮ ﺃﲪﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﻲﺀ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﺃﻥ ﺍﺭﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﻣﺰﺑﻮﺭﺍﹰ " ﻣﺎ ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻲ ﺍﺣﺪ " ﻭﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﻀﻰ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺴﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺟﻠﺒﺔ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻟﺸﺪﺓ‬
‫ﻇﻠﻤﺘﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﲔ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﲰﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﻗﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﲰﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻋﺪﺍ ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ ﺟﺎﺯ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺏ ﺍﳌﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﻷﺳﻮﺩ ﺍﳌﻈﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﻤﻊ ﺟﻠﺒﺔ ﻭﺻﻴﺎﺣﺎﹰ ﻫﺎﺋﻼﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺷﺠﻌﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻳﺘﺒﻌﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﺡ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺷﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﺎﻉ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﻏﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﳐﺰﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﻷﻧﻮﻑ ﻭﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻳﻐﲑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻓﻴﺄﻛﻞ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻠﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻣﺬﻫﺐ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﻭﻋﺪﻯ‬
‫ﻭﺍﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺮ ﺑﺄﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺭﺏ ﻓﺄﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﻮﻫﺎ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﻭﺑﺎﻟﺮﻗﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺰﺍﺋﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﱵ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻗﺪ ﻋﺮﻓﻮﻫﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺟﺎﻭﺯﻫﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ ﺍﻧﺘﻬﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺳﻠﻮﻗﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ‪‬ﺎ ﺣﻴﺔ ﲣﺮﺝ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳊﺪ ﻭﺍﳌﻘﺪﺍﺭ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻭﻫﺎ ﳑﺘﺪﺓ ﻓﻈﻨﻮﻫﺎ ﻣﻴﺘﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻬﻤﻤﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻭﻫﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻓﺮﺟﻌﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﲔ ﻭﺗﻌﻮﺫﻭﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺮﻗﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﺰﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺳﺤﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻌﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺮﻛﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﳍﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺗﺘﺤﺮﻙ ﺣﱴ ﻫﻠﻜﺖ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ‬
‫ﻃﻮﻝ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﳊﻴﺔ ﻣﻴﻞ ﻭﺇ‪‬ﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﺒﺘﻠﻊ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻠﺔ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﺪ ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺔ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﺇﱃ ﺟﺒﻞ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ ﺻﻌﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﻣﺪﻳﻨﺘﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻻ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻻ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻮﺩ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ ﳛﺮﺳﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﱂ ﳚﺪ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻭﺿﺎﻉ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﺩﻭﺍ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻬﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻋﻄﺸﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﱰﻝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻴﺪﻭﺵ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﳊﻜﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﻗﺪ ﻏﻄﻰ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﺟﺴﺪﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻳﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬

‫‪142‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳌﻐﺮﻭﺭ ﺃﻳﻦ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻣﺪ ﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺯﻗﺖ ﻓﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻜﻔﺎﻳﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﻔﻴﻢ ﺗﺘﻌﺐ ﻧﻔﺴﻚ ﻭﺟﻴﺸﻚ‪ ،‬ﻫﻼ ﻗﻨﻌﺖ‬
‫ﲟﺎ ﲤﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﻜﻠﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﺎﻟﻘﻚ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﻫﺒﻚ ﺍﻟﻐﲎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﺎﻧﻚ ‪‬ﺬﺍ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ! ﻓﻌﺠﺖ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﻟﻪ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﺪﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻬﻢ ﺇﺫ ﱂ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺃﺻﺎﺏ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺸﻬﻢ ﺃﺛﺮﺍﹰ ﻟﺴﻜﻨﺎﻫﻢ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﳓﻦ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻻ‬
‫ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﺎ ﻣﻌﺎﺷﻜﻢ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﻮﻝ ﻧﺒﺎﺕ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻧﻌﺘﺼﻢ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻧﻘﻨﻊ ﻓﻴﻘﻴﺘﻨﺎ ﻭﻳﻜﻔﻴﻨﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﲑﻣﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻤﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ‬
‫ﺗﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻏﺪﺭﺍﻥ ﻟﻨﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﳚﺘﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻄﺎﺭﻭﺍﻟﺜﻠﻮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻫﺮﺑﺘﻢ ﻋﻨﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺭﻏﺒﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺟﻮﺍﺭﻛﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﻫﺎﺩﺓ ﰲ ﺧﻠﻄﺘﻜﻢ ﻭﻛﺮﺍﻫﺔ ﻟﻘﺮﺑﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻻ ﻓﻠﻴﺲ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﳔﺎﻓﻜﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺄﻳﻦ ﺗﻜﻮﻧﻮﻥ ﺇﺫﺍ ﲪﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﰲ ﻏﲑﺍﻥ ﻟﻨﺎ ﲢﺖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻬﻞ ﲢﺘﺎﺟﻮﻥ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎﻝ ﺃﺧﻠﻔﻪ‬
‫ﻟﻜﻢ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﳕﺎ ﳛﺘﺎﺝ ﺇﱃ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺬﺥ‪.‬ﻭﳓﻦ ﻻ ﻧﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻐﻨﻴﻨﺎ ﻋﻨﻪ ﲟﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺍﻛﺘﻔﻴﻨﺎ ﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻊ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺈﻧﺎ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺯﻗﻨﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻮ ﺭﺃﻳﺘﻪ ﳊﻘﺮﺕ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻨﺪﻙ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺄﺭﻧﻴﻪ!ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺴﺮ ﻣﻌﻲ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻧﻄﻠﻖ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻭﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﻣﻌﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺭﺽ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺢ ﺟﺒﻞ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﺮﺃﻭﺍ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻗﻀﺒﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻫﺐ ﻧﺎﺑﺘﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﻭﻩ ﻭﺍﺩﻳﺎﹰ ﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺘﻴﻪ ﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺰﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﲑﻭﺯﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺃﺻﺤﺎﺑﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺨﲑﻭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﺎﺩ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﳛﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ‪‬ﻢ‬
‫ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺮﺃﻭﺍ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﺴﻜﺮ ﳛﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﳍﻢ ﻭﻳﻌﻈﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﺰﻉ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺄﻝ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞٍ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﺑﺄﺭﺿﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺎﻩ ﻋﻦ ﻋﺒﺎﺩﺓ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ ﻭﺧﻮﻓﻬﻢ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺄﻟﻪ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﻭﻭﺩﻋﻪ ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺖ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻭﺻﻔﻪ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﺮ ﻋﻠﻯﺄﻣﺔ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﺃﺛﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺃﺛﺮﺍﹰ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﱃ ﺍﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺑﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﱀ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﳛﻤﻠﻮﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﰒ ﺃﺗﻰ ﺇﱃ ﺩﻧﻘﻠﺔ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ‪‬ﺎ ﻋﻠﻤﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺯﺑﺮ ﺍﲰﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﺴﲑﻩ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮﺗﻪ ﺗﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪ ﻣﻨﻒ ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺧﺮﺝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻠﻘﻮﻩ ﺑﺄﺻﻨﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﻄﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﺣﲔ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺒﺨﻮﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﳌﻼﻫﻲ ﻭﻏﺮﺍﺋﺐ ﺍﻻﻟﻌﺎﺏ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﻗﺪ ﺑﲎ ﻟﻪ ﳎﻠﺴﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ ﺍﻻﺑﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻌﺔ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﻬﺮﳚﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺟﺎﺝ ﲰﺎﻭﻱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺍﺭﺿﻪ ﲰﻜﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﺟﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﻳﺐ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻒ ﺃﻧﺰﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻳﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﰲ ﳍﻮ ﻭﺳﺮﻭﺭ ﻳﺄﻛﻠﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﺸﺮﺑﻮﻥ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ‬
‫ﺑﻌﺮﺽ ﺟﻴﺸﻪ ﻓﻔﻘﺪ ﺳﺒﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻔﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻋﺸﺮ ﻋﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﲰﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﺑﺬﻛﺮ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺳﻔﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﺘﺢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻭﺃﺳﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‬
‫ﻫﺎﺑﻮﻩ ﻭﺧﺎﻓﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻟﺸﺪﺓ ﺑﺄﺳﻪ ﻭﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺳﻠﻄﺎﻧﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲡﱪ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻓﺒﲎ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻗﺼﻮﺭﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺭﺧﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎﺃﻋﻼﻣﺎ ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻐﺸﺎﻫﺎ ﺃﺑﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻴﻢ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‬

‫‪143‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻳﺎﻣﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺗﺴﻌﺔ ﻭﺗﺴﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﰲ ﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻠﺐ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺣﺴﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻗﺎﺕ ﻻﻣﻦ ﺭﺩﻳﺌﻬﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﺻﻼﺡ ﺍﳉﺴﻮﺭ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻬﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺤﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﰲ ﺍﻧﺒﺴﺎﻃﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﻭﺍﰱ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﻣﺮﺍﺩﻩ ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ :‬ﺇﻥ ﰲ ﻣﺪﺗﻪ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻏﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻟﻪ ﺃﺧﻮﺓ ﳛﺴﺪﻭﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺣﺘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﲡﺎﺭ‬
‫ﻳﻘﺼﺪﻭﻥ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻗﻮﺍﻓﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﺗﻌﺮﺱ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺑﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﳌﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﻟﻠﺒﻴﻊ ﻭﻧﻮﺩﻱ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﻳﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻠﻎ ﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﺫﻫﺒﺎ ﻭﻭﺯﻧﻪ ﻓﻀﺔ ﻓﺎﺷﺘﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰﻟﻴﻬﺪﻳﻪ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎﺃﺗﻰ ﺑﻪ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﻣﱰﻟﻪ ﺭﺃﺗﻪ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﻋﻤﻪ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺍﺗﺮﻛﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ ﻧﺮﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻣﻌﻬﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺸﻘﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺼﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺗﻜﺘﻢ ﺣﺒﻬﺎ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﻏﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺰﻳﻨﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺟﺎﺀﺗﻪ‬
‫ﻓﻌﺮﻓﺘﻪ ﻋﺸﻘﻬﺎ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻄﺎﻭﻋﺔ ﻟﻪ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻳﺪﻩ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃ‪‬ﺎﻻ ﺑﺪ ﳍﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺒﺘﻪ ﲟﺎﻝ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺘﻨﻊ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﳚﺪ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻬﺮﺑﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺍﻣﺖ ﺗﻘﺒﻴﻠﻪ ﻓﺄﰉ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﻬﺠﻤﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﱂ ﺗﺰﻝ ﺗﻌﺎﺭﻛﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳝﺘﻨﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻞ ﺯﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﻓﻮﺟﺪﻩ ﻫﺎﺭﺑﺎ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﻴﻨﺎ ﻻﻳﺄﰐ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻤﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻳﻌﺘﺬﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻫﻲ ﻛﻨﺖ ﻧﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻓﺄﺗﺎﱐ ﻳﺮﺍﻭﺩﱐ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻔﺴﻲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻄﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻴﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻋﺮﺽ ﻋﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻱ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻋﺘﺬﺍﺭﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﺰﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻐﻔﺮﻱ ﻟﺬﻧﺒﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻧﻚ ﻗﺪ‬
‫ﺃﺧﻄﺄﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﻭﲨﺎﻟﻪ ﺑﺎﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﺍﺑﺘﺎﻋﻪ ﻟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﱂ ﻳﺮﻩ ﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﻧﻜﺮ ﺍﳌﻌﲔ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻏﲑ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺧﱪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻏﻠﻆ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺛﻘﻒ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﻋﻨﺪﻩ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻓﻨﺴﻲ ﺧﱪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻗﺪ ﻋﺎﻭﺩ ﺍﻻﻧﻌﻜﺎﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻻﺣﺘﺠﺎﺏ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﳌﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﻛﻔﺎﻩ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻋﻴﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺧﱪ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﻣﻊ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻌﲑ‪‬ﺎﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻭﻋﻤﻠﺖ ﳍﻦ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻛﻠﻨﻪ ﺃﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﳍﻦ ﺷﺮﺍﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﻠﺴﺘﻬﻦ ﳎﻠﺴﲔ ﳎﻠﺴﺎﹰ‬
‫ﺣﺬﺍﺀ ﳎﻠﺲ‪ ،‬ﻣﺬﻫﺒﲔ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﺷﺘﻬﻤﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺝ ﺍﻷﺻﻔﺮ ﺍﳌﺬﻫﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺧﺖ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺳﺘﻮﺭ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻳﺒﺎﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺟﻠﺴﻦ ﻓﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﻟﻠﺸﺮﺍﺏ ﻭﻗﺪﻣﺖ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻦ ﻓﺎﻛﻬﺔ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﻜﺎﻛﲔ ﺃﻧﺼﺒﺘﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻗﻄﻌﻦ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﻛﻬﺔ ‪‬ﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺎﻛﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﱰﻝ ﺑﲔ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻦ ﺃﺗﺮﺝ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﳌﺘﻜﺄ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﺕ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻮﺍﺷﻂ ﺑﺘﺰﻳﲔ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺇﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﲡﻠﺲ ﻫﻲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ‬
‫ﻟﻠﺸﺮﺍﺏ‪.‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﳏﺎﺫﻳﺔ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﻓﺄﺧﺬﺗﻪ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﺷﻂ ﻭﻧﻈﻤﻦ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﺑﺎﺻﻨﺎﻑ‬

‫‪144‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﳉﻮﻫﺮ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻨﻪ ﺛﻮﺏ ﺩﻳﺒﺎﺝ ﺍﺻﻔﺮ ﻣﻨﺴﻮﺝ ﺑﺪﻭﺍﺋﺮ ﻣﺬﻫﺒﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺭ ﺧﻀﺮ ﺻﻔﺎﺭ ﻭﻋﺪﻟﻦ ﺷﻌﺮﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺒﻴﻨﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺮﺏ ﺣﺎﺟﺒﻴﻪ ﻭﻭﺻﻠﻦ ﺟﺒﻬﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻘﺮﺑﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺧﺪﻳﻪ‬
‫ﺻﺪﻏﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺩﺩﻥ ﺫﺅﺍﺑﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﺪﺭﻩ ﻭﺩﻓﻌﻦ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﲟﺬﺑﺔ ﺫﻫﺐ ﺷﻌﺮﻫﺎ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻍ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻛﻠﻬﻦ ﻭﺟﻠﺴﻦ ﻟﻠﺸﺮﺏ ﻭﺃﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺍﻛﻪ ﻭﺳﻘﺘﻬﻦ ﺃﻗﺪﺍﺣﺎﹰ‪ .‬ﺩﻓﻌﺖ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺎﻛﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﻦ ﻗﺪﺑﻠﻐﲏ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺧﺬﺗﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻱ ﻣﻊ ﻋﺒﺪﻱ ﻓﻘﻠﻦ ﳍﺎ ﺇﻥ ﺍﻻﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺑﻠﻐﻚ ﺇﻻ‬
‫ﺃﻧﻚ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﺍﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ .‬ﻭﻣﺜﻠﻚ ﻳﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻭﻻﺩ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ ﳊﺴﻨﻚ ﻭﺷﺮﻓﻚ ﻭﻋﻘﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻴﻒ ﻛﻨﺖ‬
‫ﺗﺮﺿﲔ ﺑﻌﺒﺪﻙ؟ ﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻠﻐﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﺪﻕ ﻋﲏ‪ .‬ﻭﱂ ﺍﺭﺽ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻲ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻮ ﺭﺿﻴﺘﻪ ﻟﻜﺎﻥ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻫﻼ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﺎﺭﺕ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺍﺷﻂ ﺑﺎﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻓﻌﺖ ﺳﺘﻮﺭ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳛﺎﺫﻱ ﳎﻠﺴﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻗﺒﻞ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﺬﺑﺔ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻦ ﻳﺮﻣﻘﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﳏﺎﺫﻳﺎ ﻟﻠﺸﻤﺲ ﻓﺄﺷﺮﻕ ﺍ‪‬ﻠﺲ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺑﻮﺟﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﺭﺳﻞ ﻣﻊ ﻧﻮﺭ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺷﻌﺎﻋﺎ ﻓﻜﺎﺩ ﳜﻄﻒ ﺍﺑﺼﺎﺭﻫﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻗﺒﻞ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺍﳌﺬﺑﺔ ﺑﻴﺪﻩ ﻭﻫﻦ ﻳﺮﻣﻘﻨﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻭﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻬﺎ ﻳﺬﺏ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻦ ﻻﻳﻌﻘﻠﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ‬
‫ﻭﺿﻌﻦ ﺗﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﺴﻜﺎﻛﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻳﺪﻳﻬﻦ ﻭﺃﺻﺎﺑﻌﻬﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻄﻌﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﻛﻬﺔ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺸﻌﺮﻥ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﻻ ﳚﺪﻥ ﺃﳌﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻭﻫﻲ ﲣﺎﻃﺒﻬﻦ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻔﻬﻤﻦ ﺧﻄﺎ‪‬ﺎ ﻟﻠﺬﻱ ﺃﺩﻫﺸﻬﻦ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻭﺟﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﻦ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻜﻦ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺷﺘﻐﻠﱳ ﻋﻦ ﻓﻬﻢ ﺧﻄﺎﰊ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻋﺒﺪﻱ؟ ﻓﻘﻠﻦ ﻣﻌﺎﺫ ﺍﷲ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﻋﺒﺪﻙ ﺃﻭ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺑﺸﺮ ﺇﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺇﻻ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻛﺮﱘ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﺗﺒﻖ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺍﻻ ﺃﻧﺰﻟﺖ ﻭﺣﺎﺿﺖ ﻣﻦ ﳏﺒﺘﻪ‪.‬‬

‫ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﳍﻦ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﳌﺘﲏ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﻠﻦ ﳍﺎ ﻣﺎﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻷﺣﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻠﻮﻣﻚ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻻﻣﻚ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺪ ﻇﻠﻤﻚ ﻓﺪﻭﻧﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻗﺪ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﻓﺄﰉ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺒﻨﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻗﺪﺭﺗﻦ ﻭﺃﻋﺪﻧﻪ ﺍﳋﲑ ﻣﲏ ﻭﺣﺬﺭﻧﻪ ﻋﻘﻮﺑﱵ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺩﻩ ﱄ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﺗﺪﻋﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﻧﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﺳﺮﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺒﺬﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺪﺭﺕ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻫﻮ ﳝﺘﻨﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺫﺍ‬
‫ﻗﻄﻌﺖ ﺭﺟﺎﺀﻫﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻟﻨﻔﺴﻬﺎ ﺣﻴﻨﺌﺬ ﺧﺎﻃﺒﺘﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻮﻻﺗﻚ ﲢﺒﻚ ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺗﻜﺮﻫﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﲣﺎﻟﻔﻬﺎ ﻭﻫﻲ ﺗﺒﻠﻐﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻓﻀﻞ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﺯﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﻄﻴﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺍﳉﻮﺍﻫﺮ ﻓﻮﻕ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﺿﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﻮﻝ ﻣﺎ ﱄ‬
‫ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺎﺟﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻳﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺃﲨﻌﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺧﺬﻩ ﻏﺼﺒﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﻣﺎ ﳚﻮﺯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻻﳝﻜﻦ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻟﻜﻨﻪ ﺍﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻷﻣﻨﻌﻨﻪ ﺍﻟﻠﺬﺍﺕ ﻭﻷﻧﺰﻋﻦ ﻋﻨﻪ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻋﻄﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﻷﺳﺠﻨﻨﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺭﺏ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ ﺃﺣﺐ ﺇﱄ ﳑﺎ ﻳﺪﻋﻮﻧﲏ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺴﻤﺖ ﺑﺎﳍﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﻨﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺮﺟﺪ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﺑﺎﺳﻢ ﻋﻄﺎﺭﺩ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻟﻦ‬
‫ﳚﺒﻬﺎ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺮﻳﺪﻩ ﻟﺘﺠﻌﻠﻦ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺸﻔﺖ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﻢ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺎﻧﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮﺕ ﺑﱰﻉ ﺛﻴﺎﺑﻪ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﺘﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺼﻮﻑ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﺖ ﺯﻭﺟﻬﺎ ﺃﻥ ﳛﺒﺴﻪ ﳍﺎ ﻟﻴﺰﻭﻝ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻤﺎﻝ ﺇﱃ ﻗﻮﳍﺎ ﻟﺌﻼ ﻳﻈﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺄﻫﻠﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻴﺢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﺴﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻔﻲ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻟﺔ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪145‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﲝﺒﺴﻪ ﻓﺤﺒﺲ ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ ﺑﻀﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﻣﻪ ﻛﺄﻥ ﺁﺗﻴﺎ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻼﻣﺎﹰ ﻭﻓﻼﻧﺎ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﻋﺰﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺘﻠﻚ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺎﺣﱯ ﻃﻌﺎﻣﻪ ﻭﺷﺮﺍﺑﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﰲ ﻏﺪ ﺗﻘﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻣﺮﳘﺎ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﻗﺮﺭﳘﺎ ﻓﺎﻋﺘﺮﻓﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺍﻋﺘﺮﻑ ﺍﺣﺪﳘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻜﺮ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﻓﺎﻣﺮ ﲝﺒﺴﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺮﻃﻴﺲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﺮﺍﹰ ﺭﺀﻭﻓﺎ ﺑﺄﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ ﻳﺼﱪﻫﻢ ﻭﻳﻌﻈﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﻌﺪﻫﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﺮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻔﺴﺮ ﺍﺣﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﺍﺧﱪﻩ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﻃﻌﺎﻡ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺷﺮﺍﺑﻪ ﺑﺮﺅﻳﺎﳘﺎ ﻛﻤﺎﺟﺎﺀ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺁﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺟﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻛﻤﺎ ﺃﺧﱪﳘﺎ ﺍﻥ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺃﺣﺪﻫﻢ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺍﻗﺮ ﻭﳒﺎ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﱂ ﻳﻘﺮ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﺍﺏ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﻧﻮﻣﻪ ﺍﻟﺒﻘﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺴﻨﺎﺑﻞ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﱪ ﺭﺅﻳﺎﻩ ﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﻗﻲ ﺧﱪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ ﻓﻔﺴﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻠﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺳﻠﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻘﺼﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ‬
‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺠﺌﲏ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺮﺳﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻟﻴﺨﺮﺟﻪ ﻭﳛﻤﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻟﺴﺖ ﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺣﱴ ﻳﻜﺸﻒ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ ﺍﻟﻼﰐ ﻗﻄﻌﻦ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻦ ﻭﺣﺒﺴﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺟﻠﻬﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﻓﺄﺣﻀﺮﺕ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ ﻭﻛﺸﻒ ﻋﻦ ﺣﻘﻴﻘﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻓﻮﻗﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺮﺕ ﺯﻟﻴﺨﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺴﻮﺓ ﲟﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺟﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺠﻦ ﻭﻏﺴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺭﻧﻪ ﻭﻧﻈﻒ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺕ ﻣﺎﻳﻠﻴﻖ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺭﺁﻩ ﺍﻣﺘﻸ ﻗﻠﺒﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺣﺒﻪ‪.‬ﻓﺎﻧﺰﻟﻪ ﻭﺃﻛﺮﻣﻪ ﻭﺳﺄﻟﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﻓﻔﺴﺮﻫﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ‬
‫ﻭﺟﻞ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪ .‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻓﺈﱐ ﺑﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻢ‪ .‬ﻓﺨﻠﻊ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺧﻠﻊ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻪ ﺗﺎﺟﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺎﻑ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﺍﳉﻴﻮﺵ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻳﺮﺩ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﳚﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻔﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﲰﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺰﻳﺰ ﻗﺪ ﻫﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺰﻭﺝ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺧﻼ ‪‬ﺎ ﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ‬
‫ﳑﺎﻛﻨﺖ ﺃﺭﺩﺕ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻟﺖ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺯﻭﺟﻲ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻨﻴﻨﺎ ﻭﱂ ﺗﺮﻙ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﰲ ﺣﺴﻨﻚ ﻭﻫﻴﺒﺘﻚ ﺇﻻ ﺻﺒﺎ ﻗﻠﺒﻬﺎ ﺇﻟﻴﻚ‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻳﺪﻳﺮ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻛﻴﻒ ﺷﺎﺀ ﻭﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺳﲏ ﺍﳋﺼﺐ ﻓﺎﺧﺬ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻏﻼ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺨﺰﻥ‬
‫ﺍﻛﺜﺮﻫﺎ ﰲ ﺳﻨﺎﺑﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺷﺘﺮﻯ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﺕ ﺍﳉﺴﻴﻤﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻏﻼﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺰﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺎ ﻻ ﳛﺼﺮ ﻗﺪﺭﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺟﺎﺀﺕ ﺳﲏ ﺍﳉﺪﺏ ﻭﺑﺪﺃ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻘﺼﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻨﻘﺺ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻘﺼﺎﻧﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﱵ‬
‫ﻗﺒﻠﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻼ ﺍﻟﺴﻌﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻴﻊ ﺍﳌﺄﻛﻮﻝ ﺑﺎﳉﻮﻫﺮ ﻭﺍﳌﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻴﺎﺏ ﻭﺍﻵﻧﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻘﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﺩ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﺣﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻮﻻ ﺗﺪﺑﲑ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺤﻂ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺼﺔ ﺇﺧﻮﺓ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺼﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ‬
‫ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺟﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﺇﱃ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﰲ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﺘﺎﻗﺎﻩ ﻭﺃﺩﺧﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﺣﺒﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻋﻈﻤﻪ‪.‬‬

‫‪146‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻳﺎﺷﻴﺦ ﻛﻢ ﺳﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺻﻨﺎﻋﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﻌﺒﺪﻩ؟ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﺎ ﺳﲏ ﻓﻌﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ‬
‫ﺻﻨﺎﻋﱵ ﻓﻠﻨﺎ ﻏﻨﻢ ﻧﺮﻋﺎﻫﺎ ﻓﻨﺤﻦ ﻧﻨﺘﻔﻊ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﻧﻌﻴﺶ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻋﺒﺪﻩ ﻓﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﳌﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺭﺏ ﺁﺑﺎﺋﻲ‬
‫ﻭﺁﺑﺎﺋﻚ ﻭﺇﳍﻲ ﻭﺇﳍﻚ ﻭﺇﻟﻪ ﻛﻞ ﳐﻠﻮﻕ ﻭﺧﺎﻟﻖ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﳎﻠﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻊ ﻗﻮﻝ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﺿﺎﻕ ﺑﻪ ﺫﺭﻋﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻨﻬﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺑﻠﻐﺘﻬﻢ ﺇﻧﻪ ﳚﺮﻱ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﻭﻟﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﲔ ﻟﻨﺎ‬
‫ﺧﱪﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﻴﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﻥ ﻛﻞ ﺇﻟﻪ ﻻ ﺗﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ ﻓﻠﻴﺲ ﺑﺸﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﻐﻀﺐ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﻛﺬﺑﺖ ﺃﻱ ﻋﺪﻭ ﺍﷲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻐﻴﺖ ﰲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻛﺎﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺧﺎﻟﻖ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻻ‬
‫ﺇﻟﻪ ﻏﲑﻩ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺼﻔﻪ ﻟﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺇﳕﺎ ﻳﻮﺻﻒ ﺍﳌﺨﻠﻮﻕ ﻻ ﺍﳋﺎﻟﻖ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﺍﺭﺗﻔﻊ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﻬﻮ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ‬
‫ﻗﺪﱘ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺃﺯﱄ ﻗﺎﺽ ﺑﻜﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﺪﺑﺮ ﻟﻜﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺑﻼ ﻛﻴﻒ ﻫﻮ‪ ،‬ﺣﺎﺿﺮ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﱂ ﻳﻌﺰﺏ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻠﻤﻪ‬
‫ﻣﺜﻘﺎﻝ ﺫﺭﺓ ﰲ ﻇﻠﻤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻕ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻ ﰲ ﺍﻃﺒﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﻭﺍﺕ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺮﻯ ﻭﻻ ﺗﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻮﻥ ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﳛﻴﻂ ﺑﻪ ﻓﻜﺮ ﻭﻻ ﳛﻮﻳﻪ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻠﻖ ﺍﳌﻜﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﻗﺎﻡ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻣﻐﻀﺒﺎ ﻟﻴﺨﺮﺝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺟﻠﺴﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻜﻒ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬ ﰲ‬
‫ﻏﲑ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻛﻢ ﻋﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻌﻚ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﺎﻝ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺳﺘﻮﻥ ﺭﺟﻼ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﻠﻤﻠﻚ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﳒﺪ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺒﻨﺎ ﺍﻥ ﺧﺮﺍﺏ ﻣﺼﺮ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﻗﻮﻡ ﻳﺪﺧﻠﻮﻥ ﻣﺼﺮ ﰲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺄﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻨﻒ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﻳﺎﻣﻨﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻻ ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻣﺪ ﺑﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺍﺏ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻻ ﻳﺴﺘﺒﻘﻲ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺫﺭﻳﺘﻪ ﺃﺣﺪﺍ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺇﻥ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺗﻘﻮﻝ ﻓﻼ ﳝﻜﻨﻨﺎ ﺩﻓﻌﻪ ﻭﻻ ﻋﻠﻴﻨﺎﻣﻨﻪ ﺿﺮﻭﺭﺓ ﺇﺫﺍ ﱂ ﳔﻒ ﺃﻥ ﳚﺮﻱ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﰲ ﻣﺪﺗﻨﺎ ﺃﻥ ﻧﻘﺘﻞ ﻫﺆﻻﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻢ ﻳﺬﻛﺮﻭﻥ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺇﻟﻪ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻏﲑﻧﺎ ﳑﻦ ﳜﺎﻑ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺪﻭﺭ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﺣﻖ ﺑﺎﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻗﻠﱯ ﻗﻮﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﺟﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﺠﺒﲏ ﺍﻣﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ‬
‫ﺷﻴﺦ ﺟﻠﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﺇﱃ ﺇﺫﺍﻳﺘﻪ ﺳﺒﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﺑﺄﻟﲔ ﻛﻼﻡ ﻭﻧﺎﻇﺮﻩ ﺇﻥ ﺷﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﺎﻇﺮﺗﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺠﺮﺕ ﺑﲔ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﺑﲔ ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﳐﺎﻃﺒﺎﺕ ﻟﲔ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ ﻭﻇﻬﺮ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﺃﺣﺐ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺮﻑ ﺧﱪ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻣﺪﺍﺋﻨﻬﺎ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺒﻬﺎ ﻭﺳﺤﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻃﻠﺴﻤﺎ‪‬ﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺄﻝ ﻋﻦ ﻗﻠﻴﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻛﺜﲑﻩ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺧﻠﻮﺗﻪ ﺑﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺤﻠﻔﻪ ﲝﻖ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻜﺘﻤﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺻﻒ ﻟﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﻭﺑﻴﻨﻪ ﻭﺷﺮﺡ‬

‫‪147‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻏﺮﺍﺋﺒﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﱂ ﳜﻒ ﻋﻦ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺷﻴﺌﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﻳﻌﻘﻮﺏ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻭ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﳚﻠﻪ ﻭﻳﻌﻈﻤﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺣﻀﺮﺗﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻓﺎﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻭﺻﻰ ﺃﻥ ﳛﻤﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺠﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺑﻠﻐﻮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻋﻴﺼﻮ ﻣﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺩﻓﻨﻪ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻷﻥ ﺇﺳﺤﻖ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻫﺒﻪ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺷﺘﺮﺍﻩ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻨﻪ ﲝﻜﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻨﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻭﻭﻟﺪ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻴﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺘﻢ ﺃﳝﺎﻧﻪ ﺧﻮﻓﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺴﺎﺩ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﻠﻚ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻳﻦ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻮﻡ ﻻﺑﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻫﻞ ﻣﺼﺮ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﺗﻨﻘﺼﻮﺍ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻗﺪ ﻛﱪ ﻭﺫﻫﺐ ﻋﻘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺧﱪﻩ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﻣﺎ ﺃﺑﺎﱄ ﻭﻟﻜﲏ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﻭﻫﺒﺖ ﻻﺑﻨﱵ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻛﺬﺍ ﻭﻛﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﻣﻐﺎﻳﺾ ﻣﻴﺎﻩ ﻭﻣﺮﻭﺝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺩﻓﻊ ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﺻﺒﻴﺐ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﺣﺼﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺣﱴ ﺗﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﺭﺿﺎ ﻋﺎﻣﺮﺓ ﻣﻐﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻋﻤﻞ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺍﺣﻜﻢ ﻣﺎﳝﻜﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺪﺑﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﳌﻴﺎﻩ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻄﻊ ﻣﺎﺩ‪‬ﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﺟﺴﻮﺭﻫﺎ ﻭﻗﻠﻊ ﺃﺩﻏﺎﳍﺎ‬
‫ﻭﺭﺩﻫﺎ ﺍﺭﺿﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺓ ﺟﺴﻴﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻐﻠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻲ ﺃﺭﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻓﺮﻍ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻛﻠﻪ ﰲ ﻣﺪﺓ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺠﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻄﻨﺔ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺣﻜﻤﺔ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻥ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲎ ﲟﺼﺮ ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﻟﻼﻫﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻘﺴﻮﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﻮﺯﻭﻧﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻣﺎﺕ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺩﺭﳝﻮﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻤﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻡ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺑﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻳﺎﻥ ﻭﻫﻮﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻊ ﻋﻨﺪﻫﻢ‪.‬ﻭﳌﺎ‬
‫ﻣﻠﻚ ﺧﺎﻟﻒ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﺧﻠﻴﻔﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﺃﺑﺎﻩ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺃﻛﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻳﺴﺪﺩﻩ ﻓﺮﲟﺎ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺭﲟﺎ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻇﻬﺮ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻣﻌﺪﻥ ﻓﻀﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﻣﻴﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺛﺎﺭ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﺻﻨﻤﺎﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﺳﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻷﻥ ﻃﺎﻟﻌﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﺼﺒﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﺧﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﺑﻮﻩ ﺑﻨﺎﻩ ﰲ ﺷﺮﻗﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻧﺼﺐ ﺣﻮﻟﻪ ﺃﺻﻨﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻛﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻀﺔ ﻭﺃﻟﺒﺴﻬﺎ ﺍﳊﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﻷﲪﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻠﺼﻨﻢ ﻋﻴﺪﺍﹰ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻬﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮﺇﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻞ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﺮﻃﺎﻥ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻨﺘﻘﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺷﱴ ﻳﺘﱰﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻀﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻨﻌﻪ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺩﻓﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻦ ﺭﺃﻳﻪ ﺑﺄﻱ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺃﻣﻜﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻟﻪ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﻭﺛﻼﺙ ﻭﻋﺸﺮﻭﻥ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﻪ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻡ‬
‫ﻓﻜﻔﻦ ﰲ ﺛﻴﺎﺏ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﰲ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺭﺧﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻦ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﺧﺼﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻘﺺ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ‪.‬‬

‫‪148‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻓﺎﺧﺮﺝ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺗﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﻭﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﻓﺪﻓﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻧﻘﺺ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺗﻔﻖ ﺭﺍﻳﻬﻢ ﺃﻥ ﳚﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﰲ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻐﺮﰊ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﰲ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻗﻲ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺣﺪﺙ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺃﻱ ﺃﻥ ﺷﺪﻭﺍ ﺣﻮﻝ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﺣﻠﻘﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺤﺎﺱ ﻭﺛﺎﻗﺎ ﰒ ﺭﺑﻄﻮﻩ ﲝﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺷﺪﻭﻩ ﺷﺪﺍ ﻭﺛﻴﻘﺎ ﳏﻜﻤﺎ ﻭﻟﻮﻭﻩ ﻟﻮﻳﺎ ﻭﺛﻴﻘﺎ ﰒ ﺩﻟﻮﻩ ﰲ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﻛﻮﻩ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻓﺄﺧﺼﺐ ﺍﳉﺎﻧﺒﺎﻥ ﲨﻴﻌﺎﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﺩﺍﺭﻭﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﻮﺯﺭﻩ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﻼﻃﺲ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﺑﻼﻃﺲ ﻳﻄﻠﻖ ﻟﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻨﻌﻪ‬
‫ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺫﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﻠﻎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﺒﻠﻐﺎﹰ ﻛﺒﲑﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻻﻳﺴﻤﻊ ﺑﺎﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺣﺴﻨﺎﺀ ﺇﻻ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺇﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﺖ ﺇﻟﻴﻪ‪ .‬ﻭﻓﺸﺎ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻭﺃﺿﻄﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺨﺎﻑ ﺑﻼﻃﺲ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻔﺴﺪ ﺃﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻮﺩﺩ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﻌﺘﺬﺭﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﻳﺮﺩ ﻧﺴﺎﺀﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﺎﺩﻱ ﰲ ﺍﳊﻀﻮﺭﰒ ﻟﺒﺲ ﺍﻓﺨﺮ ﺛﻴﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻓﺸﻜﻮﺍ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺎ ﺣﻞ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻋﺘﺬﺭ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ ﺧﺮﺍﺝ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﻌﻤﻞ ﻗﺼﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺸﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻛﺐ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻧﺴﺎﺅﻩ ﻭﺣﺸﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺎ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺑﺘﺰﺍﺯ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭ‪‬ﺐ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻷﺷﺮﺍﻑ ﻭﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﺭﻛﺐ ﰲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻳﻮﻣﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺎﱄ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺃﺣﺪﻕ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﺒﻞ ﺍﱃ‬
‫ﺍﳉﺒﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻣﺘﺪ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﻫﻮ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ ﺍﳋﺸﺐ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻌﺪﻱ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻭﺓ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻌﺪﻭﺓ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ‬
‫ﻳﺘﻬﻴﺄ ﻟﻪ ﺳﻮﻕ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﺑﺴﺮﻋﺔ ﻟﻌﻈﻤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﻛﺐ ﻣﺮﻛﺒﺎﹰ ﻟﻄﻴﻔﺎﹰ ﻣﻊ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﻧﻔﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺪﻣﻪ ﻭﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮﺓ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺗﻮﺳﻂ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻫﺎﺟﺖ ﺭﻳﺢ ﻋﺎﺻﻔﺔ ﻓﺎﻧﻘﻠﺐ ﺍﳌﺮﻛﺐ ﻭﻏﺮﻕ ﻫﻮ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺷﺎﻛﲔ ﰲ‬
‫ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻭﺟﺪﺕ ﺟﺜﺘﻪ ﺑﺸﻄﻨﻮﻑ ﻓﻌﺮﻑ ﲞﺎﲤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲜﻮﻫﺮ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺘﻘﻠﺪ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﻤﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻨﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻗﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﻮﺯﻳﺮ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻣﻌﺎﺯﻳﻮﺱ ﻭﺃﺟﻠﺴﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺻﺒﻴﺎﹰ ﻓﺒﺎﻳﻊ ﻟﻪ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﻭﺃﺳﻘﻂ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﺑﻮﻩ ﺃﺳﻘﻄﻪ ﻭﺯﺍﺩﻫﻢ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻭﺿﻤﻦ ﳍﻢ ﺍﻻﺣﺴﺎﻥ ﻓﺄﻃﺎﻋﻮﻩ ﻭﺭﺩ ﻧﺴﺎﺀﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﺧﺎﻣﺲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺯﻣﻨﻪ ﻃﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻭﺯﻳﺮ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻫﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻮﺯﺭ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺃﻣﻼﺩﺓ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﲔ ﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﺃﻧﻜﺮﻩ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻔﺮﺩ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎ ﻟﺌﻼ ‪‬ﻢ ﳜﺘﻠﻂ ﻏﲑﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﻄﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﺎﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻠﻲ ﻣﻨﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ‬
‫ﻷﻧﻔﺴﻬﻢ ﻣﺘﻌﺒﺪﺍﹰ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺘﻠﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺻﺤﻒ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻥ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻋﺸﻖ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺰﻭﺝ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺑﻮﺍ ﻋﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻐﻠﺐ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻌﺎﻧﻴﲔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ ﺍﻥ ﳛﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻀﺮﻳﺒﺔ ﺇﱃ ﻣﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻼﺯﻣﺔ‬
‫ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻋﻈﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻥ ﻳﺴﻤﻮﻩ ﺭﺑﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺮﻓﻊ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻨﻈﺮ ﰲ‬
‫ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﺃﻥ ﺃﺟﻌﻞ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺑﲏ ﺍﻗﺴﺎﻣﺲ ﻭﺃﻛﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ‬

‫‪149‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺭﺍﺋﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻐﻴﺐ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻋﻨﻜﻢ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻭﻋﺪﺕ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺿﻮﺍ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﳓﻦ ﻋﺒﻴﺪﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺭﺿﻴﺘﻪ ﺍﻵﳍﺔ ﻓﺤﻜﻢ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﺿﻮﻩ ﻭﻻ ﳜﺎﻟﻔﻮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﺃﻗﺴﺎﻣﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻠﺲ ﺃﻗﺴﺎﻣﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻮﺝ ﺑﺘﺎﺝ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﻇﺮﻭﻥ ﺑﲔ ﻳﺪﻳﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺭﺗﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺭ ﻭﺍﻻﻋﻤﺎﻝ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺑﺄﺑﺴﺎﻁ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻭﺳﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﰲ ﺃﺭﺯﺍﻗﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻋﻼ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻃﺎﻝ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﻣﺪﻧﺎ ﻛﺜﲑﺓﺃﺳﻔﻞ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻳﻄﻮﻝ ﺫﻛﺮﻫﺎ ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻥ ﲞﺖ‬
‫ﻧﺼﺮ ﳌﺎ ﻇﻔﺮ ﲟﺼﺮ ﺃﺧﺬ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺎﻡ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻭﻻﻳﺘﻪ ﺳﺒﻊ ﺳﻨﲔ ﺑﺎﲨﻞ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﺣﺎﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﺯﻳﺮ ﺃﺑﻴﻪ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻴﺖ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ‪ ،‬ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﺲ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺷﺠﺎﻋﺎﹰ ﺳﺎﺣﺮﺍﹰ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻛﺎﺗﺒﺎﹰ ﺣﻜﻴﻤﺎﹰ ﺫﻫﻨﻴﺎﹰ ﻣﺘﺼﺮﻓﺎﹰ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻓﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺼﻠﺢ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﲟﻜﺎﻧﻪ ﻭﺍﺣﺒﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﻌﺎﱂ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻋﻤﺮ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ ﻣﺪﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﳒﻮﻣﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﺳﻴﻜﻮﻥ ﺟﺪﺏ ﻭﺷﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﻠﻪ ‪‬ﺮﺍﻭﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻗﺪ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺫﻛﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﺇﻥ ﻣﻨﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻻﺳﻜﻨﺪﺭﻳﺔ ﺑﻨﻴﺖ ﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﰲ ﺯﻣﺎﻧﻪ ﻫﺎﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﳌﺎﱀ ﻓﻐﺮﻕ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻯ ﻭﺍﻷﺧﺒﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﺼﺎﻧﻊ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺣﻜﻲ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻗﺴﺎﻣﺲ ﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻣﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﻴﻞ ﻣﺎﺕ ﻭﻛﺘﻤﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻏﺎﺏ ﻋﻨﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻭﺛﻼﺛﲔ ﺳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﻮﺍ ﺇﺣﺪﻯ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﺳﻨﺔ ﻳﺪﺑﺮ ﻣﻠﻜﻬﻢ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﳌﺎ ﺍﻓﺘﻘﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﻭﺗﻐﲑﻭﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ‪‬ﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﲰﻪ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻟﻨﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺮ ﺇﱃ‬
‫ﺍﳌﻠﻚ؛ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻬﻢ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﲣﻠﻰ ﻋﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻭﱃ ﺍﺑﻨﻪ ﻻﻃﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺎ ﻗﺒﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﳉﻴﺶ ﻓﺮﻛﺒﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﺡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻻﻃﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺟﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﻟﺒﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺝ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺟﺮﻳﺌﺎﹰ ﻣﻌﺠﺒﺎﹰ ﺧﻠﻘﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﲨﻴﻼ‬
‫ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﻴﻢ ﻟﻜﻢ ﻣﺎ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﻤﺘﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﻣﻠﺘﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺟﺐ ﻣﻠﺖ ﻋﻨﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻟﺰﻡ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻂ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ‬
‫ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﻋﻦ ﻣﺮﺍﺗﺒﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺮﻑ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﺲ ﻋﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻓﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻻﻫﻮﻕ ﻣﻦ ﻭﻟﺪ ﺻﺎ ﺍﻻﻛﱪ ﺑﻦ ﺗﺪﺍﺭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﻓﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺧﺎﲤﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻫﻨﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﻧﻔﺬ‬
‫ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﻋﺎﻣﻼﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻔﺬ ﻣﻌﻪ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻠﻴﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺪﺩ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻻﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﲎ‬
‫ﻗﺮﻯ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺛﲑﺕ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﻣﻌﺎﺩﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ ﻭﻛﻨﻮﺯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳏﺒﺎﹰ ﻟﻠﺨﻠﻖ ﰒ ﲡﱪ ﻭﻋﻼ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﳚﻠﺲ ﺃﺣﺪ ﰲ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻻ ﻛﺎﻫﻦ ﻭﻻﻏﲑﻩ‪ ،‬ﺑﻞ ﻳﻘﻮﻣﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﺭﺟﻠﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻨﺼﺮﻓﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﰲ ﺃﺫﻯ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻨﻒ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﲨﻊ ﺃﻣﻮﺍﳍﻢ ﻭﻛﱰﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻠﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﻓﺎﺑﺘﺰ‬
‫ﻣﻨﻬﻦ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺼﺪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺴﻄﻮﺗﻪ ﻭﻓﻈﺎﻇﺘﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻌﺒﺪ ﺑﲏ ﺍﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻓﺒﻐﻀﻪ ﺍﳋﺎﺹ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺣﺸﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺻﺮﻓﻪ ﻭﻭﻻﻩ‬

‫‪150‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻴﺪ ﻓﺠﺎﺀﻩ ﲜﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺑﻼﻃﺲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺤﺎﺭﺑﻪ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﻈﻔﺮ ﺑﺒﻼﻃﺲ ﻭﻗﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻨﻒ ﻓﻌﺎﺙ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻧﺰﻝ ﻗﺼﺮ ﺍﳌﻤﻠﻜﺔ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﻦ ﻗﻮﻣﺲ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺮﻳﺮ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﻭﺣﺎﺯ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﰲ ﺧﺰﺍﺋﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺬﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﺒﻴﻨﺎ ﳏﻤﺪ ﻭﺁﻟﻪ ﻭﺻﺤﺒﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻣﺎ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻷﺛﺮ ﻓﻴﺰﻋﻤﻮﻥ ﺍﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﻮﻟﻴﺪ ﺑﻦ ﻣﺼﻌﺐ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﻟﻘﺔ ﻭﺫﻛﺮﻭﺍ ﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻋﻨﺔ ﺳﺒﻌﺔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﳛﻜﻰ ﻋﻨﻪ ﻗﺼﲑﺍﹰ ﻃﻮﻳﻞ ﺍﻟﻠﺤﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﺃﺷﻬﻞ ﺍﻟﻌﻴﻨﲔ ﺻﻐﲑ ﺍﻟﻌﲔ ﺍﻟﻴﺴﺮﻯ‪ ،‬ﰲ ﺟﺒﻴﻨﻪ ﺷﺎﻣﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻋﺮﺝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺯﻋﻢ ﻗﻮﻡ ﺍﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻘﻴﻄﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻴﻠﻪ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻭﻧﻜﺎﺣﻪ ﻓﻴﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﺟﻠﺲ ﰲ ﺍﳌﻠﻚ ﺍﺿﻄﺮﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺒﺬﻝ ﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﻝ ﻭﺭﻏﺐ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻃﺎﻋﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺘﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﻪ ﻓﺎﻋﺘﺪﻝ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﻪ ﺃﻥ ﺭﺗﺐ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﺗﺐ‬
‫ﻭﺷﻴﺪ ﺍﻷﻋﻼﻡ ﻭﺑﲎ ﺍﳌﺪﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﻨﺪﻕ ﺍﳋﻨﺎﺩﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻤﻞ ﺑﻨﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺶ ﺣﺼﻨﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺬﻟﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺩ ﻣﺼﺮ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻒ ﻫﺎﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ ﰲ ﻧﻔﺴﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺛﺎﺭ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻜﻨﻮﺯ ﻭﺻﺮﻓﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﳌﺪﺍﺋﻦ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺭﺍﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻔﺮ ﺧﻠﺠﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﺃﻧﻪ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺣﻔﺮ ﺧﻠﻴﺞ‬
‫ﺳﻮﺩﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻥ ﻛﻠﻤﺎ ﻋﺮﺟﻪ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺮﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﻯ ﺍﳊﻮﻑ ﲪﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﺃﻫﻠﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﻻ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺟﺘﻤﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺷﺊ ﻛﺜﲑ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺮﺩﻩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻫﻠﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺑﻠﻎ ﺍﳋﺮﺍﺝ ﰲ ﻭﻗﺘﻪ ﺳﺒﻌﺎﹰ ﻭﺳﺘﲔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﺃﻟﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﱰﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻭﻫﻮ ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻓﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﳑﻦ ﺻﺤﺒﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﲔ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻳﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻣﺮﻯ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﺃﺑﻮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻌﻠﻪ ﺣﺮﺳﺎﹰ‬
‫ﻟﻘﺼﺮﻩ ﻳﺘﻮﱃ ﺣﻔﻈﻪ ﻭﺇﻏﻼﻗﻪ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪ .‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﺘﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﳚﺮﻱ ﻫﻼﻛﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﻣﻮﻟﻮﺩ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﲔ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﺍﳌﻨﺎﻛﺤﺔ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺳﻨﲔ ﻷﻧﻪ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺃﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﻟﻮﺩ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺓ ﺇﻣﺮﻯ ﻳﻌﲏ‬
‫ﻋﻤﺮﺍﻥ ﺃﺗﺘﻪ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﺎﱄ ﺑﺸﻲﺀﺃﺻﻠﺤﺘﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻮﺍﻗﻌﻬﺎ ﻓﺤﻤﻠﺖ ‪‬ﺎﺭﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻭﺍﻗﻌﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﻟﺜﺔ ﻓﺤﻠﻤﺖ‬
‫ﲟﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﰲ ﻛﻬﺎﻧﺘﻪ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﲪﻞ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﳌﻮﻟﻮﺩ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺬﺑﺢ ﺍﳌﻮﻟﻮﺩﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻮﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲏ‬
‫ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻷﻣﺮﻯ ﻟﻘﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳊﺮﺍﺳﺘﻪ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﺍﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻣﺎ ﻗﺼﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﻭﻗﺬﻑ ﺃﻣﻪ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺭ ﺍﱃ ﲢﺖ ﻗﺼﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺧﺬ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻭﺍﺳﺘﺮﺿﺎﻋﻬﺎ ﻷﻣﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻣﺘﻨﻊ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺘﻠﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺃﻥ ﻛﱪ ﻭﻋﻈﻢ ﺷﺄﻧﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺩ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﺜﲑﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻮﺍﺩﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻟﻪ‬
‫ﺳﻄﻮﺓ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻟﻐﺰﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺷﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻗﺪ ﻋﺎﺛﻮﺍ ﰲ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﻣﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﰲ ﺟﻴﺶ ﻛﺜﻴﻒ ﻭﺭﺯﻗﻪ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻈﻔﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺘﻞ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻭﺃﺳﺮ ﺧﻠﻘﺎﹰ ﻭﺍﻧﺼﺮﻑ ﻏﺎﳕﺎ ﺳﺎﳌﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮ ﺑﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻮﱃ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻏﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﺜﲑ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﺍﺩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﻠﻔﻪ ﺣﱴ ﻗﺘﻞ ﺭﺟﻼﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺷﺮﺍﻑ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪،‬‬

‫‪151‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻓﻬﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﻣﺪﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺰﻭﺝ ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﺛﲑﻭﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮﺷﻌﻴﺐ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻋﻠﻯﺎﻥ ﻳﺮﻋﻰ ﻏﻨﻤﻪ ﻭﺃﻧﺴﺄﻩ ﺑﺄﺟﻠﲔ‬
‫ﻓﻘﻀﻰ ﺃﲤﻬﻤﺎ ﻭﺃﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺍﱃ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﺬﻫﺐ ﻳﻘﺘﺒﺲ ﳍﺎ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﻠﻤﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﺟﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ‪ :‬ﺃﻣﺾ ﺍﱃ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻳﺪﻩ‬
‫ﺑﺎﺧﻴﻪ ﻓﺘﺮﻙ ﺍﻣﺮﺍﺗﻪ ﳏﻠﻬﺎﻭﻣﻀﻰ ﻟﺮﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﺭﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﻟﺪﺕ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﺄﺭﺳﻞ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﲟﺎ ﻳﺼﻠﺤﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﻻﺩﺓ ﻭﺧﱳ ﺍﺑﻨﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﻐﻨﻢ ﺗﻐﺪﻭ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﻭﺗﺮﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﺑﻐﲑ ﺭﺍﻉ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﲪﻞ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﻟﻐﻼﻡ ﺣﱴ ﺃﺭﺍﻩ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻭﻫﻮﺳﺎﺋﺮ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻓﻘﺒﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻔﻞ ﰲ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﺭﺩﻩ ﺍﱃ ﺍﻣﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺮ ‪‬ﺎ ﺭﺟﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺁﻝ ﺷﻌﻴﺐ ﻓﺮﺩﻫﺎ ﺍﱃ ﻣﺪﻳﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﻟﻘﻲ ﺍﺧﺎﻩ ﻫﺎﺭﻭﻥ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺜﺒﺘﻪ ﻟﻄﻮﻝ‬
‫ﻏﻴﺒﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﻐﺘﺴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﻃﻰﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻀﺎﻓﻪ ﻓﺄﺿﺎﻓﻪ ﻭﺃﻃﻌﻤﻪ ﺟﻠﺒﺎﻧﺎ ﻣﻄﺒﻮﺧﺎﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺛﺮﺩ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺛﺮﻳﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺗﻌﺎﺭﻓﺎ ﻭﺳﺮ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻤﺎ ﺑﺒﻌﺾ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺍﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻋﺰ ﻭﺟﻞ ﺃﺭﺳﻠﻪ ﻭﻧﺒﺄﻩ ﻫﻮ ﻭﺍﺧﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻠﻪ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻀﺪﺍﹰ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻏﺪﻭﺍ ﺍﱃ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻭﺃﻗﺎﻣﺎ ﺍﻳﺎﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﺟﺒﺔ ﺻﻮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻌﻪ ﻋﺼﺎﻩ ﺍﻟﱵ ﺃﺧﺬﻫﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺷﻌﻴﺐ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﺣﺪﻯ ﺁﻳﺎﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺎ ﻳﺄﺗﻴﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻭﳚﻠﺴﺎﻥ ﺑﺒﺎﺑﻪ ﻓﻼ ﻳﺼﻼﻥ ﺍﱃ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻟﺸﺪﺓ ﺣﺠﺎﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﺍﱃ ﺍﻥ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﻀﺤﻚ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻌﺮﻓﻪ ﺣﺎﳍﻤﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﺎﻟﺒﺎﺏ ﺭﺟﻼﻥ ﻳﻄﻠﺒﺎﻥ ﺍﻻﺫﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺰﻋﻤﺎﻥ ﺃﻥ ﺇﳍﻬﻤﺎ ﺃﺭﺳﻠﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﻟﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﺑﺈﺩﺧﺎﳍﻤﺎ ﻭﺧﺎﻃﺒﻪ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻭﺃﺭﺍﻩ ﺁﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﻳﺘﻪ ﰲ ﺑﻴﺎﺽ ﺍﻟﻴﺪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﳘﺎ ﺁﻳﺘﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺴﻊ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻄﺎﺑﻪ ﺇﻳﺎﻩ ﻣﺎﻗﺼﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻐﺎﻅ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺃﻣﺮﻩ ﻭﻫﻢ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻪ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﺷﻐﻠﻪ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻃﻠﻤﺎ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﺄﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﻏﻤﺎﻣﺔ‬
‫ﻗﺪ ﺍﻗﺒﻠﺖ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﺴﺤﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻴﻮ‪‬ﻢ ﻓﻌﻤﻮﺍ‪.‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﻗﻮﻣﺎ ﺁﺧﺮﻳﻦ ﺑﻘﺘﻠﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺃﻯ ﻛﺄﻥ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ ﻗﺪ ﺃﺗﺖ ﻓﺎﺣﺮﻗﺘﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﺎﺯﺩﺍﺩ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻏﻴﻈﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻳﻦ ﻟﻚ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ؟ ﺃﺳﺤﺮﺓ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ ﻋﻠﻤﻮﻙ ﻫﺬﺍ‪ ،‬ﺃﻡ ﺗﻌﻠﻤﺘﻪ ﺑﻌﺪ‬
‫ﺧﺮﻭﺟﻚ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﺪﻧﺎ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﻣﻮﺱ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ‪.‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺻﺎﺣﺒﻪ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺻﺎﺣﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻴﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺑﻞ ﻋﻠﻤﺘﻬﺎﻣﻦ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ؛ ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﲜﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺻﺤﺎﺏ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﻓﻘﺎﻝ‬
‫ﺃﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻲ‪ ‬ﺃﺭﻓﻊ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﻟﻜﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺈﱐ ﺃﺭﻯ ﻧﻮﺍﻣﻴﺲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺣﺮ ﺭﻓﻴﻌﺔ ﺟﺪﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺮﺿﻮﺍ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻋﻤﺎﳍﻢ ﻓﺴﺮﻩ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺣﻀﺮﻩ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻓﻘﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺤﺮﻙ ﻭﻋﻨﺪﻱ ﻣﻦ ﻳﻮﰲ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻮﺍﻋﺪﻫﻢ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺰﻳﻨﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﻮﻡ ﻋﻴﺪ‬
‫ﻛﺎﻥ ﳍﻢ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻣﻦ ﻏﻠﺐ ﻣﻨﻬﻤﺎ ﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﺍﻻﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻫﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪ ﺍﺗﺒﻌﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺻﻠﻯﺎﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻣﺎﺋﺔ ﺍﻟﻒ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻔﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺮﻯﺎﻟﻮﺟﻮﻩ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﻭﻣﺸﻮﻫﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻳﻞ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺾ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﺎ ﺍﳌﻘﻠﻮﺏ ﺟﺒﻬﺘﻪ ﺇﱃ ﺍﺳﻔﻞ ﻭﳊﻴﺘﻪ ﺍﱃ ﻓﻮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎﻣﺎ ﻟﻪ ﻗﺮﻭﻥ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻫﻮ‬

‫‪152‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺱ ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻟﻪ ﺁﺫﺍﻥ ﻋﻈﺎﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﺎ ﻳﺸﺒﻪ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﻭﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﻓﻦ ﻭﰲ ﻛﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺟﺴﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻋﻈﺎﻣﺎﹰ ﻣﺎ ﺗﺒﻠﻎ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺎﺏ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﻋﻈﻴﻤﺔ ﺑﺄﺟﻨﺤﺔ ﺗﻄﲑ ﺍﱃ ﺍﳍﻮﺍﺀ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻓﻮﺍﻫﻬﺎ ﻧﺎﺭ ﳜﻴﻞ ﻟﻠﻌﺎﱂ ﺍ‪‬ﺎ ﺗﻜﺎﺩ ﲢﺮﻗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﻴﺎﺕ ﺑﺮﺀﻭﺱ ﻭﺷﻌﻮﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺫﻧﺎﺏ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﲤﺎﺛﻴﻞ ﰲ ﻃﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﺸﻴﺎﻃﲔ‪ .‬ﰒ ﻋﻤﻠﻮﺍ ﺩﺧﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻳﻐﺸﻰ ﺃﺑﺼﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﻯ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﺎﻧﺎﹰ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ‬
‫ﺻﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﲑﺍﻥ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻮ‪ ،‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺼﺪﻡ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﺎ ﺑﻌﻀﺎﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴﻤﻊ ﳍﺎ ﻗﻌﺎﻗﻊ ﻭﺿﺠﺔ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭﺍﹰ‬
‫ﺍﺧﺮﻯ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺧﻀﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺻﻮﺭﺍﹰ ﺳﻮﺩﺍﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺩﻭﺍﺏ ﺳﻮﺩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺳﺮ ﻫﻮ ﻭﲨﺎﻋﺘﻪ ﳑﻦ ﺣﻀﺮ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻏﺘﻨﻢ ﻣﻮﺳﻯﺼﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭﻛﻔﺮ ﺑﻔﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺧﻮﻓﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺘﻨﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻭﺿﻼﳍﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻟﻠﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺛﻼﺙ ﺭﺀﻭﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺻﻠﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﺿﺎﻕ ﺑﻪ ﺫﺭﺍﻋﺎ ﺃﺗﺎﻩ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻻ ﲣﻒ ﺇﻧﻚ ﺍﻧﺖ ﺍﻷﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺃﻟﻖ ﻣﺎ ﰲ ﳝﻴﻨﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺮ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻃﻤﻊ ﰲ‬
‫ﺇﳝﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺳﻜﻦ ﺧﻮﻓﻪ ﻓﺄﺳﺮ ﺇﱃ ﻋﻈﻤﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻗﺪ ﺭﺃﻳﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺻﻨﻌﺘﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻥ ﻗﻬﺮﺗﻜﻢ ﺃﺗﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﷲ ؟‬
‫ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻧﺸﻬﺪ ﻟﻨﻔﻌﻠﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﺮﺁﻩ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﻢ ﻓﻐﺎﻇﻪ ﻭﻫﻢ ﲟﻌﺎﺟﻠﺔ ﺍﳉﻤﻴﻊ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﻟﻴﻌﻠﻢ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻀﻴﺔ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻳﻬﺰﺅﻭﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻬﻤﺎ ﺩﺭﺍﻋﺘﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺻﻮﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﺣﺘﺰﻣﺎ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻴﻒ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻊ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﻋﺼﺎﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﻤﻰ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﺴﻢ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﺣﻴﻢ ﰒ ﺣﻠﻖ ﺍﻟﻌﺼﺎ ﻭﺭﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﰲ ﺍﳉﻮ ﻭﺭﻓﻌﻬﺎ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺣﱴ ﻏﺎﺑﺖ ﻋﻦ ﻋﻴﻮ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺍﻗﺒﻠﺖ ﰲ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺛﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﻋﻈﻴﻢ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻴﻨﺎﻥ ﻛﺎﻟﺘﺮﺱ ﺗﺘﻮﻗﺪﺍﻥ ﻧﺎﺭﺍﹰ‪ ،‬ﻭﲣﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻨﺨﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﻮ ﻳﺰﻳﺪ ﻏﻀﺒﺎﹰ ﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻓﻼ ﻳﻘﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺯﺑﺪﻩ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺇﻻ ﺃﺑﺮﺻﻪ ﻭﺑﺮﺻﺖ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‬
‫ﺍﺑﻨﺔ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﺜﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﻓﺎﺗﺢ ﻓﺎﻩ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻣﻪ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺣﺎﺿﺮﺓ ﻗﺮﻳﺒﺎ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﺑﺘﻠﻊ ﺍﻟﺜﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﺎ ﻋﻤﻠﺘﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﻭﻣﺎﺋﱵ ﻣﺮﻛﺐ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ‬
‫ﳑﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﻋﺼﻴﺎ ﻭﺣﺒﺎﻻ‪ ،‬ﻭﲨﻴﻊ ﻣﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻼﺣﲔ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﺘﺼﻞ ﺑﺪﺍﺭ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻋﻤﺪ ﻛﺒﲑﺓ ﻭﺣﺠﺎﺭﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻗﺪ ﲪﻠﺖ ﺇﱃ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﻟﻴﺒﻨﻯﺒﻬﺎ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺜﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﺇﱃ ﻗﺼﺮ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻟﻴﺒﻠﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﰲ ﻗﺒﺔ ﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ ﻳﺸﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺜﻌﺒﺎﻥ ﻧﺎﺑﻪ ﲢﺖ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻓﻊ ﺑﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﺔ ﻭﳍﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﳜﺮﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺍﺣﺮﻕ‬
‫ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺼﺎﺡ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻋﻨﺪﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻐﺎﺙ ﲟﻮﺳﻰ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﻓﺰﺟﺮﻩ ﻓﻌﻄﻒ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻟﻴﺒﺘﻠﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻠﻊ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻓﺴﻘﻂ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻮﻩ ﺑﻌﺾ‪.‬‬

‫‪153‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻭﺫﻫﺐ ﻟﻴﺒﺘﻠﻌﻬﻢ ﻓﺄﻣﺴﻜﻪ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﺎﺩ ﰲ ﻳﺪﻩ ﻋﺼﺎ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﳌﺮﺍﻛﺐ ﺃﺛﺮﺍ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﺒﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﺼﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻭﺍﻷﻋﻤﺪﺓ ﻭﺍﳊﺠﺎﺭﺓ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺷﺮﺑﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺮ ﺣﱴ ﺑﺎﻧﺖ ﺃﺭﺿﻪ ﺗﺮﺍﺑﺎ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺮﻭﺍ ﻟﺘﻠﻚ ﺍﻷﻋﻴﺎﻥ ﺍﺛﺮﺍ ﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻣﺎ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻋﻤﻞ ﺍﻵﺩﻣﻴﲔ ! ﻭﺍﳕﺎ ﻧﺼﻨﻊ ﳐﺎﻳﻴﻞ ﻻ‬
‫ﺗﻐﻴﺐ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻷﻋﻴﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﳍﻢ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﺃﻭﻓﻮﺍ ﺑﻮﻋﺪﻛﻢ ﻭﺇﻻ ﺳﻠﻄﺘﻪ ﻋﻠﻴﻜﻢ ﻓﻴﺒﺘﻠﻌﻜﻢ ﻛﻤﺎ ﺍﺑﺘﻠﻊ ﻏﲑﻛﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻌﻨﺪﻫﺎ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﺤﺮﺓ ﲟﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻫﺮﻭﺍ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻟﻮﺍ ﻫﺬﺍ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻌﻞ ﺇﻟﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﻮﺍﺕ ﻭﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﻓﻌﻞ ﺇﻟﻪ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪.‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻗﺪ ﻋﻠﻤﺖ ﺃﻧﻜﻢ ﻭﺍﻃﺄﲤﻮﻩ ﻋﻠﻲ ﻭﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻲ ﺣﺴﺪﺍ ﻣﻨﻜﻢ ﱄ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮ ﻣﺜﻞ‬
‫ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻫﺮﻩ ﻓﻘﻄﻌﺖ ﺍﻳﺪﻳﻬﻢ ﻭﺃﺭﺟﻠﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻑ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺮﻭﻥ ﻣﺴﺎﻛﻨﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳉﻨﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻥ ﳝﻮﺗﻮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﺎﻫﺮﺗﻪ ﺍﻣﺮﺃﺗﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ‪‬ﺎ ﺍﳌﺆﻣﻦ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ ﺑﻪ ﻣﺜﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﻗﺪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﱐ ﺭﺏ ﺍﻟﺴﻤﺎﺀ ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺭﺏ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﻗﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﻠﻔﺘﻚ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻧﺖ ﺭﺏ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺳﻜﻨﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳋﻠﻖ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺠﱪ ﻭﺍﺩﻋﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﺑﻮﺑﻴﺔ ﻭﺷﻖ ﺍﻻ‪‬ﺎﺭ ﻭﻏﺮﺱ ﺍﻷﺷﺠﺎﺭ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻣﺮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺴﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﺣﺎﱐ ﻭﺳﻘﻄﺖ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺴﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﳍﻴﺎﻛﻞ ﻭﺍﳌﻨﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻭﺧﺮﺕ ﺍﻷﺻﻨﺎﻡ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻬﻬﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻠﺖ ﺁﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻄﻞ ﻣﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﳉﺮﺍﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﻞ ﻭﺍﻟﻀﻔﺎﺩﻉ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺤﻮﻝ ﻣﺎﺅﻫﻢ‬
‫ﺩﻣﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻜﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﺔ ﺗﺴﻘﻲ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻤﻬﺎ ﻣﺎﺀ ﻓﻴﻌﻮﺩ ﰲ ﻓﻢ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﺔ ﺩﻣﺎ ﻋﺒﻴﻄﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﻌﺾ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺮﻏﻴﻒ‬
‫ﻟﺘﺄﻛﻞ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻓﺘﻌﺾ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻀﻔﺪﻉ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﺗﻠﻒ ﺍﳉﺮﺍﺩ ﻭﺍﻟﻘﻤﻞ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺪﻡ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ ﺍﺑﻨﻴﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ‬
‫ﻭﺗﺒﲔ ﻟﻠﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﻨﻔﻌﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺿﺎﻕ ﺻﺪﺭ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﻣﺪﺍﺭﺍﺓ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﻭﻋﺪﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﻠﻔﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻠﻜﻪ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﺷﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻫﺎﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ‪ .‬ﰒ ﺃﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺮﻋﻴﺔ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻘﺘﻠﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﺨﺮﺝ ﲨﺎﻋﺔ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ‬
‫ﻓﻴﻪ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﺗﺖ ﻧﺎﺭ ﻓﺄﺣﺮﻗﺘﻬﻢ‪ .‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻛﺄﻧﻪ ﺃﺧﺬ ﺑﺮﺟﻠﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻧﻜﺲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺃﺳﻪ ﰲ ﺣﻈﲑﺓ ﻧﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺄﻧﻪ‬
‫ﻳﺴﺘﻐﻴﺚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﻘﻮﻝ ﺇﱐ ﳌﺆﻣﻦ ﲟﻮﺳﻰ ﻭﺭﺑﻪ ﻓﺨﻠﻮﺍ ﻋﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﻋﺎ ﻫﺎﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻫﺬﺍ‬
‫ﺷﻲﺀ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺭﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺃﻣﻦ ﲟﻮﺳﻰ‪ ،‬ﻓﻘﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻫﻮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻋﻤﻞ ﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺮﺅﻳﺎ ﻟﻴﻬﻮﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﺘﺮﻳﺪ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﺒﺪﺍﹰ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻥ‬
‫ﻛﻨﺖ ﺭﺑﺎﹰ! ﻭﺗﺴﺘﺨﻒ ﺑﻚ ﺭﻋﻴﺘﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺴﻠﺐ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ! ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺘﻠﻄﻒ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻨﻌﻪ ﻣﻨﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻳﺒﻌﺚ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺳﺮﺍ ﻭﻳﺴﺘﻨﻈﺮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﰎ ﺍﻷﺟﻞ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻔﻌﻞ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺷﻴﺌﺎﹰ ﻛﺜﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺀ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ ﻭ‪‬ﺪﻣﺖ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻭﻓﺴﺪﺕ ﺯﺭﻭﻋﻬﻢ‬
‫ﻭﻛﺜﺮﺕ ﺍﻵﻳﺎﺕ ﰲ ﻣﻨﺎﺯﳍﻢ ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﻗﺪ ﺧﺎﻓﻮﺍ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻭﻫﺎﺑﻮﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﻳﺆﻣﻨﻮﻥ ﺑﻪ ﺳﺮﺍ‪ ،‬ﻓﻤﻦ ﺁﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ‬
‫ﺯﺍﻝ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺍﻷﺫﻯ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺯﺍﺩ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺃﺣﻀﺮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﺇﻥ ﺃﺟﺒﺘﻚ ﻣﺎ ﱄ ﻋﻨﺪﻙ؟ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺃﺭﺩﺩ ﺷﺒﺎﺑﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﺿﻌﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻤﺮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺁﻣﻨﻚ ﻣﻦ ﲨﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻦ ﺯﻭﺍﻝ ﻣﻠﻜﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻋﻠﻲ ﻳﺪﻙ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻦ ﻧﺎﻭﺃﻙ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻓﻴﻚ‬
‫ﻧﺸﺎﻃﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻛﻠﻚ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻚ‪.‬‬

‫‪154‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺇﻥ ﻓﻌﻠﺖ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﻘﺪ ﺃﻧﺼﻔﺖ ﻓﺎﻧﻈﺮﱐ ﺇﱃ ﻏﺪ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺷﺎﻭﺭ ﻫﺎﻣﺎﻥ ﻓﻤﻨﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﳕﻮﺕ ﻏﺪﺍ‬
‫ﺃﺻﻠﺢ ﻟﻨﺎ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺑﺌﺲ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺄﻃﻠﻖ ﱄ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﳕﺎ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ ﺍﺧﺮﺍﺟﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻠﺪﻱ ﻟﺘﻜﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﻢ‬
‫ﺃﻣﲑﺍﹰ ﻣﻠﻜﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻧﺎ ﺍﻧﺘﻔﻊ ﲞﺪﻣﺘﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﻫﺬﺍ ﺣﺴﺪ ﻣﻨﻚ ﱄ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻟﻪ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻓﺄﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻥ ﻻﺗﺪﻋﻲ ﺍﻟﺮﺑﻮﺑﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﺍﺫﺍﹰ ﺃﻧﻘﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﲔ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺳﻴﻬﻠﻜﻚ ﻭﻳﻬﻠﻚ ﻗﻮﻣﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺗﺼﲑ ﺍﺭﻭﺍﺣﻜﻢ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺭ ﺣﺎﻣﻴﺔ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻓﺈﱐ ﺃﻓﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻣﻌﻚ ﺳﺮﺍ ﻭﻻ ﺍﻓﻌﻠﻪ ﺟﻬﺮﺍﹰ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﺃﻗﺮﺏ ﻟﻶﳍﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺮﺍﺑﲔ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺇﻥ ﺇﳍﻲ ﻻ ﻳﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ ﺃﲨﻌﻮﻥ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺎ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺆﻣﻦ ﺑﻪ ﻭﺣﺪﻙ ﺳﺮﺍ‬
‫ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﻼ ﻳﺮﺿﻴﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻘﺒﻠﻪ ﻣﻨﻚ ﺳﺮﺍ ﺣﱴ ﺗﻈﻬﺮﻩ‪.‬‬

‫ﻗﺎﻝ ﻭﺇﻥ ﱂ ﺗﻔﻌﻞ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺎﻥ ﺍﷲ ﻣﻬﻠﻜﻚ ﻭﺍﻫﻠﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﻋﻼﻣﺔ ﻫﻼﻛﻚ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺒﻘﻰ ﻟﻚ ﻫﻴﻜﻞ ﺇﻻ ‪‬ﺪﻡ ﻭﻻﺻﻨﻢ‬
‫ﺇﻻ ﺧﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺎﻟﻔﺖ ﻣﺎ ﺩﻋﻮﺗﻚ ﺍﻟﻴﻪ ﻣﺮﺍﺭﺍﹰ ﻛﺜﲑﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﺍﺣﺬﺭﻙ ﺍﳋﻼﻑ‪ ،‬ﻭﺇﻥ ﺍﷲ ﺳﻴﻌﺠﻌﻞ ﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻌﻘﻮﺑﺔ ﻭﻻ‬
‫ﻳﻨﻈﺮﻙ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺇﻥ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻃﻮﻝ ﻣﻄﻞ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﲟﺎ ﻭﻋﺪﻩ ﰲ ﺍﻣﺮ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻨﺠﺰﻩ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﺃﻯ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﻳﺮﺟﻊ ﺇﱃ ﺧﲑ ﻭﻻ ﻳﻨﻔﻊ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﻋﻆ‪ ،‬ﻭﺧﺎﻑ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻔﺠﺄ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﻳﺬﺍﺀ ﻛﺜﲑ‪ ،‬ﻓﻌﺰﻡ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﺍﳋﺮﻭﺝ ﻋﻨﻪ ﺑﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺣﻀﺮ ﻟﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻋﻴﺪ ﻛﺎﻧﻮﺍ ﳚﺘﻤﻌﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻣﺮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺘﻌﺮﻥ ﺣﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺄﺧﺬﻥ ﻣﻨﻪ ﻣﺎ ﻳﻘﺪﺭﻥ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺛﻴﺎ‪‬ﻦ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺘﺰﻳﻦ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﻋﻴﺪﻫﻦ‪ ،‬ﻓﻔﻌﻠﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﰒ ﺩﻋﻮ‪‬ﻦ ﰲ‬
‫ﻋﻴﺪﻫﻦ ﻓﺄﻛﻠﻦ ﻣﻌﻬﻦ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻦ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺍﺑﻌﺪﻫﻢ ﻗﻠﻴﻼ ﺇﱃ ﺍﳌﺸﺮﻕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺃﻣﺮﺃﻥ ﻳﺒﻌﺪﻭﺍ ﻫﻨﺎﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﻛﻠﻮﺍ ﻭﺷﺮﺑﻮﺍ ﺃﻟﻘﻰ ﺍﷲ‬
‫ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻄﻴﲔ ﺭﺟﺎﻻ ﻭﻧﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺎﺕ ﺣﱴ ﻣﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﻛﻞ ﺷﻲﺀ‪.‬‬
‫ﰒ ﺳﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﲜﻤﻴﻊ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻭﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﺎﻥ ﻋﺪﺩﻫﻢ ﺳﺘﻤﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﻟﻒ ﻭﺃﺭﺑﻌﲔ ﺃﻟﻔﺎ‬
‫ﻭﻧﻴﻔﺎ‪ .‬ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺗﺎﺑﻮﺕ ﻳﻮﺳﻒ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﻞ ﻭﲪﻠﻮﻩ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪ ،‬ﺩﻟﺘﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺿﻌﻪ ﻋﺠﻮﺯ ﻣﺆﻣﻨﺔ ﻣﻦ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﻀﺖ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﺴﺎﺭ ﺑﺒﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﺇﱃ ﻧﺎﺣﻴﺔ ﲝﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻠﺰﻡ ﻟﻴﺨﻔﻲ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻞ ﻋﺮﻑ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﲞﺮﻭﺟﻬﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻌﻠﻮﻩ ﺑﻨﺴﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﻘﺒﻂ ﻣﻦ ﺇﻋﺎﺭﺓ ﺣﻠﻴﻬﻦ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻻﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻠﻴﺎﺕ ﻭﺩﻋﺎﺋﻬﻦ ﺑﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﺠﻠﺲ ﻟﻮﻗﺘﻪ ﻭﻧﺎﺩﻯ ﰲ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺍﺟﺘﻤﻌﻮﺍ ﺃﻣﺮﻫﻢ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺄﻫﺒﻮﺍ ﻟﻠﺮﻛﻮﺏ ﰲ ﺁﺛﺎﺭﻫﻢ ﻭﺃﺟﻠﻬﻢ ﺛﻼﺛﺔ ﺃﻳﺎﻡ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﺧﺎﻃﺐ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺑﻌﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻴﻮﺷﻪ ﻭﺣﺸﻮﺩﻩ ﺃﻥ ﻻ ﻳﺘﺄﺧﺮﻭﺍ ﻋﻦ ﳊﺎﻗﻪ ﻃﺮﻓﺔ ﻋﲔ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ ﰲ‬

‫‪155‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻡ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺑﻊ ﺭﻛﺐ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻌﻬﻢ ﻳﺘﻘﺪﻣﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﺗﺒﻌﻮﺍ ﺁﺛﺎﺭ ﺑﲏ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﺒﻖ ﺃﺣﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻭﻻﺩ ﺍﳌﻠﻮﻙ‬
‫ﻭﻻ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺗﺒﺎﻋﻬﻢ ﻭﻻ ﻣﻦ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻓﻀﻞ ﺇﻻ ﺳﺎﺭ ﻣﻌﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻴﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﻪ ﻛﻤﻞ ﻋﺪﺩﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺯﺍﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‬
‫ﺳﺘﺔ ﺁﻻﻑ ﺃﻟﻒ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻢ ﳝﺮ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻌﻠﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻋﻼﻣﻬﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺳﻘﻂ‪ ،‬ﻭﻻﺑﺼﻨﻢ ﺇﻻ ﺳﻘﻂ ﻟﻮﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺎﺭﻭﺍ ﻣﻘﺮﺑﲔ ﺣﱴ‬
‫ﳊﻘﻮﻫﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺎﺣﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺃﺣﺲ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ‪‬ﻢ‪ ،‬ﻗﺎﻝ ﻷﺧﻴﻪ ﻫﺎﺭﻭﻥ ﺗﻘﺪﻡ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻭﻛﻨﻪ ﺑﺄﰊ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻭﻣﺮﻩ ﺍﻥ ﻳﻜﻒ‬
‫ﻋﻨﺎ ﻣﻮﺟﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻳﺴﻜﻦ ﻋﻨﺎ ﺣﺮﻛﺘﻪ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺃﺻﻞ ﺃﻧﺎ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻲ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻤﻀﻰ ﻫﺎﺭﻭﻥ ﻟﺬﻟﻚ‪ ،‬ﻭﺭﻛﺐ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﻭﻗﻒ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺿﺮﺑﻪ ﺑﻌﺼﺎﻩ ﻓﺎﻧﺸﻖ‬
‫ﻟﻮﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﻇﻬﺮﺕ ﻓﻴﻪ ﺍﺛﻨﱵ ﻋﺸﺮﺓ ﻃﺮﻳﻘﺔ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﻛﻞ ﺳﺒﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺮﻳﻖ‪ ،‬ﻭﺟﻌﻞ ﺑﻴﻨﻬﻢ ﻃﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﺭﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺎﺀ‬
‫ﻟﲑﻯ ﺑﻌﻀﻬﻢ ﺑﻌﻀﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻡ‪ ،‬ﻭﺩﺧﻞ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﰲ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻫﻢ ﰲ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻫﻢ ﺑﺘﺮﻛﻬﻢ ﺧﻮﻓﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻓﺄﻗﺒﻞ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺑﻔﺮﺱ ﺑﻠﻘﺎﺀ‪ ،‬ﻓﺪﺧﻞ ﰲ ﺃﺛﺮﻫﻢ‪،‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺁﻫﺎ ﻓﺮﺱ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﻗﺘﺤﻢ ﺑﻪ ﰲ ﺍﺛﺮﻫﺎ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﻘﺪﺭ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﻣﺴﺎﻛﻪ‪ ،‬ﻷﻧﻪ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺣﺼﺎﻧﺎ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﻛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻃﺎﻝ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﺍﺗﺒﻌﻪ ﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻋﻦ ﺁﺧﺮﻫﻢ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻢ ﻳﺒﻖ ﰲ ﺍﻟﱪ ﺍﺣﺪ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺘﻮﺳﻄﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻭﻗﺪ ﺧﺮﺝ ﻣﻮﺳﻰ‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻣﻦ ﻣﻌﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺱ‪ ،‬ﻓﺎﻣﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺟﻞ ﺟﻼﻟﻪ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻄﺒﻖ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻗﻮﻣﻪ ﻓﻔﻌﻞ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﺭﺃﻯ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﻗﺎﻝ ﺁﻣﻨﺖ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻻ ﺇﻟﻪ ﺇﻻ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺁﻣﻨﺖ ﺑﻪ ﺑﻨﻮ ﺇﺳﺮﺍﺋﻴﻞ ﻭﺃﻧﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ‪ ،‬ﻭﱂ ﻳﻘﻠﻬﺎ‬
‫ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﺔ‪ .‬ﻓﻠﻤﺎ ﲰﻌﻪ ﺟﱪﻳﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﺭﲨﻪ ﺑﻜﻒ ﻣﻦ ﺍﳊﻤﺄﺓ ﺿﺮﺏ ‪‬ﺎ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﺳﺪ ‪‬ﺎ ﻓﺎﻩ‪ ،‬ﺧﻮﻓﺎ‬
‫ﺃﻥ ﻳﺮﲪﻪ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﻝ‪.‬‬
‫ﻓﻐﺮﻕ ﺍﳉﻤﻴﻊ ﻭﱂ ﻳﻔﻠﺖ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﺃﺣﺪ‪ ،‬ﻭﲪﻠﺖ ﺃﺭﻭﺍﺣﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﺎ ﻫﻠﻜﻮﺍ ﻃﺮﺡ ﺍﷲ ﺗﻌﺎﱃ ﲨﻠﺔ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ‬
‫ﻋﱪ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ‪ ،‬ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻓﺮﻋﻮﻥ ﰲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻣﺮﺗﻔﻊ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻻﺭﺽ‪ ،‬ﺣﱴ ﺭﺃﻭﻩ ﻭﻋﺮﻓﻮﻩ ﻭﺑﲔ ﺍﷲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﻪ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‬
‫ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺃﻧﺰﻟﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺭﺳﻮﻟﻪ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ ﰎ ﻭﻛﻤﻞ ﻛﺘﺎﺏ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ ﻭﻣﺎ ﺃﺑﺎﺩﻩ ﺍﳊﺪﺛﺎﻥ‬
‫ﻭﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﻟﻐﺎﻣﺮ ﺑﺎﳌﺎﺀ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻤﺮﺍﻥ‪ ،‬ﲟﻌﻮﻧﺔ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻗﻮﺗﻪ‪ ،‬ﻓﻠﻪ ﺍﳊﻤﺪ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﻜﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺎ ﺃﻭﱃ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻌﻢ‬
‫ﺍﳉﺴﺎﻡ ﻭﺍﻟﱪ ﻭﺍﻷﻧﻌﺎﻡ‪ .‬ﻋﻠﻰ ﻳﺪ ﺃﺿﻌﻒ ﻋﺒﺎﺩ ﺍﷲ ﻭﺃﺣﻮﺟﻬﻢ ﺇﱃ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﺔ ﻭﺍﳌﻐﻔﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺮﺿﻮﺍﻥ ﻋﺒﺪ ﺍﻟﺮﲪﻦ ﺑﻦ‬
‫ﳏﻤﺪ ﺑﻦ ﳏﻤﺪ ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ﺳﺎﳏﻪ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻏﻔﺮ ﻟﻪ ﻭﻟﻮﺍﻟﺪﻳﻪ‪ ،‬ﻭﳌﻦ ﻛﺎﻥ ﺍﻟﺴﺒﺐ ﰲ ﻛﺘﺎﺑﺘﻪ ﻭﳌﻦ ﻗﺮﺃ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻭﳉﻤﻴﻊ‬
‫ﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﲔ ﻭﺍﳌﺴﻠﻤﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﻭﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﲔ ﻭﺍﳌﺆﻣﻨﺎﺕ‪ ،‬ﺍﻷﺣﻴﺎﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﻢ ﻭﺍﻷﻣﻮﺍﺕ‪.‬‬
‫ﻭﻭﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻍ ﰲ ﻧﺴﺨﻪ ﻳﻮﻡ ﺍﳉﻤﻌﺔ ﺗﺎﺳﻊ ﻋﺸﺮ ﲨﺎﺩﻯ ﺍﻷﻭﱃ ﺃﺣﺪ ﺷﻬﻮﺭ ﺳﻨﺔ ﺍﺛﻨﲔ ﻭﲦﺎﻧﲔ ﻭﲦﺎﳕﺎﺋﺔ ﺃﺣﺴﻦ‬

‫‪156‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻲ ‪‬ﺎ‪.‬‬

‫ﻭﺍﳊﻤﺪ ﷲ ﻭﺣﺪﻩ ﻭﺻﻠﻰ ﺍﷲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻴﺪﻧﺎ ﳏﻤﺪ ﻭﺁﻟﻪ ﺁﻣﲔ ﺁﻣﲔ ﺁﻣﲔ ﻭﺻﺤﺒﻪ ﻭﺳﻠﻢ‪ ،‬ﻭﺣﺴﺒﻨﺎ ﺍﷲ ﻭﻧﻌﻢ‬
‫ﺍﻟﻮﻛﻴﻞ ﻭﻻ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻭﻻ ﻗﻮﺓ ﺇﻻ ﺑﺎﷲ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻲ ﺍﻟﻌﻈﻴﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻐﻔﺮ ﺍﷲ ﺍﻟﻜﺮﱘ‪.‬‬

‫‪157‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺍﻟﻔﻬﺭﺱ‬

‫ﺍﳌﻘﺪﻣﺔ ‪2 ............................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﺪﻧﻴﺎ ‪6 ...................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻷﻣﻢ ﺍﳌﺨﻠﻮﻗﺎﺕ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺁﺩﻡ ‪7 ....................................................................‬‬
‫ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ‪7 .......................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﳉﻦ ﻭﺃﺟﻨﺎﺳﻬﻢ ﻭﻗﺒﺎﺋﻠﻬﻢ ‪8 ....................................................................‬‬
‫ﻓﺼﻞ‪8 ..........................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺮ ﺍﶈﻴﻂ ﻭﻣﺎ ﻓﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺠﺎﺋﺐ ‪12 ..........................................................‬‬
‫ﺧﱪ ﺗﻨﻴﺲ ‪17 .......................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ﻭﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪30 .....................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻭﻟﺪﻩ‪33 .......................................................................‬‬
‫ﺣﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ‪39 ........................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻛﻨﻌﺎﻥ ﺍﺑﻦ ﺣﺎﻡ ‪40 ............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻳﺎﻓﺚ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ‪42 ..............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻳﺄﺟﻮﺝ ﻭﻣﺄﺟﻮﺝ ‪43 ..........................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻘﺎﻟﺒﺔ ‪43 ...................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﻴﻮﻧﺎﻧﻴﲔ‪44 ...................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﲔ ‪44 .....................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻻﻫﺘﺮﺩﺓ ‪45 ...................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﻻﻓﺮﻧﺞ ‪46 ....................................................................................‬‬
‫ﳑﻠﻜﺔﺍﻻﻧﺪﻟﺲ ‪46 ...................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﱪﺟﺎﻥ‪46 ..............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻙ ‪47 ................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﻭﻡ ‪48 ................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺱ ‪48 ...............................................................................‬‬

‫‪158‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬


‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﳑﻠﻜﺔ ﺧﺮﺍﺳﺎﻥ ‪49 .............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺳﺎﻡ ﺑﻦ ﻧﻮﺡ ‪49 ...............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺇﺑﺮﺍﻫﻴﻢ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ‪50 ........................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺍﲰﺎﻋﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ‪50 .......................................................................‬‬
‫ﺣﺪﺙ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺒﻠﺔ ‪51 ....................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﺎﺩ ‪51 ........................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﻨﺎﻕ ﺑﻨﺖ ﺁﺩﻡ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺍﻟﺴﻼﻡ ‪58 ................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺏ ‪59 ...................................................................‬‬
‫ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻴﻤﺎﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﺭﻗﺎﺀ ‪63 ..............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻋﺠﺎﺋﺐ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻭﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﻣﻠﻮﻛﻬﺎ ﻭﻛﻬﺎ‪‬ﺎ ‪64 .....................................................‬‬
‫ﻗﻮﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻫﻨﺔ‪66 ....................................................................................‬‬
‫ﺧﱪ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺎﻥ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ‪67 ........................................................................‬‬
‫ﺃﻭﻝ ﻣﻦ ﺑﲎ ﺍﻻﻫﺮﺍﻡ ‪68 .............................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺼﺮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ‪69 ...................................................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮﺩﺧﻮﳍﻢ ﺍﻟﺒﻠﺪﺓ‪ ،‬ﻭﻛﻴﻒ ﺧﺮﺟﻮﺍ ﺍﻟﻴﻬﺎ ﻭﻧﺰﻟﻮﺍ ‪‬ﺎ ‪70 ..............................................‬‬
‫ﺫﻛﺮ ﻣﻠﻮﻙ ﻣﺼﺮ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻓﺎﻥ ‪95 ...................................................................‬‬
‫ﺍﻟﻔﻬﺮﺱ ‪158........................................................................................‬‬

‫‪To PDF: www.al-mostafa.com‬‬

‫‪159‬‬ ‫ﺃﺧﺒﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﺎﻥ‪-‬ﺍﳌﺴﻌﻮﺩﻱ‬

You might also like